j( PEIHC *^l> •? ^■. iB54-- NOTES, EXPLANATORY ANP PRACTICAL, SECOND EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS EPISTLE TO THE GALATIANS. t. BY ALBERT BARNES NEW YORK: HARPER & BROTHERS, PUBLISHERS, 329 & 33X PEARL STREET, FIRANKLIN SQUARE 1854. Entered according to Act of Congress, in th« year 1839, by Albeut Barnks, in the Office of the Clerk of the District Court of the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. 'A INTRODUCTION § 1. The Design of the Second Epistle to the Corinthians, Ik the Introduction to the first Epistle to the Corinthians, the situation and character of the city of Corinth, the history of the church there, and the design which Paul had in view in writing to them at first, have been fully stated. In order to a full understanding of the design of this epistle, those facts should be borne in distinct remembrance, and the reader is referred to the statement there made as material to a correct understanding of this epistle. It was shown there that an important part of Paul's design at that time was to reprove the irregu- larities which existed in the church at Corinth. This he had done with great fidelity. He had not only answered the inquiries which they proposed to him, but he had gone with great particularity into an examination of the gross disor- ders of which he had learned by some members of the family of Chloe. A large part of the epistle, therefore, was the language of severe reproof. Paul felt its necessity ; and he had employed that language with unwavering fidelity to his Master. Yet it was natural that he should feel great solicitude in regard to the recep- tion of that letter, and to its influence in accomplishing what he wished. That letter had been sent from Ephesus, where Paul proposed to remain until after the succeeding Pentecost (1 Cor.xvi. 8); evidently hoping by that time to hear from them, and to learn what had been the manner of the reception of his epistle. He proposed then to go to Macedonia, and from that place to go again to Co- rinth (1 Cor. xvi. 5 — 7); but he was evidently desirous to learn in what manner his first epistle had been received, and what was its effect, before he visited them. He sent Timothy and Erastus before him to Macedonia and Achaia (Acts xix. 23. 1 Cor. xvi. 10), intending that they should visit Corinth, and commissioned Timothy to regulate the disordered affairs in the church there. It would appear also that he sent Titus to the church there in order to observe the effect which his epistle would produce, and to return and report to him. 2 Cor. ii. 13; vii. 6 — 16. Evidently Paul felt much solicitude on the subject ; and the manner in which they received his admonitions would do much to regulate his own future move- ments. An important case of discipline ; his authority as an apostle ; and the interests of religion in an important city, and in a church which he had himself founded, were all at stake. In this state of mind he himself left Ephesus, and went to Troas on his way to Macedonia, where it appears he had appointed Titus to meet him, and to report to him the manner in which his first epistle had been received. See Note on ch. ii. 13. Then his mind was greatly agitated and distressed because he did not meet Titus as he had expected, and in this state of mind he went for- ward to Macedonia. There he had a direct interview with Titus (ch. vii. .5, 6), and learned from him that his first epistle had accomplished all which he had desired, ch. vii. 7 — 16. The act of discipline which he had directed had been performed ; the abuses had been in a great measure corrected, and the Coriri- thians had been brought to a state of true repentance for their former irregulari- ties and disorders. The heart of Paul was greatly comforted by this intelligence ill IV , INTRODUCTION. and by the signal success which had attended this effort to produce reform. In this state of mind he wrote to them this second letter. Titus had spent some time in Corinth. He had had an opportunity of learn- mg the views of the parties, and of ascertaining the true condition of the church. This epistle is designed to meet some of the prevailing views of the party which was opposed to him there, and to refute some of the prevailing slanders in regard to himself The epistle, therefore, is occupied to a considerable extent in refuting the slanders which had been heaped upon him, and in vindicating his own character. This letter also he sent by the hands of Titus, by whom the former had been sent, and he designed doubtless that the presence of Titus should aid in accomplishing the objects which he had in view in the epistle. See 2 Cor. viii. 17, 18. § 2. The Subjects treated of in this Epistle. It has been generally admitted that this epistle is written without much definite arrangement or plan. It tieats on a vaiiety of topics mainly as they occurred to the mind of the apostle at the time, and perhaps without having formed any defi- nite arrangement before he commenced writing it. Those subjects are all impor- tant, and are all treated in the usual manner of Paul, and are all useful and in teresting to the church at large ; but we shall not find in this epistle the same systematic arrangement which is apparent in the epistle to the Romans, or which occurs in the first epistle to the Corinthians. Some of the subjects of which it treats are the following. (1.) He mentions his own sufferings, and particularly his late trials in Asia. For deliverance from these trials, he expresses his gratitude to God ; and states the design for which God called him to endure such trials to have been, that he might be better qualified to comfort others who might be afflicted in a similar manner, ch. i. 1—12. (2.) He vindicates himself from one of the accusations which his enemies had brought against him, that he was unstable and fickle-minded. He had promised to visit them ; and he had not yet fulfilled his promise. They took occasion, therefore, to say that he was unstable, and that he was afi-aid to visit them. He shows to them, in reply, the true reason why he had not come to them, and that his real object in not doing it, had been " to spare" them. ch. i. 13 — 24. (3.) The case of the unhappy individual who had been guilty of incest, had deeply affected his mind. In the first epistle, he had treated of this case at large, and had directed that discipline should be exercised. He had felt deep solicitude in regard to the manner in which his commands on that subject should be received, and had judged it not best to visit them until he should be informed of the man- ner in which they had complied with his directions. Since they had obeyed him, and had inflicted discipline on him, he now exhorts them to forgive the unhappy man, and to receive him again to their fellowship, ch. ii. 1 — 11. (4.) He mentions the deep solicitude which he had on this subject, and hisi disappointment when he came to Troas and did not meet with Titus as he had expected, and had not been informed as he hoped to have been of the manner in which his former epistle had been received, ch. ii. 12 — 17. In view of the man- ner in which they had received his former epistle, and of the success of his efforts, which he learned when he reached Macedonia, he gives thanks to God that all his efforts to promote the welfare of the church had been successful, ch. ii. 14 — 17. (5.) Paul vindicates his character, and his claims to be regarded as an apostle. He assures them that he does not need letters of commendation to them, since they were fully acquainted with his character, ch. iii. 1 — 6. This subject leads him into an examination of the nature of the ministry audits importance, which INTRODUCTION. y he illustrates by showing the comparative obscurity of the Mosaic ministrations, and the greater dignity, and permanency of the gospel, ch. iii. 7 — 18. (6.) In chs. iv. v. he states the principles by which he was actuated in the ministry. He and the other apostles were greatly afflicted, and were subjected to great and peculiar trials, but they had also great and peculiar consolations. They were sustained with the hope of heaven, and with the assurance that there was a world of glory. They acted in view of that world, and had gone forth in view of it to entreat men to be reconciled to God. (7.) Having referred in ch. v. to the nature and objects of the Christian minis- try, he expatiates with great beauty on the temper with which he and his bra thren, in the midst of great trials and afflictions, executed this important work ch. vi. 1—10. (8.) Having in this manner pursued a course of remark that was calculated to conciliate their regard, and to show his affection for them, he exhorts them (ch. vi. 11 — 18), to avoid those connexions which would injure their piety, and which were inconsistent with the gospel which they professed to love. The connexions to which he particularly referred were, improper marriages and ruinous alliances with idolaters, to which they were particulaijjy exposed. (9.) In ch. vii. he again makes a transition to Titus, and to the joy which he had brought him in the intelligence which he gave of the manner in which the commands of Paul in the first epistle had been received, and of its happy effect on the minds of the Corinthians. (10.) In chs. viii. and ix. Paul refers to, and discusses the subject on which his neart was so much set — the collection for the poor and afflicted Christians in Judea. He had commenced the collection in Macedonia, and had boasted to them that the Corinthians would aid largely in that benevolent work, and he now sent Titus to complete it in Corinth. (11.) In ch. X. he enters upon a vindication of himself, and of his apostolic authority against the accusation of his enemies ; and pursues the subject through ch. xi. by a comparison of himself with others, and in ch. xii. by an argument di- rectly in favour of his apostolic authority from the favours which God had bestowed on him, and the evidence which he had given of his having been commissioned by God. This subject he pursues also in various illustrations to the end of the epistle. The objects of this epistle, therefore, and subjects discussed, are various. They are, to show his deep interest in their welfare — to express his gratitude that his former letter had been so well received, and had so effectually accomplished what he wished to accomplish — to carry forward the work of reformation among them which had been so auspiciously commenced — to vindicate his authority as an apostle from the objections which he had learned through Titus they had con- tinued to make — to secure the collection for the poor saints in Judea, on which his heart had been so much set — and to assure them of his intention to come and visit them according to his repeated promises. The epistle is substantially of the same character as the first. It was written to a church where great dissensions and other evils prevailed ; it was designed to promote a reformation ; and is a model of the manner in which evils are to be corrected in a church. In con- nexion with the first epistle, it shows the manner in which offenders in the church are to be dealt with, and the spirit and design with which the work of discipline should be entered on and pursued. Though these were local evils, yet great principles are involved here of use to the church in all ages; and to these epistles the church must refer at all times, as an illustration of the proper manner of administering discipline, and of silencing the calumnies of enemies. 1* Vi INTRODUCTION. § 3. Tlie time and place in which the Epistle was written. It is manifest that this epistle was written from Macedonia (see ch. viii. 1 — 14, and ix. 2), and was sent by Titus to the church at Corinth. If so, it was writ- ten probably about a year sdFter the former epistle. Paul was on his way to Co- rinth, and was expecting to go there soon. He had left Ephesus, where he was when he wrote the first epistle, and had gone to Troas, and from thence to Mace- donia, where he had met with Titus, and had from him learned what was the effect of his first epistle. In the overflowing of his heart with gratitude for the success of that letter, and with a desire to carry forward the work of reformation in the church, and completely to remove all the objections which had been made to his apostolic authority, and to prepare for his own welcome reception when he went there, he wrote this letter — a letter which we cannot doubt was as kindly received as the former, and which like that accomplished the objects which he had THE SECOND EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS. CHAPTER I. "TDAUL, an apostle " of Jesus *- Christ by the will of God, CHAPTER I. This chapter consists of the following parts, or subjects : 1. The usual salutation and benedic- tion in the introduction of the epistle, ver. 1. 2. This is found in all the epistles of Paul, and was at once an affectionate salutation and an appropriate expression of his interest in their welfare, and also an appropriate mode of commencing an address to them by one who claimed to be inspired and sent from God. 2. He refers to the consolation which he had had in his heavy trials, and praises God for that consolation, and declares that the reason for which he was comforted was, that he might be qualified to administer consolation to others in the same or in similar circum- stances, ver. 3 — 7. 3. He informs them of the heavy trials which he was called to experience when he was in Ephesus, and of his merciful deliverance from those trials, ver. 8 — 12. He had been exposed to death, and had despaired of life, (ver. 8, 9); yet he had been delivered (ver. 10); he desired them to unite with him in thanksgiving on account of it (ver. 11); and in all this he had endeavoured to keep a good conscience, and had that testimony that he had endeavoured to maintain such a conscience toward all, and especially toward them. ver. 12. 4. He refers to the design which he had in writing the former letter to them, ver. 13. 14. He had written to them only such things as they admitted to be true and proper ; and such as he was persuaded they would always admit. They had always received his instruc- and Timothy our brother, unto the church of God which is at al&2Ti.l. 1. tions favourably and kindly ; and he had always sought their welfare. 5. In this state of mind, Paul had designed to have paid them a second visit, ver. 15, 16. But he had not done it yet, and it appears that his enemies had taken occasion from this to say that he was inconstant and fickle-minded. He, therefore, takes occasion to vindi- cate himself, and to convince them that he was not faithless to his word and pur- poses, and to show them the true reason why he had not visited them. ver. 17 — 24. He states, therefore, that his real intentions had been to visit them (ver. 15, 16); that his failure to do so had not proceeded from either levity or false- hood (ver. 17) ; as they might have known from the uniform doctrine which he had taught them, in which he had inculcated the necessity of a strict ad- herence to promises, from the veracity of Jesus Christ his great example (ver. 1 8—20); and from the fact that God had given to him the Holy Spirit, and anointed him (ver. 21,22); and he states, therefore, that the true reason why he had not come to them was, that he wished to spare them (ver. 23, 24) ; he was willing to remain away from them until they should have time to correct the evils which existed in their church, and prevent the necessity of severe dis- cipline when he should come. 1. Paul an apostle, &c. See Notes on Rom. i. 1, and 1 Cor. i. 1. ^ By the will of God. Through, or agreea- bly to the will of God. Note, 1 Cor. i. 1 t And Timothy our brother. Paul was accustomed to associate some other per- son or persons with him in writing his 7 8 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. Corinth, with all the saints " which are in all Achaia : 2 Grace '' be to you, and peace, from God our Father, and from the Lord Jesus Christ. 3pistles. Thus in the first epistle to the Corinthians, Sosthenes was associated with him. For the reasons of this, see Note on 1 Cor. i. 1. The name of Timothy is associated with his in the epistles to the Philippians and Colos- sians. From the former epistle to the Corinthians (ch. xvi. 10), we learn that Paul had sent Timothy to the church at Corinth, or that he expected that he would visit them. Paul had sent him into Macedonia in company with Eras- tus (Acts xix. 21, 22), intending him- self to follow them, and expecting that they would visit Achaia. From the passage before us, it appears that Timo- thy had returned from this expedition, and was now with Paul. The reason why Paul joined Timothy with him in writ- ing this epistle may have been the fol- lowing: (1.) Timothy had been re- cently with them, and they had become acquainted with him, and it was not only natural that he should express his friendly salutations, but his name and influence among them might serve in some degree to confirm what Paul wished to say to them. Comp. Note, 1 Cor. i. 1. (2.) Paul may have wished to give as much influence as possible to Timothy. He designed that he should be his fellow-labourer ; and as Timothy was much younger than himself, he doubtless expected that he would sur- vive him, and that he would in some sense succeed him in the care of the churches. He was desirous, therefore, of securing for him all the authority which he could, and of letting it be known that he regarded him as abun- dantly qualified for the great work with which he was intrusted. (3.) The in- fluence and name of Timothy might be supposed to have weight with the party In tije el^urch that had slandered Paul, fey accusing l]dm pf insincerity or in- stability in ieg^r4 ^^ hi? purposed visit 3 Blessed* 5e God, even the Father of our Lord Jesus Christ, the Father of mercies, and the God of all comfort ; o Ph. 1.1. 6Ro. 1. 7. cEp. 1.3. to them. Paul had designed to go to them directly from Ephesus, but he had changed his mind, and the testimony of Timothy might be important to prove that it was done from motives purely conscientious. Timothy was doubtless acquainted with the reasons ; and his testimony might meet and rebut a part of the charges against him. See ch. i. ver. 13 — 16. t Unto the church of God, &c. See Note 1 Cor. i. 2. 1 With all the saints ivhich are in all Achaia. Achaia, in the largest sense, included the whole of Greece. Achaia proper, however, was the district or pro- vince of which Corinth was the capital. It comprehended the part of Greece lying between Thessaly and the south- ern part of the Peloponnesus, embrac- ing the whole western part of the Pelo ponnesus. It is probable that there were not a few Christians scattered in Achaia, and not improbably some small churches that had been established by the labours of Paul or of others. From Rom. xvi. 1, we know that there was a church at Cenchrea, the eastern port of Corinth, and it is by no means improbable that there were other churches in that region. Paul doubtless designed that copies of this epistle should be circulated among them. 2. Grace be to you, Sec. This is the usual Christian salutation. See Note Rom. i. 7. 1 Cor. i. 3. 3. Blessed be God. This is the com- mencement properly of the epistle, and it is the language of a heart that is full of joy, and that bursts forth with grati- tude in view of mercy. It may have been excited by the recollection that ho had formerly written to them, and that during the interval which had elapsed between the time when the former epistle was written and when this waa penned, he had been called to a mosi severe trial, and that from that trial ho A.D.60.] CHAPTER I. 4 Who comforteth us in all our tribulation, that we may be had been mercifully delivered. With a heart full of gratitude and joy for this merciful interposition, he com- mences this epistle. It is remarked by Doddridge, that eleven out of the thir- teen epistles of Paul, begin with excla- mations of praise, joy, and thanksgiv- ing. Paul had been afflicted, but he had also been favoured with remarkable consolations, and it was not unnatural that he should allow himself to give expression to his joy and praise in view of all the mercies which God had con- ferred on him. This entire passage is one that is exceedingly valuable, as showing that there may be elevated joy in the midst of deep affliction, and as showing what is the reason why God visits his servants with trials. The phrase " blessed be God," is equivalent to ' praised be God,' or is an expres- sion of thanksgiving. It is the usual formula of praise (comp. Eph. i. 3) ; and shows his entire confidence in God, and his joy in him, and his gratitude for his mercies. It is one of innumerable instances which show that it is possible and proper to bless God in view of the trials with which he visits his people, and of the consolations which he causes to abound, f The Father of our Lord Jesus Christ. God is mentioned here in the relation of the " Father of the Lord Jesus," doubtless because it was through the Lord .Tesus, and him alone, that He had imparted the consolation which he had experienced, ver. 5. Paul knew no other God than the * Father of the Lord Jesus;' he knew no other source of consolation than the gospel ; he knew of no way in which God im- parted comfort except through his Son. That is genuine Christian con- solation which acknowledges the Lord Jesus as the medium by whom it is im- parted ; that is proper thanksgiving to God which is offered through the Re- deemer ; that only is the proper acknow- ledgment of God which recognises him as the ' Father of the Lord Jesus.' ^ The Father of mercks. This is a able to comfort them which are in any trouble, by the comfort Hebrew mode of expression, where a noun performs the place of an adjective, and the phrase is synonymous nearly with ' merciful Father.' The expression has however somewhat more energy and spirit than the simple phrase ' merciful Father.' The Hebrews used the word father often to denote the author, or source of any thing ; and the idea in phraseology like this is, that mercy pro- ceeds from God, that he is the source of it, and that it is his nature to impart mercy and compassion, as if he origi- nated it ; or was the source and foun- tain of it — sustaining a relation to all true consolation analogous to that which a father sustains to his offspring. God has the paternity of all true joy. It is one of his peculiar and glorious attributes that he thus produces conso- lation and mercy. 1,And the God of all comfort. The source of all consolation. Paul delighted, as all should do, to trace all his comforts to God ; and Paul, as all Christians have, had sufficient reason to regard God as the source of true conso- lation. There is no other real source of happiness but God ; and he is able abundantly, and willing to impart con solation to his people. 4. Who comforteth us. Paul here doubtless refers primarily to himself and his fellow apostles as having been filled with comfort in their trials ; to the support which the promises of God gave ; to the influences of the Holy Spirit, the Comforter ; and to the hopes of eternal life through the gospel of the Redeemer. ^ Tfiat we may be able to ■ comfort, &c. Paul does not say that this was the only design which God had in comforting them that they might be able to impart comfort to others ; but he does say that this is an important and main purpose. It is an object which he seeks, that his people in their afflictions should be supported and com- forted ; and for this purpose he fills the hearts of his ministers with consolation ; gives them personal experience of the sustaining power of grace in their trials; 10 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 wherewith we ourselves are com- forted of God 5 For as the sufferings " of Christ abound in us, so our consolation also aboundeth by Christ. a Col. 1. 24. and enables them to speak of what they have felt in regard to the consolations of the gospel of the Lord Jesus, t By the comfort, &c. By the same topics of Consolation ; by the same sources of joy which have sustained us. They would have experience; and by that expe- rience they would be able to minister consolation to those who were in any manner afflicted. It is only by personal experience that we are able to impart consolation to others. Paul refers here undoubtedly to the consolations which are produced by the evidence of the pardon of sin, and of acceptance with God, and the hope of eternal life. These consolations abounded in him and his fellow apostles richly ; and sustained by them he was able also to impart like consolation to others who were in simi- lar circumstances of trial. 5. For as the sufferings of Christ abound in us. As we are called to expe- rience the same sufferings which Christ endured; as we ■'are called to suffer in his cause, and in the promotion of the same object. The sufferings which they endured were in the cause of Christ and his gospel ; were endured in endea- vouring to advance the same object which Christ sought to promote ; and were substantially of the same nature. They arose from opposition, contempt, persecution, trial, and want, and were the same as the Lord Jesus was him- self subjected to during the whole of his public life. Comp. Col. i. 24. Thus Peter says (1 Pet. iv. 13) of Christians, that they were " partakers of Christ's sufferings." | So our consolation also aboundeth by Christ. By means of Christ, or through Christ, consolation is abundantly imparted to us. Paul re- garded the Lord Jesus as the source of consolation, and felt that the comfort 6 And whether we be afflicted, it is for "■ your consolation and salvation, which is * effectual in the enduring of the same suffer- ings, which we also suffer : or whether we be comforted, it is a c. 4. 15. » or wrotight. which he imparted, or which was im- parted through him, was more than sufficient to overbalance all the trials which he endured in his cause. The comforts which he derived from Christ were those, doubtless, which arose from his presence, his supporting grace, from his love shed abroad in the heart ; from the success which he gave to his gos- pel, and from the hope of reward which was held out to him by the Redeemer, as the result of all his sufferings. And it may be observed as an universal truth, that if we suffer in the cause of Christ, if we are persecuted, oppressed, and calumniated on his account, he will take care that our hearts shall be filled with consolation. 6. And whether we be afflicted. If we are afflicted ; or, our affliction is for this purpose. This verse is designed to show one of the reasons of the suf- ferings which the apostles had endured ; and it is a happy specimen of Paul's skill in his epistles. He shows that all his trials were for their welfare and would turn to their benefit. He suf- fered that they might be comforted ; he was afflicted for their advantage. This assurance would tend to conciliate their favour, and strengthen their affection for him, as it would show them that he was disinterested. We are under the deepest obligations of gratitude to one who suf- fers for us; and there is nothing that will bind us more tenderly to any one than the fact that ne has been subjc" ted to great calamity and trial on our accoint. This is one of the reasons why the Christian feels so tenderly his obligation to the Lord Jesus Christ. *I It i? for your consolation and salvation. It will be useful for your consolation ; or it is endured in order to secure your com- fort, and promote your salvation. Paul A. D. 60.] CHAPTER I. 11 for your consolation and salva- tion. 7 And our hope of you is steadfast, knowing that as * ye aRo. 8. 17. had suffered in Ephesus, and it is to this that he here particularly refers. He does not mean to say that his sufferings there were particularly for the comfort of the Corinthians; but that they had been endured in the general purpose of promoting the salvation of men, and that they, together with others, would reap the benefit of his trials. He en- dured them in order to spread the true religion, and they would be benefited by that, and besides, he would be the better able by his trials to administer to them the true consolations of the gospel in their sufferings ; and his example, and experience, and counsel, would ena- ble them to bear up under their own trials in a proper manner. % Which is effectual, &c. Margin, wrought. The Greek word in^yov/!A.ivn? denotes here efficacious, operating to, producing,- and the phrase denotes that their salva- tion would be effected, wrought out, or secured by the patient endurance of such sufferings. Those sufferings were necessary ; and a patient endurance of them would tend to promote their salvation. The doctrine that the pa- tient endurance of affliction tends to pro- mote salvation, is everywhere taught in the Bible. See Notes on Rom. v. 3 — 5. % In the enduring. By your endur- ing; or by your patience in such suf- ferings. You are called to endure the same kind of sufferings ; and patience in such trials will tend to promote your salvation, t ^^ whether we be com- forted, &,c. One design of our being comforted is, that we may be able to impart consolation to you in the times of similar trial and calamity. See ver. 4. The sentiment of the whole passage is, that their eternal welfare would be pro- moted by the example of the apostles in their trials, and by the consolations which they would be able to impart as the result of their afflictions. 7. And our hope of you is steadfast. are partakers of the sufferings so shallye he also of the consolation. 8 For we would not, bre- thren, have you ignorant of our We have a firm and unshaken hope in regard to you ; we have a confident ex- pectation that you will be saved. We believe that you will be enabled so to bear trial as to show that you are sustained by the Christian hope ; and so as to ad- vance your own piety, and confirm your prospect of heaven. 1 As ye are par- takers of the sufferings. It is evident from this, that the Corinthians had been subjected to trials similar to those which the apostle had endured. It is not known to what afflictions they were then subjected ; but it is not improbable that they were exposed to some kind of persecution and opposition. Such trials were common in all the early churches; and they served to unite all the friends of the Redeemer in common bonds, and to make them feel that they were one. They had united sorrows ; and they had united joys ; and they felt they were tending to the same heaven of glory. United sorrows and united consolations tend more than any thing else to bind people together. We always have a brotherly feeling for one who suffers as we do ; or who has th^ same kind of joy which we have. 8. For we would not have you igno- rant. We wish you to be fully in- formed. See Note, 1 Cor. x. 1 ; xii. 1. The object of Paul here is, to give a full explanation of the nature of his trials, to which he had referred in ver. 4. He presumed that the Corinthians would feel a deep interest in him and in his trials ; that they would sympathize with him, and would pray that those suf)er- ings, and that this deliverance might be attended with a blessing (ver. 11); and perhaps he wished also to conciliate their kindness towards himself by men- tioning more at length the nature of the trials which he had been called to en- dure on account of the Christian reli- gion, of which they were reaping so , material benefits. \ Of our trouble n II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. trouble" which came to us in Asia, that we were pressed out a Ac. 19. 23. which came to us in Asia. The term Asia is often used to denote that part of Asia Minor of which Ephesus was the capital. See Note, Acts ii. 9. There has been considerable diversity of opinion as to the " troubles" to which Paul here refers. Some have supposed that he refers to the persecutions at Lystra (Acts xiv. 6. 19. 20), from which he had been recovered as it were by mira- cle ; but as that happened so long before this, it seems improbable that he should here refer to it. There is every mark of freshness and recentness about this event ; and Paul evidently referred to some danger from which he had been laieli/ delivered, and which made a deep impression on his mind when he wrote this epistle. Semler supposes that he refers to the lying in wait of the Jews for him when he was about to go to Macedonia, mentioned in Acts xx. 3. Most commentators have supposed that he refers to the disturbances which were made at Ephesus by Demetrius and his friends, mentioned in Acts xix., and by reason of which he was compelled to leave the city. The only objection to this is, that which is mentioned by Whitby and Macknight, that as Paul did not go into the theatre there (Acts xix. 31), he incurred no such risk of his life as to justify the strong expressions mentioned in ver. 9 and 10. They suppose, therefore, that he refers to the danger to which he was exposed in Ephesus on another occasion, when he was compelled to fight there with wild beasts. See 1 Cor. xv. 32. But nearly all these opinions may be reconciled, per- haps, by supposing that he refers to the group of calamities to which he had been exposed in Asia, and from which he had just escaped by going to Mace- donia — referring perhaps more particu- larly to the conflict which he had been compelled to have with the wild beasts there. There was the riot excited by of measure, above strength, in- somuch that we despaired even of life ; Demetrius (Acts xix.), in which his life had been endangered, and from which he had just escaped ; and there had been the conflict with the wild beasts at Ephesus (see Note 1 Cor. xv. 32), which perhaps had occurred but just be- fore ; and there were the plots of the Jews against him (Acts xx. 3), from which, also, he had just been delivered. By these trials, his life had been endan- gered, perhaps, more than once, and he had been called to look death calmly in the face, and to anticipate the proba- bility that he might soon die. Of these trials ; of all these trials, he would not have the Corinthians ignorant ; but de- sired that they should be fully apprized of them, that they might sympathize with him, and that through their prayers they might be turned to his benefit. H That we ivere pressed out of measure. See Acts xix. We were borne down, or weighed down by calamity (£/3i) means to seal up ; to close and make fast with a seal, or signet ; as, e.g., books, letters, &c. that they may not be read. It is also used in the sense of setting a mark on any thing, or a seal, to denote that it is genuine, authentic, confirmed, or approved, as when a deed, compact, or agreement is sealed. It is thus made sure ; and is confirmed or established. Hence it is applied to persons, as de- noting that they are approved, as in Rev. vii. 3: «*Hurt not the earth, 22 Who hath also sealed ' us, b 1 Jno. 2. 20, 27. Re. 3. 18. c Ep. 1.13, 14; 4.30. 2 Ti. 2. 19 neither the sea, nor the trees, till we have sealed the servants of our God in their foreheads." Comp. Ezek. ix. 4. See Note, John vi. 27, where it is said of the Saviour, " for him hath God the Father sealed." Comp. John iii. 33. In a similar manner Christians are said to be sealed ; to be sealed by the Holy Spirit (Eph. i. 13 ; iv. 30) ; that is, the Holy Spirit is given to them to confirm them as belonging to God. He grants them his Spirit. He renews and sancti- fies them. He produces in their hearts those feelings, hopes, and desires which are an evidence that they are approved by God ; that they are regarded as his adopted children ; that their hope is genuine, and that their redemption and salvation are sure — in the same way as a seal makes a will or an agreement sure. God grants to them his Holy Spirit as the certain pledge that they are his, and shall be approved and saved in the last day. In this there is nothing miraculous, or in the nature of direct revelation. It consists of the ordinary operations of the Spirit on the heart, producing repentance, faith, hope, joy, conformity to God, the love of prayer and praise, and the Christian virtues generally; and these things are the evidences that the Holy Spirit has re- newed the heart, and that the Christian is sealed for the day of redemption. 1 And given the earnest of the Spirit. The word here used (uph^J.v from the Heb. ]^:^'^y) means properly a pledge given to ratify a contract ; a part of the price, or purchase money ; a first pay- ment ; that which confirms the bargain, and which is regarded as a pledge that all the price will be paid. The word occurs in the Septuagint and Hebrew, in Gen. xxxviii. 17, 18 ; xxxviii. 20. In the New Testament it occurs only in this place, and in ch. v. 5, and Eph. i. 14, in each place in the same con- nexion as applied to the Holy Spirit, and his influences on the heart. It re- 94 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 and given the earnest of the Spirit " in our hearts. flRo.8.9,14— 16. fers to those influences as a pledge of the future glories which await Christians in heaven. In regard to the " earnest," or the part of a price which was paid in a contract, it may be remarked, (1.) That it was of the same nature as the full price, being regarded as a part of it ; (2.) It was regarded as a pledge or assurance that the full price would be paid. So the * earnest of the Spirit,' de- notes that God gives to his people the influences of his Spirit; his operation on the heart as a part or pledge that all the blessings of the covenant of redemption shall be given to them. And it implies, (1.) Tha; the comforts of the Christian here are of the same nature as they will be in heaven. Heaven will consist of likt comforts ; of love, and peace, and joy, and purity begun here, and simply expanded there to complete and eternal perfection. The joys of heaven differ only in degree, not in kind, from those of the Christian on earth. That which is begun here is perfected there ; and the feelings and views which the Christian has here, if expanded and carried out, would constitute heaven. (2.) These comforts, these influences of the Spirit, are a pledge of heaven. They arc the security which God gives us that we shall be saved. If we are brought under the renewing influences of the Spirit here ; if we are made meek, and humble, and prayerful by ^ his agency ; if we are made to partake of the joys which result from pardoned sin ; if we are filled with the hope of heaven, it is all produced by the Holy Spirit, and is a pledge, or earnest of our future inheritance; — as the first sheaves of a harvest are a pledge of a harvest ; or the first payment under a contract a pledge that all will be payed. God thus gives to his people the assurance that they shall be saved ; and by this ' pledge' makes their title to eternal life sure. 23. Moreover, I call God for a re- cord upon my soul. It is well remarked 23 Moreover I call God for a record upon my soul, that, to by Rosenmiiller, that the second chapter should have commenced here, since there is here a transition in the subject more distinct than where the second chapter is actually made to begin. Here Tindal commences the second chapter. This verse, with the subse- quent statements, is designed to show them the true reason why he had changed his purpose, and had not vi- sited them according to his first propo- sal. And that reason was not that he was fickle and inconstant ; but it was that he apprehended that if he should go to them in their irregular and disor- derly state, he would be under a neces- sity of resorting to harsh measures, and to a severity of discipline that would be alike painful to them and to him. Dr. Paley has shown with great plausibility, if not with moral certainty, that Paul's change of purpose about visiting them was made before he wrote his first epis^ tie ; that he had at first resolved to visit them, but that on subsequent reflection, he thought it would be better to tiy the effect of a faithful letter to them, admo- nishing them of their errors, and en- treating them to exercise proper disci- pline themselves on the principal offender ; that with this feeling he wroto his first epistle, in which he does not state to them as yet his change of pur- pose, or the reason of it ; but that now after he had written that letter, and after it had had all the effect which he desired, he states the true reason why he had not visited them. It was now proper to do it ; and that reason was, that he desired to spare them the severity of discipline, and had resorted to the more mild and aflfectionate measure of sending them a letter, and thus not making it necessary personally to administer disci- pline. See Paley's Horse Paulinaj, on 2 Cor. Nos. iv. and v. The phrase, " I call God for a record upon my soul," is in the Greek, "I call God for a wit- ness against my soul." It is a solemn A. D. 60.1 (m AFTER I. 25 spare you, I came not as yet un- to Corinth. 24 Not for that we have * do- a 1 Co. 3. 5. 1 Pe. 5. 3. oath, or appeal to God ; and implies, that if he did not in that case declare the truth, he desired that God would be a witness against him, and would pu- nish him accordingly. The reason why he made this solemn appeal to God was, the importance of his vindicating his own character before the church, from the charges which had been brought against him. f That to spare you. To avoid the necessity of inflicting pu- nishment on you ; of exercising severe and painful discipline. If he went among them in the state of irregularity and disorder which prevailed there, he would feel it to be necessary to exert his authority as an apostle, and remove at once the offending members from the church. He expected to avoid the ne- cessity of these painful acts of disci- pline, by sending to them a faithful and affectionate epistle, and thus inducing them to reform, and to avoid the neces- sity of a resort to that which would have been so trying to him and to them. It was noj, then, a disregard for them, or a want of attachment to them, which had led him to change his purpose, but it was the result of tender affection. This cause of the change of his purpose, of course, he would not make known to them in his first epistle, but now that that letter had accomplished all he had desired, it was proper that they should be apprized of the reason why he had resorted to this instead of visit- ing them personall3\ 24. Not for that we have dominion, &c. The sense of this passage I take to be this : * The course which we have pursued has been chosen not be- cause we wish to lord it over your faith, to control your belief, but because we desired to promote your happiness. Had the former been our object, had we wished to set up a lordship or dominion over you, we should have corae to you with our apostolical authority, and in 3 minion over your faith, but arc helpers of your joy: for by ''faith ye stand. b Ro. 11. 20. 1 Co. 15. 1. the severity of apostolic discipline. We had power to command obedience, and to control your faith. But we chose not to do it. Our object was to promote your highest happiness. We, there- fore, chose the mildest and gentlest manner possible ; we did not exercise authority in discipline, we sent an af- fectionate and tender letter.' While the apostles had the right to prescribe the articles of belief, and to propound the doctrines of God, yet they would not do even that in such a manner as to seem to " lord it over God's heritage" {oux. Kv^iiui/uiv) ; they did not set up ab- solute authority, or prescribe the things to be believed in a lordly and impe- rative manner ; nor would they make use of the severity of power to enforce what they taught. They appealed to reason ; they employed persuasion ; they made use of light and love to ac- complish their desires. ^ Are helpers of your Joy. This is our main object, to promote your joy. This object we have pursued in our plans, and in order to secure this, we forbore to come to you, when, if we did come at that time, we should have given occasion perhaps to the charge that we sought to lord it over your faith. ^ For by faith ye stand. See Note, 1 Cor. xv. 1. This seems to be a kind of proverbial expres- sion, stating a general truth, that it was by faith that Christians were to be es- tablished or confirmed. The connexion here requires us to understand this as a reason why he would not attempt to lord it over their faith ; or to exercise dominion over them. That reason was, that thus far they had stood firm, in the main, in the faith (1 Cor. xv. 1) ; they had adhered to the truths of the gospel, and in a special vianner now, in yield- ing obedience to the commands and en- treaties of Paul in the first epistle, they had showed that they were in the faith, and firm in the faith. It was not ne- II. CORINTHIANS. fA. D. CO. cessary or proper, therefore, for him to attempt to exercise lordship over their belief, but all that was needful was to help forward their joy, for they were firm in the faith. We may observe, (1*) That it is a part of the duty of minis^ ters to help forward the joy of Chris- tians. (2.) This should be the object even in administering discipline and re- proof. (3.) If even Paul would not attempt to lord it over the faith of Chris- tians, to establish a domination over their belief, how absurd and wicked is it for uninspired ministers now, for indi- vidual ministers, for conferences, conven- tions, presbyteries, synods, councils, or for the pope, to attempt to establish a spi- ritual dominion in controlling the faith of men. The great evils in the church have arisen from their attempting to do what Paul would not do ; from attempt- ing to establish a dominion which Paul never sought, and which Paul would have abhorred. Faith must be free, and religion must be free, or they cannot exist at all. hemarks. In view of this chapter we may re- mark, 1st. God is the only true and real source of comfort in times of trial, ver. 3. It is from him that all real consola- tion must come, and he only can meet and sustain the soul when it is borne down with calamity. All persons are subjected to trial, and at some periods of their lives, to severe trial. Sickness is a trial ; the death of a friend is a trial ; the loss of property or health, disap- pointment, and reproach, and slander, and poverty, and want, are trials to which we are all more or less exposed. In these trials, it is natural to look to some source of consolation ; some way in which they may be borne. Some seek consolation in philosophy, and endea- vour to blunt their feelings and destroy vhcir sensibilities, as the ancient stoics did. But " to destroy sensibility is not to produce comfort." — Br. Mason. Some plungo deep into pleasures, and endea- vour to drown their soirows in the in- toxicating draught ; but this is not to produce comfort to the soul, even were it possible in such pleasures to forget their sorrows. Such were the ancient epicureans. Some seek consolation in their surviving friends, and look to tliera to comfort and sustain the sinking heart. But the arm of an earthly friend is fee ble, when God lays his hand upon us. It is only the hand that smites that oan heal ; only the God that sends the af fliction, that can bind up the broken spirit. He is the " Father of mercies," and he " the God of all consolation ;" and in affliction there is no true comfort but in him. (2.) This consolation in God is de- rived from many sources, (a) He is the " Father of mercies," and we may be assured, therefore, that he docs no- thing inconsistent with mercy. (Z>) We may be assured that he is right — always right, and that he does nothing but right. We may not be able to see the reason of his doings, but we may have the assurance that it is all right and will yet be seen to be right, (c) There is comfort in the fact, that our afflictions are ordered by an intelligent Being, by one who is all-wise, and all-knowing. They are not the result of blind chance ; but they are ordered by one who is wise to know what ought to be done ; and who is so just that he will do nothing wrong. There could be no consolation in the feeUng that mere chance directed our trials ; nor can there be consolation except in the feeling that a being of in- telligence and goodness directs and or- ders all. The true comfort, therefore, is to be found in religion, not in atheism and philosophy. (3.) It is possible to bless God in the midst of trials, and as the result of trial. It is possible so clearly to see his hand, and to be so fully satisfied with the wis- dom and goodness of his dealings, even when we are severely afflicted, as to see that he is worthy of our liighest confi- dence and most exalted praise, ver. 3. God may be seen, then, to be tlm " Fa ther of mercies ;" and he may impart, even then, a consolation which we never experience in the days of prosperity. , Some of the purest and most elevated A. D. 60.] CHAPTER I. joys known upon earth, are experienced in the very midst of outward calamities, and the most sincere and elevated thanks- givings which are offered to God, are often those which are the result of sanc- tified afflictions. It is when we are Drought out from such trials, where we have experienced the rich consolations and the sustaining power of the gospel, that we are most disposed to say with Paul, " Blessed be God ;" and can most clearly see that he is the " Father of mercies." No Christian will ever have occasion to regret the trials through which God has brought him. I never knew a sincere Christian who was not finally benefited by trials. (4.) Christian joy is not apathy, it is comfort, ver. 4, 5. It is not insensi- bility to suffering ; it is not stoical indif- ference. The Christian /ee& his suffer- ings as keenly as others. The Lord Jesus was as sensitive to suffering as any one of the human family ever was ; he was as susceptible of emotion from reproach, contempt, and scorn, and he as keenly felt the pain of the scourge, the nails, and the cross, as any one could. But there is positive joy, there is true and solid comfort. There is substantial, pure, and elevated happiness. Religion does not blunt the feelings, or de- stroy the sensibiUty, but it brings in consolations which enable us to bear our pains, and to endure persecution without murmuring. In this, religion differs from all systems of philosophy. The one attempts to blunt and destroy our sensibilities to suffering ; the other, while it makes us more delicate and tender in our feelings, gives consolation adapted to that delicate sensibility, and fitted to sustain the soul, notwithstand- ing the acuteness of its sufferings. (5.) Ministers of the gospel may ex- pect to be peculiarly tried and afflicted, ver. 5. So it was with Paul and his fellow-apostles ; and so it has been since. They are the special objects of the hatred of sinners, as they stand in the way of he sinful pursuits and plea- sures of the world ; and they are, like their Master, especially hated by the eneiuY of souls. Besides, they are by their office, required to minister conso- lation to others who are afflicted ; and it is so ordered in the providence of God, that they are subjected to peculiar trials often, in order that they may be able to impart peculiar consolations They are to be the examples and the guides of the church of God ; and God takes care that they shall be permitted to show by their example, as well as by their preaching, the supporting power of the gospel in times of trial. (6.) If we sufier much in the cause of the Redeemer, we may also expect much consolation, ver. 5. Christ will take care that our hearts shall be filled with joy and peace. As our trials in his cause are, so shall our consolations be. If we suffer much, we shall enjoy much; if we are persecuted much, we shall have much support ; if our names are cast out among men for his sake, we shall have increasing evidence that they are written in his book of life. There are things in the Christian reUgion which can be learned only in the fur- nace of affliction ; and he who has ne- ver been afflicted on account of his at- tachment to Christ, is a stranger yet to much, very much of the fulness and beauty of that system of reUgion which has been appointed by the Redeemer, and to much, very much, of the beauty and power of the promises of the Bible. No man will ever understand all the Bible wh.> is not favoured with much persecution and many trials. (7.) We should be wilUng to suffer, ver. 3 — 5. If we are willing to he happy, we should also be willing to suffer. If we desire to be happy in re- ligion, we should be willing to suffer. If we expect to be happy, we should also he willing to endure much. Trials fit us for enjoyment here, as well as for heaven hereafter. (8.) One great design of the conso- lation which is imparted to Christiana in the time of affliction is, that they may be able to impart consolation also to others, ver. 4, 6, 7. God designs that we should thus be mutual aids. And he comforts a pastor in his trials, that , he may, by his own experience, be abb S8 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 to minister consolation to the people of his charge ; he comforts a parent, that he may administer consolation to his children ; a friend, that he may comfort 8 friend. He who attempts to adminis- ter consolation should be able to speak fiom experience; and God, therefore, afflicts and comforts all his people, that they may know how to administer con- solation to those with whom they are connected. (9.) If we have experienced peculiar consolations ourselves in times of trial, we are under obligations to seek out and comfort others who are afflicted. So Paul felt. We should feel that God has qualified us for this work; and having qualified us for it, that he calls on us to do it. The consolation which God gives in affliction is a rich treasure which we are bound to impart to others ; the experience which we have of the true sources of consolation is an inesti- mable talent which we are to use for the promotion of his glory. No man has a talent for doing more direct good than he who can go to the afflicted, and bear testimony, from his own experience, to the goodness of God. And every man who can testify that God is good, and is able to support the soul in times of trial, — and what Christian cannot do it who has ever been afflicted? — should regard himself as favoured with a pecu- liar talent for doing good, and should rejoice in the privilege of using it to the glory of God. For there is no ta- lent more honourable than that of being able to promote the divine glory, to comfort the afflicted, or to be able, from personal experience, to testify that God IS good — always good. " The power of doing good, always implies an obli- gation to do it." — Cotton Mather. (10.) In this chapter, we have a case of a near contemplation of death, ver. 8, 9. Paul expected soon to die. He nad the sentence of death in himself. He saw no human probability of escape. He Wis called, therefore, calmly to look death in the face, and to contemplate it as an event certain and near. Such a condition is deeply interesting, it Is the important crisis of hfe. And yet it is an event which all must soon contem- plate. We all, in a short period, each one for himself, must look upon death as certain, and as near to us ; as an event in which we are personally inter- ested, and from which we cannot es- cape. Much as we may turn away from it in health, and unanxious as we may be then in regard to it, yet by no possibility can we long avert our minds from the subject. It is interesting, then, to inquire how Paul felt when he looked at death ; how we should feel ; and how we actually shall feel when we come to die. (11.) A contemplation of death as near and certain, is fitted to lead us to trust in God. This was the effect in the case of Paul. ver. 9. He had learn- ed in health to put his trust in him, and now, when the trial was apparently near, he had nowhere else to go, and he confided in him alone. He felt that if he was rescued, it could be only by the interposition of God ; and that there was none but God who could sustain him if he should die. And what event can there be that is so well fitted to lead us to trust in God as death] And where else can we go in view of that dark hour 1 For, (a) We know not what death is. We have not tried it ; nor do we know what grace may be necessary for us in those unknown pangs and suf- ferings ; in that deep darkness, and that sad gloom, (h) Our friends cannot aid us then. They will, they must, then, give us the parting hand ; and as we en- ter the shades of the dark valley, they must bid us farewell. The skill of the physician then will fail. Our worldly friends will forsake us when we come to die. They do not love to be in the room of death, and they can give us no consolation if they are there. Our pious friends cannot attend us far in the dark valley. They may pray, and commend us to God, but even they must leave xxa to die alone. Who but God can attend usi Who but he can support us then \ (c) God only knows what is beyond death. How do we know the way to his bar, to his presence, to his heaven ! How can we direct our own steps in A. D. 60.] CHAPTER I. that dark and unknown world 1 None but God our Saviour can guide us there ; none else can conduct us to his abode, (d) None but God can sustain us in the pain, the anguish, the fee- bleness, the sinking of the powers of body and of mind in that distressing hour. He can uphold us then; and it is an unspeakable privilege to be per- mitted then, " when heart and flesh faint," to say of him, "God is the strength of" our "heart, and" our " portion forever." Ps. Ixxiii. 26. (12.) We should regard a restoration from dangerous sickness, and from im- minent peril of death as a kind of resur- rection. So Paul regarded it. ver. 9. We should remember how easy it would have been for God to have re- moved us ; how rapidly we were tending to the grave ; how certainly we should have descended there but for his inter- position. We should feel, therefore, that we owe our lives to him as really and entirely as though we had been raised up from the dead ; and that the same kind of power and goodness have been evinced as would have been had God given us life anew. Life is God's gift; and every instance of recovery from peril, or from dangerous illness, is as really an interposition of his mercy as though we had been raised up from the dead. (13.) We should, in like manner, regard a restoration of our friends from dangerous sickness, or peril of any kind, as a species of resurrection from the dead. When a parent, a husband, a wife or a child has been dangerously ill, or exposed to some imminent danger, and has been recovered, we cannot but feel that the recovery is entirely owring to the interposition of God. With in- finite ease he could have consigned them to the grave; and had he not mercifully interposed, they would have died. As they were originally his gift to us, so we should regard each interpo- sition of that kind as a new gift, and receive the recovered and restored friend as a fresh gift from his hand. (14.) We should feel that lives thus preserved and thus rec jvered from dan- ger, belong to God. He has preserved them. In the most absolute sense they belong to him, and to him they should be consecrated. So Paul felt ; and his whole life shows how entirely he re- garded himself as bound to devote a life often preserved in the midst of peril, to the service of his kind Benefactor. There is no claim more absolute than that which God has on those whom he has preserved from dangerous situations, or whom he has raised up from the borders of the grave. All the strength which he has imparted, all the talent, learning, skill, which he has thus pre- served, should be regarded in the most absolute sense as his, and should be honestly and entirely consecrated to him. But for him we should have died ; and he has a right to our services and obedience which is entire, and which should be felt to be perpetual. And it may be added, that the right is not less clear and strong to the service of those whom he keeps without their being ex- posed to such peril, or raised up from such beds of sickness. A very few only of the interpositions of God in our be- half are seen by us. A small part of the perils to which we may be really exposed are seen. And it is no less owing to his preserving care that we are kept in health, and strength, and in the enjoyment of reason, than it is that we are raised up from dangerous sick- ness. Man is as much bound to devote himself to God for preserving him from sickness and danger, as he is for raising him up luhen he has been sick, and de- fending him in danger. (15.) We have here an instance of the principle on which Paul acted, ver. 12. In his aims, and in the manner of ac- complishing his aims he was guided only by the principles of simplicity and sincerity, and by the grace of God. He had no sinister and worldly purpose , he had no crooked and subtle policy by which to accomplish his purposes. lie sought simply the glory of God and the salvation of man ; and he sought this in a manner plain, direct, honest, and straight-forward. He admitted none of the principles of worldly policy which so 11. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. have been so often acted on since in the church ; he knew nothing of " pious frauds," which have so often disgraced the professed friends of the Redeemer ; he admitted no form of deception and dehision, even for the promotion of objects which were great, and good, and desirable. He knew that all that ought to be done could be accomplished by straight-forward and simple-hearted purposes ; and that a cause which de- pended on the carnal and crooked policy of the world was a bad cause ; and that such policy would ultimately ruin the best of causes. How happy would it have been if these views had always prevailed in the church ! (16.) We see the value of a good con- science, ver. 12. Paul had the testi- mony of an enlightened conscience to the correctness and uprightness of his course of life everywhere. He felt assured that his aims had been right ; and that he had endeavoured in all sim- plicity and sincerity to pursue a course of life which such a conscience would approve. Such a testimony, such an approving conscience is of inestimable value. It is worth more than gold, and crowns, and all that the earth can give. When like Paul we are exposed to peril, or trial, or calamity, it matters little, if we have an approving con- science. When like him we are per- secuted, it matters little if we have the testimony of our own minds that we have pursued an upright and an honest course of life. When like him we look death in the face, and feel that we "have the sentence of death in our- selves," of what inestimable value then will be an approving conscience ! How unspeakable the consolation if we can look back then on a life spent in conscious integrity; a life spent in endeavouring to promote the glory of God and the salvation of the world ! (17.) Every Christian should feel himself sacredly bound to maintain a character of veracity, ver. 19, 20. Christ was always true to his word ; and all that God has promised shall be certainly fulfilled. And as a Christian is a pro- fessed follower of him who was " the Amen and the true witness," he should feel himself bound by the most sacred obligations to adhere to all his promises, and to fulfil ah his word. No man can do any good who is not a man of truth ; and in no way can Christians more dishonour their profession, and injure the cause of the Redeemer, than by a want of character for unimpeachable veracity. If they make promises which are never fulfilled ; if they state that as true which is not true; if they overload their narratives with circumstances which had no existence ; if they de- ceive, and defraud others ; and if they are so loose in their statements that no one believes them, it is impossible for them to do good in their Christian profession. Every Christian shoultf have — as he easily may have — such a character for veracity that every man shall put implicit confidence in all his promises and statements ; so implicit that they shall deem his word as good as an oath ; and his promise as certain as though it were secured by notes and bonds in the most solemn manner. The word of a Christian should nf^/^ no strengthening by oaths and bonds; it should be such that it could really not be strengthened by any thing that notes and bonds could add to it. (18.) All Christians should regard themselves as consecrated to God. ver. 21. They have been anointed, or set apart to his service. They should feel that they are as really set apart to his service as the ancient prophets, priests, and kings were to their appropriate offices by the ceremony of anointing. They belong to God, and are under every sacred and solemn obligation to live to him, and him alone. (19.) It is an in estimable ^nwVeg'e to be a Christian, ver. 21, 22. It is re- garded as a privilege to be an heir to an estate, and to have an assurance that it will be ours. But the Christian has an " earnest," a pledge that heaven is his. He is anointed of God; he is sealed for heaven. Heaven is his home; and God is giving to him daily evidence in his own experience that he A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. B CHAPTER II. UT I determined this with myself, that I would not will soon be admitted to its pure and blissful abodes. (20.) The joys of the Christian on earth are of the same nature as the joys of heaven. These comforts are an " earnest" of the future inheritance ; a part of that which the Christian is to enjoy forever. His joys on earth are *' heaven begun ;" and all that is needful to constitute heaven is that these joys should be expanded and perpetuated. There will be no other heaven than that which would be constituted by the expanded joys of a Christian. (21.) No one is a Christian, no one is fitted for heaven, who has not such principles and joys as being fully ex- panded and developed would constitute heaven. The joys of heaven are not to be created for us as some new thing ; they are not to be such as we have had no foretaste, no conception of; but they are to be such as will be produced of necessity by removing imperfection from the joys and feelings of the be- liever, and carrying them out without alloy, and without interruption, and without end. The man, therefore, who has such a character, that if fairly de- veloped would not constitute the joys of heaven, is not a Christian. He has no evi- dence that he has been born again ; and all his joys are fancied and delusive. (22.) Christians should be careful not to grieve the Holy Spirit. Comp. Eph. iv. 30. It is by that Spirit that they are "anointed" and "sealed," and it is by his influences that they have the earnest of their future inheritance. All good influences on their minds pro- ceed from that Spirit ; and it should be their high and constant aim not to grieve him. By no course of conduct, by no conversation, by no impure thought, should they drive that Spirit from their minds. All their peace and joy is dependent on their cherishing his sacred influences ; and by all the means in their power they should strive to secure his constant agency on tlieir souls. come again to you in heavi- ness. " a c. 1.23.12.20,21.13.10. CHAPTER II. In this chapter Paul continues the discussion of the subject which had been introduced in the previous chapter. At the close of that chapter, he had stated the reasons why he had not vis- ited the church at Corinth. See Notes on ch. i. 23, 24. The main reason was, that instead of coming to them in that disordered, and irregular state, he had preferred to send them an affec- tionate letter. Had he come to them personally he would have felt himself called on to exercise the severity of dis- cipline. He chose, therefore, to try what the effect would be of a faithful and kind epistle. In this chapter, he prosecutes the same subject. He states, therefore, more at length, the reason why he had not come to them. ver. 1 — 5. The reason was, that he resolved not to come to them, if he could avoid it, with severity ; that his heart was pained even with the necessity of sending such a letter; that he wrote it with much anguish of spirit ; yet that he cherished towards them the most tender love. In his former epistle (ch. v.) he had di- rected them to exercise discipline on the offending person in the church. This had been done according to his direc- tion ; and the offender had been suita- bly punished for his offence. He had been excommunicated ; and it would seem that the effect on him had been to induce him to forsake his sin, and pro- bably to put away his father's wife, and he had become a sincere penitent. Paul, therefore, in the next place (ver. 6 — 1 1 ), exhorts them to receive him again into fellowship with the church. The pan ishmont he says had been sufficient (ver. 6) ; they ought now to be kind and forgiving to him lest he should be overwhelmed with his sorrow (ver. 7) ; he says, that he had forgiven him, so far as he was concerned, and he entreat- ed them to do the same (ver. 10) ; and says that they oujht, by all means, to 32 II. CORINTHIANS. 2 For if I make you sorry, who is he then that maketh me pursue such a course that Satan could get no advantage of them. ver. 11. Paul then states the disappointment which he had had at Troas in not seeing Titus, from whom he had expected to learn what was the state of the church at Corinth, and what was the reception \ of krs letter there; but that not seeing him there, he had gone on to Macedonia. ver. 12, 13. There, it would seem, he met Titus, and learned that his letter had had all the success which he could have desired. It had been kindly re- ceived ; and all that he had wished in regard to discipline had been performed, ver. 14. The hearing of this success gives him occasion to thank God for it, as one among many instances in which his efforts to advance his cause had been crowned with success. God had made him everywhere successful ; and had made him triumph in Christ in every place. This fact gives him occasion (ver. 15, 16) to state the general effect of his preaching and his labours. His efforts, he says, were always acceptable to God — though he could not be igno- rant that in some cases the gospel which he preached was the occasion of the aggravated condemnation of those who heard and rejected it. Yet he had the consolation of reflecting that it was by no fault of his. ver. 17. It was not because he had corrupted the word of God ; it was not because he was un- faithful ; it was not because he was not sincere. He had a good conscience — a conscience which assured him that he spoke in sincerity, and as in the sight of God — though the unhappy effect might be that many would perish from under his ministry. 1. But I determined this with my- self. I made up my mind on this point ; I formed this resolution in re- gard to my course, t That I would not come again to you with heaviness. In grief (^ivKvTTY). *I would not come, if I could avoid it, in circumstances which must have grieved both me and you. glad, but the same made sorry by me ? [A. I). 60. which ia I would not come while there existed among you such irregularities as must have pained my heart, and as must have compelled me to resort to such acts of discipline as would be painful to you. I resolved, therefore, to endeavour to remove these evils before I came, that when I did come, my visit might be mutually agreeable to us both. For that reason I changed my purpose about visiting you, when I heard of those disorders, and resolved to send an epistle. If that should be successful^ then the way would be open for an agreeable visit to you.' This verse, therefore, contains the statement of the principal reason why he had not come to them as he had at first proposed. It was really from no fickleness, but it was from love to them, and a de- sire that his visit should be mutually agreeable. Comp. Notes, ch. i. 23. 2. For if I made you sorry. * If when I should come among you, I should be called on to inflict sorrow by punishing your offending brethren by an act of severe discipline as soon as I came, who would there be to give me comfort but those very persons whom I had affected with grief? How little prepared would they be to make me happy, and to comfort me, amidst the deep sorrow which I should have caused by an act of severe discipline. Afte- such an act — an act that would spread sorrow through the whole church, how could I expect that comfort which I should desire to find among you. The whole church would be affected with grief; and though I might be sustained by the sound part of the church, yet my visit would be attended with painful circumstances. I resolved, therefore, to remove all cause of diflftculty, if possible, before I came, that my visit might be pleasant to us all.' The idea is, that there was such a sympathy between him and them ; that he was so attached to them, that he could not expect to be happy unless they were happy ; that A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. 33 3 And I wrote this same un- to you, lest, when I came, I fhould have sorrow from them of whom I , ought to rejoice ; though he might be conscious he was only discharging a duty, and that God would sustain him in it, yet that it would mar the pleasure of his visit, and destroy all his anticipated happiness by the general grief. 3. And I wrote this same unto you. The words "this same" (toi/to avro) refer to what he had written to them in the former epistle, particularly to what he had written in regard to the incestuous person, requiring them to excommuni- cate him. Probably the expression also includes the commands in his for- mer epistle to reform their conduct in general, and to put away the abuses and evil practices which prevailed in the church there. ^ Lest luhen I come, &c. Lest I should be obliged if I came per- sonally to exercise the severity of disci- pline, and thus to diffuse sorrow throughout the entire church, t I should have sorrow from them of whom I ought to rejoice. Lest I should have grief in the church. Lest the conduct of the church, and the abuses which prevail in it should give me sorrow. I should be grieved with the existence of these evils ; and I should be obliged to resort to measures which would be painful to me, and to the whole church. Paul sought to avoid this by persuading them before he came to exercise the discipline themselves, and to put away the evil practices which prevailed among them. ^ Having confidence in you all. Having confidence that this is your general character, that whatever adds to my joy, or promotes my happiness, would give joy to you all. Paul had enemies in Corinth ; he knew that there were some there whose minds were alieniated from him, and who were en- deavouring to do him injury. Yet he did not doubt th-at it was the general character of the church that they wished him well, and would desire to make Jim happy ; that what would tend to having confidence in you all, that my joy is the joy of you all. 4 For out of much affliction and anguish of heart I wrote un- promote his happiness would also pro- mote theirs ; and therefore, that they would be willing to do any thing that would make his visit agreeable to him when he came among them. He was, therefore, persuaded that if he wrote them an affectionate letter, they would listen to his injunctions, that thus all that was painful might be avoided when he came among them. 4. For out of much affliction. Pos- sibly Paul's enemies had charged him with being harsh and overbearing. They may have said that there was much needless severity in his letter. He here meets that, and says, that it was with much pain and many tears that he was constrained to write as he did. He was pained at their conduct, and at the ne- cessity which existed for such an epis- tle. This is an eminently beautiful in- stance of Paul's kindness of heart, and his susceptibility to tender impressions. The evil conduct of others gives pain to a good man ; and the necessity of admi- nistering reproof and discipline is often as painful to him who does it, as it is to those who are the subjects of it. ^ And anguish of heart. The word rendered " anguish" (^uvo;)(^>i) means, properly, a holding together or shutting up; and then, pressure, distress, anguish — an af- fliction of the heart by which one feels tightened or constrained ; such a pres- sure as great grief causes at the heart. t / wrote unto you with many tears. With much weeping and grief that I was constrained to write such a letter. This was an instance of Paul's great tenderness of heart — a trait of charac- ter which he uniformly evinced. With all his strength of mind, and all his courage and readiness to face danger, Paul was not asham(>d to weep; and especially if he had any occasion of censuring his Christian brethren, or ad- ministering discipline. Comp, Phil. iiL 88. Acts XX. 31. This is also a speci- TI. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 to you with many tears ; not that, ye should be grieved, but that ye might know the love " which I have more abundantly unto you. a c. 11. 2. men of the manner in which Paul met the faults of his Christian brethren^ It was not with bitter denunciation. It was not with sarcasm and ridicule. It was not Ly blazoning those faults abroad to others. It was not with the spirit of rejoicing that they had committed errors, and had been guilty of sin. It was not as if he was glad of the opportunity of administering rebuke, and took pleasure in denunciation and in the language of reproof. All this is often done by others ; but Paul pursued a diiferent course. He sent an affectionate letter to the offenders themselves ; and he did it with many tears. It was done WEKPiNG. Admonition would always be done right if it was done with tears. Discipline would always be right, and would be effectual, if it were adminis- tered with tears. Any man will receive an admonition kindly, if he who admi- nisters it does it weeping ; and the heart of an offender will be melted, if he who attempts to reprove him comes to him with tears. How happy would it be if all who attempt to reprove should do it with Paul's spirit. How happy, if all discipline should be administered in the church in his manner. But, we may add, how seldom is this done ! How few are there who feel themselves called on to reprove an offending brother, or to charge a brother with heresy or crime, that do it with tears ! ^ Nut tliat ye should be grieved. It was not my ob- ject to give you pain. *[ But that ye might know the love, &c. This was one of the best evidences of his great love to them which he could possibly give. It is proof of genuine friendship for another, when we faithfully and af- fectionately admonish him of the error of his course ; it is the highest proof of atlection when we do it with tears. It e cruelty to suffer a brother to remain 5 But if * any have caused grief, he hath not grieved me, 'but in part: that I may not overcliarge you all. 6 Sufficient to such a man ii 6Ga. 5. 10. cGa. 4. 12. in sin unadmonished ; it is cruel to ad- monish him of it in a harsh, severe, and authoi'itative tone; but it is proof of tender attachment when we go to him with tears, and entreat him to re- pent and reform. No man gives higher proof of attachment to another than he who affectionately admonishes him of his sin and danger. 5. If any have canned grief. There is doubtless here an allusion to the in- cestuous person. But it is very deli- cately done. He does not mention him by name. There is not anywhere an allusion to his name ; nor is it possible now to know it. Is this not a proof that the names of the offending brethren in a church should not be put on the re- cords of sessions, and churches, and presbyteries, to be handed down to pos- terity ? Paul does not here either eX' pressly refer to such a person. He makes his remark general, that it might be «.s tender and kind to the offending brother as possible. They would know whom he meant, but they had already punished him, as Paul supposed, enough, and now all that he said in regard to him was as tender as possible, and fitted, as much as possible, to conciliate hia feelings and allay his grief. He did not harshly charge him with sin ; he did not use any abusive or severe epithets ; but he gently insinuates that he " had caused grief;" he had pained the hearts of his brethren. 1[ He hath not grieved me, but in part. He has not particu- larly offended or grieved me. He has grieved me only in common with others, and as a part of the church of Christ. All have common cause of grief; and I have no interest in it which is not com- mon to you all. I am but one of a great number who have felt the deepest concern on account of his conduct. 1 That I may not overcharge you all. A.D. 60.] CHAPTER II. this * punishment, which was in- flicted "of many. That I may not bear hard (im/^u^Z) on you all ; that I may not accuse you all of having caused me grief. The sense is, < Grief has been produced. I, in common with the church, have been pained, and deeply pained, with the conduct of the individual referred to ; and with that of his abettors and friends. But I would not charge the whole church with it ; or seem to bear hard on them, or overcharge them with want of zeal for their purity, or unwillingness to remove the evil.' They had shown their willingness to correct the evil by prompt- ly removing the offender when he had directed it. The sense of this verse should be connected with the verse that follows ; and the idea is, that they had promptly administered sufficient disci- pline, and that they were not now to be charged severely with having neglect- ed it. Even while Paul said he had been pained and grieved, he had seen occasion not to bear hard on the whole church, but to be ready to commend them for their promptness in removing the cause of the offence. 6. Sufficient to such a man. The incestuous person that had been by Paul's direction removed from the church. The object of Paul here is to have him again restored. For that pur- pose he says that the pimishment which they had inflicted on him was " suffi- cient" It was, (1.) A sufficient expres- sion of the evil of the offence, and of the readiness of the church to preserve Itself pure ; and, (2.) It was a sufficient punishment to the offender. It had ac- complished all that he had desired. It had humbled him, and brought him to repentance; ar>d doubtless led him to put away his wdfe. Comp. Note, 1 Cor. V. 1. As that had been done, it was pro- per now that he should be again restored to the privileges of the church. No evil would result from such a restora- tion, and their duty to their penitent brother demanded it. Mr. Locke has remarked that Paul conducts this sub- 7 So '' that contrariwise ye or, censure. a 1 Co. 5. 4, 5. 1 Ti. 5. 20. &G'a. 6. 1. ject here with very great tenderness and delicacy. The entire passage from ver. 5 to ver. 10 relates solely to this ofiending brother, yet he never once mentions his name, nor does he men- tion his crime. He speaks of him only in the soft terms of " such a one" and "any one:" nor does he use an epithet which would be calculated to wound his feelings, or to transmit his name to posterity, or to communicate it to other churches. So that though this epistle should be read, as Paul doubt- less intended, by other churches, and be transmitted to future times, yet no one would ever be acquainted with the name of the individual. How different this from the temper of those who would blazon abroad the names of offenders, or make a permanent record to car- ry them down with dishonour to poste- rity ! t Which was inflicted of many. By the church in its collective capacity. See Note on 1 Cor. v. 4. Paul had re- quired the church to administer this act of discipline, and they had promptly done it. It is evident that the whole church was concerned in the adminis- tration of the act of discipline; as the words " of many" (utto tw;- TrKuovm) are not applicable either to a single "bishop," or a single minister, or a presbytery, or a bench of elders ; nor can they be so regarded, except by a forced and unnatural construction. Paul had directed it to be done by the assem- bled church (1 Cor. v. 4), and this phrase shows that they had followed his instructions. Locke supposes that the phrase means, "by the majority;" Macknight renders it, « by the greater number;" Bloomfield supposes that it means that the " punishment was car- ried into effect by all." Doddridge j»arn- phrases it, " by the whole body of your society." The expression proves be- yond a doubt that the whole body of the society was concerned in the act of the exconmiunication, and that that is a proper way of administering 36 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. ought rather to forgive him, and comfort him, lest perhaps such discipline. Whether it proves, how- ever, that that is the mode which is to be observed in all instances, may admit of a djubt, as the example of the early churches, in a particular case, does not prove that that mode has the force of a binding rule on all, 7. So that contrariwise. On the other hand : on the contrary. That is, instead of continuing the punishment. Since the punishment was sufficient, and has answered all the purpose of bearing your testimony against the of- fence, and of bringing him to repentance, you ought again to admit him to your communion, t Ye ought rather to for- give him. Rather than continue the pain and disgrace of excommunication. It follows from this, (1.) That the pro- per time for restoring an offender is only when the punishment has answered the purpose for which it was designed ; i. e. has shown the just abhorrence of the church against the sin, and has reformed the offender ; and, (2.) That when that is done the church ought to forgive the offending brother, and ad- mit him again to their fellowship. When it can be ascertained that the punish- ment has been effectual in reforming him, may depend somewhat on the na- ture of the offence. In this case, it was sufficiently shown by his putting away his wife, and by the manifestations of sorrow. So in other cases, it may be shown by a man's abandoning a course of sin, and reforming his life. If he has been unjust, by his repairing the evil ; if he has been pursuing an unlawful bu- siness, by abandoning it ; if he has pur- sued a course of vice, by his forsaking it, and by giving satisfactory evidences of sorrow and of reformation, for a period sufficiently long to show his sincerity. The time which will be required in each case, must depend, of course, somewhat en the nature of the offence, the pre- vious character of the individual, the temptations to which he may be ex- posed, and the disgrace which he may have brought on his Christian calling. a one should be swallowed up with overmuch sorrow. It is to be observed, also, that then his restoration is to be regarded as an act of forgiveness, a favour {^dL^ia-aa-^eu, i. e. ;t*5'?j favour, grace) on the part of the church. It is not a matter of jus- tice, or of claim on his part, for having once dishonoured his calling, he has for- feited his right to a good standing among Christians ; but it is a matter of favour, and he should be willing to humble himself before the church, and make suitable acknowledgment for his offences. % And comfort him. There is every reason to think that this man became a sincere penitent. If so, he must have been deeply pained at the re- membrance of his sin, and the disho- nour which he had brought on his pro- fession, as well as at the consequences in which he had been involved. In this deep distress, Paul tells them that they ought to comfort him. They should receive him kindly, as God receives to his favour a penitent sinner. They should not cast out his name as evil ; they should not reproach him for his sins; they should not harrow up his re- collection of the offence by often refer- ring to it; they should be willing to bury it in lasting forgetfulnesss, and treat him now as a brother. It is a duty of a church to treat with kindness a true penitent, and receive him to their affectionate embrace. The offence should be forgiven and forgotten. The conso- lations of the gospel, adapted to the condition of penitents, should be freely administered ; and all should be done that can be, to make the offender, when penitent, happy and useful in the com- munity. \ Lest perhaps such a one. Still forbearing to mention his name; still showing towards him the utmost tenderness and delicacy. If Should be swallowed up, &c. Should be over- come with grief; and should be render- ed incapable of usefulness by his ex- cessive sorrow. This is a strong expres- sion, denoting intensity of grief. We speak of a man's being drowned in sorrow ; or oterwhelmed with grief, of 4. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. 37 8 Wherefore I beseech you ;hat ye would confirm your love toward him. 9 For to this end also did I gjief preying upon him. The figure here is probably taken from deep waters, or from a whirlpool which seems to swallow up any thing that comes within reach. Excessive grief or calamity, in the Scriptures, is often compared to such waters. See Ps. cxxiv. 2 — 5. " If it had not been the Lord who was on our side when men rose up against us, then they had swallowed us up quick, when their wrath was kindled against us ; then the waters had over- whelmed us,the stream had gone over our soul V then the proud waters had gone over our soul." See Ps. Ixix. 1. " Save me, O God, for the waters are come into my soul." Paul apprehended that by excessive grief, the offending brother would be destroyed. His Hfe would waste away under the effect of his ex- communication and disgrace, and the remembrance of his offence would prey upon him, and sink him to the grave. 8. Wherefore I beseech you that ye would confirm, your love toward him.. The word here rendered confirm (kv^Ztm) occurs in the New Testament only here and in Gal. iii. 15. It means to give authority, to establish as valid, to confirm ; and here means that they should give strong expressions and as- surances of their love to him ; that they should pursue such a course as would leave no room for doubt in regard to it. Tindal has well rendered it, "Wherefore I exhort you that love may have strength over him." Paul referred, doubtless, here to some public act of the church by which the sentence of excommuni- cation might be removed, and by which the offender might have a public assu- rance of their favour. 9. For to this end did I write. The apostle did not say that this was the onbj purpose of his writing, to induce them to excommunicate the offender. He does not say that he wished in an 4 write,thatl might know the proof of you, whether ye be obedient " in all things. 10 To whom ye forgive any oc. 7. 16. arbitrary manner to test their willingness to obey him, or to induce them to do a thing in itself wrong, in order to try their obedience. But the meaning is this : This was the main reason why he lorote to them, rather than to come per- sonally among them. The thing ought to have been done ; the offender ought to be punished ; and Paul says that he adopted the method of writing to them, rather than of coming among them in person, in order to give them an oppor- tunity to show whether they were dis- posed to be obedient. And the sense is, ' You may now forgive him. He has not only been sufficiently punished, and he has not only evinced suitable peni- tence, but also another object which I had in view has been accomplished. I desired to see whether you were, as a church, disposed to be obedient. That object, also, has been accomplished. And now, since every thing aimed at in the case of discipline has been secured, you may forgive him, and should, without hesitation, again receive him to the bosom of the church.' 10. To whom ye forgive any thing. The sense here is, * I have confidence in you as a Christian society, and such confidence, that if you forgive an of- fence in one of your members, I shall approve the act, and shall also be ready- to forgive.' He refers, doubtless, to thig particular case ; but he makes his re- mark general. It is implied here, I think, that the Corinthians were disposed to forgive the offending brother ; and Paul here assures them that they had hig hearty assent to this, and that if they did forgive him, he was ready to join them in the act, and to forgive him also. 1 For if I forgave any thing. If I forgive any thing ; if I remit any of the punishments which have been inflicted by my authority. \ For your sakes. It is not on account of the offender alone ; it is in order to promote the hap- ^ II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. thini^, I forgive also : for if I forgave any thing, to whom I for- gave it, for your sakes forgave I it in the ^ person of Christ ; t or, sight. piness and purity of the church, t In the person of Christ. Locke para- phrases this, "By the authority, and in the name of Christ." Doddridge, " As in the person of Christ, and by the high authority with which he has been pleased to invest me." Tindal, " In the room of Christ." The word rendered person (Marg. sight, Tr^oa-mTrov, from v^o; and w^^), means properly the part to- wards, at, and around the eye. — Robin- son. Then it means the face, visage, countenance ; then the presence, person, &c. Here it probably means, in the presence of Christ ; with his eye upon me, and conscious that I am acting be- fore him, and must give account to him. It implies, undoubtedly, that Paul acted by his authority, and felt that he was doing that which Christ would approve. 11. Lest Satan. The devil. The name Satan denotes an adversary, an accuser, an enemy. It is the usual pro- per name which is given to the devil, the great adversary of God and man. If Should get an advantage of us. The literal translation of the Greek would be, ' That we may not be defrauded by Satan' ("Iva ^» frKtovatrTiB-Z/uiv Ctto rov axTAva). The verb here used denotes to have more than another,- then to gain, to take advantage of one, to de- fraud. And the idea is, that they should at once readmit the penitent offender to their communion, lest if they did not do it, Satan would take advantage of it to do injury to him and them. It is a reason given by Paul why they should lose no time in restoring him to the church. What the advantage was which Satan might gain, Paul does not specify. It might be this : That under pretence of duty, and seeking the purity of the church, Satan would tempt them to harsh measures ; to needless severity of discipline ; to an unkind and unforgiving spirit ; and thus, at the same time, in- 1 1 Lest Satan should get an advantage of us : for we are not ignorant of his devices. 12 Furthermore, when ■ I jure the cause of religion, and ruin him who had been the subject of discipline. 1[ For we are not ignorant of his de- vices. We know his plans, his thoughts, his cunning, his skill. W^e are not ig- norant of the great number of stratagems which he is constantly using to injure us, and to destroy the souls of men. He is full of wiles; and Paul had had abundant occasion to be acquainted with the means which he had used to defeat his plans and to destroy the church. The church, at all times, has been sub- jected to the influence of those wiles, as well as individual Christians. And the church, therefore, as well as indivi- dual Christians, should be constantly on its guard against those snares. Even the best and purest efforts of the church are often perverted, as in the case of ad- ministering discipline, to the worst re- sults ; and by the imprudence and want of wisdom; by the rashness or over- heated zeal ; by the pretensions to great purity and love of truth ; and by a harsh, severe, and censorious spirit, Sa- tan often takes advantage of the church, and advances his own dark and mis- chievous designs. 12. Furthermore. But (•ft). This particle is properly adversative ; but frequently denotes transition, and serves to introduce something else, whether op- posite to what precedes, or simply c-»n- tinuative or explanatory. Here, it is designed to continue or explain the statement before made of his deep affec- tion for the church, and his interest in its affairs. He therefore tells them tna when he came to Troas, and was fa- voured there with great success, and was engaged in a manner most likely of all others to interest his feelings and to give him joy, yet he was deeply dis- tressed because he had not heard, as he expected, from them ; but so deep waa his anxiety that he left Tioas and went A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. came to Troas to preach Christ's gospel, and a " door was opened unto me of the Lord, 13 I had no rest* in ray spirit, a 1 Co. 16. 9. b c. 7. 5, 6, into Macedonia, t When I came to Troas. This was a city of Phrygia, or Mysia, on the Hellespont, between Troy on the north, and Assos on the south. See Note on Acts xvi. 8. It was on the regular route from Ephesus to Ma- cedonia. Paul took that route because on his journey to Macedonia he had re- solved, for the reasons above stated, not to go to Corinth. ^ To preach Christ's gospel. Greek. 'For (si?) the gospel of Christ;' that is, on account of his gospel; or to promote it. Why he selected Troas, or the region of the Troad (Note, Acts xvi. 8), as the field of his labours, he does not say. It is probable that he was waiting there to hear from Corinth by Titus, and while there he resolved not to be idle, but to make known as much as possible the gospel. ^ And a door was opened unto me. See Note, 1 Cor. xvi. 9. There was an opportunity of doing good, and the people were disposed to hear the gospel. This v«ras a work in which Paul delighted to engage, and in which he usually found his highest comfort. It was of all things the most adapted to promote his happiness. 13. I had no rest in my spirit. I was disappointed, sad, deeply anxious. Though the work in which I was en- gaged was that which usually gives me my highest joy, yet such was my anxie- ty to learn the state of things in Corinth, and the success of my letter, and to see Titus, whom I was expecting, that I had comparatively no peace, and no comfort, t But taking my leave of them. Though so many considerations urged me to stay; though there was such a promising field of labour, yet such was my anxiety to hear from you, that I left them, f I went from thence into Macedonia. See Note, Acts xvi. 9. I went over where I expected to find Titus, and to learn the state of your because I found not Titus my brother : but taking my leave of them, I went from thence into Macedonia. 14 Now thanks he unto God, affairs. This is one of the few instances in which Paul left an inviting field of labour, and where there was a prospect of signal success, to go to another place. It is adduced here to show the deep in- terest which he had in the church at Corinth, and his anxiety to learn what was their condition. It shows that there may be cases where it is proper for ministers to leave a field of great and inviting usefulness, to go to another field, and to engage in another part of the great vineyard. 14. Now thanks be unto God, &c. There seem to have been several sources of Paul's joy on this occasion. The principal was, his constant and uniform success in endeavouring to advance the interests of the kingdom of the Re- deemer. But in particular he rejoiced, (1.) Because Titus had come to him there, and had removed his distress. Comp. ver. 13. (2.) Because he learned from him that his efforts in re- gard to the church at Corinth had been successful, and that they had hearkened to his counsels in his first letter ; and, (3.) Because he was favoured with signal success in Macedonia. His be- ing com polled, therefore, to remove from Troas and to go to Macedonia had been to him ultimately the cause of great joy and consolation. These instances of success Paul regarded as occasions of gratitude to God. t Which always causeth us. Whatever may be our efforts, and wherever we are. Whether it is in endeavouring to remove the errors and evils existing in a particular church, or whether it be in preaching the gospel in places where it has been unknown, still success crowns our efforts, and we have the constant evi- dence of divine approbation. This was PauVs consolation in the midst of his many trials ; and it proves that, what- ever may be the external circumstance* 40 11. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. • which always causeth us to tri- umph in Christ, and maketh aRo.8.37. of a minister, whether poverty, want, persecution, or distress, he will have abundant occasion to give thanks to God if his efforts as a minister are crowned with success, t To triumph in Christ. To triumph through the aid of Christ, or in promoting the cause of Christ. Paul had no joy which was not connected with Christ, and he had no success which he did not trace to him. The word which is here render- ed triumph (^-^tctjui^suovri from Q^ia/ji- 0iuai) occurs in no other place in the New Testament, except in Col. ii. 15. It is there rendered " triumphing over them in it," that is, triumphing over the principaUties and powers which he had spoiled, or plundered ; and it there means that Christ led them in triumph after the manner of a concjueror. The word is here used in a causative sense — the sense of the Hebrew Hiphil conju- gation. It properly refers to a triumph ; or a triumphal procession. Originally the wordS-^/ityMjSi? meant a hymn which was sung in honour of Bacchus; then the tumultuous and noisy procession which constituted the worship of the god of wine ; and then any procession of a similar kind. — Passow. It was particularly applied among both the Greeks and the Romans to a public and solemn honour conferred on a victorious general on a return from a successful war in which he was allowed a mag- nificent entrance into the capital. In these triumphs, the victorious com- mander was usually preceded or at- tended by the spoils of war; by the most valuable and magnificent articles which he had captured ; and by the princes, nobles, generals, or people whom he had subdued^ The victor was drawn in a magnificent chariot, usually by two white horses. Other animals were sometimes used. " When Pompey tri- umphed over Africa, his chariot was drawn by elephants; that of Mark Antony by lions ; that of Heliogabalus manifest the savour ^ of his knowledge by us in every place. b Ca. 1. 3. by tigers; and that of Aurelius by deer." — Clark. The people of Corinth were not unacquainted with the nature of a triumph. About one hundred and forty-seven years before Christ, Lucius Mummius, the Roman consul, had conquered all Achaia, and had destroy- ed Corinth, Thebes, and Colchis, and by order of the Roman senate was fa- voured with a triumph, and was sur- named Achaious. Tindal renders this place, *' Thanks be unto God which always giveth us the victory in Christ." Paul refers here to a victory which he had, and a triumph with which he was favoured by the Redeemer. It was a victory over the enemies of the gospel ; it was success in advancing the interests of the kingdom of Christ ; and he re- joiced in that victory, and in that suc- cess, with more solid and substantial joy than a Roman victor ever felt on re- turning from his conquests over nations, even when attended with the richest spoils of victory, and by humbled princes and kings in chains, and when the assembled thousands shouted lo triumphe/ f And maketh manifest. Makes known; spreads abroad — as a pleasant fragrance is diffused through the air. ^ The savour (o 15 For we are unto God a sweet savour of Christ, in them triumphal march of the conqueror. And that odour or savour was acceptable to God — as the fragrance of aromatics and of incense was pleasant in the triumphal procession of the returning; victor. The phrase " makes manifest , the savour of his knowledge,'* therefore, I means, that the knowledge of Christ [ vas diffused everywhere by Paul, as ' the grateful smell of aromatics was diffused all around the triumphing war- rior and victor. The effect of Paul's conquests everywhere was to diffuse the knowledge of the Saviour — and this was acceptable and pleasant to God — though there might be many who would not avail themselves of it, and would perish. See ver. 15. 15. For we are unto God. We who are his ministers, and who thus triumph. It is implied here that Paul felt that ministers were labouring for God, and felt assured that their labours would be acceptable to him. — The object of Paul in the statement, in this and in the fol- lowing verses, is undoubtedly to meet the charges of his detractors and ene- mies. He says, therefore, that what- ever was the result of his labours in regard to the future salvation of men ; yet, that his well-meant endeavours, and labours, and self-denials in preaching the gospel, were acceptable to God. The measure of God's approbation in the case was not his success, but his fidelity, his zeal, his self-denial, whatever might be the reception of the gospel among those v/ho heard it. t A sweet savour. Like the smell of pleasant incense, or of grateful aromatics, such as were burned in the triumphal processions of returning conquerors. The meaning is, that their labours were acceptable to God ; he was pleased with them, and would bestow on them the smiles and proofs of his approbation. The word here rendered " sweet savour" (gyaJk) occurs only in this place, and in Kph. v. 2. Phil. iv. 18 ; and is applied to per- sons or things well-pleasing to God. It 4* " that are saved, and in them that perish : • a 1 Co. 1. 18. properly means good odour, or fragrance, and in the Septuagint it is frequently applied to the incense that was burnt in the public worship of God and to sacrifices in general. Gen. viii. 21. Ex xxix. 18. 2.5. 41. Lev. i. 9. 13. 17; ii 2. 9. 12; iii. 5. 16 ; iv. 31, &c. &c. Here it means that the services of Paul and the other ministers of religion were as grateful to God as sweet incense, or acceptable sacrifices. 1 Of Christ. That is, we are Christ's sweet savour to God : we are that which he has ap- pointed, and which he has devoted and consecrated to God ; we are the offering, so to speak, which he is continually making to God. ^ In them that are saved. In regard to them who believe the gospel through our ministry and who are saved. Our labour in carrying the gospel to them, and in bringing them to the knowledge of the truth, is acceptable to God. Their salvation is an object of his highest desire, and he is gratified with our fidelity, and with our success. This reason why their work was acceptable to God is more fully stated in the following verse, where it is said that in reference to them they were the " savour of life unto life." The word " saved" here refers to all who be- come Christians, and ^ho enter heaven; and as the salvation of men is an object of such desire to God, it cannot but he that all who bear the gospel to men art engaged in an acceptable service, and that all their efforts will be pleasing to him, and approved in his sight. In re- gard to this part of Paul's statement, there can be no difficulty. | And in them that perish. In reference to them who reject the gospel, and who are finally lost. — It is implied here, (1.) That some would reject the gospel and perish,, with whatever fidelity and self-denial the ministers of religion might labour. (2.) That though this would be the result, yet the labours of the ministers of religion would be acceptable to God. This is a fearful and awful declaration, 43 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. and nas been thought by many to be attended with difficulty. A few re- marks may present the true sense of the passage, and remove the difficulty from it. (1.) It is not affirmed or implied here that the destruction of those who would reject the gospel, and who would perish, was desired by God or would be pleasing to him. This is nowhere affirmed or implied in the Bible. (2.) It is affirmed only that the labours of the ministers of religion in endeavour- ing to save them would be acceptable and pleasing to God. Their labours would be in order to save them, not tf) destroy them. Their desire was to bring all to heaven — and this was ac- ceptable to God. Whatever might be the result, whether successful or not, yet God would be pleased with self- denial, and toil, and prayer that was honestly and zealously put forth to save others from death. They would be ap- proved by God in proportion to the amount of labour, zeal, and fidelity which they evinced. (3.) It would be by no fault of faithful ministers that men would perish. Their efforts would be to save them, and those efforts would be pleasing to God. (4.) It would be by no fault of the gospel that men would perish. The regular and proper tendency of the gospel is to save, not to destroy men ; as the tendency of medi- cine is to heal them, of food to support the body, of air to give vitality, of light to give pleasure to the eye, &c. It is provided for all, and is adapted to all. There is a sufficiency in the gospel for all men, and in its nature it is as really fitted to save one as another. What- ever may be the manner in which it is received, it is always in itself the same pure and glorious system ; full of be- nevolence and mercy. The bitterest enemy of the gospel cannot point to one of its provisions that is adapted or designed to make men miserable, and to destroy them. All its provisions are adapted to salvation; all its arrange- ments are those of benevolence ; all the powers and influences which it origi- nates, are those which are fitted to save, r 'to destroy men. The gospel is what it is in itself — a pure, holy, and benevo- lent sj^stem, and is answ^erable only for effects which a pure, holy, and benevo- lent system is fitted to produce. To use the beautiful language of Theo- doret, as quoted by Bloomfield, "We indeed bear the sweet odour of Christ's gospel to all; but all who participate in it do not experience its salutiferous ef- fects. Thus to diseased eyes even the light of heaven is noxious ; yet the sun does not bring the injury. And to those in a fever, honey is bitter ; yet it is sweet nevertheless. Vultures too, it is said, fly from sweet odours of myrrh ; yet myrrh is myrrh though the vultures avoid it. Thus, if some be saved, though others perish, the gospel retains its own virtue, and we the preachers of it remain just as we are ; and the gospel retains its odorous and salutiferous properties, though some may disbelieve and abuse it, and perish." Yet, (.5.) It is implied that the gospel would be the occasion of heavier condemnation to some, and that they would sink into deeper ruin in consequence of its being preached to them. This is implied in the ex- pression in ver. 16. "to the one we are a savour of death unto death." In the explanation of this, we may observe, (a) That those who perish would have pe- rished at any rate. All were under condemnation whether the gospel had come to them or not None will perish in consequence of the gospel's having been sent to them who would not have perished had it been unknown. Men do not perish because the gospel is sent to them, but for their own sins. (b) It is in fact by their own fault that men reject the gospel, and that they are lost. They are voluntary in this ; and, whatever is their final destiny, they are not under compulsion. The gospel compels no ope against his will either to go to heaven, or to helL (c) Men under the gospel sin against greater light than they do without it. They have more to answer for. 'It in- creases their responsibility. If,' there- fore, they reject it, and go down to eternal death, they go from higher pri- vileges ; and they go, of course, to meet A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. 43 16 To " the one %ve are the savour of death unto death ; and a Jno. 9. 39. 1 Pe. 2. 7, 8. a more aggravated condem nation . For condemnation will always be in exact proportion to guilt; and guilt is in pro- portion to abused light and privileges. {d) The preaching of the gospel, and the offers of life, are often the occasion of the deeper guilt of the sinner. Often he becomes enraged. He gives vent to the deep malignity of his soul. He op- poses the gospel with malice and infu- riated anger. His eye kindles with in- dignation, and his lip curls with pride and scorn. He is profane and blas- phemous ; and the offering of the gospel to him is the occasion of exciting deep and malignant passions against God, against the Saviour, against the minis- ters of religion. Against the gospel, men often manifest the same malignity and scorn which they did against the Saviour himself. Yet this is not the fault of the gospel, nor of the ministers of religion. It is the fault of sinners themselves; and while there can be no doubt that such a rejection of the gospel will produce their deeper condemna- tion, and that it is a savour of death unto death unto them ; still the gospel is good and benevolent, and still God will be pleased with those who faithfully offer its provisions, and who urge it on the attention of men. 16 To the one. To those who perish. T[ We arc the savour of death unto death. We are the occasion of deepening their condemnation, and of sinking them lower into ruin. The expression here used means literally, ' to the one class we bear a death-conveying odour lead- ing to their death' — a savour, a smell which, under the circumstances, is de- structive to life, and which leads to death. Mr. Locke renders this, "To the one my preaching is of ill savour, unacceptable and offensive, by their rejecting whereof they draw death on themselves." Grateful as their labors were to God, and acceutable as would to the other the savour of life unto life. And who * is suffi- cient for these things ? h 0. 3. 5, 6. be their efforts, whatever might be the results, yet Paul could not be ignorant that the gospel would in fact be the means of greater condemnation to many. See Notes on ver. 15. It was indeed by their own fault : yet wherever the gospel was preached, it would to many have this result. It is probable that the language here used is borrow- ed from similar expressions which were common among the Jews. Thus in Debarim Rabba, sec. 1, fol. 248, it is said, " As the bee brings home honey to the owner, but stings others, so it is with the words of the law." "They (the words of the law) are a savour of life to Israel, put a savour of death to the people of this world." Thus in Taarieth, fol. 7, 1. " Whoever gives attention to the law on account of the law^ itself, to him it becom.es an aroma- tic of life but to him who does not attend to the law on account of the law itself, to him it becomes an aroma- tic of death " — the idea of which is, that as medicines skilfully applied will heal, but if unskilfully applied will aggravate a disease, so it is with the words of the law. Again, "The word of the law which proceeds out of the mouth of God is an odour of life to the Israelites, but an odour of death to the Gentiles." See Rosenmuller, and Bloomfield. The sense of the passage is plain, that the gospel, by the wilful rejection of it, becomes the means of the increased guilt and condemnation of many of those who hear it. T[ And to the other. To those who embrace it and are saved. Tf The savour of life. An odour, or fragrance producing life, or tending to life. It is a living, or life giving savour. It is in itself grate- ful and pleasant. IT Unto life. Tend- ing to life ; or adapted to produce life. The word Ufe here, as often elsewhere, is used to denote salvation. It is (1.) Life in opposition to the death in sin in which 44 II. CORINTHIANS. 17 For we are not as many, which corrupt * the word of God : but as of sincerity, but as » or, deal deceitfully with. c. 4. 2. all are by nature ; (2.) In opposition to death in the grave — as it leads to a glorious resurrection ; (3.) In opposition to eternal death ; to the second dying, as it leads to life and peace and joy in heaven. See the words "life" and "death" explained in the Notes on Rom. vi. 23. The gospel is " the sa- vour of life unto life," because, (1 .) It is its nature and tendency to produce life and salvation. It is adapted to that ; and is designed to that end. (2.) Be- cause it actually results in the life and salvation of those who embrace it. It is the immediate and direct cause of their salvation ; of their recovery from sin ; of their glorious resurrection ; of their eternal life in heaven. *| And who is sufficient for these things? For the arduous and responsible work of the ministry ; for a work whose influ- ence must be felt either in the eternal salvation, or the eternal ruin of the soul. Who is worthy of so important a charge 1 Who can undertake it without trembling] Who can engage in it without feeling that he is in him- self unfit for it, and that he needs con- stant divine grace ] This is an excla- mation which any one may well make in view of the responsibilities of the work of the ministry. And we may remark, (1.) If Paw/ felt this, assuredly others should feel it also. If, with all the divine assistance which he had ; all the proofs of the peculiar presence of God, and all the mighty miraculous powers conferred on him, Paul had such a sense of unfitness for this great work, then a consciousness of unfitness, and a deep sense of responsibiUty, may well rest on all others. (2.) It was this sense of the responsibility of the minis- try which contributed much to Paul's success. It was a conviction that the results of his work must be seen in the joys of heaven, or the woes of hell, that led him to look to God for aid, and to of God, in the sig-ht speak we ^ in Christ. a He. 11. 27. [A. D. 60 ' of God ' or, of. devote himself so entirely to his great work. Men will not feel much concern unless they have a deep sense of tha magnitude and responsibility of their work. Men who feel as they should about the ministry will look to God foi aid, and will feel that he alone can sus- tain them in their arduous duties. 1 7. For we are not as many. This refers doubtless to the false teachers at Corinth ; and to all who mingled human philosophy or tradition with the pure word of truth. Paul's design in the statement in this verse seems to be to affirm that he had such a deep sense of the responsibility of the ministerial office, and of its necessary influence on the eternal destiny of man, that it led him to preach the simple gospel, the pure word of God. He did not dare to dilute it with any human mixture. He did not dare to preach philosophy, or human wisdom. He did not dare to mingle with it the crude conceptions of man. He sought to exhibit the simple truth as it was in Jesus ; and so deep was his sense of the responsibility of the office, and so great was his desire on the subject, that he had been enabled to do it, and to triumph always in Christ. So that, although he was conscious that he was in himself unfit for these things, yet by the grace of God he had been able always to exhibit the simple truth, and his labours had been crowned with constant and signal success. ^ Which corrupt the word of God. Margin, "deal deceitfully with." The word here used (Ka7rnKivcvri;) occurs nowhere else in the New Testament, and does not occur in the Septuagint. The word is derived from naTniKcs, which signifies properly a huckster, or a retailer of vnne, a petty chapman ; a man who buys up articles for the purpose of selling them again. It also means sometimes a vintner, or an innkeeper The proper idea is that )f a small dealei A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. 45 and especially in wine. Such persons were notorious, as they are now, for diluting their wines with water (comp. Sept. in Isa. i. 22) ; and for compound- ing wines of other substances than the juice of the grape for purposes of gain. Wine, of all substances in trade, perhaps, affords the greatest facilities for such dishonest tricks; and accordingly the dealers in that article have generally been most distinguished for fraudulent practices and corrupt and diluted mix- tures. Hence the word comes to de- note to adulterate ; to corrupt, &c. It is here applied to those who adulterated or corrupted the pure word of God in any way, and for any purpose. It probably has particular reference to those who did it either by Judaizing opinions, or by the mixtures of a false and de- ceitful philosophy. The latter mode would be likely to prevail among the subtle and philosophizing Greeks. It is in such ways that the gospel has been usually corrupted. (1.) It is done by attempting to attach a philosophical explanation to the facts of revelation, and making the theory as important as the fact. (2.) By attempting to explain away the offensive points of revelation by the aid of philosophy. (3.) By attempting to make the facts of Scripture accord with the prevalent notions of philosophy, and by apply- ing a mode of interpretation to the Bible which would fritter away its meaning, and make it mean any thing or nothing at pleasure. In these, and in various other ways, men have cor- rupted the word of God; and of all the evils which Christianity has ever sustained in this world, the worst have been those which it has received from philosophy, and from those teachers who have corrupted the word of God. The fires of persecution it could meet, and still be pure; the utmost efforts of princes, and monarchs, and of Satan to destroy it, it has outlived, and has shone purely and brightly amidst all these efforts; but, when corrupted by phi- losophy, and by " science falsely so called," it has been dimmed in its lus- tre, paralyzed in its aims, and shorn of its power, and has ceased to be mighty in pulling down the strong holds of Satan's kingdom. Accordingly, the enemy of God has ceased to excite per- secution, and now aims in various ways to corrupt the gospel by the admixture of philosophy, and of human opinions. Tindal renders this passage, " For we are not as many are which choppe and chaunge with the word of God" — an idea which is important and beautiful— but this is one of the few instances in which he mistook the sense of the original text. In general, the accuracy of his translation and his acquaintance with the true sense of the Greek text are very remarkable. ^ But as of sincerity. Sincerely ; actuated by unmingled ho- nesty and simplicity of aim. See Note on ch. i, 12. ^ As of God. As influ- enced by him ; as under his control and direction ; as having been sent by him ; as acting by his command. See Note, ch. i. 12. 1 In the sight of God. As if we felt that his eye was always on us. Nothing is better fitted to make a man sincere and honest, than this. ^ Speak we in Christ. In the name, and in the service of Christ. We de- .Jer our message with a deep con- sciousness that the eye of the all-seeing God is on us; that we can conceal nothing from him ; and that we must soon give up our account to him. REMARKS. 1. In this chapter, and in the ma- nagement of the whole case to which Paul here refers, we have an instance of his tenderness in administering dis- cipline. This tenderness was mani- fested in many ways. (1.) He did nothing to wound the feelings of the offending party. (2.) He did nothing in the way of punishment which a stern sense of duty did not demand, (3.) He did it all with many tears. He wept at the necessity of adminis- tering discipline at all. He wept over the remissn»-'ss of the church. He wept over the fall of the offending brother. (4.) He did not mention even the name of the offender. He did not blazon hia fsults abroad ; nor has he left any duo 46 II. CORINTHIANS. [A O.Ofi by which it can be known ; nor did he take any measures which were fitted to pain, unnecessarily, the feelings of his friends. If all discipline in the church were conducted in this manner, it would probably always be effectual and suc- cessful, ver. 1 — 10. 3. We ought cordially to receive and forgive an offending brother, as soon as he gives evidence of repentance. We should harbour no malice against him ; and if, by repentance, he has put away his sins, we should hasten to forgive him. This we should do as individuals, and as churches. God cheerfully for- gives us, and receives us into favour on our repentance ; and we should hail the privilege of treating all our offend- ing brethren in the same manner, ver. 7,8. 3. Churches should be careful that Satan should not get an advantage over them. ver. 11. In every way possible he will attempt it ; and perhaps in few modes is it more often done than in ad- ministering discipline. In such a case, Satan gains an advantage over a church in the following ways. (1.) In inducing it to neglect discipline. This occurs often because an offender is rich, or ta- lented, or is connected with influential families ; because there is a fear of driv- ing off such families from the church ; because the individual is of elevated rank, and the church suffers him to remain in her bosom. The laws of the church, like other laws, are often like cobwebs : Great flies break through, and the small- er ones are caught. The consequence is, that Satan gains an immense advan- tage. Rich and influential offenders re- main in the church ; discipline is re- laxed ; the cause of Christ is scanda- lized ; and the church at large feels the influence, and the work of God declines. (2.) Satan gains an advantage in dis- cipline, sometimes, by too great severity of discipline. If he cannot induce a church to relax altogether, and to suffer offenders to remain, then he excites them to improper and needless severity. He drives them on to harsh discipline for small offences. He excites a spirit of persecution. He enkindles a false zeal on account of the Shibboleth of joctrini He excites a spirit of party, anti cause the church to mistake it for zeal fa truth. He excites a spirit of persecu tion against some of the best men it the church, on account of pretended er rors in doctrine, and kindles the flamet of intestine war ; and breaks the church up into parties and fragments. Or he urges on the church, even in cases where discipline is proper, to needlesp and inappropriate severity; drives the offender from its bosom ; breaks his spirit; and prevents ever-onward his usefulness, his return, and his happi- ness. One of the chief arts of Satan has been to cause the church, in casei of discipline to use severity instead ol kindness ,- to excite a spirit of persecu- tion instead of love. Almost all the evils which grow out of attempts at dis- cipline might have been prevented by a spirit of LOVE. (3.) Satan gains au advantage in cases of discipline, when the church is unwilling to re-admit to fellowship an offending but a penitent member. His spirit is broken ; his use- fulness is destroyed. The world usually takes sides with him against the church, and the cause of religion bleeds. 4. Individual Christians, as well as churches, should be careful that Satan does not get an advantage over them. ver. 1 1. A mong the ways in which he does this are the following : (I.) By inducing them to conform to the world. This is done under the plea that religion is not gloomy, and morose, and ascetic. Thence he often leads professors into all the gayeties, and amusements, and follies of which the world partake. Sa- tan gains an immense advantage to his cause when this is done — for all the in- fluence of the professed Christian is with him, (2.) By producing laxness of opinion in regard to doctrine. Christ intends that his cause shall advance by the influence of truth ; and that his church shal be the witness of the truth. The cause of Satan advances by error and falsehood; and when professed Christians embrace falsehood, or are in- different to truth, their whole influence is on the side of Satan, and his ad van- A. D. 60.] CHAPTER II. 47 tage is immense when they become the advocates of error. (3.) By producing among Christians despondency, melan- choly, and despair. Some of the best men are often thus afflicted and thrown into darkness, as Job was. Job xxiii. 8 — y. Indeed, it is commonly the best members of a church that have doubts in this manner, and that fail into tempta- tion, and that are left to the buffetings of Satan. Your gay, and worldly, and fashionable Christians have usually no such troubles — except when they lie on a bed of death. They are not in the way of Satan. They do not oppose him, and he will not trouble them. It is your humble, praying, self-denying Christians that he dreads and hates ; and it is these that he is suffered to tempt, and to make sad, and to fill with gloom and doubt. And when this is done, it is an immense advantage to his cause. It produces the impression that religion is nothing but gloom and me- lancholy, and the people of the world are easily led to hate and avoid it. Chris- tians, therefore, should be cheerful, and benevolent, and happy — as they may be — lest Satan should get an advantage over them. (4.) By fanaticism. For when Satan finds that he can get no advantage over Christians by inducing them to do nothing, or to do any thing positively wrong or immoral, he drives them on with over-heated and ill-timed zeal ; he makes them unreasonably strermous for some single opinion or measure ; he disposes them to oppose and persecute all who do not fall into their views, and feel as they feel. (5.) By contentions and strifes. Satan often gets an advantage in that way. No matter what the cause may be, whether it be for doctrines, or for any other cause, yet the very fact that there are contentions among the professed follow- ers of " the Prince of peace" does in- jury, and gives Satan an advantage. No small part of his efforts, therefore, have been to excite contentions among Christians, an effort in which he has been, and is still, eminently success- ful. 5. Satan gets an advantage over sin- ners, and they should be on their guard. He does it, (1.) By producing a sense of security in their present condition ; and by leading them to indifference in regard to their eternal condition. In this he is eminently successful; and when this is gained, all is gained that his cause demands. It is impossible to conceive of greater success in any thing than Satan has in producing a state of indifference to the subject of religion among men. (2.) By inducing them to defer attention to religion to some future time. This is an advantage, because, («) It accomplishes all he wishes at present ; (b) Because it is usually successful altogether. It is usually the same thing as resolving not to attend to religion at all. (3.) By producing false views of religion. He represents it at one time as gloomy, sad, and melancholy ; at an- other, as so easy, that it may be ob- tained whenever they please ; at another, by persuading them that their sins are so great that they cannot be forgiven. One great object of Satan is to blind the minds of sinners lo the true nature of religion ; and in this he is usually successful. (4.) He deludes the aged by telling them it is too late ; and the young by telling them that now is the time for mirth and pleasure, and that reli- gion may be attended to at some future period of life. (5.) He gains an advan- tage by plunging the sinner deeper and deeper in sin ; inducing him to listen to the voice of temptation ; by making him the companion of the wicked ; and by deluding him with the promises of plea- sure, honour, and gain in this world until it is too late, and he dies. 6. Ministers of the gospel may have occasion to triumph in the success of their work. Paul always met with success of some kind ; always had soma cause of triumph. In all his trials, he had occasion of rejoicing, and alwaya was assured that he was pursuing that course which would lead him ultimately to triumph, ver. 14. 7. The gospel may be so preached as to be successful, ver. 14. In the hands of Paul it was successful. So it was with the other apostles. So it was 48 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 with Luther, Knox, Calvin. So it was with Whitefield, Edwards, Wesley, and Payson. If ministers are not successful, it is not the fault of the gospel. It is adapted to do good, and to save men ; and it may he so preached as to accom- plish those great ends. If all ministers were as self-denying, and laborious, and prayerful as were these men, the gospel would be as successful now as it has ever been, 8. Much of the work of the ministry Is pleasant and delightful. It is the savour of hfe unto life. ver. 16, 16. There is no joy on earth of a higher and purer character than that which the ministers of the gospel have in the success of their work. There is no work more pleasant than that of im- parting the consolations of religion to the sick, and the afflicted ; than that of directing inquiring sinners to the Lamb of God; no joy on earth so pure and elevated as that which a pastor has in a revival ot religion. In the evidence that God accepts his labours, and that to many his message is a savour of life unto life, there is a joy which no other pursuit can furnish; a joy, even on earth, which is more than a compensa- tion for all the toils, self-denials, and trials of the ministry. 9. In view of the happy and saving results of the work of the ministry, we see the importance of the work. Those results are to be seen in heaven. They are to enter into the eternal destiny of the righteous. They are to be seen in the felicity and holiness of those who shall be redeemed from death. The very happiness of heaven, therefore, is dependent on the fidelity and success of the ministry. This work stretches be- yond the grave. It reaches into eternity. It is to be seen in heaven. Other plans and labours of men terminate at death. But the work of the ministry reaches in its results into the skies ; and is to be seen ever onward in eternity. Well might the apostle ask, " Who is sufficient for these things'?" 10. The ministers of the gospel will be accepted of God, if faithful, whatever may be the result of their labours ; whether seen in the salvation, or the augmented condemnation of those who hear them. ver. 15. They are a sweet savour to God. Their acceptance with him depends not on the measure of their success ; but on their fidelity. If men reject the gospel, and make it the occa- sion of their greater condemnation, the fault is not that of ministers, but is their own. If men are faithful, God accepts their efforts ; and even if many reject the message and perish, still a faithful ministry will not be to blame. That such results should follow from their ministry, indeed, increases their respon sibility, and makes their office more awful, but it will not render them less acceptable in their labours in the sight of God. 11. We are to anticipate that the ministry will be the means of the deeper condemnation of many who hear the gospel, ver. 16. The gospel is to them a savour of death unto death. We are to expect that many will reject and despise the message, and sink into deeper ."in, and condemnation, and wo. We are not to be disappointed, there- fore, when we see such effects follow, and when the sinner sinks into a deeper hell from under the ministry of the gospel. It always has been the case, and we have reason to suppose it always will be. And painful as is the fact, yet ministers must make up their minds to witness this deeply painful result of their work. 12. The ministry is a deeply and aw- fully responsible work. ver. 16. It is connected with the everlasting happi- ness, or the deep and eternsd condemna- tion of all those who hear the gospel. Every sermon that is preached is mak- ing an impression that will never bo obliterated, and producing an effect that will never termmate. Its effects will never all be seen until the day of judg- ment, and in the awful solemnities of the eternal world. Well might Paul ask, " Who is sulficient for these things 1" 13. It is a solemn thing to hear the gospel. If it is solemn for a minister to dispense it, it is not less solemn to hear it. It is connected with the eter A D 60.] CHAPTER II. 49 nal welfare of those who hear. And tnoughtless as are multitudes who hear it, yet it is deeply to affect them hereafter. If they ever embrace it, they will owe their eternal salvation to it ; if they con- tinue to neglect it, it will sink them deep and forever in the world of wo. Every imlividual, therefore, who hears the gos- pel dispensed, no matter by whom, should remember that he is listening to God's solemn message to men ; and that it will ard must exert a deep influence on his eternal doom. 14. A people should pray much for a minister. Paul often entreated the churches to which he wrote to pray for him. If Paul needed the prayers of Christians, assuredly Christians now do. Prayer for a minister is demaoled be- cause, (1.) He has the same infirmities, conflicts, and temptations which other Christians have. (2.) He has those which are peculiar, and which grow out of the very nature of his office ; for the warfare of Satan is earned on mainly with the leaders of the army of God. (3.) He is engaged in a great and most responsible work — the greatest work ever committed to mortal man. (4.) His success will be generally in propor- tion as a people pray for him. The welfare of a people, therefore, is identi- fied with their praying for their minister. He will preach better, and they will hear better, just in proportion as they pray for him. His preaching will be dull, dry, heavy ; will be without unc- tion, spirituality and life, unless they pray for him ; and their hearing will be dull, lifeless, and uninterested, unless the.y pray for him. No people will hear the gospel to much advantage who do not feel anxiety enough about it to pray for their minister. 15. The intei-view between a minis- ter and his people in the day of judg- ment will be a very solemn one. Then the effect of his ministry will be seen. Then it will be known to whom it was a savour of life unto life, and to whom it was a savour of death unto death. Then the eternal destiny of all will be 5 settled. Then the faithful minister will be attended to heaven by all to whom his ministry has been a savour of life unto life ; and then he will part forever with all whom he so oft«n warned and entreated in vain. In dis- tant worlds — worlds forever separated — shall be experienced the result of his labours. O ! how solemn must be the scene when he must give up his account for the manner in which he has preach- ed ; and thei/y for the manner in which they attended on his ministry ! 16. Let all ministers, then, be care- ful that they do not corrupt the word of God. ver. 17. Let them preach it in simplicity and in truth. Let them not preach philosophy, or metaphysics, or their own fancy, or the tradition of men, or the teaching of the schools, but the simple truth as it is in Jesus. Let them preach as sent hy God ; as in the sight of God ; as commissioned by Christ to deliver a simple, plain, pure message to mankind, whether they will hear or forbear. Their success will be in pro- portion to the simplicity and purity of the gospel which they present; their peace and joy in death and in heaven will be just as they shall have evidence then that in simplicity and sino^-M"ity they have endeavoured to prcbrnt every- where, and to all, the pure ano simple gospel of Jesus Christ. As ministers, therefore, desire acceptance with God and success in the work, let them preach the pure gospel; not adulterating it with foreign admixtures; not endea- vouring to change it so as to be pala- table to the carnal mind ; not substitut- ing philosophylFor the gospel, and not withholding any thing in the gospel be- cause men do not love it; and let the people of God everywhere sustain the ministry by their prayers, and aid them in their work by daily commending them to the God of grace. So shall they be able to perform the solemn functions of their office to divine accept- ance ; and so shall ministers and people find the gospel to be "a savour of lifo unto life." 50 D II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 CHAPTER m. O we begin again to com- mend " ourselves ? or need CHAPTER III. This chapter is closely connected in its design with the preceding. Paul had said in that chapter (ver. 14), that he had always occasion to triumph in the success which he had, and that God always blessed his labours; and espe- cially had spoken, in the close of the previous chapter (ver. 17), of his sin- cerity as contrasted with the conduct of some who corrupted the word of God. This tnight appear to some as if he de- signed to commend himself to them, or that he had said this for the purpose of securing their favour. It is probable also, that the false teachers at Corinth had been introduced there by letters of recommendation, perhaps from Judea. In reply to this, Paul intimates (ver. 1) that this was not his design ; (ver. 2) that he had no need of letters of recom- mendation to them, since (ver. 2, 3) they were his commendatory epistle ; they were themselves the best evidence of his zeal, fidelity, and success in his labours. He could appeal to them as the best proof that he was qualified for the apostolic office. His success among them, he says (ver. 4), was a ground of his trusting in God, an evidence of nis acceptance. Yet, as if he should seem to rely on his own strength, and to boast of what he had done, he says (ver. 5) that his success was not owing to any strength which he had, or to any skill of his own, but entirely to the aid which he had received from God. It was God, he says (ver. 6), who had qualified him to preach, and had given him grace to be an able minister of the New Testament. It is not improbable that the false teachers, being of Jewish origin, in Co- rinth, had commended the laws and in- stitutions of Moses as being of superior clearness, and even as excelling the gos- pel of Ckrist. Paul takes occasion, therefore (ver. 7 — 11), to show that the laws and institutions of Moses were far we, as some others, epistles ' of commendation to yon, or let- a c. 5. 12. Ac. 18. 27. inferior in this respect to the gospel. His was a ministration of death (ver. 7) ; though glorious it v^as to be done away (ver. 7) ; the ministration of the Spirit was therefore to be presumed to be far more glorious (ver. 8) ; the one was a ministration to condemnation, the other of righteousness (ver. 9) ; the one had comparatively no glory, being so much surpassed by the other (ver. 1 0) ; and the former was to be done away, while the latter was to remain, and was therefore far more glorious, ver. 11. This statement of the important dif- ference between the laws of Moses and the gospel, is further illustrated by show- ing the effect which the institutions of Moses had had on the Jews themselves, ver. 12 — 15. That effect was to blind them. Moses had put a veil over his face (ver. 13), and the effect had been that the nation was blinded in reading the Old Testament, and had no just views of the true meaning of their own Scriptures, ver. 14, 15. Yet, Paul says, that that veil should be taken away. ver. 16 — 18. It was the intention of God that it should be re- moved. When that people should turn again to the Lord, it should be taken away. ver. 16. It was done where the Spirit of the Lord was. ver. 17. It was done in fact in regard to all true Chris- tians, ver. 18. They were permitted to behold the glory of the Lord as in a glass, and they were changed into the same image. The same subject is con- tinued in ch. iv., where Paul illustrates the effect of this clear revelation of the gospel, as compared with the institutions of Moses, on the Christian ministry. 1. Do we begin again. This is de- signed evidently to meet an objection. He had been speaking of his triumph in the ministry (ch. ii. 14), and of his sincerity and honesty, as contrasted with the conduct of many who corrupt ed the word of God. ch. ii. 17. IJ might be objected that he was magnify A. D.60.J CHAPTER III. 51 ters of commendation from you ? ing himself in these statements, and designed to commend himself in this manner to the Corinthians. To this he raphes in the following verses. ^ I'o commend ourselves? To recommend ourselves ; do we speak this in our own praise, in order to obtain your favour. 1 Or need we, as some others. Probably Borne who had brought letters of recom- mendation to them from Judea. The false teachers at Corinth had been ori- ginally introduced there by commend- atory letters from abroad. These were letters of introduction, and were com- mon among the Greeks, the Romans, and the Jews, as they are now. They were usually given to persons who were about to travel, as there were no inns, and as travellers were dependent on the hospitality of those among whom they travelled. ^ Of commendation from you. To other churches. It is im- plied here by Paul, that he sought no such letters ; that he travelled without them ; and that he depended on his zeal, and self-denial, and success to make him known, and to give him the affections of those to whom he ministered — a much better recommendation than mere in- troductory letters. Such letters were, however, sometimes given by Chris- tians, and are by no means improper. Acts xviii. 27. Yet, they do not ap- pear to have been sought or used by the apostles generally. They depended on their miraculous endowments, and on the attending grace of God to make them known. 3. Ye are our epistle. Comp. 1 Cor. ix. 2. This is a most beautiful and happy turn given to the whole subject. The sense is plain. It is, that the con- version of the Corinthians, under the faithful labours of the apostle, was a better testimonial of his character and 2 Ye are our epistle, writ- a 1 Co. 9. 2. fidelity than any letters could be. To see the force of this, it must be remem- bered, (1.) That Corinth was an ex- ceedingly dissolute and abandoned place (see the Introduction to the first epistle) ; (2.) That a large number of them had been converted, and a church organized ; (3.) That their conversion, and the or- ganization of a church in such a city were events that would be known abroad ; and, (4.) That it had been ac complished entirely under the labour o| Paul and his companions. To their knowledge of him, therefore, and to his success there, he could confidently ap peal as a testimonial of his character. The characteristics of this commendato- ry epistle, he proceeds immediately to state. The general sense is, that they were the letter of recommendation which God had given to him ; and that their conversion under his ministry was the public testimonial of his character which all might see and read. ^ Written in our hearts. A few MSS. and versions read thus, "your hearts;" and Dod- dridge has adopted this reading, and supposes that it means that the change produced not only in their external conduct, but in their inward temper, was so great, that all must see that it was an unanswerable attestation to his ministry. But there is not sufficient authority for changing the text ; nor is it necessary. The sense is, probably, that this letter was, as it were, written on his heart. It was not merely that Paul had a ten der affection for them, as Clarke sup poses ; nor was it that he regarded them as " a copy of the letter of recom- mendation from Christ written in his heart," according to the fanciful conceit of Macknight ; but Paul's idea seems to have been ^is. He is speaking of the testimonial which he had from God. That testimonial consisted in the con- version of the Corinthians. This he says was written on his heart. It was not a cold letter of introduction, but it was such as, while it left him no room to doubt that God had sent him, also affected his feelings, and was engraven on his soul. It was to him, therefore, far more valuable than any mere letter of commendation or of introduction could be. It was a direct testimonial from God to his own heart of his ap- 62 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 ten in our hearts, known and read of all men : 3 Forasmuch as ye are mani- j-obation, and of his having appointed him to the apostoUc office. All the diffiiralty, therefore, which has been felt by commentators in this passage, may be obviated by supposing that Paul here speaks of this testimonial or epis- tle as addressed to himself, and as sa- tisfactory to liim. In the other charac- teristics which he enumerates, he speaks of it, as fitted to be a letter commenda- tory of himself to others, t Known and read of all men. Corinth was a large, splendid, and dissipated city. Their conversion, therefore, would be known afar. All men would hear of it ; and their reformation, their subse- quent life under the instruction of Paul, and the attestation which God had given among them to his labours, was a suffi- cient testimonial to the world at large, that God had called him to the apostolic office. 3. Forasmuch as ye are manifestly declared. You are made manifest as the epistle of Christ ; or you, being made manifest, are the epistle, &c. They had been made manifest to be such by their conversion. The sense is, it is plain, or evident, that ye arc the epistle of Christ. ^ To he the epistle of Christ. That which Christ has sent to be our testimonial. He has given this letter of recommendation. He has converted you by our ministry, and that is the best evidence which wc can have that we have been sent by him, and that our labour is accepted by him. Your con- version is his work, and it is his public attestation to our fidelity in his cause. *![ Ministered hy us. The idea here is, that Christ had employed their ministry in accomplishing this. They were Christ's letter, but it had been prepared by the instrumentality of the apostles. It had not been prepared by him inde- pendently of their labours, but in con- nexion with, and as the result of those labours. Christ, in writing this epistle, flo to speak, has used our aid ; or em- festly declared to be the epistle of Christ ministered by us, written not with ink, but with the Spirit ployed us as amanuenses. Tf Written not with ink. Paul continues and va- ries the image in regard to this " epistle," so that he may make the testimony borne to his fidelity and success more striking and emphatic. He says, there- fore, that it was not written as letters of introduction are, with ink — by traces drawn on a lifeless substance, and in lines that easily fade, or that may be- come easily illegible, or that can be read only by a few, or that may be soon destroyed. Tf But with the Spirit of the living God. In strong contrast thus with letters written with ink. By the Spirit of God moving on the heart, and producing that variety of graces which constitute so striking and so beautiful an evidence of your conver- sion. If written by the Spirit of the living God, it was far more valuable, and precious, and permanent than any record which could be m.ade by ink. Every trace of the Spirit's influences on the heart was an undoubted proof that God had sent the apostles ; and was a proof which they would much more sensibly and tenderly feel than they could any letter of recommendation written in ink. *f Not in talks of stone. It is generally admitted that Paul here refers to the evidences of the divine mis- sion of Moses which was given by the lav/ engraven on tablets of stone. Comp. ver. 7. Probably those who were false teachers among the Corinthians were Jews, and had insisted much on the divine origin and permanency of the Mosaic institutions. The law had been engraven on stone by the hand of God himself; and had thus the strongest proofs of divine origin, and the divine attestation to its pure and holy nature. To this fact the friends of the law, and the advocates for the permanency of the Jewish institutions, would appeal. Paul says, on the other hand, that the testimonials of the divine favour through him were not on tablets of stone. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER III. 53 of the living God ; not in tables of stone, " Ijut ^ in fleshly tables of the heart. A Ex. 24. 12. b Je. 31. 33. Eze. 11. 19. They were frail, and easily broken. There was no life in them (comp. ver. 6 and 7) ; and valuable and important Qs they were, yet they could not be compared with the testimonials which God had given to those who successfully preached the gospel. ^ But in Jleskli/ tables of the heart. In truths engraven on the heart. This testimonial was of more value than an inscription on stone, because, (1.) No hand but that of God could reach the heart, and inscribe these truths there. (2.) Because it would be attended with a life-giving and living influence. It was not a mere dead letter. (3.) Because it would be per- manent. Stones, even where laws were engraven by the finger of God, would moulder and decay, and the inscription made there would be destroyed. But not so with that which was made on the heart. It would live forever. It would abide in other worlds. It would send its influence into all the relations of life; into all future scenes in this world; and that influence would be seen and felt in the world that shall never end. By all these considerations, therefore, the testimonials which Paul had of the divine approbation were more valuable than any mere letters of intro- duction, or human commendation could have been ; and more valuable even than the attestation which was given to the divine mission of Moses himself. 4. And such trust have we. Such confidence have we that we are ap- pointed by God, and that he accepts our work. Such evidence have we in the success of our labours ; such irrefragable proof that God blesses us; that we have trust, or confidence that we are sent by God, and are owned by him in our mi- nistry. His confidence did not rest on letters of introduction from men, but in the evidence of the divine presence, and the divine acceptance of his work. ^ Through Christ. By the agency of 5* 4 And such trust have we through Christ to God-ward : 5 Not that we are sufficient Christ. Paul had no success whicl b« did not trace to him ; he had no joy of which he was not the source ; he had no confidence, or trust in God of which Christ was not the author; he had no hope of success in his ministry which did not depend on him. | To God- ward. Toward God ; in regard to God (jrsci; Tov Qiov). Our confidence relates to God. It is confidence that he has ap- pointed us, and sent us forth ; and con- fidence that he will still continue to own and to bless us. 5. Not that we are sufficient of our- selves. This is evidently designed to guard against the appearance of boast- ing, or of self-confidence. He had spoken of his confidence ; of his tri- umph ; of his success ; of his undoubt- ed evidence that God had sent him. He here says, that he did not mean to be understood as affirming that any of his success came from himself, or that he was able by his own strength to accomplish the great things which had been effected by his ministry. He well knew that he had no such self-sufficiency; and he would not insinuate, in the slightest manner, that he believed him- self to be invested with any such power. Comp. Note on John xv. 5. t To think any thing (hoyia-ctT^xi ti). The word here used means properly to rea- son, think, consider ; and then to reckon, count to, or impute to any one. It is the word which is commonly rendered impute. See it explained more fully in the Note on Rom. iy. 5. Robinsor. (Lexicon) renders it in this place, " tc reason out, to think out, to find out by thinking." Doddridge renders it, "to reckon upon any thing as from our- selves." Whitby renders it, "to reason ; ' as if the apostlo had said, We are un- able by any reasoning of our own to bring men to conversion. Macknight gives a similar sense. Locke renders it, " Not as if I were sufficient of myself, 54 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. CO. of " ourselves to think any thing, | as of ourselves, but ^ our suffi ciency is of God ; aJno. 15. 5. 6 1 Co. 15. 10. Th. 2. 13. 6 Who also hath made us able " ministers of the New ' ttEp. 3.7. ITi. 1. 12. b Mat. 26. 28. He. 8. 6—10. to reckon upon any thing as from my- self;" and explains it to mean that Paul was not isufficient of himself by any strength of natural parts to attain the knowledge of the gospel truths which he preached. The word may be ren- dered here, to reckon, reason, think, &c.; but it should be confined to the imme- diate subject under consideration. It does not refer to thinking in general ; or to the power of thought on any, and on all subjects — however true it may be in itself— but to the preaching the gospel. And the expression may be regarded as referring to the following points, which are immediately under discussion. (1.) Paul did not feel that he was sufficient of himself to have reasoned or thought out the truths of the gospel. They were conimunicated by God. (2.) He had no power by reasoning to convince or convert sinners. That was all of God. (3.) He had no right to reckon on success by any strength of his own. All success was to be traced to God. It is, however, also true, that all our powers of thinking and reasoning are from God ; and that we have no ability to think clearly, to reason calmly, close- ly, and correctly, unless he shall preside over our minds and give us clearness of thought. How easy is it far God to disarrange all our faculties, and produce insanity ! How easy to sufier our minds to become unsettled, bewildered, and distracted with a multiplicity of thoughts ! How easy to cause every thing to appear cloudy, and dark, and misty ! How^ easy to affect our bodies with weakness, languor, disease, and through them to destroy all power of close and consecutive thought ! No one who considers on how many things the power of close thinking depends, can doubt that all our sufficiency in this is from God; and that we owe to him every clear idea on the subjects of common life, and on scientific subjects, no less certainly than we do in the truths of religion. Comp. the case of Bezalcel and Aholiab in common arts. Ex. xxxi. 1 — 6, and Job xxxii. 8. 6. \V7io also hath made us able mi- nisters, &c. This translation does not quite meet the force of the original. It would seem to imply that Paul regarded himself and his fellow-labourers as men of talents, and of signal ability ; and that he was inclined to boast of it. But this is not the meaning. It refers properly to his sense of the responsibility and dif- ficulty of the work of the ministry ; and to the fact that he did not esteem him- self to be sufficient for this work in his own strength (ch. ii. 16; iii. 5) ; and he here says that God had made liim suff,- cient : not able, talented, learned, but sufficient (jKavcDo-iv yi/jiug') ; he has sup- plied our deficiency ; he has rendered us competent, or fit ; — if a word may be coined after the m.anner of the Greek here, 'he has sufficienced us for this work.' There is no assertion, therefore, here, that they were men of talents, or peculiar ability, but only that God had qualified them for their work, and made them by his grace sufficient to meet the toils and responsibilities of this arduous office. *lf Of the Ncio Testa- ment. Of the new covenant (Note, Matt. XXV. 28), in contradistinction from the old covenant, which was es- tablished through Moses. They were appointed to go forth and make the pro- visions of that new covenant known to a dying \rorld. 1 Not of the letter Not of the literal, or verbal meaning, in contradistinction from the Spirit. See Notes on Rom. ii. 27, 29 ; vii. 6. This is said, doubtless, in opposition to the Jews, and Jewish teachers. They insisted much on the letter of the law, but entered little into its real meaning. They did not seek out the true spiritual sense of the Old Testament ; and hence they rested on the mere literal observ- ance of the rites and ceremonies of reli- gion, without understanding their true A. D. 60.] CHAPTER III. 55 Testament ; not of the letter, " but of the spirit : for the ^ letter killeth, but ' the spirit * giveth life. a Ro. 2. 23, 29. b Ro. 4. 15. 7. 9, 10. c Jno. G. 63. Ro. 8. 2. i or, quickeneth. «aturo and design. Their service, though in many respects conformed to the letter of thq law, yet became cold, formal, and hypocritical ; abounding in mere ceremonies, and where the heart had little to do. Hence there was little pure spiritual worship offered to God ; and hence also they rejected the Mes- siah whom the old covenant prefi- gured, and was designed to set forth. f For the letter killeth. Comp. Notes on Rom. iv. 15 ; vii. 9, 10. The mere letter of the law of Moses. The effect of it was merely to produce condemna- tion ; to produce a sense of guilt, and danger, and not to produce pardon, re- lief, and joy. The law denounced death; condemned sin in all forms; and the effect of it was to produce a sense of guilt and condemnation. 1 But the spirit giveth life. The spirit, in contradistinction from the mere literal interpretation of the Scrip- tures. The Spirit, that is, Christ, says Locke. Comp. ver. 17. The spirit here means, says Bloomfield, that new spiritual system, the gospel. The spirit of God speaking in us, says Dod- dridge. The spirit here seems to refer to the New Testament, or the new dis- pensation in contradistinction from the old. That was characterized mainly by its strictness of law, and by its bur- densome rites, and by the severe tone of its denunciation for sin. It did not in itself provide a way of pardon and peace. Law condemns ; it does not speak of forgiveness. On the contrary, the gospel, a spiritual system, is de- signed to impart life and comfort to the soul. It speaks peace. It comes not to liondernn, but to save. It discloses a way of mercy, and it invites all to par- take and live. It is called "spirit," probably because its consolations are imparted and secured by the Spirit of 7 But if the ministration of death, written and engraven in stones, was glorious, so that the children of Israel could not stedfastly behold the face of God — the source of all true life to tlie soul. It is the dispensation of the Spirit ; and it demands a spiritual service — a service that is free, and elevated, and tending eminently to purify the heart, and to save the soul. See Note on ver. 17. 7. But if the ministration of death. In the previous verses, Paul had referred incidentally to the institutions of Moses, and to the superiority of the gospel. He had said that the former were en- graven on stones, but the latter on the heart (ver. 3) ; that the letter of the former tended to death, but the latter to life (ver. 6). This sentiment he pro- ceeds further to illustrate, by showing in what the superior glory of the gos- pel consisted. The design of the whole is, to illustrate the nature, and to show the importance of the ministerial office ; and the manner in which the duties of that office were to be performed. That the phrase " ministration of death" re- fers to the Mosaic institutions, the con- nexion sufficiently indicates, ver. 13 — 15. The word "ministration" (J'aicivU) means, properly, ministry ; the office of ministering in divine things. It is usually applied to the officers of the church in the New Tes- tament. Acts i. 17. 25. Rom. xi. 13. 1 Cor. xii. 5. The word here, however, seems to refer to the whole arrangement under the Mosaic economy, by which his laws were promulgated, and per- petuated. The expression " a minis- tration — written and engraven on stone," is somewhat harsh; but the sense evidently is, the ministration of a covenant, or of laws written on stones. The word "ministration" there refers to the arrangement, office, &c. by which the knowledge of these laws was main- tained; the ministering under a sys- tem like that of the Jewish ; or, more 56 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 Moses for " the glory of his a Ex. 34. 1, 29—35. strictly, the act and occasion on which Moses himself ministered, or promul- gated that system to the Jews, and when the glory of the work was irradiated even from his countenance. And the purpose of the apostle is to show that the ministry of the gospel is more glorious than even the ministry of Moses, when he was admitted near to God on the holy mount; and when such a glory attended his receiving and promulgating the law. It is called the " ministration of death," because it tended to condemnation ; it did not speak of pardon ; it was fitted only to deepen the sense of sin, and to produce alarm and dread. See Note on ver. 6. If Written and engraven in stones. The ten commandments — the substance of all the Mosaic institutes, and the principal laws of his economy — were written, or engraven on tables of stone. ^ Was glorious. Was attended with magnificence and splendour. The glory here referred to, consisted in the cir- cumstance of sublimity and grandeur in which the law of Moses was given. It was, (1.) The glory of God as he was manifested on Mount Sinai, as the Law- giver and Ruler of the people. (2.) The glory of the attending circum- stances, of thunder, fire, &c. in which God appeared. The law was given in these circumstances. Its giving — called here the "ministration" — was amidst such displays of the glory of God. It was, (3.) A high honour and glory for Moses to be permitted to ap- proach so near to God; to commune with him ; and to receive at his hand the law for his people, and for the world. These were circumstances of imposing majesty and grandeur, which, however, Paul says were eclipsed and sui-passed by the ministry of the gospel. H So that the children of Israel, &c. In Ex. xxxiv. 29, 30, it is said, that " When Moses came down from Mount Sinai with the two tables of testimony in Moses' hand, when he came down countenance ; which glory was to be done away ; from the mount, that Moses wist not that the skin of his face shone, while He talked with him. An i when Aaron and all the children of Israel saw Moses, behold, the skin of his face shone ; and they were afraid to come nigh him." The word rendered " stedfastly behold" (dnvia-su), means to gaze intently upon; to look steadily, or constantly, or fixedly. See Note on Acts i. 10. There was a dazzling splendour, an ir- radiation ; a diffusion of light, such that they could not look intently and steadily upon it — as we cannot look steadily at the sun. How this was produced, is not known. It cannot be accounted for from natural causes, and was doubt- less designed to be to the Israelites an attestation that Moses had been with God, and was commissioned by him. They would see, (1.) That it was un- natural, such as no known cause could produce; and, (2.) Not improbably they would recognise a resemblance to the manner in which God usually ap- peared — the glory of the Shechinah in which he so frequently manifested him- self to them. It would be to them, there- fore, a demonstration that Moses had been with God. *t Which glory was to be done away. The splendour of that scene was transitory. It did not last. It was soon destroyed (t«v x^T^rt^T^cy^jW). It was not adapted or designed long to continue. This does not mean, as Dod- dridge supposes, " soon to be abolished in death ;" or, as others, " ceasing with youth ;" but it means, that the shining or the splendour was transitory ; it was soon to cease ; it was not designed to be permanent. Neither the wonderful scenes accompanying the giving of the law on Sinai, nor the shining on the countenance of Moses, was designed to abide. The thunders of Sinai would cease to roll; the lightnings to play; the visible manifestations of the presence of God would all be gone; and the supernatural illumination of the fate of Moses also would soon cease — 'perhaps^ A.. D. 60.] CHAPTER III. 57 8 How shall not the ministra- tion of the Spirit be rather glo- rious ? as Macknight, Bloomfield, and others suppose, as a prefiguration of the abro- gation of the glory of the whole system of the Levitical law. Paul certainly means to say, that the glory of Moses, and of his dispensation, was a fading glory ; but that the glory of the gospel would be permanent, and increasing forever, 8. Hoiu shall not the ministration of the Spirit. This is an argument from the less to the greater. Several things in it are worthy of notice. (1.) The proper contrast to the " ministra- tion of death" (ver. 7), would have been ' ministration of life.' But Paul chose rather to call it the ' ministration of the Spirit ;' as the source of life ; or as con- ferring higher dignity on the gospel than to have called it simply the minis- tration of life. (2.) By the " Spirit" here is manifestly meant the Holy Spirit; and the whole phrase denotes the gospel, or the preaching of the gos- pel, by which eminently the Holy Spirit is imparted. (3.) It is the high honour of the gospel ministry, that it is the means by which the Holy Spirit is imparted to men. It is designed to se- cure the salvation of men by his agency ; and it is through the ministry that the Holy Spirit is imparted, the heart renewed, and the soul saved. The work of the ministry is, therefore, the most important and honourable in which man can engage, f Be rather glorious. (I.) Because that of Moses tended to death ; this to life. (2,) Be- cause that was engraven on stone ; this is engraved on the heart. (3.) Be- cause th^t was the mere giving of a law ; this is connected with the renovat- ing influences of the Holy Spirit. (4.) Because that was soon to pass away. All the magnificence of the scene was soon to vanish. But this is to remain. Its influence and effect are to be ever- lasting. It is to stretch into eternity ; and its main glory is to be witnessed in 9 For if the ministration of condemnation be glory, much more doth the ministration souls renewed and saved ; and amidst the splendours of heaven. " The work of the Spirit of God on the heart of a rational being, is much more important than any dead characters which can be engraved on insensible stones." — Dod- dridge. 9. For if the ministratioJi of conderri' nation. Of Moses in giving the law, the effect of which is to produce con- demnation. — Law condemns the guilty ; it does not save them. It denounces punishment ; it contains no provisions of pardon. To pardon is to depart from the law ; and must be done under the operation of another system — since a law which contains a provision for the pardon of offenders, and permits them to escape, would be a burlesque in legislation. The tendency of the Mo- saic institutions, therefore, was to pro- duce a sense of condemnation. And so it will be found by all who attempt to be justified by the law. It will tend to, and result in, their condemnation. ^ Be glory. Be glorious ; or be glory itself. — It was glorious as a manifesta- tion of the holiness and justice of God ; and glorious in the attending circum- stances. No event in our world has been more magnificent in the circum-- stances of external majesty and splen dour than the giving of the law on Mount Sinai, t The ministration of righteousness. The gospel ; the pro- mulgation of the plan of mercy. It is called " the ministration of righteous- ness," in contradistinction from the law of Moses, which was a " ministration of condemnation." The word "right- eousness," how^ever, does not exactly express the force of the original word. That word is iiK^ioT-jviic, and it stands directly opposed to the word k^ta- x.!>t(Tia>^, condemnatio7i. It should be rendered 'the ministration o^ justifica- tion ;^ the plan by which God justifies men. See Note, Rom. i. 17. The law of Moses condemns; the gospel is the 58 II. CORINTHIANS exceed [A. D. 60. of righteousness glory. 10 For even that which was made glorious had no glory in plan by which man is justified. And if that which condemns could be glo- rious, much more must that be by which men can be justified, acquitted, and saved. The superior glory of the gos- pel, therefore, consists in the fact that it is a scheme to justify and save lost sinners. And this glory consists, (1.) In the fact that it can be done when all law condemns. (2.) In the showing forth of the divine character while it is done, as just, and merciful, and bene- volent in doing it — blending all his great and glorious attributes together — while the law disclosed only one of his attributes — his justice. (3.) In the manner in which it is done. It is by the incarnation of the Son of God — a far more glorious manifestation of deity than was made on Mount Sinai. It is by the toils, and sufferings, and death of him who made the atonement, and by the circumstances of awful and im- posing grandeur which attended his death, when the sun was darkened, and the rocks were rent — far more grand and awful scenes than occurred when the law was given. It is by the resurrec- tion, and ascension of the Redeemer — scenes far more sublime than all the ex- ternal glories of Sinai when the law was given. (4.) In the effects, or re- sults. The one condemns; the other justifies and saves. The effect of the one is seen in the convictions of con- science, in alarm, in a sense of guilt, in the conscious desert of condemnation, and in the apprehension of eternal pun- ishment. The other is seen in sins forgiven ; in peace of conscience ; in the joy of pardon ; in the hope of heaven ; in comfort and triumph on the bed of death, and amidst the glories of heaven. 10. For even that which was made glorious (to iiS:^et^y.'ivov). That was splendid, excellent, or glorious. This refers doubtless, to the laws and insti- tutions of Moses, especially to the an- this respect, by reason of the glory that excelleth. 11 For if " that which is done aRc.5. 20, 21. mary giving of the law. Paul does not deny that it had an honour and majesty such, in some respects, as the Jews claimed for it. It was glorious in the manner in which it was given ; it was glorious in the purity of the law itself; and it was glorious, or splendid in the magnificent and imposing ritual in which the worship of God was cele- brated. But all this was surpassed in the brighter glory of the gospel. 1 Had no glory. Gr. Was not glorious, or splendid {ohSl iiio'^a. when Moses is read upon their heart. 1 6 Nevertheless, when it shall in the time of Paul ; and the character and conduct of the Jews now so entirely accords with the description which he gives of them in his time, as to show that he drew from nature, and as to constitute one of the strong incidental proofs that the account in the New Testament is true. Of no other people on earth, probably, would a description be accurate eighteen hundred years after it was made, f When Moses is read. When the five books of Moses are read, as they were regularly and constantly in their synagogues. See Note on Luke iv. 16. t The vailis upon their h^art. They do not see the true meaning and beauty of their own Scriptures — a description as applicable to the Jews now as it was to those in the time of Paul. 16. Nevertheless. This is not always to continue. The time is coming when they shall understand their own Scrip- tures, and see their true beauty. ^ When it shall turn to the Lord. When the Jewish people shall be con- verted. The word " it" here refers un- doubtedly to "Israel" in ver. 1.3; and the sense is, that their blindness is not always to remain ; there is to be a pe- riod when they shall turn to God, and shall understand his promises, and be- come acquainted with the true nature of their own religion. This subject the apostle has discussed at much greater length in the eleventh chapter of the epistle to the Romans. See Notes on that chapter. T[ The vail shall be taken away. They shall then understand the true meaning of the prophecies, and the true nature of their own institutions. They shall see that they refer to the Lord Jesus, the incarnate Son of God, and the true Messiah. The genuine sense of their sacred oracles shall break upon their view with full and irresist- ible light. There may be an allusion in the language here to the declaration turn to the Lord, the vail shall be taken away. " 17 Now the Lord ** is that a Is. 25. 7. a 1 Co. 15. 45 in Isa. XXV. 7 : " And he will destroy in this mountain the face of the cover- ing cast over all people, and the vail that is spread over all nations." This verse teaches, (1.) That the time will come when the Jews shall be converted to Christianity ; expressed here by their turning unto the Lord, that is, the Lord Jesus. See Note, Acts i. 24. (2.) It seems to be implied that their conversion will be a conversion of the people at large ; a conversion that shall be nearly simulta- neous ; a conversion en masse. Such a conversion we have reason to anticipate of the Jewish nation. (3.) The effect of this will be to make them acquainted with the true sense of their own Scrip- tures, and the light, and beauty of the sayings of their own prophets. Now they are in deep darkness on the sub- ject ; then they will see how entirely they meet and harmonize in the Lord Jesus. (4.) The true and only way of having a correct and full meaning of the Bible is by turning unto God. Love to him, and a disposition to do his will, is the best means of interpreting the Bible. 17. Now the Lord is that Spirit. The word " Lord" here evidently refers to the Lord Jesus. See ver. 16. It may be observed in general in regard to this word, that where it occurs in the New Testament unless the connexion require us to understand it of God, it refers to the Lord Jesus. It was the common name by which he was known. See John xx. 13 ; xxi. 7. 12. Eph. iv. 1. 5. The design of Paul in this verse seems to be to account for the " liberty" which he and the other apostles had, or for the boldness, openness, and plain- ness (ver. 12) which they evinced in contradistinction from the Jews, who so little understood the nature of their in- stitutions. He had said (ver. 6), that he was a minister " not of the letter, but of the Spirit;" and he had stated 64 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. Spirit: and where the « Spirit of the Lord is, there is liberty. a Ro. 8. 2. that the Old Testament was not under- stood by the Jews who adhered to the literal interpretation of the Scriptures. He here says, that the Lord Jesus was *' the Spirit" to which he referred, and by which he was enabled to understand the Old Testament so as to speak plain- ly, and without obscurity. The sense is, that Christ was the Spirit; i. e. the sum, the substance of the Old Testa- ment. The figures, types, prophecies, &c. all centered in him, and he was the end of all those institutions. If con- templated as having reference to him, it was easy to understand them. This I take to be the sentiment of the passage, though expositors have been greatly divided in regard to its meaning. Thus explained, it does not mean absolutely and abstractly th-at the Lord Jesus was " a Spirit," but that he was the sutu, the essence, the end, and the purport of the Mosaic rites the spirit of which Paul had spoken in ver. 6, as contra- distinguished from the letter of the law. t And where the Spirit of the Lord is, there is liberty. This is a general truth designed to illustrate the particular sen- timent which he had just advanced. The word "liberty" here (jAii/S-s^/ci) refers, I think, to freedom in speaking ; the power of speaking openly, and freely, as in ver. 12. It states the general truth, that the effect of the Spirit of God was to give light and clearness of view ; to remove obscurity from a subject, and to enable one to see it plainly. This would be a truth that could not be denied by the Jews, who held to the doctrine that the Spirit of God revealed truth, and it must be ad- mitted by all. Under the influence of that Spirit, therefore, Paul says, that he was able to speak with openness, and boldness ; that he had a clear view of truth, which the mass of the Jews had not; and that the system of religion which he preached was open, plain, and clear. The word "freedom," would 18 But we all, with open face beholding as in a glass ** the a 1 Co. 13. 12. perhaps, better convey the idea. 'Theio is freedom from the dark and obscuie views of the Jews ; freedom from their prejudices, and their superstitions ; freedom from the slavery and bondage of sin ; the freedom of the children of God, who have clear views of him as their Father and Redeemer, and who are enabled to express those views openly and boldly to the world.' 18. But we all. All Christians The discussion in the chapter has re- lated mainly to the apostles ; but this declaration seems evidently to refer to all Christians, as distinguished from the Jews. t With open face. Comp. Note on 1 Cor. xiii. 12. Tindal ren ders this, " and now the Lord's glory appeareth in us all as in a glass." The sense is, " with unvailcd face," alluding to the fact (ver. 13) that the face of Moses was vailed, so that the children of Israel could not steadfastly look on it. In contradistinction from that, Paul says that Christians are enabled to look upon the glory of the Lord in the gos- pel without a vail — without any obscure intervening medium. \ Beholding as 171 a glass. On the word glass, and the sense in which it is used in the New Testament, see note on 1 Cor. xiii. 12. The word here used (x-ctTOTrr^ii^ouivot') has been very variously rendered. Macknight renders it, "we all reflecting as mirrors the glory of the Lord." Doddridge, " beholding as by a glass." Locke, "with open countenances as mirrors, reflecting the glory of the Lord." The word naTOTrT^i^cii occurs nowhere else in the New Testament. It properly means to look in a mirror to behold as in a mirror. The mirrors of the ancients were made of burnished metal, and they reflected images witb great brilliancy and distinctness. Ani the meaning is, that the gospel reflected the glory of the Lord ; it was, so f speak, the mirror — the polished, bus nished substance in which the glory o^ k, D. 60.] CHAPTER III. glory of the Lord, are changed into the same « image from * glory a Ro. 8. 29. b Vs. 84. 7. the Lord shone, and where that glory was irradiated and reflected so that it might be seen by Christians. There was no vail over it ; no obscurity ; no- thing to break its dazzling splendour, or to prevent its meeting the eye. Chris- tians, by looking on the gospel, could see the glorious perfections and plans of God as bright, and clear, and bril- liant as they could see a light reflected from the burnished surface of the mirror. So to speak, the glorious per- fections of God shone from heaven; beamed upon the gospel, and were thence reflected to the eye and the heart of the Christian, and had the ef- fect of transforming them into the same image. This passage is one of great beauty, and is designed to set forth the gospel as being the refiedion of the infi- nite glories of God to the minds and hearts of men. ^ The glory of the Lord. The splendour, majesty, and holiness of God as manifested in the gospel, or of the Lord as incarnate. The idea is, that God was clearly and distinctly seen in the gospel. There was no obscurity, no vail, as in the case of Moses. In the gospel they were permitted to look on the full splendour of the divine per- fections — the justice, goodness, mercy, and benevolence of God — to see him as he is with undimmed and unvailed glory. The idea is, that the perfections of God shine forth with splendour and beauty in the gospel, and that we are permitted to look on them clearly and Ofienly. ^ Are changed into the same image. It is possible that there may be an allusion here to the effect which was produced by looking into an ancient mirror. Such mirrors were made of burnished metal, and the reflection from them would be intense. If a strong Tu'lit were thrown on them, the rays w ould be cast by reflection on the face of him who looked on the mirror, and it would be strongly illuminated. And the idea may be, that the glory of God, 6* to glory even as * by the Spirit of the Lord. 1 or, of the Lord the Spirit. the splendour of the divine perfections^ was thrown on the gospel, so to speak, like a bright light on a polished mirror ; and that that glory was reflected from the gospel on him who contemplated it, so that he appeared to be transformed into the same image. Locke renders it, " We are changed into his very image by a continued succession of glory, as it were, streaming upon us from the Lord." The figure is one of great beauty ; and the idea is, that by placing ourselves within the light of the gospel ; by contemplating the glory that shines there, we become changed into the like- ness of the same glory, and conformed to that which shines there with so much splendour. By contemplating the resplendent face of the blessed Re- deemer, we are changed into something of the same image. It is a law of our nature that we are moulded, in our moral feelings, by the persons with whom we associate, and by the objects which we contemplate. We become insensibly assimilated to those with whom we have intercourse, and to the objects with which we are familiar. We imbibe the opinions, we copy the habits, we imitate the manners, we fall into the customs of those with whom we have daily conversation, and whom we make our companions and friends. Their sentiments insensibly become our sentiments, and their ways our ways. It is thus with the books with which we are familiar. We are insensibly, but certainly moulded into conformity to the opinions, maxims, and feelings which are there expressed. Our own sentiments undergo a gradual change, and we are likened to those with which in this manner we are conversant. So it is in regard to the opinions and feelings which from any cause we are in the habit of bringing before our minds. It is the way by which men become cor- rupted in their sentiments and feelings in their contact with the world ; it is the 66 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. way in which amusements, and the com- pany of the gay and the dissipated possess so much power; it is the way in which the young and inexperienced are heguiled and ruined ; and it is the way in which Christians dim the lustre of their piety, and obscure the bright- ness of their reUgion by their contact with the gay and fashionable world. — And it is on the same great principle that Paul says that by contemplating the glory of God in the gospel, we be- come insensibly, but certainly conform- ed to the same image, and made like the Redeemer. His image will be re- flected on us. We shall imbibe his sentiments, catch his feelings, and be moulded into the image of his own purity. Such is the great and wise law of our nature ; and it is on this prin- ciple, and by this means, that God de- signs we should be made pure on earth, and kept pure in heaven forever. t From glory to glory. From one degree of glory to another. " The more we behold this brilliant and glorious light, the more do we reflect back its rays ; that is, the more we contemplate the great truths of the Christian re- ligion, the more do our minds become imbued with its spirit." — Bloomfield. This is said in contradistinction pro- bably to Moses. The splendour on his face gradually died away. But not so with the light reflected from the gospel. It becomes deeper and brighter con- stantly. — This sentiment is parallel to that expressed by the psalmist : " They go from strength to strength" (Ps. Ixxxiv. 7) ; i. e. they go from one degree of strength to another, or one degree of holiness to another, until they come to the full vision of God himself in heaven. The idea in the phrase before us is, that there is a continual increase of moral purity and hoUness under the gospel until it results in the perfect glory of heaven. The doctrine is, that Christians advance in piety ; and that this is done by the contemplation of the glory of God as it is revealed in the gospel, t As by the Spirit of the Lord. Marg. "Of the Lord of the Spirit." Gr. "As froir the Lord the Spirit." So Beza, Locko, Wolf, Rosenmiiller, and Doddridge render it. The idea is, that it is by the Lord Jesus Christ the spirit of the law, the spirit referred to by Paul above, vei*. 6. 17. It is done by the Holy Spirit procured or impart- ed by the Lord Jesus. This sentiment is in accordance with that which pre- vails everywhere in the Bible, that it is by the Holy Spirit alone that the heart is changed and purified. And the object of the statement here is, doubtless, to prevent the supposition that the change from " glory to glory" was produced in any sense by the mere contemplation of truth, or by any physical operation of such contemplation on the mind. It was by the Spirit of God alone that the heart was changed even under the gos- pel, and amidst the full blaze of its truth. I Were it not for his agency, even the contemplation of the glorious truths of the gospel would be in vain, and would produce no saving efiect on the human heart. BEMARKS. 1. Thebest of all evidences of a call to the ofliice of the ministry is the divine blessing resting on our labours, ver. 1, 2. If sinners are converted ; if souls are sanctified ; if the interests of pure reli- gion are advanced ; if by humble, zeal ous, and self-denying efforts, a man is enabled so to preach as that the divine blessing shall rest constantly on his la- bours, it is among the best of all evi- dences that he is called of God, and is approved by him. And though it may be true, and is true, that men who are self-deceived, or are hypocrites are some- times the means of doing good, yet it is still true, as a general rule, that eminent, and long-continued success in the mi- nistry is an evidence of God's accept- ance, and that he has called a minister to this office. Paul felt this, and often appealed to it ; and why may not others also] 2. A minister may appeal to the effect of the gospel among his own people as a proof that it is from God. ver. 2, 3. Nothing else would produce such efiects as were produced at Corinth, but the A. D. 60.] CHAPTER III. 67 power of God. If the wicKed are re- slairaed ; if ths intemperate and licen- tious are made temperate and pure ; if A\e dishonest are made honest ; and the scoffer learns to pray, under the gospel, it proves that it is from God. To such effects a minister may appeal as proof Ihat the gospel which he preaches is from heaven. A system which will pro- duce these effects must be true. 3. A minister should so live among » people as to be able to appeal to them with the utmost confidence in regard to the purity and integrity of his own character, ver. 1, 2. He should so live, ftnd preach, and act, that he will be un- der no necessity of adducing testimonials from abroad in regard to his character. The eflect of his gospel, and the tenor of his life, should be his best testimonial ; and to that he should be able to appeal. A man who is under a necessity, con- stantly, or often, of defending his own character ; of bolstering it up by testi- monials from abroad; who is obliged to spend much of his time in defending his reputation, or who chooses to spend much of his time in defending it, has usually a character and reputation not ivorth defending. Let a man live as he ought to, and he will, in the end, have a good reputation. Let him strive to do the will of God, and save souls, and he will have all the reputation which he ought to have. God will take care of his character ; and will give him just as much reputation as it is desirable that he should have. See Ps. xxxvii. 5, 6. 4. The church is, as it were, an epistle sent by the Lord Jesus, to show his character and will. ver. 3. It is his representative on earth. It holds his truth. It is to imitate his example. It is to show how he lived. And it is to accomplish that which he would ac- complish were he personally on earth, and present among men — as a letter is designed to accomplish some important purpose of the writer when absent. The church, therefore, should be such as shall appropriately express the will and desire of the Lord Jesus. It should resemble him. It should holi his truth ; and it should devote itself with untiring diligence to the great purpose of advancing his designs, and spread- ing his gospel around the world. 5. Religion has its seat in the heart, ver. 3. It is engraven there. It is written not with ink, or engraven on stone, but it is written by the Spirit of God on the heart. That professed reli- gion, therefore, which does not reach the heart, and which is not felt there, is false and delusive. There is no true religion which does not reach and affect the heart. 6. We should feel our dependence on God in all things, ver. 5. We are dependent on him, (1.) For revelation itself. Man had no power of originating the truths which constitute revelation They are the free and pure gift of God. (2.) For success in saving souls. God only can change the heart. It is not done by human reasoning; by any power of man ; by any eloquence of persuasion. It is by the power of God ; and if a minister of religion meets with any success, it will be by the presence and by the power of God alone. (3.) We are dependent on him for the power of thought at all; for^ clearness of intellect ; for such a state of bodily health as to permit us to think; for bright conceptions ; for ability to arrange oui thoughts ; for the power of expressing them clearly ; for such a state of mind as shall be free from vain fancies, and vagaries, and eccentricities ; and for such a state as shall mark our plans as those of common sense and prudence. On such plans much of the comfort of life depends ; and on such plans depends also nearly all the success which men ever meet with in arny virtuous and honourable calling. And if men felt, as they should do, how much they are dependent on God for the power of clear thiiiking, and for the character- istics of sound sense in their schemes, they would pray for it more than they do; and would be more grateful that such a rich blessing is so extensively conferred on men. 7. Religion has a living power, ver. 6. It is not the letter, but the spirt. It is II. CORINTHIANS [A. D. 60 not made up of forms and ceremonies. It does not consist imcold, external rites, however regular they may be ; nor in formal prayer, or in stated seasons of devotion. All these will be dead and vain unless the heart is given to God, and to his service. If these are all, there is no religion. And if we have no better religion than that, we should at once abandon our hopes, and seek for that which does not kill, but which makes alive. 8. The office of the ministers of the gospel is glorious, and most honourable, ver. 7 — 9. It is far more honourable than was the office of Moses ; and their work is far more glorious than was his. His consisted in giving the law on ta- bles of stone ; in the external splendour which attended its promulgation ; and in introducing a system which must be soon done away. His was a ministry " of death" and of " condemnation." Theirs is a ministration by which the Holy Spirit is communicated to men — through them as channels, or organs by which the saving grace of that Spirit is imparted ; it is a work by which men are made righteous, justified, and accept- ed ; it is a work whose effects are never to fade away, but which are to live amidst the splendours of heaven. 9. The responsibihty and solemnity of the work of the ministry. It was a solemn and responsible work for Moses to give the law amidst the thunders of Sinai to the children of Israel. It is much more solemn to be the medium by which the eternal truths of the gos- pel are made known to men. The one, imposing as it was, was designed to be temporary, and was soon to pass away. The other is to be eternal in its effects, and is to enter vitally and deeply into the eternal destiny of man. The one pertained to laws written on stone ; the other to influences that are deeply and forever to affect the heart. No work can be more solemn and responsible than that through which the Holy Spirit, with renewing and sanctifying power, is conveyed to man ; that which is connected with the justific-ation of sinners ; and that which in its effects is to be permanent as the soul itself, and to endure as long as God shall exist. 10. We see the folly of attempting to be justified by the law. ver. 7. 9. It is the ministration of death and of condemnation. It speaks only to con- demn. Law knows nothing of pardon. It is not given for that purpose ; and no perfect law can contain within itself provisions for pardon. Besides, no one has ever complied with all the demands of the law ; no one ever will. All have sinned. But if all the demands of the law be not complied with, it speaks only to condemn. James ii. 10. If a man in other respects has been ever so good a citizen, and yet has com- mitted murder, he must die. So says the law. If a man has been ever so valiant, and fought ever so bravely, and yet is guilty of an act of treason, he must die. The question is not what he has been in other respects, or what else he may, or may not have done, but has he committed this offer If he has, the law knows no forgiveness ; and pronounces his condemnation. If par- doned, it must be by some other system than by the regular operation of law. So with the sinner against God. If the law is violated, it speaks only to con- demn. If he is pardoned, it can be only by the gospel of Jesus Christ. 11. The danger of grieving the Holy Spirit, ver. 8. The gospel is the field of the operations of the Holy Spirit in our world. It is the ministration of the Spirit. It is the channel by which his influences descend on man. To reject that gospel is to reject Him, and to cut off the soul from all possi- bility of being brought under his sav- ing influence and power forever. He strives with men only in connexion with the gospel ; and all hope, there- foi-e, of being brought under his saving power, is in attending to that gospel, and embracing its provisions. The multitudes, therefore, who are rejecting or neglecting that gospel, are throwing themselves beyond his saving influences ; and placing themselves beyond the possi- bility of salvation. 12. We see the. guilt of neglecting A n. 60.] CHAPTER III. 6» or rejecting the gospel. It is the scheme, and the only scheme for pardon, ver. 8 — 10. It is a far more glorious mani- festation of the goodness of God than the law of piloses. It is the glorious and benevolent manifestation of God through the incarnation, the sufferings, and the death of his Son. It is the only plan of pardoning mercy that has been, or that will be revealed. If men are not pardoned through that, they are not pardoned at all. If they arc not saved hy that, they must die forever. What guilt is there, therefore, in neglecting and despising it ! What folly is there in turning away from its provisions of mercy, and neglecting to secure an in- terest in what it provides ! 13. The gospel is to spread around the world, and endure to the end of time. ver. 11. It is not like the insti- tutions of Moses, to endure for a limited period, and then to be done away. The cloud and tempest; the thunder and lightning on Mount Sinai which attend- ed the giving of the law, soon disap- peared. The unusual and unnatural splendour on the countenance of Moses soon vanished away. All the magnifi- cence of the Mosaic ritual also soon faded away. But not so the gospel. That abides. That is the last dispensa- tion ; the permanent economy ; that under which the affairs of the world are to be brought to an end. That is to pervade all lands ; to bless all people ; to survive all revolutions ; to outlive all the magnificence of courts, and all the splendour of mighty dynasties, and is to endure till this world shall conie to an end, and live in its glorious effects for- ever and ever. It is, therefore, to be the fixed principle on which all Chris- tians are to act, that the gospel is to be permanent, and is to spread over all lands, and yet fill all nations with joy. And if so, how fervent and unceasing should be their prayers and efforts to accomplish this great and glorious re- sult I 14 We learn from this chapter the duty of preaching in a plain, simple, in- telligible manner, ver. 12. Preaching should always be characterized indeed by good sense, and ministers should show that they are not fools, and their preaching should be such as to interest thinking men — for there is no folly or nonsense in the Bible. But their preach- ing should not be obscure, metaphysical, enigmatical, and abstruse. It should be so simple that the unlettered may learn the plan of salvation ; so plain that no one shall mistake it except by his ovm fault. The hopes of the gospel are so clear that there is no need of ambiguity or enigma ; no need of abstruse meta- physical reasoning in the pulpit. Nor should there be an attempt to appear wise or profound, by studying a dry, abstruse, and cold style and manner. The preacher should be open, plain, simple, sincere ; he should testify what he feels ; should be able to speak as himself animated by hope, and to tell of a world of glory to which he is him- self looking forward with unspeakable joy- 15. It is the privilege of the Christian to look on the unvailed and unclouded glory of the gospel, ver. 12, 13. He does not look at it through types and shadows. He does not contemplate it when a vail of obscurity is drawn de- signedly over it. He sees it in its true beauty and splendour. The Messiah has come, and he may contemplate openly and plainly his glory, and the grandeur of his work. The Jews look- ed upon it in the light of prophecy ,- to us it is history. They saw it only through obscure shadows, types, and figures; we see it in open day, may survey at leisure its full beauty, and contemplate in the fulness of its splen- dour the gospel of the blessed God. For this we cannot be too thankful; nor can we be too anxious lest we un- dervalue our privileges, and abuse the mercies that we enjoy. 16. In reading the Old Testament, we see the importance of suffering the reflected light of the New Testament to be thrown upon it, in order correctly to understand it. ver. 13, 14. It is our privilege to know what the institutions of Moses meant ; to see the end which he contemplated. And it is our privi- ■JO II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. lege to see what they referred to, and how they prefigured the Messiah, and his gospel. In reading the Old Testa- ment, therefore, there is no reason why we should not take with us the know- ledge which we have derived from the New, respecting the character, work, and doctrines of the Messiah ; and to Buffer them to influence our understand- ing of the laws and institutions of Moses. Thus shall we treat the Bible as a whole, and allow one part to throw light on another — a privilege which we always concede to any book. There is no reason why Christians in reading the Old Testament should remain in the same darkness as the ancient, or the modern Jews. 17. Thus read, the Old Testament will be to us of inestimable value, ver. 14. It is of value not only as intro- ducing the gospel ; as furnishing pre- dictions whose fulfilment are full demonstration of the truth of religion ; as containing specimens of the sub- limest and purest poetry in the world ; but it is of value as embodying, though amidst many types and shadows and much obscurity, all the great doctrines of the true religion. Though to the Jews, and to the world, there is a vail cast over it; yet to the Christian there is a beauty and splendour on all its pages — for the coming of Christ has removed that vail, and the sense of those ancient writitigs is now fully seen. True piety will value the Old Testa- ment, and will find there, in the sweetest poetry in the world, the expression of feelings which the religion of the Mes- siah only can produce ; and pure and elevated thoughts which could have been originated by nothing but his an- ticipated coming. It is no mark of piety or of wisdom to disparage the Jewish Scriptures. But the higher the attainments in Christian feeling, the more will the writings of Moses and the prophets be loved. 18. Men may have the Bible, and may read it long, and much, and yet not understand it. ver. 15. So it was, and is with the Jews. The Scriptures were attentively read by them, and yet they did not understand them. So it is still. There is a vail on their heart, and they are blinded. So it is often now with others. Men often read the Bible, and see little beauty in it. They read, and they do not understand it. The reason is, the heart is not right. There should be a correspondence of feeling between the heart and the Bible, or a congeniality of view in order t© appreciate its value and its truth. No man can understand or appreciate Milton or Cowper who has not a taste like theirs. No man can understand and appreciate a poem or an csay on patriotism, who is not a lover of his country ; or on chastity, who is impure ; or on temperance, who is intemperate ; or on virtue in general, who is a stranger to virtue in every form. And so in reading the Bible. To appreciate and understand fully the writings of David, Isaiah, Paul, or John, we must have their feelings; our hearts must glow with their love to God and the Re- deemer; we must feel as they did the guilt and burden of sin ; and we must rejoice as they did in the hope of deli- verance, and in the prospect of heaven. Till men have these feelings, they are not to wonder that the Bible is to them a dead letter, or a sealed book, and that they do not understand it, or see any beauty in its pages. 19. This chapter furnishes an argu- ment for the fidelity and truth of the statement of Paul. ver. 1 5. The argu- ment is, that his description is as ap- plicable to the Jews now as it was in his own time — and that, therefore, it must have been drawn from nature. The same vail is on their hearts now as in his time ; there is the same blindness and darkness in regard to the true mean- ing of their Scriptures. The language of Paul will accurately express that blindness now; and his description therefore is not drawn from fancy, but from fact. It is true now in regard to that singular people, and it was true in his own time ; and the lapse of eighteen hundred years has only served to confirm the truth of his description in regard to the people of his own nation and time. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER IV. CHAPTER IV. 'pHEREFORE, seeing we -*- have this ministry, as we 20. That veil is to be removed only by their turning to God. ver. 16. It is only by true conversion that the mind can lie brought to a full and clear un- derstanding of the Scriptures; and that event will yet take place in regard to the Jews. They shall yet be converted to the Messiah whom their fathers slew, and whom they have so long rejected ; and when that event shall occur, they shall see the beauty of their own Scrip- tures, and rejoice in the promises and glorious hopes which they hold out to the view. ?l. The duty oi meditating much on the glory of the gospel, ver. 18. It is by that we arc purified. It is by keeping it constantly before the mind ; dwelhng on its splendour ; thinking of its glorious truths, that we become transformed into the same image, and made lilie God. If the character is formed by the objects which we contem- plate, and with which we are familiar ; if we are insensibly moulded in our feelings and principles by that with which we constantly associate, then we should think much of the truths of the gospel. We should pray much — for thus we come in contact wdth God and his truth. We should read the Scrip- ture much. We should commune with the good and the pure. We should make our companions of those who most love the Lord Jesus, and most decidedly bear his image. We should think much of a pure heaven. Thus shall we be moulded, insensibly it may be, but certainly, into the image of a holy God and Saviour, and be prepared for a pure and holy heaven. CHAPTER IV. Tuis chapter is intimately connected with the preceding, and is indeed mere- ly a statement of the consequences or results of the doctrine advanced there. In that chapter, Paul had stated the clearness and plainness of the gospel as have received not ; a 1 Co. 7.25 71 mercy, we faint contrasted with the institutions of Moses, and particularly that the Christian mi- nistry was a ministration more glorious than that of Moses. It was more clear It was a ministration of justification (ver. 9), and of the Spirit (ver. 8), and was a ministration where they were permitted to look upon the unvailed and unclouded glories of God. ver. 18. In this chapter he states some of the consequences, or results of their being called to thi.-» ministry ; and the design is, to magnify the office of the ministry, to show the sustaining power of the truths which they preached ; the interest which the Corinthian Christians and all other Christians had in the ministry, and thus to conciliate their favour ; and to show what there was to comfort them in the various trials to which as minis- ters they were exposed. Paul states therefore in this chapter, 1. That these clear and elevated views of the gospel sustained him ; kept him from fainting ; preserved him from deceit and all improper acts ; made him open and honest ; since he had no ne- cessity for craft and guilt, but proclaim- ed a system of religion which could be commended to every man's conscience, and be seen to be true. ver. 1 , 2. 2. That if any persons were lost, it was not the fault of the gospel, ver. 3, 4. That was clear, open, plain, glorious, and might be understood ; and if they were lost, it was to be traced to the ma- lign influence of the god of this world, and not to the gospel. 3. That the great purpose of Paul and his associates was to make known this clear and glorious truth of the gospel, and that, therefore, the apostles did not preach themselves, but Christ Jesus, the revealer and source of all tliis glory, ver. 5, 6. Their sole object was» to show forth tliis pure and glorious hght of the gospel. 4. That it was so arranged by God's appointment and providence that all II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. the gloiy of the lesults of the ministry should be his. ver. 7 — 11. He had ta- ken especial care that they should have no cause of self-exultation or glorying in preaching the gospel ; and had taken effectual means that they should be humbled, and not lifted up with pride from the fact that they were commis- sioned to make known such glorious truths, and had a ministry more ho- nourable than that of Moses. He had, therefore, committed the treasure to earthen vesssels ; to frail, weak, dying men, and to men in humble life (ver. 7), and he had called them to submit to constant trials of persecution, poverty, peril, and want, in order that they might be humbled, and that God might manifestly have all the glory, vtr. 8 —11. 5. All this was for the sake of the church, a fact which was adapted to concihate the favour of Christians, and excite their sympathy in the sufferings of the apostles, and to lead them to honour the ministry in a proper man- ner, ver. 12 — 15. It was not for their own welfare, happiness, honour, or emolument that they endured these trials in the ministry ; it was that the church might be benefited, and thus abundant praise redound to God. 6. These considerations sustained them in their trials, ver. 16 — 18. They had comfort in all their afflictions. They felt that they were doing and suffering these things for the salvation of souls, and the glory of God (ver. 16); they had inward strength given them every day, though the outward man perished (ver. 16) ; they knew that the result of this would be an eternal weight of glory (ver. 1 7) ; and they were enabled to look to another and a better world ; to keep the eye on heaven, and to contemplate by faith the things which were unseen and eternal, ver. 18. These things supported them ; and thus upheld, they went cheerfully to their great work, and met with calmness and joy all the trials which it involved. 1. Therefore (A(a rouro). On ac- count of this. That is, because the Hght of the gospel is so clear ; because it re- veals so glorious truths, and all obscurity is taken away, and we are permitted to behold as in a mirror the glory of the Lord. ch. iii. 18. Since t'he glories of the gospel dispensation are so great, and its effects on the heart are so trans- forming and purifying. The object is, to show the effect of being intrusted with such a ministry, on the character of his preaching. 1 Seeing we have this ministry. The gospel ministry, so much more glorious than that of Moses (ch. iii. 6) ; which is the ministry by which the Holy Spirit acts on the hearts of men (ch. iii. 8) ; which is the mi- nistry of that system by which men are justified (ch. iii. 9) ; and which is the ministry of a system so pure and un- clouded, ch. iii. 9 — 11. 18. t As we have received mercy. Tindal renders this, "even as mercy is sure in us." The idea is, that it was by the mere mercy and favour of God, that he had been intrusted with the ministry, and the object of Paul is doubtless to prevent the appearance of arrogance and self- confidence by stating that it was to be traced entirely to God that he was put into the ministry. He doubtless had his eye on the fact that he had been a per- secutor and blasphemer; and that it was by the mere favour of God that he had been converted and intrusted with the ministry. 1 Tim. i. 13. Nothing will more effectually humble a minister, and prevent his assuming any an-ogant and self-confident airs, than to look over his past life ; especially if his life was one of blasphemy, vice, or infidelity ; and to remember that it is by the mere mercy of God that he is intrusted with the high office of an ambassador of Jesus Christ. Paul never forgot to trace his hope, his appointment to the ministerial office, and his success, to the mere grace of God. t We faint not. This is one of the effects of being in- trusted with such a ministry. The word here used (fxx^xoyp.sv) means pro- perly, to turn out a coward ; to lose one's courage; then to be faint-hearted, to faint, to despond, in view of trial, difficulty, &c. — Robinson. Here it means, that bv the mercy of God, ho A. I). 60.] CHAPTER IV. IS 2 But have renounced the hid- den things of * dishonesty, not > shamt. ^ts not disheartened by the difficirities which he met; his faith and zeal did not flag; he was enabled to be faithful, and laborious, and his courage always kopt up, and his mind was filled with cheerfulness. See Note on ch. ii. 1 4. He was deterred by no difficulties ; em- barrassed by no opposition ; driven from his purpose by no persecution; and his strength did not fail under any trials. The consciousness of being intrusted with such a ministry animated him ; and the mercy and grace of God sus- tained him. 2. But havs^ renounced {diTraTrdfxi^A, from OLTTQ and e/Tcv). The word means properly to speak out or off; to refuse or deny ; to interdict or forbid. Here it means, to renounce, or disown ; to spurn, or scorn with aversion. It oc- curs nowhere else in the New Testa- ment ; and the sense here is, that the apostles had such a view of the truth of religion, and the glory of the Christian scheme (ch. iii. 13 — 18), as to lead them to discard every thing that was disguised, and artful, and crafty ; every thing like deceit and fraud. The reli- gions of the heathen were made up mainly of trick, and were supported by de« eption practised on the ignorant, and on the mass of men. Paul says, that he and his feIlow4abourers had such views of the truth, and glory, and holi- ness of the Christian scheme, as to lead them solemnly to abjure and abhor all such dishonest tricks and devices. Truth never needs such arts ; and no cause will long succeed by mere trick and cunning. •! The hidden things of dishonesty. Marg. shame. The Greek word most commonly means shame, or disgrace. The hidden things of shame here mean disgraceful conduct; clan- destine and secret arts, which were in themselves shameful and disgraceful. They denote all t*nc?erAanc?edf dealings; all dishonest artifices and plans, such a.s were common among the heathen, and 7 walking in craftiness, nor hand- ling the word of God deceitfully, " o c. 2. 17. such probably as the false teachers adopted in the propagation of their opinions at Corinth. The expression here does not imply that the apostles ever had any thing to do with such arts; but that they solemnly abjured and abhorred them. Religion is open, plain, straight-forward. It has no alli- ance with cunning, and trick, and arti- fice. It should be defended openly; stated clearly ; and urged with steady argument. It is a work of light, and not of darkness. ^ Not walking in craftiness. Not acting craftily; not behaving in a crafty manner. The word here used (Tuvcu^yii, from Tav, all, igjycv, work, i. e. doing every thing, or capable of doing any thing) denotes shrewdness, cunning, and craft. This was common; and this was probably practised by the false teachers in Corinth. With this Paul says he had nothing to do. He did not adopt a course of carnal wisdom and policy (Note, ch. i. 12) ; he did not attempt to impose upon them, or to deceive them ; or to make his way by subtle and de- ceitful arts. True religion can never be advanced by trick and craftiness. 1[ Nor handling the word of God deceitfully {ioxoZvn-;). Not falsifying; or deceit- fully corrupting or disguising the truth of God. The phrase seems to be sy- nonymous with that used in ch. ii. 1"^, and rendered "corrupt the word of God." See Note on that verse. It properly means to falsify, adulterate, corrupt, by Jewish traditions, &c. (Robinson, Bloomfield, Doddridge, &c.); or it may mean, as in our translation, to handle in a deceitful manner ; to make use of trick and art in propagating and defending it. Tindal renders it, " nei- ther corrupt we the word of God." ^But by mayiifestation of the truth. By making the truth manifest ; i. e. by a simple exhibition of the truth. By stating it just as it is, in an undisguised and open manner. Not by adulteratinj 74 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. but by manifestation of the truth commending oursehes to every it with foreign mixtures ; not by min- gling it with philosophy, or traditions ; not by blunting its edge, or concealing any thing, or explaining it away ; but by an open, plain, straight-forward ex- hibition of it as it is in Jesus. Preach- ing should consist in a simple exhibition of the truth. There is no deceit in the gospel itself; and there should be none in the manner of exhibiting it. It should consist of a simple statement of things as they are. The whole design of preaching is, to make known the truth. And this is done in an effectual manner only when it is simple, open, undisguised, without craft, and without deceit, f Commending ourselves to every man^s conscience. That is, so speaking the truth that every man's conscience shall approve it as true ; every man shall see it to be true, and to be in accordance with what he knows to be right. Conscience is that faculty of the mintl which distinguishes between right and wrong, and which prompts us to choose the former and avoid the latter. John viii. 9. Note Rom. ii. 15. 1 Cor. x. 25. 27—29. 2 Cor. i. 12. It is im^jlied here, (1.) That a course of life, and a manner of preaching that shall be free from dis- honesty, and art, and trick, will be such as the consciences of men will ap- prove. Paul sought such a course of life as should accord with their sense of right, and thus serve to commend the gospel to them. (2.) That the gospel may be so preached as to be seen by men to be true ; so as to be approved as right ; and so that every man's con- science shall bear testimony to its truth. Men do not love it, but they may sec that it is true ,• they may hate it, but they may see that the truth which con- demns their practices is from heaven. This is an exceedingly important prin- ciple in regard to preaching, and vastly momentous in its bearing on the views which ministers should have of their own work. The gospel is reasonable. It may be seen to be true by every man ^ li-t--- \t -a preached. And it should be the aim of every preacher so to preach it, as to enlist the consciences of his hearers in his favour. And it is a very material fact that when so preach- ed the conscience and reason of every man is in its favour, and they know that it is true even when it pronounce* their own condemnation, and denounce* their own sins. This passage proves, therefore, the following things. (1.) That the gospel may be so preached aa to be seen to be true by all men. Men are capable of seeing the truth, and even when they do not love it, they can perceive that it has demonstration that it is from God. It is a system sc« reasonable ; so well established by evi- dence ; so fortified by miracles, and tha fulfilment of prophecies ; so pure in it» nature ; so well-adapted to man ; s(? fitted to his condition, and so well de- signed to make him better; and sc happy in its influence on society, thai men may be led to see that it is true. And this I take to be the case with almost all those who habitually attend on the preaching of the gospel. Infidelsi do not often visit the sanctuary ; and when they are in the habit of doing it* it is a fact that they gradually come to the conviction that the Christian reli gion is true. It is rare to find professed infidels in our places of worship; and the great mass of those who attend on the preaching of the gospel may be set down as speculative believers in the truth of Christianity. (2.) The con- sciences of men are on the side of truth, and the gpspel may be so preached as to enlist their consciences in its favour. Conscience prompts to do right, and condemns us if we do wrong. It can never be made to approve of wrong never to give a man peace if he doep that which he knpws to be evil. By nu art or device ; by no system of laws, or bad government ; by no training or dis- cipline, can it be made the advocate of sin. In all lands, at all times, and in all circumstances, it prompts a man to do what is right, and condemns him if he does wrong. It may be silenced fol A.D.60.] CHAPTER IV. 75 man's conscience m the sight of God. a time ; it may be " seared as with a hot iron" and for a time be insensible, but if it speak at all, it speaks to prompt a man to do what he believes to be light, and condemns him if he does that which is wrong. The consciences of men are on the side of the gospel ; and it is only their hearts which are opposed to it. Their consciences are in favour of the gospel in the following, among other respects, (a) They approve of it as a just, pure, holy, and reasonable system ; as in accordance with what they feel to be right ; as recommending that which ought to be done, and forbidding that which ought not to be done, (b) In its special requirements on themselves. Their consciences tell them that they ought to love God with all the heart; to repent of their sins ; to trust in that Saviour who died for them ; and to lead a life of prayer and of devotedness to the service of God ; that they ought to be sincere and humble Christians, and prepare to meet God in peace, (c) Their consciences approve the truth that condemns them. No matter how strict it may seem to be ; no matter how loud its denunciation against their sins; no matter how much the gospel may condemn their pride, avarice, sensuality, levity, dishonesty, fraud, intemperance, profaneness, blasphemy, or their neglect of their soul, yet their consciences ap- prove of it as right, and proclaim that these things ought to be con- demned, and ought to be abandoned. The heart may love them, but the con- science cannot be made to approve them. And the minister of the gospel may always approach his people, or an indi- vidual man, with the assurance that however much they may love the ways of sin, yet that he has their consciences in his favour, and that in urging the claims of God on them, their consciences will always coincide with his appeals. (3.) The way in which a minister is to commend himself to the consciences of men, is that which was pursued by 3 But if our gospel be hid, it is hid to them " that are lost : a 2 Th. 2. 10. Paul. He must (a) Have a clear and unwavering conviction of the truth him- self. On this subject he should have no doubi. He should be able to look on it as on a burnished mirror (Note, ch. iii. 18); and to see its glory as with open face, (b) It should be by the simple statement of the truth of the gospel. Not by preaching philosophy, or meta- physics, or the traditions of man, or the sentiments of theologians, but the sim- ple truths of the gospel of Jesus Christ. Men may be made to see that these are truths, and God will take care that the reason and consciences of men shall be in their favour, (c) By the absence of all trick and cunning, and disguised and subtle arts. The gospel has nothing of these in itself, and it will never ap- prove of them, nor will God bless them. A minister of Jesus should be frank, open, undisguised, and candid. Ha should make a sober and elevated ap peal to the reason and conscience of man. The gospel is not " a cunningly devised fable ;" it has no trick in itself, and the ministers of religion should solemnly abjure all the hidden things of dishonesty. ^ In the sight of God. As in the immediate presence of God. We act as if we felt that his eye was upon us; and this consideration serves to keep us from the hidden things of dis- honesty, and from improper arts in spreading the true religion. See Note on ch. ii. 17. 3. But if our gospel be hid. Paul here calls it his gospel, because it was that which he preached, or the message which he bore. See Note, Rom. xvi. 25. The sense here is, *if the gospel which I preach is not understood ; if its meaning is obscure or hidden ; if its glory is not seen.' It is implied here, that to many the beauty and glory of the gospel was not perceived. This was undeniable, notwithstanding the plainness and fulness with which its truths were made known. The object o Paul here is, to state "that this fact 76 4 In whom the god " of this a Jno. 12. 31. 40. II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. world hath blinded the minds of was not to be traced to any want of clearness in the gospel itself, but to other causes, and thus probably to meet an objection which might be made to his argument about the clearness and ful- ness of the revelation in the gospel. In the language which Paul uses here, there is undoubted allusion to what he had said respecting Moses, who put a vail on his face. ch. iii. 13. He had hid, or concealed his face, as emblematic of the nature of his institutions (Note, ch. iii. 14.); and here Paul says that it was not to be denied that the gospel was vailed also to some. But it was not from the nature of the gospel. It was not because God had purposely con- cealed its meaning. It was not from any want of clearness in itself. It was to be traced to other causes. ^ It is hid to them that are lost. On the mean- ing of the word here rendered "lost," see Note, ch. ii. 15, there rendered "perish." It is hid among them who are about to perish ; who are perishing (iv T&7? d5roAAy//4vo/f); those who deserve to perish. It is concealed only among that class who may be designated as the perishing, or as the lost. Grotius explains this, " those who deserve to perish, who foster their vices, and will not see the truth which condemns those vices." And he adds, that this might very well be, for, " however conspicuous the gospel was in itself, yet like the aun it would not be visible to the blind.** The cause was not in the gospel, but In themselves. This verse teaches, therefore, ( 1 .) That the beauty of the gospel may be hidden from many of the human family. This is a matter of simple fact. There are thousands and millions to whom it is preached who see no beauty in it, and who regard it as foolishness. (2.) That there is a class of men who may be called, even now, the lust. They are lost to virtue, to piety, to happiness, to hope. They deserve to perish; and they are hastening to merited ruin. This class in the time of Paul was large ; and 't is large now. It is composed of those to whom the gospel is hidden, or to whom it appears to be vailed, and who see no beauty in it. It is made up in- deed of all the profane, polluted, and vile ; but their characteristic feature is, that the gospel is hidden from them, and that they see no beauty and glory in it. (3.) This is not the fault of the gospel. It is not the fault of the sun when men shut their eyes and will not see it. It is not the fault of a running stream, or a bubbling fountain, if men will not drink of it, but rather choose to die of thirst. The gospel does not obscure and conceal its own glory any more than the sun does. It is in itself a clear and full revelation of God and his grace ; and that glory is adapted to shed light upon the benighted minds of men. 4. In whom. In respect to whom among whom ; or in whose hearts. The design of this verse is to accou7}t for the fact that the glory of the gospel was not seen by them. It is to be traced entirely to the agency of him whom Paul here calls " the god of this world." ^ The god of this world. There can be no doubt that Satan is here designated by this appellation; though some of the fathers supposed that it means the true God, and Clarke inclines to this opinion. In John xii. 31, he is called "the prince of this world." In Eph. ii. 2, he is called " the prince of the power of the air." And in Eph. vi. 12, the same bad influence is referred to under the names of " principalities, and powers," " the rulers of the darkness of this world," and " spiritual wickedness in high places." The name " god" is here given to him, not because he has any divine attributes, but because he actually has the homage of the men of this world as their god, as the being who is really worshipped, or who has the affections of their hearts in the same way as it is given to idols. By " tliis world" is meant the wicked world ; or the mass of men. He has dominion over the world. They obey his will ; A. D. CO.] CHAPTER IV. r> them which believe not, lest the light of the glorious gospel of tliey execute his plans ; they further his purposes, and they are his obedient subjects. He had subdued the world to himself, and was really adored in the place of the true God. See Note on 1 Cor. X. 20. " They sacrificed to devils and not to God." Here it is meant by the declaration that Satan is the god of this world, (1.) That the world at large was under his control and direction. He secured the apostasy of man, and early brought him to follow his plans ; and he has maintained his sceptre and dominion since. No more abject sub- mission could be desired by him than has been rendered by the mass of men. (2.) The idolatrous world particularly IS undgr iiis control, and subject to him. '1 Cor. x. 20. He is worshipped there ; and the religious rites and cere- monies of the heathen are in general just such as a mighty being who hated human happiness, and who sought pol- lution, obscenity, wretchedness, and blood would appoint ; and over all the heathen world his power is absolute. In the time of Paul all the world, except the Jews and Christians, was sunk hi heathen degradation. (.3.) He rules in the hearts and lives of all wicked men — and the world is full of wicked men. They obey him, and submit to his will in executing fraud, and rapine, and piracy, and murder, and adultery, and lewdness ; in wars and fightings ; in their amuse- ments and paetimes ; in dishonesty and falsehood. The dominion of Satan over this world has been, and is still almost universal and absolute j nor has the lapse of eighteen hundred years rendered the appellation improper as des(jriptive of his influence, that he is the god of this world. The world pur- sues his plans; yields to his tempta- tions ; neglects, or rejects the reign of God as he pleases ; and submits to his sceptre, and is still full of abomination, cruelty, and pollution, as he desires it to be. \ Hath blinded i he minds of them 7* Christ, who is the image ** of God, should shine unto them. a Jno. 1. 14, 18. which believe not. Of all who discern no beauty in the gospel, and who reject it. It is implied here, (1.) That the minds of unbelievers are blinded ; that they perceive no beauty in the gospel. This is often aflirmed of those who reject the gospel, and who live in sin. See Note on ch. ii. 13. Matt, xxiii. 16, 17. 26. Luke iv. 18. John ix. 39 ; xii. 40. Rom. xi. 7. The sense is, that they did not see the spiritual beauty and glory of the plan of redemp- tion. They act in reference to that as they would in reference to this world, if a bandage were over their eyes, and they saw not the light of the sun, the beauty of the landscape, the path in which they should go^ or the counte- nance of a friend. All is dark, and ob- scure, and destitute of beauty to them^ however much beauty may be seen in all these objects by others. (2.) That this is done by the agency of Satan ; and that his dominion is secured by keeping the world in darkness. The aflSrmation is direct and positive, that it is by his agency that it is done. Some of the modes in which it is done are the fol- lowing, (a) By a direct influence on the minds of men. I do not know why it is absurd to suppose that one intellect may, in some way unknown to us, have access to another, and have power to influence it ; nor can it be proved that Satan may not have power to pervert the understanding ; to derange its powers ; to distract its attention ; and to give in view of the mind a wholly de- lusive relative importance to objects. In the time of the Saviour it cannot be doubted that in the numerous cases of demoniacal possessions, Satan directly affected the minds of men ; nor is there any reason to think that he has ceased to delude and destroy them, (b) By the false philosophy which has pre- vailed — a laVge part of which seems to have been contrived as if on purpose to deceive the world, and destroy the 78 IT. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. peace and happiness of men. (c) By the systems of superstition and idolatry. All these seem to be under the control of one master mind. They are so well conceived and adapted to prostrate the moral powers; to fetter the intellect; to pervert the will ; to make men debased, sunken, polluted, and degraded ; and they 80 uniformly accomplish this effect, that they have all the marks of being under the control of one mighty mind, and of having been devised to accomplish his purposes over men. (d) By producing in the minds of men a wholly dispro- portionate view of the value of objects. A very small object held before the eye will shut out the light of the sun. A piece of money of the smallest value laid on the eye will make every thing appear dark, and prevent all the glory of midday from reaching the seat of vision. And so it is with the things of this world. They are placed directly before us, and are placed directly be- tween us and the glory of the gospel. And the trifles of wealth and of fashion ; the objects of pleasure and ambition, are made to assume an importance in view of the mind which wholly excludes the glory of the gospel, and shuts out all the realities of the eternal world. And he docs it (e) By the blinding influence of passion and vice. Before a vicious mind all is dark and obscure. There is no beauty in truth, in chastity, or honesty, or in the fear and love of God. Vice always renders the mind blind, and the heart hard, and shrouds every thing in the moral world in midnight. And in order to blind the minds of men to the glory of the gospel, 8atan has only to place splendid schemes of speculation before men ; to tempt them to climb the steeps of ambition ; to entice them to scenes of gayety ; to secure the erection of theatres, and gambling houses, and houses of infamy and pollution ; to fill the cities and towns of a land with taverns and dram-shops ; and to give opportunity everywhere for the full play and Unrestrained indulgence of passion; and the glory of the gospel will be as effectually unseen as the glory of the sun is in the darkest night. t Lest the light, &c. This passage states the design for which Satan blinds the minds of men. It is because he hates the gospel, and wishes to prevent its influence and spread in the world. Satan has always hated and opposed it, and all his arts have been employed to arrest its diffusion on earth. The word light here means excellence, beauty, or splendour. Light is the emblem of knowledge, purity, or innocence; and is here and elsewhere applied to the gospel, because it removes the errors, and sins, and wretchedness of men, as the light of the sun scatters the shades of night. This purpose of preventing the light of the gospel shining on men, Satan will endeavour to accomplish by all the means in his power. It is his grand object in this world, because it is by the gospel only that man can be saved ; by that that God is glorified on earth more than by any thing else ; and because, therefore, if he can prevent sinners from embracing that, he will secure their destruction, and most ef- fectually show his hatred of God. And it is to Satan a matter of little impor- tance wliat men may be, or are, pro- vided they are not Christians. They may be amiable, moral, accomplished, rich, honoured, esteemed by the world, because in the possession of all these he may be equally sure of their ruin, and because, also, these things may contri- bute somewhat to turn away their minds from the gospel. Satan, there- fore, will not oppose plans of gain o. ambition ; he will not oppose purposes of fashion and amusement ; he may not oppose schemes by which we desire to rise in the world ; he will not oppose the theatre, the ball-room, the dance, or the song ; he will not oppose thoughtless mirth ; but the moment the gospel begins to shine on the benighted mind, that moment he will make resist- ance, and then all his power will bo concentrated, t The glorious gospel Gr. ' The gospel of the glory of Christ,* a Hebraism for the glorious gospel Mr. Locke renders it, "the glorious brightness of the light of the gospel of Christ," and supposes it means tlio A. D. 60 ] CHAPTER IV. 79 5 For \vc preach not selves, but Christ Jesus our- the brightness, or clearness, of the doctrine wherein Christ is manifested in the gospel. — It is all light, and splendour, and beauty, compared with the dark systems of philosophy and heathenism. It is glorious, for it is full of splendour ; makes known the glorious God; dis- closes a glorious plan of salvation ; and conducts ignorant, weak, and degraded man to a world of light. No two words in our language are so full of rich and precious meaning, as the phrase " glo- rious gospel." t ^^0 is the image of God. Christ is called the image of God, (1.) In respect to his divine nature, his exact resemblance to God in his divine attributes and perfections. See Col. i. 15, and Heb. i. 3 ; and, (2.) In his moral attributes as Mediator, as showing forth the glory of the Father to men. He resembles God, and in him we see the divine glory and perfections embodied, and shine forth. It is from his resemblance to God in all respects that he is called his image ; and it is through him that the divine perfections are made known to men. — It is an ob- ject of especial dislike and hatred to Satan that the glory of Christ, who is the image of God, should shine on men, and fill their hearts. Satan hates that image; he hates that .men should be- come like God ; and he hates all that has a resemblance to the great and glo- rious Jehovah. 5. For we preach not ourselves. The connexion here is not very apparent, and the design of this verse has been vadously understood. The connexion seems to me to be this. Paul gives here a reason for what he had said in the previous parts of the epistle respecting his conduct in the ministry. He had said that his course had been open, and pure, and free frcm all dishonest arts and tricks, and that he had not cor- rupted the word of God, or resorted to any artifice to accomplish his designs. Ch. ii. 17 ; iv. 1, 2. The reason of this he here says is, that he had not preach- Lord ; and vants for Jesus ourselves '' sake. your ser- ed himself, or sought to advance hia own interest. He regarded himself as sent to make known a Saviour ; himself as bound by all means to promote his cause, and to imitate him. Other men — the false teachers, and the cunning priests of the heathen religion — sought to advance their own interest, and to per- petuate a system of delusion that would be profitable to themselves ; and they therefore resorted to all arts, and stra- tagems, and cunning devices to per- petuate their authority, and extend their influence. But the fact that Paul and his associates went forth to make known the Lord Jesus, was a reason why they avoided all such dishonest arts and artifices. * We are merely the ambas- sadors of another. We are not princi- pals in this business, and do not de- spatch it as a business of our own, but we transact it as the agents for another, i. e. for the Lord Jesus, and we feel ourselves bound, therefore, to do it as he would have done it himself; and as he was free from all trick, and dishonest art, we feel bound to be also.' "This seems to me to be the design of this passage. Ministers may be said to preach them selves in the following ways. (1.) When their preaching has a primary reference to their own interest ; and when they engage in it to advance their reputation, or to secure in some way their own advantage. When they aim at exalting their authority, extending their influence, or in any way promot- ing their own welfare. (2.) When they proclaim their own opinions and not the gospel of Christ; when they de- rive their doctrines from their owKi reasonings, and not from the Bible. (3.) When they put themselves for- ward ; speak much of themselves ; refer often to themselves; are vain of their powers of reasoning, of their eloquence, and of their learning, and seek to make these known rather than the simple truth of the gospel. In one word, when self is primary, and the gospel is se- 80 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. condary ; when they prostitute the minis- t"y to gain popularity ; to live a life of ease ; to be respected ; to obtain a liveli- hood ; to gain influence ; to rule over a people ; and to make the preaching of the gospel merely a?? occasion of advanc- ing themselves in the world. — Such a plan, it is implied here, would lead to dishonest arts and devices, and to trick and stratagem to accomplish the end in view. And it is implied here, also, that to avoid all such tricks and arts the true way is not to preach ourselves, but Jesus Christ, f But Christ Jesus the Lord. This Paul states to be the only purpose of the ministry. It is so far the sole design of the ministry that had it not been to make known the Lord Jesus, it would never have been established ; and whatever other objects are secured by its appointment, and whatever other truths are to be illustrated and enforced by the ministry, yet, if this is not the primary subject, and if eveiy other object is not made subservient to this, the design of the ministry is not secured. The word *' Christ" properly means the anointed, i. e. the Messiah, the anointed of God for this great office (see Note, Matt. i. 1) ; but it is used in the New Testament as a proper name, the name that was ap- propriate to Jesus. Still it may be used with a reference to the fact of the Mes- siahship, and not merely as a proper name, and in this place it may mean that they preached Jesus o^ the Messiah, or the Christ, and defended his claims to that high appouitment. The word *'Lord" also is used to designate him (Mark xi. 3. John xx. 25) ; and when it stands by itself in the New Testa- ment, it denotes the Lord Jesus (Note, Acts i. 24) ; but it properly denotes one who has rule or authority, or proprietor- ship ; and it is used here not merely as a part of the appropriate title of the Sa- viour, but with reference to the fact that he had the supreme headship, or lordship. over the church and the world. This important passage, therefore, means, that they made it their sole busi- ness to make known Jesus the Messiah, or the Christ, as the supreme head and I^ord of people ; i. c. to set forth the Messiahship and the lordship of Jesus of Nazareth, appointed to these high offices by God. To do this, or to prew;!! Jesus Christ the Lord, implies the fol- lowing things. (1.) To prove that he is the Messiah so often predicted in the Old Testament, and so long expected by the Jewish people. To do this was a very vital part of the work of the ministry in the time of the apostles, and was essential to their success in all their attempts to convert the Jews ; and to do this will be no less important in all attempts to bring the Jews now or in future times to the knowledge of the truth. No man can be successful among them who is not able to prove that Jesus is the Messiah. — It is not indeed so vital and leading a point now in reference to those to whom the ministers of the gospel usually preach ; and it is probable that the importance of this argument is by many overlooked, and that it is not urged as it should be by those who " preach Christ Jesus the Lord." It involves the whole argu- meiit for the truth of Christianity. It leads to all the demonstrations that this religion is from God ; and the establish- ment of the proposition that Jesus is the Messiah, is one of the most direct and certain ways of proving that his religion, is from heaven. For (a) It contains the argument from the fulfilment of the prophecies — one of the main evidences of the truth of revelation ; and (b) It involves an examination of all the evi deuces that Jesus gave that he was the Messiah sent from God, and of course an examination of all the miracles that he wrought in attestation of his divine mission. The first object of a preacher, therefore, is to demonstrate that Jesus is sent from God in accordance with the predictions of the prophets. (2.) To proclaim the truths that he taught To make known his sentiments, and his doctrines, and not our own. This in- cludes, of course, all that he taught respecting God, and respecting man; all that he taught respecting his own nature, and the design of his coming , all that he taught respecting the charac- ter of the human heart, and about hu- A. D. 60.] CHAPTER IV. 81 man obligation anJ duty ; all that he taught respecting death, the judgment, and eternity — respecting an eternal heaven, and an eternal hell. To ex- plain, enforce, and vindicate his doc- trines, is one great design of the minis- try ; and were there nothing else, this would be a field sufficiently ample to employ the life ; sufficiently glorious to employ the best talents of man. The minister of the gospel is to teach the sentiments and doctrines of Jesus Christ, in contradistinction from all his own sentiments, and from all the doctrines of mere philosophy. He is not to teach science, or mere morals, but he is to proclaim and defend the doctrines of the Redeemer. (3.) He is to make known the facts of the Saviour's life. He is to show how he lived — to hold up his ex- ample in all the trying circumstances in which he was placed. For he came to show by his life what the law required ; and to show how men should live. And it is the office of the Christian ministry, or a part of their work in preaching " Christ Jesus the Lord," to show how he lived, and to set forth his self-denial, his meekness, his purity, his blameless life, his spirit of prayer, his submission to the divine will, his pa- tience in suffering, his forgiveness of his enemies, his tenderness to the af- flicted, the weak, and the tempted ; and the manner of his death. Were this all, it would be enough to employ the whole of a minister's life, and to command the best talents of the world. For he was the only perfectly pure mo- del ; and his example is to be followed by all his people, and his example is designed to exert a deep and wide in- fluence on the world. Piety flourishes just in proportion as the pure example of Jesus Christ is kept before a people ; and the world is made happier and better just as that example is kept con- stantly in view. To the gay and the thoughtless, the ministers of the gospel are to show how serious and calm was the Redeemer ; to the worldly-miuded, to show how he lived above the world ; to the avaricious, how benevolent he was ; to the profane and licentious, how pure he was ; to the tempted, how he endured temptation ; to the afflicted, how patient and resigned ; to the dying, how he died : — to all, to show how holy, and heavenly-minded, and prayerful, and pure he was ; in order that they may be won to the same purity, and be prepared to dwell with him in his kingdom. (4.) To set forth the design of his death. To show why he came to die ; and what was the great object to be effected by his sufterings and death. To exhibit, therefore, the sorrows of his life ; to describe his many trials; to dwell upon his sufferings in the garden of Geth- semane, and on the cross. To show why he died, and what was to be the influence of his death on the destiny of man. To show how it makes an atone- ment for sin ; how it reconciles God to man ; how it is made efficacious in the justification and the sanctification of the sinner. And were there nothing else, this would be sufficient to employ all the time, and the best talents in the mmistry. P or the salvation of the soul depends on the proper exhibition of the design of the death of the Redeemer. There is no salvation but through his blood ; and hence the nature and design of his atoning sacrifice is to be exhi- bited to every man, and the oflers of mercy through that death to be pressed upon the attention of every sinner. (5.) To set forth the truth and the design of his resurrection. To prove that he rose from the dead, and that he ascend- ed to heaven ; and to show the influence of his resurrection on our hopes and destiny. The whole structure of Chris- tianity is dependent on making out the fact that he rose ; and if he rose, all the difficulties in the doctrine of the resur- rection of the dead are removed at once, and his people will also rise. The in- fluence of that fact, therefore, on our hopes and on our prospects for eternity, is to be shown by the ministry of the gospel ; and were there nothing else, this would be ample to command all the time, and the best talents of the ministry. (6.) To proclaim him as " Lord." This is expressly specified i» the passage before us. " For we preach S2 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. Christ Jesus the liOnn ;'' we proclaim him as the Lord. I'hat is, he is to he preached as having dominion over tlie conscience; as the supreme Ruler in his Church ; as above all councils, and synods, and conferences, and all human authority ; as having a right to legislate for his people ; a right to prescribe their mode of worship ; a right to define and determine the doctrines which they shall believe. He is to be proclaimed also as ruling over all, and as exalted in his mediatorial character over all worlds, and as having all things put be- neath his feet. Ps. ii. 6. Isa. ix. 6, 7. Matt, xxviii. 1 8. John xvii. 2. Eph. i. 20. Heb. ii. 8. ^ And ourselves your servants, &c. So far as we make any mention of ourselves, it is to declare that we are your servants, and that we are bound to promote your welfare in the cause and for the sake of the Redeemer. That is, they were their servants in all things in which they could advance the interests of the Redeemer's kingdom among them. The doctrine is, that they re- garded themselves as under obligation not to seek their own interest, or to build up their own reputation and cause, but to seek the welfare of the church ; and promote its interests, as a servant does that of his master. They should not seek to lord it over God's heritage, and to claim supreme and independent authority. They were not masters but servants. The church at large was the master, and they were its servants. This implies .the following things. (1.) That the time of ministers belongs to the church, and should be employed in its welfare. It is not their own ; and it is not to be employed in farming, or in speculating, or in trafficking, or in idleness, or in lounging, or in unpro- fitable visiting, or in mere science, or in reading or making books that will not advance the interests of the church. The time of the ministry is not for ease, or ambition, or self-indulgence, but is to promote the interests of the body of Christ. So Paul felt, and so he lived. (2.) Their talents belong to the church. AH their original talents, and all that lliey can acquire, should be honestly devoted to the welfare of the church of the Redeemer. (3.) Their best efforts and plans, the avails of their best thoughts and purposes, belong to the church, and should be honestly devoted to it. Their strength, and vigour, and influence should be devoted to it, as the vigour, and strength, and talent, and skill of a servant belong to the master. See Ps. cxxxvii. 5, 6. The language of the ministry, as of every Christian, should be: I love thy church, O God, Her walls before thne stand. Dear as the apple of thine eye, And graven on thy hand. If e'er to bless thy sons My voice or hands deny, These hands let us'jful skill forsake, This voice in silence die. If e'er my heart forget Her welfare or her wo, Let every joy this heart forsake. And every grief o'erfiow. For her my tetrs shall fall. For her my prayers ascend. To her my cares and toils be eiven^ Till toils and cares shall end. And it implies, (4.) That they are the servants of the church in time of trial, temptation, and affliction. They are to devote themselves to the comfort of the afflicted. They are to be the guide to the perplexed. They are to aid the tempted. They are to comfort those that mourn, and they are to sustain and console the dying. They are to regard themselves as the servants of the church to accomplish these great objects ; and are to be willing to deny themselves, and to take up their cross, and to con- secrate their time to the advancement of these great interests. And they are, in all respects, to devote their time, and talents, and influence to the welfare of the church, with as much singlt-mind- edness as the servant is to seek the interest of his master. It was in this way eminently that Paul was favoured with the success with which God blessed him in the ministry ; and so every minister will be successful, just in proportion to the single-mindedness with which he devotes himself to the work of preaching Jesus Christ tub Lord. A. D. 60.] 6 For God, who commanded " aGe. 1.3. CHAPTER IV. 83 the light to shine out of darkness, 6. For God, who commanded, &c. The design of this verse seems to be, to give a reason why Paul and his fellow- apostles did not preach themselves, but Jesus Christ the Lord. ver. 5. That reason was, that their minds had been so illuminated by that God who had commanded the light to shine out of darkness, that they had discerned the glory of the divine perfections shining in and through the Redeemer, and they therefore gave themselves to the work of making him known among men. The doctrines which they preached they had not derived from men in any form. They had not been elaborated by human reasoning or science, nor had they been imparted by tradition. They had been communicated directly by the source of all light — the true God — who had shined into the hearts that were once benighted by sin. Having been thus illuminated, they had felt themselves bound to go and make known to others the truths which God had imparted to them, f Who commanded the light, &c. Gen. i. 3. God caused it to shine by his simple command. He said " let there be light, and there was light." The fact that it was produced by his saying so is referred to here by Paul by nis use of the phrase (o «iVJ.v) " Who saying^'' or speaking the light to shine from darkness. The passage in Genesis is adduced by Longinus as a striking instance of the sublime, t Hath shined m our hearts. Marg. "It is he who hath." This is more in accordance with the Greek, and the sense is, ♦The God who at the creation bade the light to shine out of darkness, is he who has shined into our hearts ; or it is the same God who has illuminated us, who commanded the light to shine at the creation.' Light is everywhere in the Bible the emblem of knowledge, purity, and truth; as darkness is the emblem of ignorance, error, sin, and wretchedness. See Note, John i. 4, b. And the sense here is, that God had removed this ignorance, and poured a flood of light and truth on their minds. This passage teaches, therefore, the following important truths in regard to Christians — since it is as applicable to all Christians, as it was to the apostles. (1.) That the mind is by nature igno- rant and benighted — to an extent which may be properly compared with the darkness which prevailed before God commanded the light to shine. Indeed, the darkness which prevailed before the light was formed, was a most striking emblem of the darkness which exists in the mind of man before it is enlightened by revelation, and by the Holy Spirit. For (a) In all minds by nature there is deep ignorance of God, of his law, and his requirements ; and (b) This is often greatly deepened by the course of life which mon lead; by their education; or by their indulgence in sin, and by their plans of life ; and especially by the in- dulgence of evil passions. The ten- dency of man if left to himself is to plunge into deeper darkness, and to involve his mind more entirely in the obscurity of moral midnight. " Light is come into the world, and men loved darkness rather than light, because their deeds were evil." John iii. 19. (2.) This verse teaches the fact, that the minds of Christians are illuminated. They are enabled to see things as they are. This fact is often taught in the Scriptures. See 1 John ii. 20. 1 Cor. ii. 12 — 15. They have different views of things from their fellow-men, and different from what they once had. They perceive a beauty in religion which others do not see, and a glory in truth, and in the Saviour, and in the promises of the gospel, which they did not see before they were converted. This does not mean (a) That they are superior in their powers of understand- ing to other men — for the reverse is often the fact ; nor (b) That the effect of religion is at once to enlarge their own intellectual powers, and make them different from what they were before in this respect. But it means that they have 84 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. ^ hath shined in our hearts, to give the light of the knowledge » it is he who hath. clear and consistent views ; they look at things as they are ; they perceive a beauty in reUgion and in the service of God which they did not before. They see a beauty in the Bible, and in the doctrines of the Bible, which they did not before, and which sin- ners do not see. The temperate man will see a beauty in temperance, and in an ar- gument for temperance, which the drunk- ard will not ; the benevolent man will see a beauty in benevolence which the churl will not ; and so of honesty, truth, and chastity. And especially will a man who isreformedfrom intemperance, impurity, dishonesty, and avarice, see a beauty in a virtuous life which he did not before see. There is indeed no immediate and direct enlargement of the intellect ; but there is an effect on the heart which produces an appropriate and indirect effect on the un- derstanding. It is at the same time true, that the practice of virtue, that a pure heart, and that the cultivation of piety all tend to regulate, strengthen, and expand the intellect, as the ways of vice and the indulgence of evil passions and propensi- ties tend to enfeeble, paralyze, darken, and ruin the understanding; so that, other things being equal, the man of most decided virtue, and most calm and elevated piety, will be the man of the clearest and best regulated mind. His powers will be most assiduously, care- fully, and conscientiously cultivated, and he will feel himself bound to make the most of them. — The influence of piety in giving light to the mind is often strikingly manifested among un- lettered and ignorant Christians. It often happens, as a matter of fact, that they have by far clearer, and more just and elevated views of truth than men of the most mighty intellects, and most highly cultivated by science and adorned witli learning, but who have no piety ; and a practical acquaintance with their own hearts, and a practical experience of the power of religion in the days of temptation and trial is a better en- lightener of the mind on the subject of of the glory of God in the face of Jesus Christ. religion than all the learning of the schools. (3.) This verse teaches, thai it is the same God who enlightens the mind of the Christian that commanded the light at first to shine. He is th*! source of all light. He formed the light in the natural world ; he gives all light and truth on all subjects to the understanding ; and he imparts all cor- rect views of truth to the heart. Light is not originated by man ; and man on the subject of religion no more creates the light which beams upon his be- nighted mind than he created the light of the sun when it first shed its beams over the darkened earth. " All truth is from the sempiternal source of light di- vine ;" and it is no more the work of man to enlighten the mind, and dissipate the darkness from the soul of a benighted sinner, than it was of man to scatter the darkness that brooded over the creation, or than he can now turn the shades of midnight to noonday. All this work lies beyond the proper province of man ; and is all to be traced to the agency of God — the great fountain of light. (4.) It is taught here that it is the same power that gives light to the mind of the Christian which at first commanded the light to shine out of darkness. It requires the exertion of the same Omni- potence ; and the change is often as remarkable, and surprising. — Nothing can be conceived to be more grand than the first creation of light — when by one word the whole solar system was in a blaze. And nothing in the moral world is more grand than when by a word God commands the light to beam on the soul of a benighted sinner. Night is at once changed to day ; and all things are seen in a blaze of glory. The works of God appear different; the word of God appears different ; and a new as- pect of beauty is diffused over all things. — If it be asked in avhat way God thus imparts light to the mind, we may reply, (1.) By his written and preached word. All spiritual and saving light to A. D. 60.] CHAPTER IV. 65 the minds of men has come through his revealed truth. Nor does the Spirit of God now give or reveal any light to the mind which is not to be found in the word of God, and which is not im- parted through that medium. (2.) God makes use of his providential deal- ings to give light to the minds of men. They are then, by sicluiess, disappoint- ment, and pain, made to see the folly and vanity of the things of this world, and to see the necessity of a better por- tion. (3.) It is done especially and mainly by the influences of the Holy Spirit. It is directly by his agency that the heart becomes affected, and the mind enlightened. It is his province in the world to prepare the heart to receive the truth ; to dispose the mind to attend to it; to remove the obstructions which existed to its clear perception ; to enable the mind clearly to see the beauty of truth, and of the plan of salvation through a Redeemer. And whatever may be the means which may be used, it is still true that it is only by the Spirit of God that men are ever brought to see the truth clearly and brightly. The same Spirit that inspired the prophets and apostles also illuminates the minds of men now, removes the darkness from their minds, and enables them clearly to discover the truth as it is in Jesus. See Notes, 1 Cor. ii. 10 — 15. 1 To give the light of the knowledge of the glory of God. This shows the object, or the effect of enlightening the mind. It is that Christians may behold the divine glory. The meaning is, that it is for the purpose of enlightening and instructing them concerning the know- ledge of the glory of God. — Bloomjield. Doddridge renders it, " the lustre of the knowledge of God's glory." Tindal, " to give the light of the knowledge of the glorious God." The sense is, that the purpose of his shining into their hearts was to give light {v^oq ipaiTi(r/u.ov) i. e. unto the enlightening ; and the pur- pose of that light was to acquaint them with the knowledge of the divine glory. 1 In the face of Jesus Christ. That is, that they might obtain the knowledge of the divine glory as it shines in the 8 face of Jesus Christ ; or as it is reflected on the face, or the person of the Re- deemer. — There is undoubted allusion here to what is said of Moses (ch. iii. 13) when the divine glory was reflected on his face, and produced such a splen- dour and magnificence that the children of Israel could not steadfastly look upon it. The sense here is, that in the face or the person of Jesus Christ the glory of God shone clearly, and the divinity appeared without a vail. The divine perfections, as it were, illuminated him, as the face of Moses was illuminated ; or they shone forth through him, and were seen in him. The word rendered " face" here (rr^o^J,7r(iv) may mean either face or person. See Note, ch. ii. 10. The sense is not materially affected whichever translation is preferred. It is, that the divine perfections shone in and through the Redeemer. This re- fers doubtless to the following truths, ( 1.) That the glory of the divine nature is seen in him, since he is " the bright- ness of his glory, and the express image of his person." Heb. i. 3. And it is in and through him that the glory of the divine perfections are made known. (2.) That the glory of the divine attributes are made known through him, since it is through him that the work of creation was accomplished (John i. 3. Col. i. 16) ; and it is by him that the mercy and goodness of God have been mani- fested to men. (3.) That the glory of the divine moral character is seen through him, since when on earth he manifested the embodied divine perfec- tions; he showed what God is when incarnate ; he lived as became the in- carnate God — he was as pure and holy in human nature as God is in the heavens. And there is not, that we know of, one of the divine attributes or perfections which has not at some period, or in some form, been evinced by Jesu9 Qhrist. If it be the prerogative of God to be eternal, he was eternal. Isa. ix. 6. Rev. i. 8. 18. If it be the prerogative of God to be the creator, he was also the creator (John i. 3) ; if to be omni- scient, he was omniscient (Matt. xi. 27 Luke X. 22) ; if to be omnipresent, he II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 7 But we have this treasure is omnipresent (Matt, xviii. 20) ; if to be almighty, he was almighty (Isa. ix. 6) ; if to raise the dead, to give life, he did it (John v. 21 ; xii. 43, 44); if to still waves and tempests, he did it (Mark iv. 39) ; if to be full of benevo- lence, to be perfectly holy, to be with- out a moral stain or spot, then all this is found in Jesus Christ. And as the wax bears the perfect image of the seal •^perfect not only in the outline, and in the general resemblance, but in the filling up — in all the lines, and features, and letters on the seal, so it is with the Redeemer. There is not one of the divine perfections which has not the counterpart in him, and if the glory of the divine character is seen at all, it will be seen in and through him. 7. But we have this treasure. The treasure of the gospel ; the rich and in- valuable truths which they were called to preach to others. The word " trea- sure" is applied to those truths on ac- count of their inestimable worth. Paul in the previous verses had spoken of the gospel, the knowledge of Jesus Christ, as full of glory, and infinitely precious. This rich blessing had been committed to him and his fellow-la- bourers, to dispense it to others, and to diffuse it abroad. His purpose in this and the following verses is, to show that it had been so intrusted to them as to secure all the glory of its propagation to God, and so also as to show its un- speakable value. For this purpose, he not only afiirms that it is a treasure, but says that it had been so intrusted to them as to show the power of God in its propagation ; that it had showed its value in sustaining them in their many trials ; and thei/ had showed their sense of its worth by being willing to endure all kinds of trial in order to make it every where known, ver. 8 — 11. The expression here is similar to that which the Saviour uses when he calls the gospel "the pearl of great price." Matt. xiii. 46. ^ In earthen vessels. This refers to the apostles and ministers in earthen vessels, tliat the ex of religion, as weak and feeble; as having bodies decaying and dying; a« fragile, and liable to various accidents, and as being altogether unworthy to hold a treasure so invaluable; as if valuable diamonds and gold were placed in vessels of earth of coarse composi- tion, easily broken, and liable to decay. The word vessel (a-Ktvo;) means properly any utensil or instrument ; and is ap- plied usually to utensils of household furniture or hollow vessels for contain- ing things. Luke viii. 16. John xix.29. It is applied to the human body, as made of clay, and therefore frail and feeble, with reference to its containing any thing, as, e.g., treasure.. Comp. Note on Rom. ix^ 22, 23. The word rendered earthen, (c<7-Tg3fx./v5;>^ov) means that which is easy to bear, and is usually applied to a burden. See Matt. xi. 30. Comp. 2 Cor. i. 17. t Which is but for a moment. The Greek word here used (-rst^itvrlK'j.) occurs nowhere else in the New Testa- ment. It is an adverb, from ahrUct, etyTOf, and means properly, at this very instant; immediately. Here it seems to qualify the word " light," and to be used in the sense of momentary, tran- sient. Bloomfield renders it, " for the at present lightness of our affliction." Doddridge, " for this momentary light- ness of our affliction, which passes off 80 fast, and leaves so little impression that it may be called levity itself." The apostle evidently wished to express two ideas in as emphatic a manner as possi- ble; first, that the affliction was light, and, secondly, that it was transient, momentary, and soon passing away. His object is to contrast this with the glory that awaited him, as being heavy, and as being also eternal. ^ Worketh for us. See Note, ver. 12. Will pro- duce, will result in. The effect of these afflictions is to produce eternal glory. This they do, (1.) By their tendency to wean us from the world ; (2.) To purify the heart, by enabling us to break off from the sins on account of which God afflicts us; (3.) By disposing us to look to God for consolation and support in our trials; (4.) By inducing us to con- template the glories of the heavenly world, and thus winning us to seek heaven as oiu' home ; and, (5.) Because God has graciously promised to reward his people in heaven as the result of their bearing trials in this life. It is by affliction that he purifies them (Isa. xlviii. 10) ; and by trial that he takes their affections from the objects of time and sense, and gives them a relish for the enjoyments which result from the prospect of perfect and eternal glory. If A far more exceeding (itxB-' vTn^^j- km (k v!ri^0o\yiv). There is not to be found anywhere a more energetic ex pression than this. The word {vvi^^o K>i, here used (whence our word hy perbole) means properly a throwing, casting, or throwing beyond. In the New Testament it means excess, ex- cellence, eminence. See ver, 7. " The excellency of the power." The phrase Kx^'vTTigk'.-Kiiv means exceedingly, super- eminently, Rom, vii, 13, 1 Cor, xii. 31. 2 Cor. i. 8. Gal. i. 13. This expression would have been by itself intensive in a high degree. But this was not sufficient to express Paul's sense of the glory which was laid up for Christians. It was not enough for him to use the ordi- nary highest expression for the superla- tive to denote the value of the object in his eye. He therefore coins an ex- pression, and adds tU C?ri^0'j\>iv. It is not merely eminent ; but it is eminent unto eminence ; excess unto excess ; a hyperbole unto hyperbole — one hyper- bole heaped on another; and the ex A. D. 60.] CHAPTER IV. 95 18 While we look not at the pression means that it is "exceeding exceedingly'* glorious; glorious in the highest possible degree. — Robinson. Mr. Slade renders it, " infinitely exceed- ing." The expression is the Hebrew forr» of denoting the highest superla- tive • and it means that all hyperboles fail of expressing that eternal glory which remains for the just. It is infi- nite and boundless. You may pass from one degree to another; from one sublime height to another ; but still an infinity remains beyond. Nothing can describe the uppermost height of that glory; nothing can express its infini- tude, t Eternal. This stands in con- trast with the affliction that is for a mo- ment (jrdL^ioniKit). The one is mo- mentary, transient ; so short, even in the longest life, that it may be said to be an instant ; the other has no limits to its duration. It is literally everlasting. 1 Weight (/2a'^o?). This stands opposed to the {^iK:ie, like him, the following views and feelings — views and feelings 9* adapted to sustain us in all our trials, and to uphold us in all the conflicts of life. (1.) A firm and unwavering be- lief of the truth of the religion which we profess, and of the truth which we make known to others, ver, 12. No man can preach successfully, and no man can do much good, whose mind is vacillating and hesitating; who is filled with doubts, and who goes timidly to work, or who declares that of which he has no practical acquaintance, and no deep-felt conviction, and who knows not whereof he affirms. A man to do good must have a faith which never wavers; a conviction of truth which is constant ; a belief settled like the everlasting hills, which nothing can shake or overturn. With such a conviction of the truth of Christianity, and of the great doctrines which it inculcates, he cannot hut speak of it, and make known his convictions. He that believes that men ahe in fact in danger of hell, will tell them of it; he that believes there is an awful bar of judgment, will tell them of it ; he that believes that the Son of God became in- carnate and died for men, will tell them of it ; he that believes that there is a heaven, will invite them to it. And one reason why professing Christians are so reluctant to speak of these things, is, that they have no very settled and defi- nite conviction of their truth, and no correct view of their relative importance. (2.) We should have a firm assurance that God has raised up the Lord Jesus, and that we also shall be raised from the dead. ver. 14. The hope and ex- pectation of the resurrection of the dead was one of the sustaining principles which upheld Paul in his labours, and to attain to this was one of the grand objects of his life. Acts xxiii. 6. Phil, iii. 11. Under the influence of this hope and expectation, he was willing to encounter any danger, and to endure any trial. The prospect of being raised up to eternal life and glory was all that was needful to make trials welcome, and to uphold him in the midst of privation and toils. And so we, if we are assured of this great truth, shall welcome trial also, and shall be able to endure a^o 102 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. GO. tions and persecutions. They will soon be ended, and the eternal glory in the morning of the resurrection shall be more than a compensation for all that we shall endure in this life. (3.) We should have a sincere desire to promote the glory of God, and to bring as many as possible to join in his praise, and to celebrate his saving mercy, ver. 15. It was this which sustained and animated Paul; and a man who has this as the leading object of his life, and his great purpose and aim, will be willing to endure much trial, to suffer much per- secution, and to encounter many dan- gers. No object is so noble as that of endeavouring to promote the divine glory ; and he who is influenced by that will care little how many sutferings he is called to endure in this life. 24, Christians should have such a belief of the truth of their religion as to be willing to speak of it at all times, and in all places, ver. 13. If we have such a belief wc shall be willing to speak of it. We cannot help it. We shall so see its value, and so love it, and our hearts will be so full of it, and we shall see so much the danger of our fellow-men, that we shall be instinctively prompted to go to them and warn them of their danger, and tell them of the glories of the Re- deemer. 25. Christians may expect to be sup- ported and comforted in the trials and toils of life. ver. 16. The "outward man" will indeed perish and decay. The body will become feeble, weary, jaded, decayed, decrepit. It will be filled with pain, and will languish un- der disease, and will endure the mortal agony, and will be corrupted in the tomb. But the "inward man" will be renewed. The faith will be invigorated, the hope become stronger, the intellect brighter, the heart better, the whole soul be more like God. While the body, therefore, the less important part, decays and dies, the immortal part shall live and ripen for glory. Of what con- sequence is it, therefore, how soon or how much the body decays ; or when, and whore, and how it dies. Let the vnmortal part be preserved, let that live, and all is well. And while this is done, we should not, we shall not " faint." We shall be sustained ; and shall find the consolations of religion to be fitted to all our wants, and adapted to all the necessities of our condition as weak, and frail, and dying creatures. 26. We learn from this chapter how to bear affliction in a proper manner, ver. 17, 18. It is by looking at eternity and comparing our trials with the eter- nal weight of glory that awaits us. In themselves afflictions often seem heavy and long. Human nature is often ready to sink under them. The powers of the body fail, and the mortal frame is crush- ed. The day seems long while we suffer; and the night seems often to be almost endless. Deut. xxviii. 67. But compared with eternity how short are all these trials ! Compared with the weight of glory which awaits the be- liever, what a trifle are the severest sufferings of this life. Soon the ran- somed spirit will be released, and will be admitted to the full fruition of the joys of the world above. In that world all these sorrows will seem like th6 sufferings of childhood, that we have now almost forgotten, and that now seem to us like trifles. 27. We should not look to the things which are seen as our portion, ver. 17, 18. They are light in their character, and are soon to fade away. Our great interests are beyond the grave. There all is weighty, and momentous, and eternal. Whatever great interests we have are there. Eternity is stamped upon all the joys and all the sorrows which are beyond this life. Here all is temporary, changing, decaying, dying. There all is fixed, settled, unchanging, immortal. It becomes us then as ra- tional creatures to look to that world, to act with reference to it, to feel and act 05 if we felt that all our interests were there. Were this life all, every thing in relation to us would be trifling. But when we remember that there is an eternity ; that we are near it ; and that our conduct here is to determine our character and destiny there, life becomes invested with infinite importance. Who A. D. 60.] CHAPTER V. 103 CHAPTER V. "C*OR we know, that if our ■*• earthly house of this taber- can estimate the magnitude of the in- terests at stake 1 Who can appreciate aright the importance.of every step we take, and every plan vye form ] 28. All here below is temporary, de- caying, dying, ver. 17, 18. Afflictions are temporary. They are but for a mo- ment, and will soon be passed away. Our sorrows here will soon be ended. The last sigh on earth will soon be heaved ; the last tear will have fallen on the cheek ; the last pain will have shot across the seat of life ! The last pang of parting with a beloved friend will soon have been endured ; and the last step which we are to take in " the valley of the shadow of death," will soon have been trod. And in like man- ner we shall soon have tasted the last cup of earthly joy. All our comforts here below will soon pass from us. Our friends will die. Our sources of happiness will be dried up. Oar health will fail, and darkness will come over our eyes, and we shall go down to the dead. All our property must be left, and all our honours be parted with forever. In a little time — 0, how brief! we shall have gone from all these, and shall be engaged in the deep and awful solemnities of the unchanging world. How vain and foolish, therefore, the attachment to earthly objects! How important to secure an interest in that future inheritance which shall never fade away ! 29. Let it not be inferred, however, that all affliction shall be light, and for a moment, or that all earthly trial shall of course work out a far more exceed- ing and eternal weight of glory. There are sorrows beyond the grave compared with which the mostJieavy and most protracted woes tliis side the tomb, are "light," and are "but for a moment." And there are sorrows in this life, deep and prolonged afflictions — which by no means tend to prepare the soul for the "fur more exceeding and eternal weight nacle « were dissolved, we have a building of God, an house ^ not a Job 4. 19. 2 Pe. 1.13, 14. ft 1 Pe. 1. 4. of glory." Such are those afflictions where there is no submission to the will of God ; where there is murmuring, re- pining, impatience, and mcreased re- bellion ; where there is no looking to God for comfort, and no contemplation of eternal glory. Such are those afflic- tions where men look to philosophy, or to earthly friends to comfort them ; or where they plunge deeper into the busi- ness, the gayety, or the vices of the world, to drown their sorrows and to obliterate the sense of their calamities. This is " the sorrow of the world which worketh death." 2 Cor. vii. 10. In afflictions, therefore, it should be to us a matter of deep and anxious solicitude to know whether we have the right feelings, and whether we are seeking the right sources of consolation. And in such seasons it shall be the subject of our deep and earnest prayer to God that our trials may, by his grace, be made to work out for us " a far more exceeding and eternal weight of glory." All are afflicted ; all suffer in various ways ; and all may find these trials ter- minate in eternal blessedness beyond the grave. CHAPTER V. This chapter is closely cor^nected with the former, and indeed has been improperly separated from it, as is mani- fest from the word " For" (yoLg) with which it commences. It contains a further statement of reasons for what had been said in the previous chapter. The main subject there was the mixis- TRT ; the honesty and fidelity with which Paul and his fellow-labourers toiled (ver. 1 — 3) ; the trials and dan- gers which they encountered in the work of the ministry (ver. 7 — 12) ; and the consolations and supports which , they had in its various trials, ver. 13 — 18 This chapter contains a continuation of the same subject, and a further state- ment of the motives which prompted them to their work, and of the supports 104 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 made with hands, eternal in the neavens. which upheld them in the arduous du- ties to which they were called. It is a chapter full of exquisite beauties of sentiment and of language, and as well adapted to give consolation and support to all Christians now as it is to minis- ters; and the sentiments are as well adapted to sustain the humblest believer in his trials as they were to sustain the apostles themselves. The following are the points of consolation and support, and reasons for their zeal and self-denial, to which the apostle refers. 1. They had the assured prospect of the resurrection, and of eternal life, ver. 1 — 4. The body might decay, and be worn out ; it might sigh and groan, but they had a better home, a mansion of eternal rest in the heavens. It was their earnest desire to reach heaven ; though not such a desire as to make them unwiUing to endure the toils and trials which God should ap- point to them here below, but still an earnest, anxious wish to reach safely their eternal home in the skies. In the prospect of their heavenly home, and their eternal rest, they were willing to endure all the trials which were ap- pointed to them. 2. God had appointed them to this ; he had fitted them for these trials ; he had endowed them with the graces of his Spirit; and they were, therefore, willing to be absent from the body, and to be present with the Lord. ver. 5 — 8. They had such a view of heaven as their home that they were willing at any time to depart and enter the world of rest, and they did not, therefore, shrink from the trials and dangers which would be likely soon to bring them there. 3. They had a deep and constant conviction that they must soon appear before the judgment seat of Christ, ver. 9 — 1 1 . They laboured that they might be accepted by him (ver. 9) ; they knew that they must give a solemn account to him (ver. 10) ; they had a 2 For in this we groan, " a Ro. 8. 23. clear view, and a deep impression of the awful terrors of that day, and they laboured, therefore, to save as many as possible from the- condemnation of the great Judge of all, and endeavoured to " persuade" them to be prepared for tliat scene, ver. 11. 4. Though to some they might ap- pear to be under the influence of im- proper excitement, and even to be de- ranged (ver. 14), yet they were acting only under the proper influence of the love of Christ, ver. 14, 15. They were constrained and urged on by his love ; they knew that he had died for all, and that all men were dead in siii ; and they felt themselves the ftonstraining influence of that love prompting them to deny themselves, and to devote their all to his service and cause. 5. Their views of all things had been changed, ver. 16, 17. They had ceased to act under the influences which govern other men ; but their own hearts had been changed, and they had become new creatures in Christ, and in their lives they evinced the spirit which should govern those who were thus re- newed. 6. They had been solemnly commis- sioned by God as his ambassadors in this cause. They had been sent to make known the terms and the way of reconciliation, and they felt it to be their duty to proclaim those terms on as wide a scale as possible, and wkh the utmost zeal and self-denial. It was God's glo- rious plan of reconciliation ; and on the ground of the atonement made by the Redeemer, they could now offer salva- tion to all mankind, and as all might be saved, they felt themselves bound to ofler the terms of salvation to as many as possible, ver. 18 — 21. The grand argument for urging sinners to be re- conciled to God, is the fact that Christ has died for their sins, and, therefore, the apostles apprized of this fact, sought to urge as many as possible to become his friends, ver. 21. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER V. 105 1. For we know. We who are en- gaged in the work of the gospel minis- try. Paul is giving a reason why he and his fellow-labourers did not become weary and faint in their work. The reason was, that they knew that even if their body should die, they had an in- heritance reserved for them in heaven. The expression "we know" is the lan- guage of strong and unwavering assux*- ance. They had no doubt on the sub- ject. And it proves that there may be the assurance of eternal life ; or such evidence of acceptance with God as to leave no doubt of a final admission into heaven. This language was often used by the Saviour in reference to the truths which he taught (John iii. 11 ; iv. 22) ; and it is used by the sacred writers in regard to the truths which they record- ed, and in regard to their own personal piety. John xxi. 24 ; 1 John ii. 3. 5. 18; iii. 2. 14. 19. 24; iv. 6. 13; v. 2. 15. 19, 20. "^l That if our earthly house. The word "eai-thly" here (i?rlyMc) stands opposed to " heavenly," or to the " house eternal (iv role ougx- )i??) in the heavens." The word pro- perly means ' upon earth, terrestrial, be- longing to the earth, or on the earth,' and is applied to bodies (1 Cor. xv. 40) ; to earthly things (John iii. 12) ; to earth- ly, or worldly wisdom, James iii. 15. The word house here refers doubtless to the body, as the habitation, or the dwell- ing-place of the mind or soul. The soul dwells in it as we dwell in a house, or tent. 1 Of this taheriiacle. This Word means a booth, or tent — a mov- able dwelling. The use of the word here is not a mere redundancy, but the idea which Paul designs to convey is, doubtless, that the body — the house of the soul — was not a permanent dwell- ing-place, but was of the same nature as a booth or tent, that was set up for a temporary purpose, or that was easily taken down in migrating frorn one place to another. It refers here to the body as the frail and temporary abode of the soul. It is not a permanent dwelling; a fixed habitation, but is liable to be taken down at any moment, and was fitted up with that view. Tindal ren- ders it, ' if our earthly mansion wherein we now dwell." The Syriac renders it, " for we know that if our house on earth,which is our body, were dissolved." The idea is a beautiful one, that the body is a mere unfixed, movable dwell- ing-place ; liable to be taken down at any moment, and not designed, any more than a tent is, to be a permanent habitation. 1 Were dissolved (nctTa- Kv^ij). This word means properly tq disunite the parts of any thing; and is applied to the act of throwing down, or destroying a building. It is applied here to the body, regarded as a temporary dwelling that might be taken down, and it refers, doubtless, to the dissolution of the body in the grave. The idea is, that if this body should moulder back to dust, and be resolved into its original elements ; or if by great zeal and labour it should be exhausted and v^orn out. Language like this is used by Eliphaz, the Temanite, in describing the body of man. " How much less in those that dwell in houses of clay," &c. Job iv. 19. Comp. 2 Pet. i. 13, 14. ^ We have a building of God. Robinson {Lexicon) supposes that it refers to " the future spiritual body as the abode of the soul." Some have supposed that it refers to some "celestial vehicle" with which God invests the soul during the inter- mediate state. But the Scripture is si lent about any such celestial vehicle. It is not easy to tell what was the pre- cise idea which Paul here designed to convey. Perhaps a few remarks may enable us to arrive at the meaning (1.) It was not to be temporary ; not a tent or tabernacle that could be taken down. (2.) It was to be eternal in the heavens. (3.) It was to be such as to constitute a dwelling ; a clothing, or such a protection as should keep the soul from being " naked." (4.) It was to be such as should constitute " life" in contradistinction from "mortality." These things will better agree with the supposition of its referring to the future body of the saints than any thing else ; and probably the idea of Paul is, that the body there will be incorruptible and i aamortal. When he says it is a " build- IQ6 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. earnestly desiring to be clothed ing of God" (k Qiov), he evidently means that it is made by God ; that he is the architect of that future and eternal dwelling. Macknight and some others, however, understood this of the man- sions which God has fitted up for his |«ople in heaven, and which the Lord lesus has gone to prepare for them. Comp. John xiv. 2. But see Note on ver. 3. t An house. A dwelling ; an abode; that is, according to the inter- pretation above, a celestial, pure, im- mortal body; a body that shall have God for its immediate author, and that shall be fitted to dwell in heaven forever. •[[ Not made with hands. Not con- structed by man ; a habitation not like those which are made by human skill, and which are therefore easily taken down or removed, but one that is made by God himself. This does not imply that the " earthly house" which is to be superseded by that in heaven is made with hands, but the idea is, that the earthly dwelling has things about it which resemble that which is made by man, or as if it were made with hands ; i. e. it is temporary, frail, easily taken down or removed. But that which is in heaven is permanent, fixed, eternal, as if made by God. 1 Eternal in the heavens. Immortal; to live forever. The future body shall never be taken down or dissolved by death. It is eternal, of course, only in respect to the future, and not in respect to the past. And it is not only eternal, but it is to abide forever in the heavens — in the world of glory. It is never to be sub- jected to a dwelling on the earth ; never to be in a world of sin, suffering, and death. 2. For in this. In this tent, taber- nacle, or dwelling. In our body here. 1 We groan. Comp. Note Rom. viii. 22. The sense is, that we are subject- ed to so many trials and afflictions in the present body ; that the body is sub- jected to so many pains and to so much suffering, as to maiie us earnestly desire to be invested with that body which shall bo free from all susceptibility to upon witli our house which is from heaven : suffering, t Earnestly desiring to be clothed upon with our house, &c. There is evidently here a change of the meta- phor which gives an apparent harshness to the construction. One idea of the apostle is, that the body here, and the spiritual body hereafter, is a house or a dwelling. Here he speaks of it as a garment which may be put on or laid off; and of himself as earnestly desiring to put on the immortal clothing or vestment which was in heaven. Both these figures are common in ancient writings, and a change in this manner in the popular style is not unusual. The Pythagoreans com- pared the body to a tent, or hut for the soul ; the Platonists liken it to a vest- ment. — Bloomjield. The Jews speak of a vestment to the soul in this world and the next. They affirm that the soul had a covering when it was under the throne of God, and before it was clothed with the body. This vestment they say was " the image of God" which was lost by Adam. After the fall, they say, Adam and all his posterity were regarded as naked. In the future world they say the good will be clothed with a vestment for the soul which they speak of as lucid and radiant, and such as no one on earth can attain. — Schoettgen. But there is no reason to think that Paul referred to any such trifles as the Jews have believed on this subject. He evidently regarded man as composed of body and soul. The soul was the more important part, and the body constituted its mere habitation or dwelling. Yet a body was essential to the idea of the complete man ; and since this was frail and dying, he looked forward to a union with the bod}' that should be eternal in the heavens, as a more desirable and perfect habitation of the soul. Mr Locke has given an interpretation of this in which he is probably alone, but which has so much appearance of plausibility that it is not improper to re- fer to it. He supposes that this whole passage has reference to the fact that at the coming of the Redeemer the body A. D. 60.1 CHAPTER V. 107 3 If so be that being clothed we shall not be found naked. " oRe. 3. 18; 16, 15. will be changed without experiencing death (comp. 1 Cor. xv. 51, 52) ; that Paul jxpected that this might soon occur, and that he earnestly desired to undergo this transformation without ex- periencing the pains of dying. He therefore paraphrases it, " For in this tabernacle I groan, earnestly desiring, without putting off this mortal, eartWy body by death, to have that celestial body superinduced, if so be the coming of Christ shall overtake me in this life, before I put off this body." t With our house. The phrase ' to be clothed upon with our house' seems to be harsh and unusual. The sense is plain, however, that Paul desired to be invested with that pure, spiritual, and undecaying body which was to be the eternal abode of his soul in heaven. That he speaks of as a house (olzur^nv), a more perma- nent and substantial dwelling than a tent, or tabernacle. 3. If so be that being clothed. This passage has been interpreted in a great many different ways. The view of Locke is given above. Rosenmiiller ren- ders it, " For in the other life we shall not be wholly destitute of a body, but we shall have a body." Tindal renders it, " If it happen that we be found clothed, and not naked." Doddridge supposes it to mean, "since being so clothed upon, we shall not be found naked, and exposed to any evil and inconve- nience, how entirely soever we may be stripped of every thing we can call our own here below." Hammond explains it to mean, " If, indeed, we shall, happily, be among the number of those faithful Christians, who will be found clothed upon, not naked." Various other ex- positions may be seen in the larger com- mentaries. The meaning is probably this: (1.) The word "clothed" refers to the future spiritual body of believers ; the eternal habitation in which they shall reside. (2.) The expression im- »Ues an earnest iesire of Paul to be thus 4 For we that are in this ta- bernacle do groan, being burden- ed: not for that we would be invested with that body. (3.) It is the language of humility and of deep solici- tude, as if it were possible that they might fail, and as if it demanded their utmost care and anxiety that they might thus be clothed with the spiritual body in heaven. (4.) It means that in that future state, the soul will not be naked ; i. e. destitute of any body, or covering. The present body will be laid aside. It will return to corruption, and the dis- embodied Spirit will ascend to God and to heaven. It will be disencumbered of the body with which it has been so long clothed. But we are not thence to infer that it will be destitute of a body ; that it will remain a naked soul. It will be clothed there in its appropri- ate glorified body ; and will have an appropriate habitation there. This does not imply, as Bloomfield supposes, that the bodies of the wicked will be desti- tute of any such habitation as the glo- rified body of the saints ; which may be true — but it means simply that the soul shall not be destitute of an appropriate body in heaven, but that the union of body and soul there shall be known as well as on earth. 4. For we. We who are Christians. All Christians. % That are in this ta- bernacle. This frail and dying body. Note, ver. 1. 'i Do groan. See ver. 2. This is a further explanation of what is said in ver. 2. It implies an ardent and earnest desire to leave a world of toil and pain, and to enter into a world of rest and glory, t Being burdened. Being borne down by the toils, and trials, and calamities of this life. See Note, ch. iii. 7 — 10. t Not for that lue would be unclothed. Not that we are impatient, and unwilling to bear these burdens as long as God shall appoint. Not that we merely wish to lay aside this mortal body. We do not desire to die and depart merely because we suffer much, and because the body here is subjected to great trials. This is not 108 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. unclothed, but clothed upon, that mortality * might be swallowed up of life. 5 Now he that hath wrought* a 1 Co 15. 53. b Is. 29. 23. Ep. 2. 10. the ground of our wish to depart. We are willing to bear trials. We are not impatient under afflictions. — The senti- ment here is, that the mere fact that we may be afflicted much and long, should not be the principal reason why we should desire to depart. We should be willing to bear all this as long as God shall choose to appoint. The anxiety of Paul to enter the eternal world was from a higher motive than a mere desire to get away from trouble. ^ But clothed upon. To be invested with our spiritual body. We desire to be clothed with that body. We desire to be in heaven, and to be clothed with immor- tality. We wish to have a body that shall be pure, undecaying, ever glorious. It was not, therefore, a mere desire to be released from sufferings ; it was an earnest wish to be admitted to the glories of the fature world, and partaHfe of the happiness which he would enjoy there. This is 07ie of the reasons why Paul wished to be in heaven. Other reasons he has stated elsewhere. Thus in Phil. i. 23 he says he had " a desire to depart and to be with Christ" So in ver. 8 of this chapter, he says he was *' willing rather to be absent from the body and to be present with the Lord." In 2 Tim. iv. 6 — 8, he speaks of the "crown of righteousness" laid up for him as a rea'son why he was willing to die. \ That mortality might be swal- lowed up of life. On the meaning of the word rendered "swallowed up" (KSLTHTroB-rj) see Note on 1 Cor. xv. 54. The meaning here is, that it might be completely absorbed ; that it might cease to be; that there might be no more mor- tality, but that he might pass to the immortal state — to the condition of eter- nal life in the heavens. The body here is mortal; the body there will be im- mortal ; and Paul desired to pass away from the mortal state to one that shall us for the selfsame thing, is God, who also hath given unto us the earnest " of the Spirit. 6 Therefore we are always cEp. 1. 14. be immortal, a world where there shafj be no more death. Comp. 1 Cor. xv. 53, 5. Now he that hath wrought us for the self-same thing. The phrase " self- same thing" here means this very thing, i. e. the thing to which he had referred — the preparation for heaven, or the hea- venly dwelling. The word " wrought" here (Ku.rieyct put in us. to Christ, and manifested himself by him. So Doddridge interprets it. Christ was the mediator by means of whom God designed to accomplish the great work of reconciliation. T] Reconciling the world unto himself. The world here evidently means the human race generally, without distinction of nation, age, or rank. The whole world was alienated from him, and he sought to have it reconciled. This is one inci- dental proof that God designed that the plan of salvation should be adapted to all men. See Note on ver. 14. It may be observed further, that God sought that the world should be recon- ciled. Man did not seek it. He had no plan for it. He did not desire it. He had no way to effect it. It was the offended party, not the offending, that sought to be reconciled ; and this shows the strength of his love. It was love for enemies and alienated beings, and love evinced to them by a most earnest desire to become their friend, and to be at agreement with them. Comp. Note on Rom. v. 8. Tindal renders this very accurately, "For God was in Christ, and made agreement between the world and himself, and imputed not their sins unto them." ^ Not imputing their trespasses. Not reckoning their trans- gressions to them; that is, forgiving them, pardoning them. On the mean- ing of the word impute, see Note, Rom. iv. 3. The idea here is, that God did not charge on them with inexorable severity and stern justice their offences, but graciously provided a plan of par- don, and offered to remit their sins on the conditions of the gospel. The plan of reconciliation demonstrated that he was not disposed to impute their sins to them, as he might have done, and to punish them with unmitigated severity for their crimes, but was more disposed to pardon and forgive. And it may be here asked, if God was not disposed to charge with unrelenting severity their 20 Now then we are " am- bassadors for Christ ; as though a Job 33. 23. Mai. 2. 7. Ep. 6. 20. own sins to their account, but was rather disposed to pardon them, can we believe that he is disposed to charge en them the sin of another ? If he does not charge on them with inexorable and unmitigated severity their own trans- gressions, will he charge on them with unrelenting severity — or at all — the sin of Adam 1 See Note on Rom. v. 1 9. The sentiment here is, that God is not disposed or inclined to charge the trans- gressions of men upon them ; he has no pleasure in doing it ; and therefore he has provided a plan by which they may be pardoned. At the same time it is true that unless their sins are par- doned, justice will charge or impute their sitis to them, and will exact pu- nishment to the uttermost. Ij And hath committed unto us the word of recon- ciliation. Margin, " put in us." Tin- dal renders this, " and hath committed unto us the preaching of the atonement." The meaning is, that the office of mak- ing known the nature of this plan, and the conditions on which God was will- ing to be reconciled to man, had been committed to the ministers of the gospel. 20. Now then toe are ambassadors for Christ. We are the ambassadors whom Christ has sent forth to negotiate with men in regard to their reconciliation to God. Tindal renders this, " Now then are we messengers in the room of Christ." The word here used (;rgsT- fiiucfAiv, from Trgia-Suc, an aged man, an elder, and then an ambassador) means to act as an ambassador, or sometimes merely to deliver a message for another, without being empowered to do any thing more than to explain or enforce it. — Bloomjield. See Thucyd. 7. 9. An ambassador is a minister of the highest rank, employed by one prince or state at the court of another, to manage the concerns of his own prince or state, and representing the dignity and power of his sovereign. — Webster. He is sent 130 II. CORIMTHIANS. [A. D. 60. God did beseech you by us, we 1 pray you in Christ's stead, Be ye reconciled to God. to do what the sovereign would himself do were he present. They are sent to make known the will of the sovereign, and to negotiate matters of commerce, of war, or of peace, and in general every thing affecting the interests of the sovereign among the people to whom they are sent. At all times, and in all countries an ambassador is a sacred character, and his person is regarded as inviolable. He is bound implicitly to obey the instructions of his sovereign, and as far as possible to do only what the sovereign would do were he himself present. Ministers are ambassadors for Christ, as they are sent to do what he would do were he personally present. They are to make known, and to ex- plain, and enforce the terms on which God is willing to be reconciled to men. They are not to negotiate on any new terms, nor to change those which God has proposed, nor to follow their own plans or devices, but they are simply to urge, explain, state, and enforce the terms on which God is willing to be reconciled. Of course they are to seek the honour of the sovereign who has sent them forth, and to seek to do only his will. They go not to promote their own welfore ; not to seek honour, digni- ty, or emolument; but they go to trans- act the business which the Son of God would engage in were he again person- ally on the earth. It follows that their office is one of great dignity, and great responsibility, and that respect should be showed them as the ambassadors of the King of kings, t As though God did beseech you by us. Our message is to be regarded as the message of God, It is God who speaks. What we say to you is said in his name and on his authority, and should be received with the respect which is due to a message directly from God. The gospel message is God speaking to men through the ministry, and entreating them to be ••ecoflciled. This invests the messafio 21 For "he hath made him to be sin for us, w!io knew no a Is. 53. 6, 9, 12. Ga. 3. 13. 1 Pe. 2. 22, 24, 1 Jno. 3. 5. which the ministers of religion bear with infipite dignity and solemnity ; and it makes it a fearful and awful thing to reject it. t ^e pray you, m Christ's stead {vTTi^ X§/o-TiLi). In the place of Christ; or doing what he did when on earth, and what he would do were he where we are. 1 Be ye reconciled to God. This is the sum and burden of the message which the ministers of the gospel bear to their fellow-men. See Noteonver. 19. It implies that man has something to do in this work. Ha is to be reconciled to God. He is to give up his opposition. He is to submit to the terms of mercy. All the change in the case is to be in him, for God can- not change. God has removed all the obstacles to reconciliation which existed on his part. He has done all that h^ will do, all that needed to be done, in order to render reconciliation easy as possible. And now it remains that man should lay aside his hostility, abandon his sins, embrace the terms of mercy, and become in fact reconciled to God. And the great object of the ministers of reconcilation is to urge this duty on their fellow-men. They are to do it in the name of Christ. They are to do it as if Christ were himself present, and were himself urging the message. They are to use the arguments which he would use ; evince the zeal which he would shov/ ; and present the motive* which he would present to induce a dying world to become in fact reconcilec to God. 21. For he hath made him to be sin for us. The Greek here is, ' for hira who knew no sin, he hath made sin, or a sin-offering for us.' The design of this very important verse is, to urge the strongest possible reason for being recon- ciled to God. This is implied in the word (>a§) for. Paul might have urged other arguments, and presented other strong considerations. But he chooses to present this fact, that Christ has been A. D. 60.] CHAPTER V. sin ; that wo might be made * aRo. 5. 19. m»dp s»»T) f^r us as imbodying and con- santn^tingr all. It is the most affecting of all arguments ; it is the one that is Ukeiy to prove most effectual. It is not ii.deed imp/opei to urge on men every other considaration to induce them to be reconciled to God. It is not improper to appeal to them by the conviction of duty; to appeal to their reason and conscience ; to remind them of the claims, the power, the goodness, and the fear of the Creator ; to remind them of the awful consequences of a con- tinued hostility to God ; to persuade them by the hope of heaven, and by the fear of hell (ver. 11) to become his friends ; but, after all, the strongest argu- ment, and that which is most adapted to melt the soul, is the fact that the Son of God has become incarnate for our eins, and has suffered and died in our stead. When all other appeals fail this is effectual ; and this is in fact the strong argument by which the mass of those who become Christians are induced to abandon their opposition and to become reconciled to God. ^ To be sin. The words ' to be' are not in the original. Literally it is, * he has made him sin, or asm-offering' (ajuu^'ri'J.viTroiiKriv). But what is meant by this 1 What is the exact idea which the apostle intended to convey 7 I answer, it cannot be, (1.) That he was literally sin in the abstract, or sin as such. No one can pretend this. The expression must be, therefore, in some sense, figurative. Nor, (2.) Can it mean that he was a sinner, for it is said in immediate connexion that he " knew no sin," and it is every- where said that he was holy, harmless, undefiled. Nor, (3.) Can it mean that he was, in any proper sense of the word, guilty, for no one is truly guilty who is not personally a transgressor of the law ; and if he was, in any proper sense, guilty, then he deserved to die, and his death could have no more merit than that of any other guilty being ; and if he was properly guilty it would make 131 the righteousness of God in him. no difference in this respect whether it was by his own fault or by imputation, a guilty being deserves to be punished ; and where there is desert of punishment there can be no merit in sufferings. But all such views as go to make the holy Redeemer a sijiner, or guilty, or deserving of the sufferings which he endured, border on blasphemy, and are abhorrent to the whole strain of the Scriptures. In no form, in no sense possible, is it to be maintained that the Lord Jesus was sinful or guilty. It is a corner stone of the whole system of religion, that in all conceivable senses of the expression he was holy, and pure, and the object of the divine approbation. And every view which fairly leads to the statement that he was in any sense guilty, or which implies that he deserved to die, is prima facie a false view, and should be at once abandoned. But, (4.) If the declaration that he was made "sin" (afA^gjictv) does not mean that he was sin itself, or a sinner, or guilty, then it must mean that he was a sin- offering, — an offering or a sacrifice for sin ; and this is the interpretation which is now generally adopted by expositors ; or it must be taken as an abstract for the concrete, and mean that God treated him as if he were a sinner. The former interpretation, that it means that God made him a sin-offering, is adopted by Whitby, Doddridge, Macknight, Rosen- miiller, and others ; the latter, that it means that God treated him as a sin- ner, is adopted by Vorstius, Schoettgen, Robinson (Lex.), Bishop Bull, and others. There are many passages in the Old Testament where the word "sin" (afxa^TiA) is used in the sense of sin-offering, or a sacrifice for sin. Thus, Hos. iv. 8 : " They eat up the sin of my people ;" i. e. the sin-offerings. See Ezek. xUii. 22. 25 ; xliv. 29 ; xlv. 22, 23. 25. See Whitby's Note on this verse. But whichever meaning is adopted, whether it means that he was a sacrifice for sin, or that God treated him as if 13^ II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 he weie a sinner, L e. subjected him to sufferings which, if he had been per- sonally a sinner, would have been a proper expression of his hatred of trans- gression, and a proper punishment for sin, in either case it means that he made an atonement ; that he died for sin ; that his death was not merely that of a martyr ; but that it was designed by substituted sufferings to make recon- ciliation between man and God. Locke renders this, probably expressing the true sci'.se, " For God hath made him subject to suffering and death, the pu- nishment and consequence of sin, as if he had been a sinner, though he were guilty of no sin." To me, it seems probable that the sense is, that God treated him as if he had been a sinner ; that he subjected him to such pains and woes as would have been a proper punishment if he had been guilty ; that while he was, in fact, in all senses per- fectly innocent, and while God knew this, yet that in consequence of the \oluntary assumption of the place of man which the Lord Jesus took, it pleased the Father to lay on him the deep sorrows which would be the proper expression of his sense of the evil of sin ; that he endured so much suffering, as would answer the same great ends in maintaining the truth, and honour, and justice of God, as if the guilty had them- selves endured the penalty of the law. This, I suppose, is what is n.sually meant when it is said ' our sins were imputed .o him ;' and though this language is not used in the Bible, and though it is liable to great misapprehension and per- version, yet if tliis is its meaning, there can be no objection to it. ^ Who knew no sin. He was not guilty. He was perfectly holy and pure. This idea is thus expressed by Peter (1 Pet. ii. 22) : "who did no sin, neither was guile found in his mouth ;" and in Heb. vii. 26, it is said he was " holy, harmless, undefiled, separate from sinners." In all respects, and in all conceivable senses, the Lord Jesus was pure and holy. If he had not been, he would not have been qualified to make an atonement. Hence the sacred writers are every- where at great pains to keep this idea prominent, for on this depends the whole superstructure of the plan of salvation. The phrase '^kneiv no sin," is an ex- pression of great beauty and dignity. It indicates his entire and perfect pu- rity. He was altogether unacquainted with sin ; he was a stranger to trans- gression ; he was conscious of no sin ; he committed none. He had a mind and heart perfectly free from pol- lution, and his whole life was perfectly pure and holy in the sight of God. T[ That we might he made the right- eousness of God. This is a Hebraism, meaning the same as divinely righteous. It means that we are made righteous in the sight of God ; that is, that we are accepted as righteous, and treated as righteous by God on account of what the Lord Jesus has done. There is here an evident and beautiful contrast between what is said of Christ, and what is said of us. He was made sin; we are made righteousness ,• that is, he was treated as if he were a sinner, though he was perfectly holy and pure ; we are treated as if we were righteous, though we are defiled and depraved. The idea is, that on account of what the Lord Jesus has endured in our behalf we are treated as if we had ourselves entirely fulfilled the law of God, and had never become exposed to its penalty. In the phrase *' righteousness of God,** there is a reference to the fact that this is his plan of making men righteous, or of justifying them. They who thus become righteous, or are justified, are justified on his plan, and by a scheme which he has devised. Locke renders this, " that we, in and by him, might be made righteous, by a righteousness im- puted to us by God." The idea is that all our righteousness in the sight of God we receive in and through a Redeemer. All is to be traced to him. This verse contains a beautiful epitome of the whole plan of salvation, and the peculiarity of the Christian scheme. On the one hand, one who was perfectly innocent, by a voluntary substitution, is treated as if he were guilty ; that is, is subjected to pains and sorrows which A. D. 60.] CHAPTER \. 133 if he were guilty would be a proper pu- nishment for sin : and on the other, they who are guilty and who deserve to be pu- nisbid, arc treated, through his vicarious sufferings, as if they were perfectly in- nocent; that is, in a manner which would be a proper expression of God's approbation if they had not sinned. The wiiole plan, therefore, is one of substi- tution ; and without such substitution, there can be no salvation. Innocence voluntarily suffers for guilt, and the guilty are thus made pure and holy, and are saved. The greatness of the divine compassion and love is thus shown for the guilty ; and on the ground of this it is right and proper for God to call on men to be reconciled to him. It is the strongest argument that can be used. When God has given his only Son to the bitter suflering of death on the cross in order that we may be reconciled, it is the highest possible argument which can be used why we should cease our opposition to him, and become his friends. HEMARKS. 1. It is possible for Christians to have the assurance that they shall enter into heaven, ver. 1. Paul said that he knew this; John knew this (see Note on ver. 1), and there is no reason why others should not know it. If a man hates sin he may know that as well as any thing else ; if he loves God, why should he not know that as well as to know that he loves an earthly friend ] If he desires to be holy, to enter heaven, to be eternally pure, why should he have any doubt about thatl If he loves to pray, to read the Bible, to converse of heaven — if his heart is truly in these tilings, he may know it, as well as know any thing else about his own character or feelings. 2. If a Christian may know it, he should know it. No other knowledge is so desirable as this. Nothing will produce so much comfort as this. Nothing will contribute so much to make him firm, decided, and consistent in his Christian walk as this. No other knowledge will give him so much 13 support in temptation ; so much com- fort in trial ; so much peace in death. And ?/ a man is a Christian, he should give himself no rest till he obtains assu- rance on this subject; if he is not a Christian he cannot know that too soon, or take too early measures to flee from the wrath to come. 3. The body will soon be dissolved in death, ver. 1 . It is a frail, crumbling, decaying dwelling, that must soon be taken down. It has none of the proper- ties of a permanent abode. It can be held together but a little time. It is like a hut or cottage, that is shaken by every gust of wind ; like a tent when the pins are loose, and the cords un- stranded, or rotten, and when the wind will soon sweep it away. And sinc« this is the fact, we may as well Jcnow it, and not attempt to conceal it from the mind. All truth may be looked at calmly, and should be, and a man who is residing in a frail and shattered dwell- ing, should be looking out for one that is more permanent and substantial. Death should be looked at. The fact that this tabernacle shall be taken down should be looked at; and every man should be asking with deep interest the question whether there is not a more permanent dwelling for him in a better world. 4. This life is burdened, and is full of cares, ver. 2. 4. It is such as ia fitted to make us desire a better state. We groan here under sin, amidst tempta- tion, encompassed by the cares and toils of life. We are burdened with duties, and we are oppressed by trials ; and under all we are sinking to the grave. Soon, under the accumulated burdens, the body will be crushed, and sink back to the dust. Man cannot endure the burden long, and he must soon die. These accumulated trials and cares are such as are adapted to make him desire a better inheritance, and to look forward to a better world. God designs that this shall be a world of care and anxiety, in order that we may be led to seek a better portion beyond the grave. 5. The Christian has a permanent home in heaven, ver. 1, 2, 4. There 134 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. is a house not made with hands; an eternal home ; a world where mortality is unknown. There is his home ; that is his eternal dwelling. Here he is a stranger, among strangers, in a strange world. In heaven is his home. The body here may be sick, feeble, dying; there it shall be vigorous, strong, im- mortal. He may have no comfortable dwelling here ; he may be poor, and afflicted ; there he shall have an unde- caying dwelling, an unchanging home. Who in a world like this should not desire to be a Christian ] What other condition of life is so desirable as that of the man who is sure that after a few more days he shall be admitted to an eternal home in heaven, where the body never dies, and where sin and sorrow are kripwn no more 1 6. The Christian should be willing to bear all the pain and sorrow which God shall appoint, ver. 1 — 4. Why should he not] He knows not only that God is good in all this ; but he knows that it is but for a moment ; that he is advancing toward heaven, and that he will soon be at home. Compared with that eternal rest what trifles are all the sufferings of this mortal Ufe ! 7. We should not desire to die merely to get rid of pain, or to be absent from the body. ver. 4. It is not merely in order that we may be " unclothed," or that we may get away from a suffering body, that we should be willing to die. Many a sinner suffers so much here that he is willing to plunge into an awful eternity, as he supposes, to get rid of pain, when, alas ! he plunges only into deeper and eternal wo. We should be willing to bear as much pain, and to bear it as long as God shall be pleased to appoint. We should submit to all without a murmur. We should be anxious to be relieved only when God shall judge it best for us to be away from the body, and to be present with the Lord. 8. In a mere readiness to die there is no evidence that we are prepared for heaven. Comp. ver. 4. Many a man supposes that because he is ready to die, that, therefore, he is prepared. Many a one takes comfort because a dying friend was ready and willing to die. But in a mere willingness to die there is no evidence of a preparation for death, because a hundred causes may conspire to produce this besides piety. And let us not be deceived by supposing that because we have no alarm about death, and are willing to go to another world, that therefore we are prepared. It may be either stupidity, or insensibility ; it may be a mere desire to get rid of suffering; it may be be- cause we are cherishing a hope of heaven which is altogether vain and illusive. 9. The Christian should, and may desire to depart and to be in heaven, ver. 2. Heaven is his home ; and it is his privilege to desire to be there. Here he is in a world of trial and of sin. There he shall be in a world of joy and of holiness. Here he dwells in a frail, suffering, decaying body. There he shall be clothed with immoi-tality. It is his privilege, therefore, to desire, as soon as it shall be the will of God, to depart, and to enter on his eternal in- heritance in heaven. He should have a strong, fixed, firm desire for that world ; and should be ready at the shortest notice to go and to be forever with the Lord. 10. The hopes and joys of Chi istians, and all their peace and calmness in the prospect of death, are to be traced to God. ver. 5. It is not that they are not naturally as timid and fearful of dying as others ; it is not that they have any native courage or strength, but it is to be traced entirely to the mercy of God, and the influence of his Spirit, that they are enabled to look calmly at death, at the grave, at eternity. With the assured prospect of heaven, they have nothing to fear in dying ; and if we have the "earnest of the Spirit" — the pledge that heaven is ours — we have nothing to fear in the departure from this world. 11. The Christian should be, and may be, always cheerful, ver. 6. Paul said tkat he vi'as always confident, or cheerful. Afflictions did not depress him ; trials did not cast him down. He A.D.60.J CHAPTER V. 135 was not disheartened by opposition ; he ] did not lose his courage by being reviled and persecuted. In all this he was cheerful and bold. There is nothing m religion to make us melancholy and sad. The assurance of the favour of God, and the hope of heaven, should have, and will have, just the opposite effect. A sense of the presence of God, a conviction that we are sinners, a deep impression of the truth that we are to die, and of the infinite interest of the soul at stake, will indeed make us serious and solemn, and should do so. But this is not inconsistent with cheer- fulness, but is rather fitted to produce it. It is favourable to a state of mind where all irritability is suppressed, and where the mind is made calm and settled ; and this is favourable to cheer- fulness. Besides, there is much, very much in religion to prevent sadness, and to remove gloom from the soul. The hope of heaven, and the prospect of dwelling with God and with holy be- ings forever, is the best means of expel- ling the gloom which is caused by the disappointments and cares of the world. And much as many persons suppose that religion creates gloom, it is certain that nothing in this world has done so much to lighten care, to break the force of misfortune and disappointment, to support in times of trial, and to save from despair, as the religion of the Re- deemer. And it is moreover certain that there are no persons so habitually calm in their feelings, and cheerful in their temper^, as consistent and devoted Christians. If there are some Chris- tians, like David Brainerd, who are melancholy and sad, as there are un- doubtedly, it should be said, (1.) That they are few in number; (2.) That their gloom is to be traced to constitu- tional propensity, and not to religion ; (3.) That they have, even with all their gloom, joys which the world never ex- periences, and which can never be found in sin ; and, (4.) That their gloom is not produced by religion, but by the xvanfofm&re of it. 12. It is noble to act with reference to things unseen and eternal, ver. 7. It elevates the soul ; lifts it above the earth ; purifies the heart ; and gives to man a new dignity. It prevents all the grovelling effect of acting from a view of present objects, and with refer- ence to the things which are just around us. " Whatever withdraws us," says Dr. Johnson, " from the power of our senses ; whatever makes the past, the distant, or the future, predominate over the present, advances us in the dignity of thinking beings." — Tour to the He brides, p. 322, ed. Phil. 1810. What ever directs the eye and the heart to heaven ; whatever may make man feel and believe that there is a God, a Saviour, a heaven, a world of glory, elevates him with the consciousness of his immortality, and raises him above the grovelling objects that wither and debase the soul. Man should act with reference to eternity. He should be conscious of immortality. He should be deeply impressed with that high honour that awaits him of standing be- fore God. He should feel that he may partake in the glories of the resurrection ; that he may inherit an eternal heaven. Feeling thus, what trifles are the things of the earth ! How little should he be moved by its trials ! How little should he be influenced by its wealth, its pleasures, and its honours ! 13. The Christian, when he leaves the body, is at once with the Lord Jesus, ver. 8. He rushes, as it were instinct- ively, to his presence, and casts himself at his feet. He has no other home than where the Saviour is ; he thinks of no future joy or glory but that which is to be enjoyed with him. Why then should we fear death ! Lay out of view, as we may, the momentary pang, the chilli' ness, and the darkness of the grave, and think of that which will be the moment after death — the view of the Redeemer, the sight of the splendours of the heavenly world, the angels, the spirits of the just made perfect, the river of the paradise of God, and the harps of praise, and what has man to fear in the prospect of dying ! 136 11. CORINTHIANS. £A. D. 60. Why should I shrink at pain or wo, Or feel at death dismay "? I've Canaan's goodly land in view, And realms of endless day. Apostles, martyrs, prophets there. Around my Saviour stand ; And soon my friends in Christ below Will join the glorious band. Jerusalem ! my happy home ! My soul still pants for thee ; When shall my labours have an end In joy, and peace, and thee ! C. Wesley. 14. We should act feeling that we are in the immediate presence of God, and so as to n:>eet his acceptance and approbation, whether we remain on earth, or whether we are removed to eternity, ver. 9. The prospect of being with him, and the consciousness that his eye is fixed upon us, should make us dili- gent, humble, and laborious. It should be the great purpose of our lives to secure his favour, and meet with his acceptance ; and it should make no difference with us in this respect, where we are — whether on earth or in heaven ; with the prospect of long life, or of an early death ; in society or in solitude ; at home or abroad ; on the land or on the deep ; in sickness or in health ; in prosperity or in adversity, it should be our great aim so to live as to be " ac- cepted of him," And the Christian will so act. To act in this manner is the very nature of true piety ; and where this desire does not exist, there can be no true religion. 15. We must appear before the judg- ment seat. ver. 10. We must all ap- pear there. This is inevitable. There is not one of the human family that can escape. Old and young ; rich and poor ; bond and free; all classes, all conditions, all nations must stand there, and give an account for all the deeds done in the body, and receive their eternal doom. How solemn is the thought of being arraigned ! How deeply affecting the idea that on the issue of that one trial will depend our eternal weal or wo ! How overwhelming the reflection thart from that sentence there can be no ap- peal ; no power of reversing it ; no possi- bility of after wards changing our destiny ! 16. We shall soon be there, ver. 10. No one knows when he is to die ; and death when it comes will remove us at once to the judgment seat. A disease that may carry us off in a few hours may take us there ; or death that may come in an instant shall bear us to that awful bar. How many are stricken down in a moment; how many are hurried without any warning to the solemnities of the eternal world ! So we may die. No one can insure our lives ; no one can guard us from the approach of the invisible king of terrors. 17. We should be ready to depart If we must stand at that awful bar ; and if we may be summoned there any moment, assuredly we should lose no time in being ready to go. It is our great business in life ; and it should claim our first attention, and all other things should be postponed that we may be ready to die. It should be the first inquiry every morning, and the last sub- ject of thought every evening — for who knows when he rises in the morning but that before night he may stand at the judgment seat ! Who, when he lies down on his bed at night, knows but that in the silence of the night-watches he may be summoned to go alone — to leave his family and friends, his home and his bed, to answer for all the deeds done in the body 1 18. We should endeavour to save others from eternal death, ver. 11. If we have ourselves any just views of the awful terrors of the day of judgment, and if we have any just views of the wrath of God, we should endeavour " to persuade" others to flee from the wrath to come. We should plead with them ; we should entreat them ; we should weep over them ; we should pray for them, that they may be saved from going up to meet the awful wrath of God. If out friends are unprepared to meet God ; if they are living in impenitence and sin, and if we have any influence over others in any way, we should exert it all to induce them to come to Christ, and to save themselves from the awful terrors of that day. Paul deemed no self-denial and no sacrifice too great, if A D.60.1 CHAPTER V. 137 he might persuade them to come to God, and to save their souls. And who that has any just views of the awful terrors of the day of judgment; of the woes of an eternal hell, and of the glories of an eternal heaven, can deem that labour too great which shall be the means of saving immortal souls ! Not to frighten them should we labour, not to alarm them merely should we plead with them but we should endeavour by all meanrf to persuade them to come to the Redeemer. We should not use tones of harshness and denunciation; we . should not speak of hell as if we would rejoice to execute the sentence, but we should speak with tenderness, earnest- ness, and with tears (comp. Acts xx. 31), that we may induce our friends and fellow-sinners to be reconciled to God. 19. We should not deem it strange or remarkable if we are charged with being deranged for being active and zealous in the subject of religion, ver. 13. There will always be enough, both in the church and out of it, to charge us with over-heated zeal ; with want of prudence ; or with decided mental aliena- tion. But we are not to forget that Paul was accused of being " mad ;" and even the Redeemer was thought to be " beside himself." " It is sufficient for the disciple that he be as his master, and the servant as his Lord ;" and if the Redeemer was charged with derange- ment on account of his peculiar views and his zeal, we should not suppose that • any strange thing had happened to us if we are accused in like manner. 20. The gospel should be offered to all men. ver. 14. If Christ died for all, then salvation is provided for all ; and then it should be offered to all freely and fully. It should be done without any mental reservation, for God has no such mental reservation; without any hesitation or misgiving ; without any statements that would break the force, or weaken the power of such an offer on the consciences of men. If they reject it, they should be left to see that they reject that which is in good faith offered to them, and that for this they must give an account to God. Every 13* man who preaches the gospel should feel that he is not only permitted but REQ.UIKED to preach the gospel "to every creature ;" nor should he embrace any opinion whatever which will in form or in fact cramp him or restrain him in thus offering salvation to all man- kind. The fact that Christ died for all, and that all may be saved, should be a fixed and standing point in all sys- tems of theology, and should be allowed td" shape every other opinion, and to shed its influence over every other view of truth. 21. All men by nature are dead in sins. ver. 14. They are insensible to their own good ; to the appeals of God ; to the glories of heaven, and to the terrors of hell. They do not act for eternity ; they are without concern in regard to their everlasting destiny. They are as insensible to all these things, until aroused by the Spirit of God, as a dead man in his grave is to surrounding objects. And there is nothing that ever did arouse such a man, oy ever could, but the same power that made the world, and the same voice that raised Lazarus from his grave. This melancholy fact strikes us everywhere ; and we should be deeply humbled that it is our condi- tion by nature, and should mourn that it is the condition of our fellow men everywhere. 22. We should form our estimate of objects and of their respective value and importance by other considerations than those which are derived from their tem- poral nature, ver. 16. It should not be simply according to the flesh. It should not be as they estimate them who are living for this world. It should not be by their rank, their splendour, or their fashion. It should be by their reference to eternity, and their bearing on the state of things there. 23. It should be with us a very serious inquiry whether our views of Christ are such as they have who are living after the flesh, or such only as the un- renev^^ed mind takes, ver. 1 6. The carnal mind has no just views of the Redeemer To every impenitent sinner he is "a root out of a dry ground." There is no 139 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 beauty in him. Ami to every hypo- crite, and every deceived professor of religion, there is really no beauty seen in him. There is no spontaneous, ele- vated, glowing attachment to him. It »s all forced and unnatural. But to the true Christian there is a beauty seen in his character that is not seen in any other ; and the whole soul loves him, and embraces him. His character is geen to be most pure and lovely ; his benevolence boundless ; his ability and willingness to save, infinite. The re- newed soul desires no other Saviour ; and rejoices that he is just what he is — rejoices in his humiliation as well as his exaltation ; in his poverty as well as his glory ; rejoices in the privilege of being saved by him who was spit upon, and mocked, and crucified, as well as by him who is at the right hand of God. One thing is certain, unless we have just views of Christ we can never be saved. 24. The new birth is a great and most important change, ver. 17. It is not in name or in profession merely, but it is a deep and radical change of the heart. It is so great that it may be said of each one that he is a new crea- tion of God ; and in relation to each one, that old things are passed away and all things are become new. How important it is that we examine our hearts and see whether this change has taken place, or whether we are still living without God and without hope. It is indispensable that we be born again. John iii. If we are not born again, and if we are not new creatures in Christ, we must perish forever. No matter what our wealth, talent, learning, accom- plishment, reputation, or morality, un- less we have been so changed that it may be said, and that we can say, "old things are passed away, and all things are become new," we must pe- rish forever. There is no power in the universe that can save a man who is not born again. 25. The gospel ministry is a most responsible and important work. ver. 18, 19. There is no other office of the same importance ; there is no situation in which man can be placed more solemn than that of making known the terms on which God is willing to bestow favour on apostate man. 26. How amazing is the divine con- descension, that God should have ever proposed such a plan of reconciliation, ver. 20, 21. That he should not only have been willing to be reconciled, but that he should have sought, and have been so anxious for it as to be willing to send his own Son to die to secure it ! It was pure, rich, infinite benevolence. God was not to be benejited by it. He was infinitely blessed and happy even though man should have been lost. He was pure, and just, and holy, and it was not necessary to resort to this in order to vindicate his own character. He had done man no wrong ; and if man had perished in his sins, the throne of God would have been pure and spot- less. It was love ; mere love. It was pure, holy, disinterested, infinite benevo- lence. It was worthy of a God ; and it has a claim to the deepest gratitude of man. Let us then, in view of this whole chapter, seek to be reconciled to God, Let us lay aside all our opposition to him. Let us embrace his plans. Let us be willing to submit to him, and to become his kteksal friknds. liCt us seek that heaven to which he would raise us ; and though our earthly house of this tabernacle must be dissolved, let us be prepared, as we may be, for that eternal habitation which he has fitted up for all who love him in the heavens. - CHAPTER VL This chapter, closely connected in sense with the preceding, is designed as an address to the Corinthian Christians, exhorting them to act worthily of their calling, and of their situation under such a ministry as they had enjoyed. In the previous chapters, Paul had dis- coursed at length of the design and of the labours of the ministry. The main drift of all this was to show them the nature of reconciliation, and the obligation to turn to God, and to live to him. This idea is pursued in this chapter ; and in view of the labour A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. CHAPTER VI. 139 W E then, as workers " to- gether with him, be- tt c. 5. 20. and self-denials of the ministry, Paul urges on the Corinthian Christians the duty of coming out from the world, and of separating themselves entirely from all evil. The chapter may be conve- niently contemplated in the following I. Paul states that he and his asso- ciates were fellow-labourers with God, and he exhorts the Corinthians not to receive the grace of God in vain. To induce them to make a wise improve- ment of the privileges which they en- joyed, he quotes a passage from Isaiah, and applies it as meaning that it was then an acceptable time, and that they might avail themselves of mercy, ver. 1, 2. II. He enumerates the labours and self-denials of the ministry. He refers to their sincerity, zeal, and honesty of life. He shows how much they had been willing to endure in order to con- vey the gospel to others, and how much they had in fact endured, and how much they had benefited others. He speaks of their afflictions in a most tender and beautiful manner, and of the happy re- sults which had followed from their self-denying labours, ver. 3 — 10. The design of this is, evidently, to remind them of what their religion had cost, and to appeal to them in view of all this to lead holy and pure lives. III. Paul expresses his ardent at- tachment for them, and says that if they were straitened ; if they did not Hve as they should do, it was not because he and his fellow-labourers had not loved them, and sought their welfare, but from a defect in themselves, ver. 11, 12. IV. As a reward for all that he had done and suffered for them, he now asked only that they should live as be- came Christians, ver. 13 — 18. He eought not silver, or gold, or apparel. He had not laboured as he had done tv'iih "T^-r vjevsr to a temporal reward. seech you also that ye re- ceive not the grace of God 'n vain. h He. 12. 15. And he now asked simply that they should come out from the world, and be dissociated from every thing that was evil. He demanded that they should be separate from all idolatry, and idol- atrous practices ; assures them that there can be no union between light and dark- ness ; righteousness and unrighteous- ness ; Christ and Belial ; that there can be no agreement between the temple of God and idols ; reminds them of the fact that they are the temple of God ; and encourages them to do this by the assurance that God would be their God, and that they should be his adopted sons and daughters. The chapter is one of great beauty ; and the argument for a holy life among Christians is one that is exceedingly forcible and tender. 1. We then, as workers together with him. On the meaning of this expression, see Note, 1 Cor. iii. 9. The Greek here is {(TvnsycviTi?) ' working together,' and may mean either that the apostles and ministers to whom Paul refers were joint labourers in entreating them not to receive the grace of God in vain ; or it may mean that they co-operated with God, or were engaged with him in en- deavouring to secure the reconciliation of the world to himself. Tindal renders it, " we as helpers." Doddridge, " we then as the joint-labourers of God." Most expositors have concurred in this interpretation. The word properly means, to work together ; to co-operate in producing any result. Macknight supposes that the word here is in the vocative, and is an address to the fellow- labourers of Paul entreating them not to receive the grace of God in vain. In this opinion he is probably alone, and has manifestly departed from the scope and design of the passage. Probably the most obvious meaning is that of our translators, who regard it as teaching that Paul was a joint-worker with God in securing the salvation of men. \ Thai. 140 II. CORINTHIANS. LA. D. 60. 2 (For lie saith, * I have heard a Is. 49. 8. Vf' receive not the gi-ace of God In vain, 1 he ' grace of God' here means evident- ly the gracious offer of reconciliation and pardon. And the sense is, * We en- treat you not to neglect or slight this offer of pardon, so as to lose the benefit of it, and he lost. It is offered freely and fully. It may be partaken of by all, and all may be saved. But it may also be slighted, and all the benefits of it will then be lost.' The sense is, that it was possible that this offer might be made to them, they might hear of a Saviour, be told of the plan of recon- ciliation, and have the offers of mercy pressed on their attention and accept- ance, and yet all be in vain. They might notwithstanding all this be lost, for simply to hear of the plan of salva- tion or the offers of mercy, will no more save a sinner than to hear of medicine will save the sick. It must be embraced and applied, or it will be in vain. It is true that Paul probably addressed this to those who were professors of religion ; and the sense is, that they should use all possible care and anxiety lest these offers should have been made in vain. They should examine their own hearts ; they should inquire into their own con- dition ; they should guard against self- deception. The same persons (ch. v. 20) Paul had exhorted also to be reconciled 10 God ; and the idea is, that he would earnestly entreat even professors of re- ligion to give all diligence to secure an interest in the saving mercy of the gospel, and to guard against the possi- bility of being self-deceived and ruined. 2. For he saith. See Isaiah xlix. 8. In that passage the declaration refers to the Messiah, and the design is there to show that God would be favourable to him ; that he would hear him when he prayed, and would make him the me- dium eral terms. In this expression, he refers to the fact that he and his fellow-labourers were scourged in watchings, in fastings. * or in tossinjrs to and fro. in synagogues and cities as if they had been the worst of men. In 2 Cor. xi. 23 — 25, Paul says that he had been scourged five times by the Jews, and had been thrice beaten with rods. See the Notes on that place. Tf In imprl' sonments. As at Philippi. Acts xvi. 24. seq. It was no uncommon thing for the early preachers of Christianity to be imprisoned, t In tumults. Marg. Tossing to and fro. The Greek word {axA^'XTTuo-U) denotes properly insta- bility, thence disorder, tumult, commo- tion. Here it means that in the various tumults and commotions which were produced by the preaching of the gospel, Paul endeavoured to act as became a minister of God. Such tumults were excited at Corinth (Acts xviii. 6) ; at Philippi (Acts xvi. 19, 20) ; at Lystra and Derbe (Acts xiv. 19) ; at Ephesus (Acts xix), and in various other places. The idea is, that if the ministers of re- ligion are assailed by a lawless mob, they are to endeavour to show the spirit of Christ there, and to evince all pa- tience, and to do good even in such a scene. Patience and the Christian spirit may often do more good in such scenes than much preaching would do else- where, t In labours. Referring pro- bably to the labours of the ministry, and its incessant duties, and perhaps also to the labours which they performed for their own support, as it is well known that Paul and probably also the other apostles, laboured often to support them- selves. Tl In watchings. In wake- fulness, or want of sleep. He probably refers to the fact that in these arduous duties, and in his travels, and in anxious cares for the churches, and for the ad- vancement of religion, he was often de- prived of his ordinary rest. He refers to this again in chap. xi. 27. f In fastings. Referring probably not only to the somewhat frequent fasts to which he voluntarily submitted as acts of devo- £44 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 6 By pureness, by knowledge, by long-suffering, by kindness, tion, but also to the fact that in his travels, when abroad and among stran- gers, he was often destitute of food. To such trials, those who travelled as Paul did, among strangers, and without property, would be often compelled to submit ; and such trials, almost without number, the religion which we now enjoy has cost. It at first cost the pain- ful life, the toils, the anxieties, and the sufferings of the Redeemer ; and it has been propagated and perpetuated amidst the deep sorrows, the sacrifices, and the tears and blood of those who have con- tributed to perpetuate it on earth. For such a reUgion, originated, extended, and preserved in such a manner, we can never express suitable gratitude to God. Such a religion we cannot over- estimate in value ; and for the extension and perpetuity of such a religion, we also should be willing to practise un- wearied self-denial. 6. By pureness. Paul, having in the previous verses, grouped together some of the sufferings which he endured, and by which he had endeavoured to com- mend and extend the true religion, pro- ceeds here to group together certain other influences by which he had sought the same object. The substance of what he here says is, that it had not only been done by sufferings and trials, but by a holy life, and by entire consecra- tion to the great cause to which he had devoted himself. He begins by stating ihat it was by pureness, that is, by integrity, sanctity, a holy and pure life. All preaching, and all labours would have been in vain without this ; and Paul well knew that if he succeeded in the ministry, he must be a good man. The same is true in all other profes- sions. One of the essential requisites of an orator, according to Quintilian, is, that he musi be a good man ; and no man may expect ultimately to succeed in any calling of life unless he is pure. But however this may be in other callings, no one will doubt it in regard to the ministry of the gospel. by the Holy Ghost, by love unfeigned, ^ By knowledge. Interpreters have dif- fered much in the interpretation of this. Rosen miiller and Schleusner understand by it prudence. Grotius interprets it as meaning a knowledge of the law. Doddridge supposes that it refers to a solicitude to improve in the knowledge of those truths which they were called to communicate to others. Probably the idea is a very simple one. Paul is showing how he endeavoured to com- mend the gospel to others, ver. 4. He says, therefore, that one way was by com- municating knowledge, true knowledge. He proclaimed that which was true, and which was real knowledge, in opposi- tion to the false science of the Greeks and in opposition to those who would substitute declamation for argument, and the mere ornaments of rhetoric for truth. The idea is, that the ministry should not be ignorant, but that if they wished to commend their office, they should be well-informed, and should be men of good sense. Paul had no belief that an ignorant ministry was preferable to one that was characterized by true knowledge ; and he felt that if he was to be useful it was to be by his impart- ing to others truth that would be useful. " The priest's lips should keep know- ledge." Mai. ii. 7. ^ By lung-suffering. By patience in our trials, and in the provocations which we meet with. We endeavour to obtain and keep a control over our passions, and to keep them in subjection. See this word explained in the Notes on 1 Cor. xiii. 4. ^ By kind- ness. See Note, 1 Cor. xiii. 4. By gentleness of manner, of temper, and of spirit. By endeavouring to e\mce this spirit to all, whatever may be their treatment of us, and whatever may be our provocations. Paul felt that if a minister would do good he must be kind, and gentle to all. ^ By the Holy Ghost. By the sanctifying influences of the Holy Spirit. By those graces and virtues which it is his office pecu- liarly to produce in the heart. Comp. Gal. v. 22, 23. Paul here evidently A D.bO.j CHAPTER VI. 14* 7 By the word " of truth, by the * power of God, by the o c. 4. 2. 6 1 Co. 2. 4. re'ers not to the miraculous agency of the Holy Spirit, but he is referring to the Spirit which he and his fellow-ministers manifested, and means here, doubtless, that they evinced such feelings as the Holy Spirit produced in the hearts of the children of God. t By love un- feigned. Sincere, true, ardent love to all. By undissembled, pure, and genuine affection for the souls of men. What good can a minister do if he does not love his people, and the souls of men ? The prominent characteristic in the life of the Redeemer was love — love to all. So if we are lilce him, and if we do any good, we shall have love to men. No man is useful without it ; and ministers, in general, are useful just in proportion as they have it. It will prompt to labour, self-denial, and toil ; it will make them patient, ardfent, kind ; it will give them zeal, and will give them access to the heart ; it will accomplish what no elo- quence, labour, or learning will do with- out it. He who shows that he loves me has access at once to my heart ; he who does not, cannot make a way there by any argument, eloquence, denuncia- tion, or learning. No minister is useful without it ; no one with it can be other- wise than useful. 7. By the word of truth. That is, by making known the truths of the gospel. It was his object to make known the simple truth. He did not corrupt it by false mixtures of philosophy and human wisdom, but communicated it as it had been revealed to him. The object of the appointment of the Chris- tian ministry is to make known the truth, and when that is done it cannot but be that they will commend their office and work to the favourable re- gards of men. t -Sy the power of God. By the divine power which attended the preaching of the gospel. Most of the ancient commentators explain this of the power of working miracles. — Bloom- Jield. But it probably includes all the 13 armour ''of righteousness on the right hand and on the left, cEp. 6. 11. &c. displays of divine power which attended the propagation of the gospel, whether in the working of miracles, or in the conversion of men. If it be asked how Paul used this power so as to give no offence in the work of the ministry, it may be replied, that the miraculous endowments bestowed upon the apostles, the power of speaking foreign languages, &c., seem to have been bestowed upon them to be employed in the same way as were their natural faculties. See Notes on 1 Cor. xiv. 32. The idea here is, that they used the great powers intrusted to them by God, not as impostors would have done, for the purposes of gain and ambition, or for vain display, but solely fi5r the furtherance of the true religion, and the salvation of men. They thus showed that they were sent from God, as well by the nature of the powers with which they were intrusted, as by the man- ner in which they used them, t By the armour of righteousness on the right hand and on the left. Interpreters have varied much in the exposition of this passage ; and many have run into utter wildness. Grotius says, that it refers to the manner in which the ancient soldiers were armed. They bore a spear in their right hand, and a shield in the left. With the former they attacked their foes, with the latter they made defence. Some have sup- posed that it refers to the fact that they were taught to use the sword with the left hand as well as with the right. The simple idea is, that they were com- pletely armed. To be armed on the right hand and on the left is to be well armed, or entirely equipped. They wen forth to conflict. They met persecutiot. opposition, and slander. As the soldie. went well armed to battle, so did they But the armour with which they m their foes, and which constituted thei. entire panoply, was a holy life. With that they met all the assaults of their enemies; with that all slander and perse- 146 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 8 By honour and dishonour by evil report and good re- culion. That was their defence, and by that they hoped and expected to achieve their conquests. They had no swords, and spears, and helmets, and shields; no carnal weapons of offence and defence ; but they expected to meet all their assaults, and to gain ail their victories, by an upright and holy life. 8. By honour and dishonour. The apostle is still illustrating the proposition that he and his fellow-labourers en- deavoured to give no offence (ver. 3), and to commend themselves as the mi- nisters of God. ver. 4. He here (ver. 8 — 10) introduces another group of particulars in which it was done. The main idea is, that they endeavoured to act in a manner so as to commend the ministry and the gospel, whether they were in circumstances of honour or dis- honour, whether lauded or despised by the world. The word rendered " by" (f the apostles. 1 And yei possessing all things. That is, (1.) Possessing a portion of all things that may be neces- sary for our welfare, as far as our heaven- ly Father shall deem to be necessary for us. (2.) Possessing an interest in all things, so that we can enjoy them. We can derive pleasure from the works of God — the heavens, the earth, the hills, the streams, the cattle on the mountains or in the vales, as the v/orks of God. We have a possession in them so that we can enjoy them as his works, andean say, "Our Father made them all." They are given to man to enjoy. They are a part of the inheritance of man. And though we cannot call them our own in the legal sense, yet we can call them ours in the sense that we can derive pleasure from their contemplation, and see in them the prQpfs of the wis- dom and the goodness of God. The child of God that looks upon the hills and vales ; upon an extensive and beautiful farm or landscape, may derive more pleasure from the contemplation of them as the work of God and his gift to men, than the real owner does, if irreligious, from contemplating all this as his own. And so far as mere happiness is concerned, the friend of God who sees in all this the proofs of God's beneficence and wisdom, may have a more valuable possession in those things than he who holds the title-deeds. (3.) Heirs of all things. We have a title to immortal life — a promised part in all that the universe can furnish that can make us happy. (4.) In the pos- session of pardon and peace ; of the friendship of God and the knowledge of the Redeemer, we have the posses- eion of all things, Tl|is comprises all. 11 O ye Corinthians, our mouth is open unto you, our * heart is enlarged. b Ep. 6. 8. Re. 22. 12. He that has this, what need has he ol more ] This meets all the desires ; satisfies the soul ; makes the man happy and blessed. He that has God for his portion, may be said to have all things, for he is " all in all." He that has the Redeemer for his friend has all things that he needs, for " he that spared not his own Son, but gave him up for us all, how shall he not with him also freely give us all things'?" Rom viii. 32. 11. ye Corinthians, our mouth is open unto you. We speak freely, and fully. This is an affectionate address to them, and has reference to what he had just said. It means that, when the heart was full on the subject, words would flow freely, and that he had given vent to the fervid language which he had just used because his heart was full. He loved them ; he felt deeply ; and he spoke to them with the utmost freedom of what he had thought, and purposed, and done. ^ Our heart is enlarged. We have deep feelings, which naturally vent themselves in fervent and glowing language. The main idea here is, that he had a strong affection for them ; a heart which embraced and loved them all, and which expressed itself in the language of deep emotion. He had loved them so that he was willing to be reproached, and to be persecuted, and to be poor, and to have his name cast out as evil. ' I cannot be silent. I con- ceal or dissemble nothing. I am full of ardent attachment, and that naturally vents itself in the strong language which I have used.' True attachment will find means of expressing itself, A heart full of love will give vent to its feelings. There will be no dissembling and hy- pocrisy there. And if a minister loves the souls of his people he will pour out the affections of his heart in strong and glowing language. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. 151 12 Ye are not straitened in us, but ye are straitened in your own bowels. 13 Now for a recompence in 12. Ye are not straitened in us. ITiat is, you do not possess a narrow or contracted place in our afiections. We love you fully, ardently, and are ready to do all that can be done for your welfare. There is no want of room in our affections towards you. It is not narrow, confined, pent up. It is ample and free. ^ But ye are straitened in your own bowels. That is, in the affec- tions of your hearts. The word here used {a-TTKay^^vdi.) commonly means in the Bible the tender affections. The Greek word properly denotes the upper viscera ; the heart, the lungs, the liver. It is applied by Greek writers to denote those parts of victims which were eaten during or after the sacrifice, — Robinson {Lex.). Hence it is applied to the heart, as the seat of the emotions and passions ; and especially the gentler emotions, the ten- der affections, compassion, pity, love, &c. Our word " bowels" is applied usually to the lower viscera, and by no means expresses the idea of the word which is used in Greek. The idea here is, that they were straitened, or were confined in their afiections for him. It is the language of reproof, meaning that he had not received from them the demon- strations of attachment which he had a right to expect, and which was a fair and proportionate return for the love bestowed on them. Probably he refers to the fact that they had formed parties ; had admitted false teachers ; and had not received his instructions as impli- .•itly and as kindly as they ought to lave done. 13. Now far a recompense in the mme. ' By way of recompense, open four hearts in the same manner towards Hne as I have done toward you. It is all the reward or compensation which I ask of you ; all the return which I de- sire. I do not ask siirer or gold, or any earthly poascasicns, I ask only a return i the same, (I speak as unto my children,) be ye also enlarged. 14 Be "ye not unequally yoked together with unbelievers ; for aDe. 7. 2, 3. 1 Co. 7. 39. of love, and a devotedness to the cause which I love, and which I endeavour to promote.' t -^ speak as unto my child ren. I speak as a parent addressing his children. I sustain toward you the relation of a spiritual father, and I have a right to require and expect a return, of affection. ^ Be ye also enlarged Be not straitened in your affections Love me as I love you. Give to me the same proofs of attachment which I have given you. The idea in this verse is, that the only compensation or remu neration which he expected for all the love which he had shown them, and for all his toils and self-denials in theii behalf (ver. 4, 5), was, that they would love him, and yield obedience to the laws of the gospel requiring them to be separate from the world, ver. 14 — 18 One ground of the claim which he had to their affection was, that he sustained toward them the relation of a father, and that he had a right to require and to ex- pect such a return of love. The Syriac renders it well, "Enlarge your love towards me." Tindal renders it, "I speak unto you as unto children, which have like reward with us ; stretch your- selves therefore out ; bear not the yoke with unbelievers." 14. Be ye not unequally yoked to- gether with unbelievers. This is closely connected in sense with the previous verse. The apostle is there stating the nature of the remuneration or recom- pense which he asks for all the love which he had shown to them. He here says, that one mode of remuneration would be to yield obedience to his com- mands, and to separate themselves from all improper aUiance with unbelievers. ' Make me this return for my love. Love me also, and as a proof of your affec- tion, be not improperly united with unbelievers. Listen to me as a father addressing his children, and secure your 152 11. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 what fellowship hath righteous- ness with unrighteousness ? and own happiness and piety by not being unequally yoked with those who are not Christians.' The word which is here used (iTi^o^uyiU)) means properly, to bear a different yoke, to be yoked heterogeneously. — Robinson (Lex.). It is applied to the custom of yoking animals of different kinds together (Pas- sow) ; and as used here means not to mingle together, or be united with un- believers. It is implied in the use of the word that there is a dissimilarity between believers and unbelievers so great that it is as improper for them to mingle together as it is to yoke animals of dif- ferent kinds and species. The ground of the injunction is, that there is a dif- ference between Christians and those who are not, so great as to render such unions improper and injurious. The direction here refers doubtless to all kinds of improper connexions with those who were unbelievers. It has been usually supposed by commentators to refer particularly to marriage. But there is no reason for confining it to marriage. It doubtless includes that, but it may as well refer to any other intimate connexion, or to intimate friendships, or to participation in their amusements and employments, as to marriage. The radical idea is, that they were to abstain from all con- nexions with unbelievers — with infidels, and heathens, and those who were not Christians, which would identify them with them ; or they were to have no connexion with them in any thing as unbelievers, heathens, or infidels ; they were to partake with them in nothing that was peculiar to them as such. They were to have no part with them in their heathenism, unbelief, and idolatry, and infidelity ; they were not to be united with them in any way or sense where it would necessarily be under- stood that they were partakers with them in those things. This is evidently the principle here laid down, and this principle is as applicable now as it was then. In the remainder of this what communion hath light with darkness 1 verse and the following verses (15, 16), he states reasons why they should have no such intercourse. There is no princi- ple of Christianity that is more impor- tant than that which is here stated by the apostle ; and none in which Chris- tians are more in danger of erring, or in which they have more difficulty in determining the exact rule which they are to follow. The questions which arise are very important. Are we to have no intercourse with the people of the world ? Are we cut loose from all our friends who are not Christians 1 Are we to become monks, and live a recluse and unsocial life ? Are we never to mingle with the people of the world in business, in innocent recrea- tion, or in the duties of citizens, and as neighbours and friends 1 It is important, therefore, in the highest degree, to en- deavour to ascertain what are the prin- ciples on which the New Testament requires us to act in this matter. And in order to a correct understanding of this, the following principles may be suggested. I. There is a large field of action, pursuit, principle, and thought, over which infidelity, sin, heathenism, and the world as such, have the entire control. It is wholly without the range of Christian law, and stands opposed to Christian law. It pertains to a different kingdom ; is conducted by different principles, and tends to destroy and annihilate the kingdom of Christ. It cannot be reconciled with Christian principle, and cannot be conformed to but in entire violation of the influence of reUgion. Here the prohibition of the New Testament is absolute and entire. Christians are not to mingle with the people of the world in these things ; and are not to partake of them. This pro- hibition, it is supposed, extends to the following, among other things. (1 .) To idolatry. This was plain. On no ac- count or pretence were the early Chris- tians to partake of that, or to counte- nance it. In primitive times, during the Roman persecutions, all that was A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. 153 asked was that they should cast a little incense on the altar of a heathen god. They refused to do it, and because they refused to do it, thousands perished as martyrs. Tiiey judged rightly; and the world has approved their cause. (2.) Sin, vice, licentiousness. This is also plain. Christians are in no way to patronise them, or to lend their influ- ence to them, or to promote them by their name, their presence, or their property. " Neither be partakers of other men's sins." 1 Tim. v. 22. 2 John 11. (3.) Arts and acts of dishonesty, de- ception, and fraud in traffic and trade. Here the prohibition also must be absolute. No Christian can have a right to enter into partnership with another where the business is to be con- ducted on dishonest and unchristian principles, or where it shall lead to the violation of any of the laws of God. If it involves deception and fraud in the principles on which it is conducted ; if it spreads ruin and poverty — as the distilling and vending of ardent spirits does ; if it leads to the necessary viola- tion of the Christian Sabbath, then the case is plain. A Christian is to have no "fellowship with such unfruitful works of darkness, but is rather to re- prove them." Eph. v. 11. (4.) The amusements and pleasures that are en- tirely worldly, and sinful in their nature ; that are wholly under worldly influence, and which cannot be brought under Christian principles. Nearly all amuse- ments are of this description. The true principle here seems to be, that if a Christian in such a place is expected to lay aside his Christian principles, and if it would be deemed indecorous and improper for him to introduce the sub- ject of religion, or if religion would be regarded as entirely inconsistent with the nature of the amusement, then he is not to be found there. The world reigns there, and if the principles of his Lord and Master vi'ould be excluded, he should not be there. This applies of course to the theatre, the circus, the ball-room, and to large and splendid parties of pleasure. We are not to associate with idolaters in their idolatry; nor with the licentious in their licen- tiousness ; nor with the infidel in his infidelity ; nor with the proud in their pride ; nor with the gay in their gayety; nor with the friends of the theatre, or the ball-room, or the circus in their attachment to these places and pursuits. And whatever other con- nexion we are to have with them as neighbours, citizens, or members of our families, we are not to participate with them IN" these things. Thus far all seems to be clear; and the rule is a plain one, whether it applies to mar- riage, or to business, or to religion, or to pleasure. Comp. Note, 1 Cor. v. 10. II. There is a large field of action, thought, and plan which may be said to be common with the Christian and the world ; that is, where the Chris- tian is not expected to abandon his own principles, and where there will be, or need be, no compromise of the stern- est views of truth, or the most upright, serious, and holy conduct. He may carry his principles with him ; may always manifest them if necessary ; and may even commend them to others. A few of these may be referred to. (1.) Commercial transactions and pro- fessional engagements that are con- ducted on honest and upright principles, even when those with whom we act are not Christians. (2.) Literary and scientific pursuits, which never, when pursued with a right spirit, interfere with the principles of Christianity, and never are contrary to it. (3.) The love and affection which are due to relatives and friends. Nothing in the Bible assuredly will prohibit a pious son from uniting with one who is not pious in supporting an aged and infirm parent, or a much loved and affectionate sister. The same remark is true also respecting the duty which a wife owes to a hus- band, a husband to a wife, or a parent to a child, though one of them should not be a Christian. And the same ob- servation is true also of neighbours, who are not to be prohibited from uniting us neighbours in social intercourse, and in acts of common kindness and charity though all not Christians. (4.) As 154 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 15 And what concord hath Christ with Belial ? or what citizens. We owe duties to our country, and a Christian need not refuse to act with others in the elective franchise, or in making or administering the laws. Here, however, it is clear that he is not at liberty to violacte the laws and the principles of the Bible. He cannot be at liberty to unite with them in political schemes that are contrary to the law of God, or in elevating to office men whom he cannot vote for with a good conscience as qualified for the station. (5.) In plans of public improvement, in schemes that go to the advancement of the public welfare, when the schemes do not violate the laws of God. But if they involve the necessity of violating the Sabbath, or any of the laws of God, assuredly he cannot consistently par- ticipate in them. (6.) In doing good to others. So the Saviour was with sin- ners ; so he ate, and drank, and conversed with them. So we may mingle with them, without partaking of their wicked feelings and plans, so far as we can do them good, and exert over them a holy and saving influence. In all the situa- tions here referred to, and in all the duties growing out of them, the Chris- tian may maintain his principles, and may preserve a good conscience. In- deed the Saviour evidently contemplated that his people would have such inter- course with the world, and that in it they would do good. But in none of these is there to be any compromise of principle ; in none to be any yielding to the opinions and practices that are contrary to the laws of God. III. There is a large field of action, conduct, and plan, where Christians only will act together. These relate to the peculiar duties of religion — to prayer, Christian fellowship, the ordinances of the gospel, and most of the plans of Christian be- neficence. Here the world will not in- trude ; and here assuredly there will be no necessity of any compromise of Christian principle. ^ Far what fel- lowship. Paul proceeds here to state reasons why there should be no such improper connexion with the world. The main reason, though under various forms, is, that there can be no fellow- ship, no communion, nothing in com- mon between them ; and that therefore they should be separate. The word fellowship (^(xarQ-xi) means partnership, participation. What is there in com- mon ; or how can the one partake with the other ] The interrogative form here is designed to be emphatic, and to de- clare in the strongest terms that there can be no such partnership. \ Right- eousness. Such as you Christians are required to practise ; implying that all were to be governed by the stern and uncompromising principles of honesty and justice. \ With unrigfiteousness. Dishonesty, injustice, sin ; implying that the world is governed by such principles. ^ And what communion (ttoivmiu.). Participation ; communion ; that which is in common. What is there in com- mon between light and darkness 1 What common principle is there of which they both partake 1 There is none. There is a total and eternal separation, f Light. The emblem of truth, virtue, holiness. See Note, Matt. iv. 1 6 ; v. 1 6. John i. 4. Rom. ii. 19. 2 Cor. iv. 4. 6. It is implied here that Christians are en- lightened, and walk in the light. Their principles are pure and holy — principles of which light is the proper emblem. ^ Darkness. The emblem of sin, cor- ruption, ignorance ; implying that the world to which Paul refers was go- verned and influenced by these. The idea is, that as there is an entire sepa- ration between light and darkness in their nature ; as they have nothing in common, so it is and should be, between Christians and sinners. There should be a separation. There can be nothing in common between holiness and sin ; and Christians should have nothing to do " with the unfruitful works of dark ness." Eph. v. 11. 15. And what concord (a-u/m^^vna-tc) Sympathy, unison. This word refera properly to the unison or harmony pro» A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. 155 part hatn he that believeth with an infidel ? 16 And what agreement hath duced by musical instruments, where there is a chord. What accordance, what unison is there ; what strings are there which being struck will produce a chord or harmony 1 The idea is, then, there is as much that is discordant be- tween Christ and Belial as there is be- tween instruments of music that produce only discordant and jarring sounds. t Hath Christ. What is there in com- mon between Christ and Belial, imply- ing that Christians are governed by the principles, and that they follow the example of Christ, t Belial. B«a/ox or B«\/a^, as it is found in some of the late editions. The form Beliar is Syriac. The Hebrew word('7];>S3)means literally without profit ; worthlessness ,' wicked- ness. It is here evidently applied to Satan. The Syriac translates it " Satan." The idea is, that the persons to whom Paul referred, the heathen, wicked, un- believing world, were governed by the principles of Satan, and were " taken captive by him at his will" (2 Tim. ii. 26. Comp. John viii. 44), and that Christians should be separate from the wicked world, as Christ was separate from all the feelings, purposes, and plans of Satan. He had no participation in them ; he formed no union with them ; and so it should be with the followers of the one in relation to the followers of the other, t Or what part {fxi^t;). Portion, share, participation, fellowship. This word refers usually to a division of an estate. Luke x. 42. Note, Acts viii. 21. Col. i. 12. There is no par- ticipation ; nothing in common, t He that believeth. A Christian ; a man the characteristic of whom it is that he believes on the Lord Jesus, t With an infidel. A man who does not be- lieve — whether a heathen idolater, a profane man, a scoffer, a philosopher, a man of science, a moral man, or a son or daughter of gayety. The idea \ that on the subjeet of religion there the temple of God with idols ? for ye " are the temple of the living God ; as God hath said, a 1 Co. 3. 16, 17 ; 6. 19. Ep. 2. 21, 22, is no union ; nothing in common ; no participation. They are governed by different principles ; have different feel- ings ; are looking to different rewards and are tending to a different destiny The believer, therefore, should not select his partner in life and his chosen com- panions and friends from this class, but from those with whom he has sympathy, and with whom he has common feelings and hopes. 16. And what agreement {^vyKn- rdB-io-t;). Assent, accord, agreement; what putting or laying down together is there 1 What is there in one that re- sembles the other. ^ TJie temple of God. What has a temple of God to do with idol worship 1 It is erected for a different purpose, and the worship of idols in it would not be tolerated. It is implied here that Christians are them- selves the temple of God, a fact which Paul proceeds immediately to illustrate , and that it is as absurd for them to min- gle with the infidel world as it would be to erect the image of a heathen god in the temple of Jehovah. This is strong language, and we cannot but admire the energy and copiousness of the expressions used by Paul, " which cannot," says Bloomfield, "be easily paralleled in the best classical writers." H With idols. Those objects which God hates, and on which he cannot look but with abhorrence. The sense is, that for Christians to mingle with the sinful world ; to partake of their plea- sures, pursuits, and follies, is as detesta- ble and hateful in the sight of God as if his temple were profaned by erecting a deformed, and shapeless, and senseless block in it as an object of worship. And, assuredly, if Christians had such a sense of the abomination of mingling with the world, they would feel the obligation to be separate and pure, t For ye are the temple of the living God. See this explained in the Notes on 1 Cor. iii. ItJ, 156 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. " I will dwell in them, and walk in them; and I will be their God, and they shall be my peo- ple. a Ex.29. 45. Le. 26. 12. Je. 31. 1,33; 82, 38. Ez. 11. 20; 36. 28 ; 37. 26, 27. 17. The idea is, that as God dwells with his people, they ought to be sepa- rated from a sinful and polluted world. t As God hath said. The words here quoted are taken substantially from Ex. xxxix. 45. Lev. xxvi. 12. Ezek. xxxvii. 27. They are not literally quoted, but Paul has thrown together the sub- stance of what occurs in several places. The sense, however, is the same as occurs in the places referred to. t I will dwell in them (\voiKwa)). I will take up my indwelling in them. There is an allusion doubtless to the fact that he would be present among his people by the Shechinah, or the visi- ble symbol of his presence. See Note on 1 Cor. iii. 16, 17. It implies, when used with reference to Christians, that the Holy Spirit would abide with them, and that the blessing of God would attend them. See Rom. viii. Col. iii. 16. 2 Tim. i. 14. Tf And walk in them. That is, I will walk among them. I will be one of their number. He was present among the Jews by the public manifestation of his presence by a sym- bol ; he is present with Christians by the presence and guidance of his Holy ■Spirit. H And I will he their God. Not only the God whom they worship, but the God who will protect and bless them. I will take them under my pecu- liar protection, and they shall enjoy my favour. This is certainly as true of Christians as it was of the Jews, and Paul has not departed from the spirit of the promise in applying it to the Christian character. His object in quoting these passages is, to impress on Christians the solemnity and importance of the truth that God dwelt among them and with them ; that they were under his care and protection ; that they be- longed to him, and that they therefore should be separate from the world. 17 Wherefore * come out from among them, and be ye separate, saith the Lord, and touch not the unclean thing ; and I will re ceive you, b Is. 52. 11. c. 7.1. Re. 18.4. 17. Wherefore. Since you are a pe- culiar people. Since God, the holy and blessed God, dwells with you and among you. If Come out from among them That is, from among idolaters and \xn believers ; from a gay and vicious world. These words are taken, by a slight change, from Isaiah Iii. 11. They are there applied to the Jews in Babylon, and are a solemn call which God makes on them to leave the place of their exile, to come out from among the idolaters of that city and return to their own land. See my Note on that place. Babylon, in the Scriptures, is the em- blem of whatever is proud, arrogant, wicked, and opposed to God ; and Paul, therefore, applies the words here with great beauty and force to illustrate the duty of Christians in separating them- selves from a vain, idolatrous, and wick- ed world. *|I And he ye separate. Separate from the world, and all its cor- rupting influences, f Saith the Lord. See Isaiah Iii. 1 1 . Paul does not use this language as if it had original refer- ence to Christians, but he applies it as containing an important principle that was applicable to the case which he was considering, or as language that would appropriately express the idea which he wished to convey. The language of the Old Testament is often used in this manner by the writers of the New. t And touch not the unclean thing. In Isaiah, " touch no unclean thing ;" that is, they were to be pure, and to have no connexion with iiolatry in any of its forms. So Christians were to avoid all unholy contact with a vain and polluted world. The sense is, ' Have no close connexion with an idolater, or an unholy person. Be pure ; and feel that you belong to a community that is under its own laws, and that is to be distinguished in moral purity from all A D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. 18 And " will be a Father un- to you, and ye shall be my sons aJe. 31. 9. Re. 21. 7. the rest of the world.' t ^nd I will receive you. That is, I will receive and recognise you as my friends and my adopted children. This could not be done until they were separated from an idolatrous and wicked world. The fact of their being received by God, and recognised as his children, depended on their coming out from the world. These words with the verse following, though used evidently somewhat in the form of a quotation, yet are not to be found in any single place in the Old Testament. In 2 Sam. vii. 14. God says of Solomon, " I will be his Father, and he shall be my son." In Jer. xxxi. 9, God says, " For I am a Father to Israel, and Ephraim is my first-born." It is probable that Paul had such passages in his eye, yet he doubt- less designed rather to express the gene- ral sense of the promises of the Old Testament than to quote any single passage. Or why may it not be that we should regard Paul here himself as speaking as an inspired man directly, and making a promise then first com- municated immediately from the Lord ] Paul was inspired as well as the prophets ; and it may be that he meant to communicate a promise directly from God. Grotius supposes that it was not taken from any particular place in the Old Testament, but was a part of a hymn that was in use among the He- brews. 18. And I will he a Father unto you. A father is the protector, counsellor, and guide of his children. He in- structs them, provides for them, and counsels them in time of perplexity. No relation is more tender than this. In accordance with this, God says, that he will be to his people their protector, counsellor, guide, and friend. He will cherish towards them the feelings of a father; he will provide for them, he will acknowledge them as his children. No higher honour can be conferred on mor- tals than to be adopted into the family 14 and daughters, saith Almighty. 157 the Lora of God, and to be permitted to call the Most High our Father. No rank is so elevated as that of being the sons and the daughters of the Lord Almighty. Yet this is the common appellation by which God addresses his people; and the most humble in rank, the most poor and ignorant of his friends on earth, the most despised among men, may re- flect that they are the children of the ever living God, and have the Maker of the heavens and the earth as their Father and their eternal Friend. How poor are all the honours of the world compared with this ! ^ The Lord Almighty. The word here used (TrAVTOK^dro!^) oc- curs nowhere except in this place and in the book of Revelation. Rev. i. 8 ; iv. 8 ; xi. 17 ; xv. 3 ; xvi. 7. 14 ; xix. 6. 16 ; xxi. 22. It means one who has all power ; and is applied to God in contradistinction from iclols that are weak and powerless. God is able to protect his people, and they who put their trust in him shall never be con- founded. What has he to fear who has a friend of almighty power 1 REMAKKS. 1. It is right and proper to exhort Christians not to receive the grace of God in vain. ver. 1. Even they some- times abuse their privileges ; become neglectful of the mercy of God ; under- value the truths of religion, and do not make as much as they should do of the glorious truths that are fitted to sanctify and to save. Every Christian should endeavour to make just as much as possible of his privileges, and to become just as eminent as he can possibly he in his Christian profession. 2. The benefits of salvation to this vrorld come through the intercession of Jesus Christ, ver. 2. It is because God is pleased to hear him ; because he calls on God in an accepted time that we have any hope of pardon. The sinner enjoys no offer of mercy, and no possibility of pardon edccept what he 158 II. CORINTHIANS. LA. D. 60 owes to Jesus Christ. Should he cease to plead for men, the offers of salvation would be withdrawn, and the race would perish forever. 3. The world is under a dispensation of mercy, ver. 2. Men may be saved. God is willing to show compassion, and to rescue them from ruin. 4. How important is the present mo- ment ! ver. 2. How important is each moment ! It may be the last period of mercy. No sinner can calculate with any certainty on another instant of time. God holds his breath, and with infinite ease he can remove him to eternity. Eternal results hang on the present — the fleeting moment, and yet how un- concerned are the mass of men about their present condition ; how unanxious about what may possibly or probably occur the next moment! Now, the sinner may be pardoned. The next moment he may be beyond the reach of forgiveness. This instant, the bliss of heaven is offered him ; the next, he may be solemnly excluded from hope and heaven ! 5. The ministers of the gospel should give no occasion of offence to any one. ver. 3. On each one of them depends a portion of the honour of the ministry in this world, and of the honour of Jesus Christ among men. How solemn is this responsibility ! How pure, and holy, and unblameable should they be ! 6. Ministers and all Christians should be willing to suffer in the cause of the Redeemer, ver. 4, 5. If the early minis- ters and other Christians were called to endure the pains of imprisonment and persecution for the honour of the gos- pel, assuredly we should be willing also to suffer. Why should there be any more reason for their suffering than for ours 1 7. We see what our religion has cost. ver. 4, .5. It has come down to us through suffering. All the privileges that we enjoy have been the fruit of toil, and blood, and tears, and sighs. The best blood in human veins has flowed to procure these blessings ; the holiest men on earth have wept, and been scourged, and tortured, that we might possess these privileges. What thanks should we give to God for all this ! How highly should we prize the religion that has cost so much ! 8. In trial we should evince such a spirit as not to dishonour, but to honour our religion, ver. 3 — 5. This is as in cumbent on all Christians as it is on ministers of the gospel. It is in such scenes that the reality of religion is tested. It is then that its power is seen. It is then that its value may be known Christians and Christian ministers often do good in circumstances of poverty, persecution, and sickness, which they never do in health, and in popular favour, and in prosperity. And God often places his people in trial that they may do good then, expecting that they will accomplish more then than they could in prosperous circumstances They whose aim it is to do good havo often occasion to bless God that they were subjected to trial. Bunyan wrote the " Pilgrim's Progress" in a dungeon ; and almost all the works of Baxter were written when he was suffering undey persecution, and forbidden to preach the gospel. The devil is often foiled in this way. He persecutes and opposes Chris- tians ; and on the rack and at the stake they do most to destroy his kingdom ; he throws them into dungeons, and they make books which go down even to the millennium, making successful war on the empire of darkness. Christians, therefore, should esteem it a privilege to be permitted to suffer on account of Christ. Phil. i. 29. 9. If ministers and other Christiana do any good they must be pure. ver. 6, 7. The gospel is to be commended by pureness, and knowledge, and the word of truth, and the armour of righteous- ness. It is in this way that they are to meet opposition ; in this way that they are to propagate their sentiments. No man need expect to do good in the mi- nistry or as a private Christian, who is not a holy man. No man who is a holy man can help doing good. It will be a matter of course that he will shed a healthful moral influence around him. And he will no more live without effect A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VI. 159 than the sun sheds its steady beams on the earth without etTect. His influence may be very noiseless and still, like the sun-beams or the dew, but it will be felt in the world. Wicked men can resist any thing else better than they can a holy example. They can make a mock of preaching ; they can deride exhortation ; they can throw away a tract ; they can burn the Bible ; but what can they do against a holy exam- ple ■? No more than they can against the \ivifying and enlightening beams of the sun ; and a man who leads a holy life cannot help doing good, and cannot be prevented from doing good. 10. They who are Christians must expect to meet with much dishonour, and to be subjected often to the influ- ence of evil report, ver. 8. The world is unfriendly to religion, and its friends must never be surprised if their motives are impeached, and their names calum- niated. 11. Especially is this the case with ministers, ver. 8. They should make up their minds to it, and they should not suppose that any strange thing had happened to them if they are called thus to suffer. 12. They who are about to make a profession of religion, and they who are about entering on the work of the ministry, or who are agitating the ques- tion whether they should be ministers, should ask themselves whether they are prepared for this. They should count the cost ; nor should they either make a profession of religion or think of the ministry as a profession, unless they are willing to meet with dishonour, and to go through evil report ; to be poor (ver. 10), and to be despised and persecuted, or to die in the cause which they embrace. 13. Religion has power to sustain the soul in trials, ver. 10. Why should he be sad who has occasion to rejoice always ] Why should he deem him- self poor, though he has slender earthly possessions, who is able to make many rich 1 Why should he be melancholy as if he had nothing, who has Christ as his portion, and who is an heir of all things ] Let not the poor, who are rich in faith, despond as though they had nothing. They have a treasure which gold cannot purchase, and which will be of infinite value when all other trea- sure fails. He that has an everlasting inheritance in heaven cannot be called a poor man. And he that can look to such an inheritance should not be un- willing to part with his earthly posses- sions. Those who seem to be most wealthy are often the poorest of mortals ; and those who seem to be poor, or who are in humble circumstances, often have an enjoyment of even this world which is unknown in the palaces and at the tables of the great. They look on all things as the work of theii Father ; and in their humble dwellings, and with their humble fare, they have an enjoyment of the bounties of their heavenly Benefactor, which is not ex perienced often in the dwellings of the great and the rich. 14. A people should render to a minister and a pastor a return of love and confidence that shall be proper tionate to the love which is shown to them. ver. 1 2. This is but a reasonable and fair requital, and this is necessary not only to the comfort, but to tlie suc- cess of a minister. What good can he do unless he has the affections and con- fidence of his people 1 15. The compensation or recompense which a minister has a right to expect and require for arduous toil is, that his people should be "enlarged" in love towards him, and that they should yield themselves to the laws of the Redeemer, and be separate from the world, ver. 13. And this is an ample reward. It is what he seeks, what he prays for, what he most ardently desires. If he is worthy of his office, he will seek not theirs but them (2 Cor. xii. 14), and he will bo satisfied for all his toils if he sees them walking in the truth (3 John 4), and showing in their lives the pure and elevated principles of the gospel which they profess to love. 1 6. The welfare of religion depends on 160 II CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. ths fact that Christians should be sepa- rate from a vain, and gay, and wicked world, ver. 14 — 16. Why should they partake of those things in which they can, if Christians, have nothing in com- mon? Why attempt to mingle light with darkness 1 to form a compact between Christ and Belial ] or to set up a polluted idol in the temple of the living God ? The truth is, there are great and eternal principles in the gospel which should not be surrendered, and which cannot be broken down. Christ intended to set up a kingdom that should be unlike the kingdoms of this world. And he designed that his people should be governed by different principles from the people of this world. 17. They who are about to make a profession of religion should resolve to separate themselves from the world, ver. 14, 15. Religion cannot exist where there is no such separation, and they who are unwilling to forsake infidel companions and the gay amusements and vanities of life, and to find their chosen friends and pleasures among the people of God, can have no evi- dence that they are Christians. The world with all its wickedness and its gay pleasures must be forsaken, and there must be an effectual line drawn between the friends of God and the friends of sin. Let us, then, who profess to be the friends of the Redeemer remember how pure and holy we should be. It should not be indeed with the spirit of the Pharisee ; it should not be with a spirit that will lead us to say " stand by, for I am hoUer than thou ;" but it should be, while we discharge all our duties to our impenitent friends, and while in all our intercourse with the world we should be honest and true, and while we do not refuse to mingle with them as neigh- bours and citizens as far as we can without compromitting Christian princi- ples, still our chosen friends and our dearest friendships should be with the people of God. For, his friends should be our friends ; our happiness should be with them, and the world should see tlxat we prefer the friends of the Re- deemer to the friends of gayety, ambi- tion, and sin. 18. Christians are the holy temple of God. ver. 16. How pure should they be ! How free should they be from sin ! How careful to maintain consciences void of offence ! 1 9. What an inestimable privilege it is to be a Christian ! (ver. 18) ; to be a child of God ! to feel that he is a Father and a Friend ! to feel that though we may be forsaken by all others ; though poor and despised, yet there is one who never forsakes ; one who never forgets that he has sons and daughters dependent on him, and who need his constant care. Compared with this, how small the honour of being permitted to call the rich our friends, or to be regarded as the sons or daughters of nobles and of princes ! Let the Christian then most highly prize his privileges, and feel that he is raised above all the elevations of rank and honour which this world can bestow. All these shall fade away, and the high- est and the lowest shall meet on the same level in the grave, and alike return to dust. But the elevation of the child of God shall only begin to be visible and appreciated when all other honours fade away. 20. Let all seek to become the sons and daughters of the Lord Almighty. Let us aspire to this rather than to earthly honours ; let us seek this rather than to be numbered with the rich and the great. All cannot be honoured in this world, and few are they who can be regarded as belonging to elevated ranks here. But all may be the children of the living God, and be permitted to call the Lord Almighty their Father and their Friend. O ! if men could as easily be permitted to call themselves the sons of monarchs and princes ; if they could as easily be admitted to the palaces of the great and sit down at their tables as ihey can enter heaven, how greedily would they embrace it ! And yet how poor and paltry would be such honour and pleasure compared with that of feeling that we are the adopted children of the great and the eternal God ! A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VII. TTAVING therefore these CHAPTER Vn. 161 promises, dearly beloved, a c. 6. 17, 18. 1 Jno. 3. 3. CHAPTER VII. The first verse of this chapter proper- ly belongs to the previous chapter, and should have been attached to that. It is an exhortation made in viewr of the promises there referred to, to make every effort to obtain perfect purity, and to be- come entirely holy. In ver. 2, 3, he entreats the Corinth- ians, in accordance with the wish which he had expressed in ch.vi. 13, to receive him as a teacher, and a spiritual father ; as a faithful apostle of the Lord Jesus. To induce them to do this, he assures them that he had given them, at no time, any occasion of offence. He had injured no man ; he had wronged no man. Possibly some might suppose that he had injured them by the stern- ness of his requirements in forbidding them to contract friendships and al- liances with infidels ; or in the case of discipline in regard to the incestuous person. But he assures them that all his commands had been the fruit of most tender love for them, and that he was ready to live and die with them. The remainder of the chapter (ver. 4 — 15) is occupied mainly in stating the joy which he had at the evidence which they had given that they were ready to obey his commands. He says, there- fore (ver. 4), that he was full of com- fort and joy ; and that in all his tribu- lation, the evidence of their obedience had given him great and unfeigned satisfaction. In order to show them the extent of his joy, he gives a pa- thetic description of the anxiety of mind which he had on the subject ; his troubles in Macedonia, and particularly his distress on not meeting with Titus as he had expected, ver. 5. But this distress had been relieved by his com- ing, and by the evidence which was furnished through him that they were ifeady to yield obedience to his com- 14* let us cleanse '' ourselves from all filthiness of the flesh and spirit, perfecting holiness in the fear of God. b Ps. 51 . 10. Ez. 36. 25, 26. 1 Jno. 1. 7, 9. mands. ver. 6, 7. This joy was greatly increased by his hearing from Titus the effect which his former epistle to them had produced, ver. 8 — 13. He had felt deep anxiety in regard to that. He had even regretted, it would seem (ver. 8), that he had sent it. He had been deeply pained at the necessity of giving them pain. ver. 8. But the effect had been all that he had desired ; and when he learned from Titus the effect which it had produced — the deep repentance which they had evinced, and the thorough reformation which had oc- curred (ver. 9 — 11), he had great occa- sion to rejoice that he had sent the epistle to them. This new and dis- tinguished instance of their obedience had given him great joy, and confirmed him in the proof that they were truly attached to him. The apostle adds, in the conclusion of the chapter, that his joy was greatly increased by the joy which Titus manifested, and his entire satisfaction in the conduct of the Co- rinthians and the treatment which he had received from them (ver. 13), so that though he, Paul, had often had occasion to speak in the kindest terms of the Corinthians, all that he had ever said in their favour Titus had realized in his own case (ver. 14), and the affec- tion of Titus for them had been greatly increased by his visit to them. ver. 1 5. The whole chapter, therefore, is emi- nently adapted to produce good feeling in the minds of the Corinthians toward the apostle, and to strengthen the bonds of their mutual attachment. I. Having therefore these promises. The promises referred to in ch. vi. 17, 18 ; the promise that God would be a Father, a protector, and a friend. The idea is, that as we have a promise that God would dwell in us, that he would be our God, that he would be to us a father, we should remove from us what rm II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. ever s offensive in his sight, and become perfectly holy, f Lei us cleanse our- selves. Let us purify ourselves. Paul was not afraid to bring into view the agency of Christians themselves in the work of salvation. He, therefore, says, *let us purify ourselves,' as if Christians had much to do ; as if their own agency was to be employed ; and as if their purifying was dependent on their own efforts. While it is true that all purify- ing influence and all holiness proceeds from God, it is also true that the effect of all the influences of the Holy Spirit is to excite us to diligence to purify our own hearts, and to urge us to make strenuous efforts to overcome our own sins. He who expects to be made pure without any effort of his own will never become pure ; and he who ever becomes holy will become so in consequence of strenuous efforts to resist the evil of his own heart, and to become like God. The argument here is, that we have the promises of God to aid us. We do not go about the work in our own strength. It is not a work in which we are to have no aid. But it is a work which God desires, and where he will give us all the aid which we need. ^ From all Jilthiness of the Jlesh. The noun here used (/ucKva-fjto;) occurs nowhere else in the New Testament. The verb occurs in 1 Cor. viii. 7. Rev. iii. 4 ; xiv. 4, and means to stain, defile, pollute, as a garment; and the word here used means a soiling, hence defilement, pollution, and refers to the defiling and corrupting influence of fleshly desires and carnal appetites. The filthiness of the flesh here denotes evidently the gross and corrupt appetites and passions of the body, including all such actions of all kinds as are inconsistent with the virtue and purity with which the body, re- garded as the temple of the Holy Ghost, should be kept holy — all such passions and appetites as the Holy Spirit of God would not produce. H And Spirit. By * filthiness of the spirit,' the apostle means, probably, all the thoughts or mental associations that defile the man. Thus the Saviour (Matt. xv. 19) speaks of evil thoughts, &c. that proceed out of the heart, and that pollute the man. And probably Paul here includes all the sins and passions which appertain particularly to mind or to the soul rather than to carnal appetites, such as the desire of revenge, pride, avarice, ambi- tion, &c. These are in themselves as polluting and defiling as the gross sen- sual pleasures. They stand as much in the way of sanctification, they are as offensive to God, and they prove as certainly that the heart is depraved as the grossest sensual passions. The main difference is, that they are more decent in the external appearance ; they can be better concealed ; they are usually indulged by a more elevated class in society ; but they are not the less offen- sive to God. It may be added, also, that they are often conjoined in the same person ; and that the man who is defiled in his "spirit" is often a man most corrupt and sensual in his " flesh." Sin sweeps with a desolating influence through the whole frame, and it usually leaves no part unaffected, though some part may be more deeply corrupted than others. ^ Perfecting. This word (iTrnsxovvnc) means properly to bring to an end, to finish, complete. The idea here is, that of carrying it out to the completion. Holiness had been com- menced in the heart, and the exhortation of the apostle is, that they should make every effort that it might be complete in all its parts. He does not say that this work of perfection had ever been accomplished — nor does he say that it had not been. He only urges the obli- gation to make an effort to be entirely holy ; and this obligation is not affected by the inquiry whether any one has been or has not been perfect. It is an obli- gation which results from the nature of the law of God and his unchangeable claims on the soul. The fact that no one has been perfect does not relax the claim ; the fact that no one will be in this hfe does not weaken the obligation. It proves only the deep and dreadful depravity of the human heart, and should humble us under the stubbornness of guilt The obligation to be perfect is one that is unchangeable and eternal A. IX 60.] CHAPTER VII. 2 Receive us ; we have wrong- ed no man, we have corrupted See Matt. v. 48. 1 Pet. i. 15. Tindal renders this, " and grow up to full holi- ness in the fear of God." The unceas- ing and steady aim of every Christian should be perfection — [)erfection in all things — in the love of God, of Christ, of man ; perfection of heart, and feel- ing, and emotion ; perfection in his words, and plans, and dealings with men ; perfection in his prayers, and in his submission to the will of God. No man can be a Christian who does not sincerely desire it, and who does not constantly aim at it. No man is a friend of God who can acquiesce in a state of sin, and who is satisfied and contented that he is not as holy as God is holy. And any man who has no desire to be perfect as God is, and who does not make it his daily and constant aim to be as perfect as God, may set it down as demonstrably certain that he has no true religion. How can a man be a Christian who is willing to acquiesce in a state of sin, and who does not de- sire to be just like his Master and Lord ] ^ In the fear of God. Out of fear and reverence of God. From a regard to his commands, and a reverence for his name. The idea seems to be, that we are always in the presence of God ; we are professedly under his law ; and v/e sheuld be awed and restrained by a sense of his presence from the com- mission of sin, and from indulgence in the pollutions of the flesh and spirit. There are many sins that the presence of a child will restrain a man from com- mitting ; and how should the conscious presence of a holy God keep us from sin ! If the fear of man or of a child will restrain us, and make us attempt to be holy and pure, how should the fear of the all-present and the all-seeing God keep us not only from outward sins, but from polluted thoughts and unholy desires ! 2. Receive us. Tindal renders this, "understand us." The word here used 163 we have defrauded no no man, man. a 1 Sa. 12. 3, 4. Ac. 20. 33. c. 12. 17. (^u^»^'jlt() means properly, give space, place, or room ; and it means here evi- dently, make place or room for us in your affections ; that is, admit or receive us as your friends. It is an earnest entreaty that they would do what he had exhorted them to do in ch. vi. 13. See Note on that verse. From that he had digressed in the close of the last chapter. He here returns to the subject, and asks an interest in their affections and their love. % We have wronged no man. We have done injustice to no man. This is given as a reason why they should admit him to their full confi- dence and affection. It is not improba- ble that he had been charged with injuring the incestuous person by the severe discipline which he had found it necessary to inflict on him. Note 1 Cor. V. 5. 'I'his charge would not impro- bably be brought against him by the false teachers in Corinth. But Paul here says, that whatever was the se- verity of the discipline, he was conscious of having done injury to no member of that church. It is possible, however, that he does not here refer to any such charge, but that he says in general that he had done no injury, and that there was no reason why they should not receive him to their entire confidence. It argues great consciousness of integrity when a man who has spent a considerable time, as Paul had, with others, is able to say that he had wronged no man in any j way. Paul could not have made this I solemn declaration unless he was cer- j tain he had lived a very blameless life. Comp. Acts XX. 33. ^ We have cor- ! rupted no man. This means that ho [ had corrupted no man in his morals, { either by his precept or his example. j The word (jp^iieas) means in general to bring into a worse state or condition, I and is very often applied to morals. The j idea is, here, that Paul had not by his I precept or example made any man the I worse. He had not corrupted his princi- 164 n. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 3 I speak not this to condemn you^ for I have said "before, that ye are in our hearts to die and live with you. 4 Great is my boldness of a c. 6. 11, 12. pies or his habits, or led him into sin. K We have defrauded no man. We have taken no man's property by cun- ning, by trick, or by deception. The word TTKiovvtTiCD means literally to have more than another, and then to take advantage, to seek unlawful gain, to circumvent, defraud, deceive. The idea is, that Paul had taken advantage of no circumstances to extort money from them, to overreach them, or to cheat them. It is the conviction of a man who was conscious that he had lived honestly, and who could appeal to them all as full proof that his life among them had been blameless. 3. I speak not this to condemn you. I do not speak this with any desire to reproach you. I do not complain of you for the purpose of condemning, or because I have a desire to find fault, though I am compelled to speak in some respect of your want of affection and liberality towards me. It is not because I have no love for you, and wish to have occasion to use words implying com- plaint and condemnation, i For I have said before, chap. vii. 11,12. Tf That ye are in our hearts. That is, we are so much attached to you ; or you have such a place in our affections, f To die and live with you. If it were the will of God, we would be glad to spend our lives among you, and to die with you ; an expression denoting most tender at- tachment. A similar well-known ex- pression occurs in Horace : Tecum vivere amem, tecum obeam libens. Odes, B. III. IX. 24. With the world I live, with the world I die. This was an expression of the tender- est attachment. It was true that the Corinthians had not shown themselves remarkably worthy of the affections of Paul, but from the beginning he had felt towards them the tenderest attach- speech toward you, great ^is my glorying of you : I am filled with comfort, I am exceeding joyful " in all our tribulation. fclCo. 1.4. c. 1,14. c Ph. 2. 17, Col. 1.24 ment. And if it had been the will of God that he should cease to travel, and to expose himself to perils by sea and land to spread the knowledge of the Saviour, he would gladly have confined his labours to them, and there have ended his days. 4. Great is my boldness of speech toward you. This verse seems designed to soften the apparent harshness of what he had said (ch.. vi. 12), when he intimated that there was a want of love in them towards him (Bloomjield), as well as to refer to the plainness which he had used all along in his letters to them. He says, therefore, that he speaks freely ; he speaks as a friend ; he speaks with the utmost openness and frankness ; he conceals nothing from them. He speaks freely of their faults, and he speaks freely of his love to them ; and he as frankly commends them and praises them. It is the open, undisguised lan- guage of a friend, when he throws open his whole soul and conceals nothing. 1 Great is my glorying of you. I have great occasion to commend and praise you, and I do it freely. He refers here to the fact that he had boasted of their liberality in regard to the proposed col- lection for the poor saints of Judea (ch. ix. 4) ; that he had formerly boasted much of them to Titus, and of their readiness to obey his commands (ver. 14) ; and that now he had had abundant evidence, by what he had heard from Titus (ver. 5. seq.),that they were dis- posed to yield to his commands, anj obey his injunctions. He had probably often had occasion to boast of their favourable regard for him. ^ I am filled with comfort. That is, by the evidence which I have received of your readiness to obey me. ^ / am exceed- ing Joyful. I am overjoyed. The word here used occurs nowhere else in the A.D.60.] CHAPTER VII. 165 5 For, when we were come into Macedonia, our flesh had no rest, but we were troubled on every side ; without " ivere fight- ings, within were fears. 6 Nevertheless God that com- a De. 32. 25. New Tes'ament except in Kom. v. 20. It is not found in the classic writers ; and is a word which Paul evidently compounded (from vTrtg and Tn^io-a-ivas), and means to superabound over, to superabound greatly, or exceedingly. It is a word which would be used only when the heart was full, and when it would be difficult to find words to ex- press its conceptions. Paul's heart was full of joy; and he pours forth his feelings in the most fervid and glowing language. I have joy which cannot be expressed. ^ -^'^ o,tt our tribulation. See Note, ch. i. 4. 5. For when we were come info Macedonia. For the reasons which induced Paul to go into Macedonia, see Notes on ch. i. 16. Comp. Notes, ch. ii. 12, 13. ^ Our Jieah had no rest. We were exceedingly distressed and agitated. We had no rest. The causes of his distress he immediately states. ^ But we were troubled on every side. In every way. We had no rest in any quarter. We were obliged to enter into harassing labours and strifes there, and we were full of anxiety in regard to you. t Without were fightings. Probably he here'refers to fierce opposi- tion, which he met with in prosecuting his work of preaching the gospel. He met there, as he did everywhere, with opposition from Pagans, Jews, and false brethren. Tumults were usually excited wherever he went ; and he preached the gospel commonly amidst violent opposi- tion, t Within were fears. Referring probably to the anxiety which he had in regard to the success of the epistle which he had sent to the church at Corinth. He felt great solicitude on the subject. He had sent Titus there to see what was the state of the church forteth those that are cast down, comforted us by the coming of Titus ; " 7 And not by his coming only, but by the consolation where- with he was comforted in you, I c. 2. 13. and to witness the effect of his instruc- tions. Titus had not come to him as he had expected, at Troas (ch. ii. 13), and he felt the deepest anxiety in regard to him and to the success of his epistle. His fears were probably that they would be indisposed to exercise the discipline on the oftender ; or lest the severity of the discipline required should alienate them from him ; or lest the party under the influence of the false teachers should prevail. All was uncertainty, and his mind was filled with the deepest appre- hension. 6. God that comforteth those that are cast down. Whose characteristic is, that he gives consolation to those who are anxious and depressed. All his consolation was in God ; and by whatever instrumentality comfort was administered, he regarded and acknow ledged God as the author. See Note, ch. i. 4. t By the coming of Titus, To Macedonia. He rejoiced not only in again seeing him, but especially in the intelligence which he brought re- specting the success of his epistle, and the conduct of the church at Corinth. 7. And not by his coming only. Not merely by the fact that he was restored to me, and that my anxieties in regard to him were now dissipated. It is evident that Paul, not having met with Titus as he had expected, at Troas, had felt much anxiety on his account, perhaps apprehending that he was sick, or that he had died, t But by the con- solution ivherewith he was comforted in you. Titus was satisfied and de- lighted with his interview with you. He had been kindly treated, and he had seen all the effect produced by the letter which he had desired. He had, there- fore, been much comforted by his visit II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. GO when he told us your earnest desire, your mourning, your fer- vent mind toward me ; so that I rejoiced the more. to Corinth, and this was a source of adc3itional joy to Paul. He rejoiced at what he had witnessed among you, and he imparted the same joy to me also. The joy of one friend will diffuse it- self through the heart of another. Joy is diffusive, and one Christian cannot well be happy without making others happy also, t When he told us of your earnest desire. Either to rectify what was amiss {Doddridge, Clarke) ; or to see me. — Macknight, Kosenmuller, Bloomjield. It seems to me that the connexion requires us to understand it of their desire, their anxiety to comply with his commands, and to reform the abuses which existed in the church, and which had given him so much pain. t Your mourning. Produced by the epistle. Your deep repentance over the sins which had prevailed in the church. ^ Your fervent mind toward me. Greek, * Your zeal for me.' It denotes that they evinced great ardour of attach- ment to him, and an earnest desire to comply with his wishes. ^ So that I rejoiced the more. I not only rejoiced at his coming, but I rejoiced the more at what he told me of you. Under any circumstances the coming of Titus would have been an occasion of joy ; but it was especially so from the account which he gave me of you. 8. For though I made you sorry, &c. That is, in the first epistle which he had sent to them. In that epistle he had felt it necessary to reprove them for their dissensions and other disorders which had occurred and which were tolerated in the church. That epistle was fitted to produce pain in them — as severe and just reproof always does; and Paul felt very anxious about its effect on them. It was painful to him to write it, and he was well aware that it must cause deep distress among them to be thus reproved. \ Ido not repent. I have seen such happy effects produced 8 For though I made you sorry with a letter, I do not re- pent, though I " did repent : for o c. 2. 4. by it ; it has so completely answered the end which I had in view ; it was so kindly received, that I do not regret now that I wrote it. It gives me no pain in the recollection, but I have occasion to rejoice that it was done. ^ Though I did repent. Doddridge renders this, " however anxious I may have been.''* The word here used does not denote repentance in the sense in which that word is commonly understood, as if any wrong had been done. It is not the language of remorse. It can denote here nothing more than *' that uneasi- ness which a good man feels, not from the consciousness of having done wrong but from a tenderness for others, land a fear lest that which, prompted by duty, he had said, should have too strong an effect upon them." — Campbell, diss. \i. part iii. § 9. See the meaning of the word further illustrated in the same dissertation. The word ( /urrA/ui\o/uAt) denotes properly to change one's pur- pose or mind after having done any thing (Robinson) ; or an uneasy feel- ing of regret for what has been done without regard either to duration or effects. — Campbell. Here it is not to be understood that Paul meant to say he had done any thing wrong. He was an inspired man, and what he had said was proper and right. But he was a man of deep feeling, and of tender affections. He was pained at the ne- cessity of giving reproof. And there is no improbabihty in supposing that af- ter the letter had been sent off, and he reflected on its nature and on the pain which it would cause to those whom he tenderly loved, there might be some misgiving of heart about it, and the deepest anxiety, and regret at the neces- sity of doing it. What parent is there who has not had the same feeling as this 1 He has felt it necessary to cor- rect a beloved child, and has formed the purpose, and has executed it. But is A.. D. 60.] CHAPTER VII. 167 I perceive that the same epistle hath made you sorry, though it were but for a season. 9 Now I rejoice, not that ye were made sorry, but that ye there no misgiving of heart? No question asked whether it might not have been dispensed with 1 No inter- nal struggle; no sorrow; no emotion which may be called regret at the resolution which has been taken 1 Yet there is no repentance as if the parent had done wrong. He feels that he has done what was right and necessary. He approves his own course, and has occasion of rejoicing at the good effects which follow. Such appears to have been the situation of the apostle Paul in this case ; and it shows that he had a tender heart, that he did not delight in giving pain, and that he had no desire to overwhelm them with grief. When the effect was seen, he was not un- willing that they should be apprized of the pain which it had cost him. When a parent has corrected a child, no injury is done if the child becomes acquainted with the strugglings which it has cost him, and the deep pain and anxiety (•aused by the necessity of resorting to chastisement, t For I perceive, &c. I perceive the good effect of the epistle. I perceive that it produced the kind of sorrow in you which I desired. I see that it has produced permanent good results. The sorrow which it caused in you is only for a season ; the good effects will be abiding. I have, there- fore, great occasion to rejoice that I sent the epistle. It produced permanent re- pentance and reformation (ver. 9), and thus accomplished all that I wished or desired. 9. Now Irejoice, not that ye were made sorry, &c. I have no pleasure in giving pain to any one, or in witnessing the distress of any. When men are brought to repentance under the preaching of the gospel, the ministers of the gospel do not find pleasure in their grief as such. They are not desirous of making men unhappy by calling them to re- sorrowed to repentance : for ye were made sorry, ^ after a godly manner, that ye might receive damage by us in nothing. « or, according to Ood. pentance, and they have no pleasure in the deep distress of mind which is often produced by their preaching, in itself considered. It is only because such sorrow is an indication of their return to God, and will be followed by happi- ness and by the fruits of good living, that they find any pleasure in it, or that they seek to produce it. ^ But that ye sorrowed to repentance. It was not mere grief ; it was not sorrow producing melancholy, gloom, or despair ; it was not sorrow which led you to be angry at him who had reproved you for your errors — as is sometimes the case with the sorrow that is produced by reproof; but it was sorrow thai led to a change and re- formation. It was sorrow that was follow- ed by a putting away of the evil for the existence of which there had been oc- casion to reprove you. The word here rendered "repentance" { /uLtravoiAv) is a different word from that which, in ver. 8, is rendered " I did repent," and in- dicates a different state of mind. It properly means a change of mind or purpose. Comp. Heb. xii. 7. It denotes a change for the better ; a change of mind that is durable and productive in its consequences; a change which amounts to a permanent reformation. See Campbell's Diss, ut supra. The sense here is, that it produced a change, a reformation. It was such sorrow for their sm as .to lead them to reform and to put away the evils which had ex- isted among them. It was this fact, and not that they had been made sorry, that led Paul to rejoice. ^ After a godly manner. Marg. " according to God." See Note on the next verse. 1 That ye might receive damage by us in no- thing. The Greek word rendered " re- ceive damage" (^«^/a>3-«iT«) means pro- perly to bring loss upon any one ; to receive loss or detriment. See Note on 1 Cor. iii. 1 5. Comp. Phil. iii. 8. The i Ir^f II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 10 For godly sorrow " work- a Je. 31. 9. Ez. 7. 16. here seems to be, * So that on the whole no real injury was done you in any respect by me. You were indeed put to pain and grief by my reproof. You sorrowed. But it has done you no injury on the whole. It has been a benefit to you. If you had not reformed, if you had been pained without putting away the sins for which the reproof was adminis- tered, if it had been mere grief without any proper fruit, you might have said that you would have suffered a loss of happiness, or you might have given me occasion to inflict severer discipline. But now you are gainers in happiness by all the sorrow which I have caused.' Sinners are gainers in happiness in the end by all the pain of repentance pro- duced by the preaching of the gospel. No man suffers loss by being told of his faults if he repents ; and men are under the highest obligations to those faithful ministers and other friends who tell them of their errors, and who are the means of bringing them to true re- pentance. 10. For godly sorrow. ' Sorrow ac- cording to God' ('H yag^ KXTa Qiiv KiTrn). That is, such sorrow as has respect to God, or is according to his will, or as leads the soul to him. This is a very important expression in regard to true repentance, and shows the exact nature of that sorrow which is connecter} with a return to God. The phrase may be egarded as implying the following ihings. (1.) Such sorrow as God ap- proves, or such as is suitable to, or con- formable to his will and desires. It cannot mean that it is such sorrow or grief as God has, for he has none ; but such as shall be in accordance with what God demands in a return to him. It is a sorrow which his truth is fitted to produce on the heart; such a sorrow as shall appropriately arise from viewing sin as God views it ; such sorrow as exists in the mind when our views ac- cord with his in regard to the existence, the extent, tlie nature, and the ill-desert eth repentance to salvation not to be repented of: but the sor- of sin. Such views will lead to sorrow that it has ever been committed ; and such views will be ' according to God.' (2.) Such sorrow as shall be exercised towards God in view of sin ; which shall arise from a view of the evil of sin as committed against a holy God. It ia not mainly that it will lead to pain ; that it will overwhelm the soul in disgrace ; that it will forfeit the favour or lead to the contempt of man ; or that it will lead to an eternal hell ; but it is such as arises from a view of the evil of sin as committed against a holy and just God, deriving its main evil from the fact that it is an offence against his in- finite Majesty. Such sorrow David had (Ps. li. 4), when he said, " against thee, thee only have I sinned ;" when the offence regarded as committed against man, enormous as it was, was lost and absorbed in its greater evil when re- garded as committed against God. So all true and genuine repentance is that which regards sin as deriving its main evil from the fact that it is committed against God. (3.) That which leads to Gtd. It leads to God to obtain for- giveness; to seek for consolation. A heart truly contrite and penitent seeks God, and implores pardon from him. Other sorrow in view of sin than that which is genuine repentance leads the person away from God. He seeks con- solation in the world ; he endeavours to drive away his serious impressions or to drown them in the pleasures and the cares of life. But genuine sorrow for sin leads the soul to God, and conducts the sinner, through the Redeemer, to him to obtain the pardon and peace which he only can give to a wounded spirit. In God alone can pardon and true peace be found ; and godly sorrow for sin will seek them there. ^ Work- eth repentance. Produces a change that shall be permanent; a reformation. It is not mere regret ; it does not soon pass away in its effects, but it produces permanent and abiding changes. A man \. D. 60.] CHAPTER Vll. 169 row of the world <* worketh death. a Pr. 17. 22. who mourns over sin as committed against God, and who seeks to God for pardon, will reform his life and truly repent He who has grief for sin only because it will lead to disgrace or shame, or because it will lead to poverty or pain, will not necessarily break off from it and reform. It is only when it is seen that sin is committed against God and is evil in his sight, that it leads to a change of life. ^ Not to be repented of {:.fAiTa.fxiK)iT(,]i). See Note on ver. 8. Not to be regretted. It is permanent and abiding. There is no occasion to mourn over such repentance and change of Ufe. It is that which the mind ap- proves, and which it will always approve. There will be no reason for regretting it, and it will never be regretted. And it is so. Who ever yet repented of having truly repented of sin ] Who is there, who has there ever been, who became a true penitent, and a true Christian, who ever regretted it 1 Not an individual has ever been known who regretted his having become a Christian. Not one who regretted that he had be- come one too soon in life, or that he had served the Lord Jesus too faithfully or too long. % But the sorrow of the world. All sorrow which is iiot toward God, and which does not arise from just views of sin as committed against God, or lead to God. Probably Paul refers here to the sorrow which arises from worldly causes, and which does not lead to God for con- solation. Such may be the sorrow which arises from the loss of friends or pro- perty ; from disappointment, or from shame and disgrace. Perhaps it may include the following things. (1.) Sor- row arising from losses of property and friends, and from disappointment. (2.) Sorrow for sin or vice when it over- whelms the mind with the consciousness of guilt, and when it does not lead to God, and when there is no contrition of soul from viewing it as an offence against God. Thus a female who has wandered from the paths of virtue, and involved her family and herself in dis- 15 11 For behold this self-same thing, that ye sorrowed after a grace ; or a man who has been guilty of forgery, or perjury, or any other dis- graceful crime, and who is detected ; a man who has violated the laws of the land, and who has involved himself and family in disgrace, will often feel regret, and sorrow, and remorse, but it arises wholly from worldly considerations, and does not lead to God. (.3.) When the sorrow arises from a view of worldly consequences merely, and when there is no looking to God for pardon and consolation. Thus men, when they lose their property or friends, often pine in grief without looking to God. Thus when they have wandered from the path of virtue and have fallen into sin, they often look merely to the disgrace among men, and see their names blasted, and their comforts gone, and pine away in grief. There is no looking to God for pardon or for consolation. The sorrow arises from this world, and it terminates there. It is the loss of what they va- lued pertaining to this world, and it is all which they had, and it produces death. It is sorrow such as the men of this world have, begins with this world, and terminates with this world. ^ Work- eth death. Tends to death, spiritual, tem- poral, and eternal. It does not tend to life. (1.) It produces distress only. It is attended with no consolation. (2.) It tends to break the spirit, to destroy the peace, and to mar the happiness. (3.) It often leads to death itself. The spirit is broken, and the heart pines away under the influence of the unalleviated sorrow ; or under its influence men often lay violent hands on themselves and take their lives. Life is often closed under the influence of such sor- row. (4.) It tends to eternal death. There is no looking to God ; no look- ing for pardon. It produces murmur- ing, repining, complaining, fretfulness against God, and thus leads to his dis- pleasure and to the condemnation and ruin of the soul. 11. For behold this self-same thing. For see in your own case tlie happy 170 godly " sort, what carefulness ' it wrought in you, yea, what clear- ing *of yourselves, yea, what a Is. 66. 2. 6 Tit. 3. 8. c Ep. 5. 11. II. CORINTHIANS. indignation, effects of godly sorrow. See the effects which it produced ; see an illustration of what it is fitted to produce. The construction is, ' For lo ! this very thing, to wit, your sorrowing after a godly manner, wrought carefulness, clearing of yourselves,' &c. The object of Paul is to illustrate the effects of godly sorrow, to which he had referred in ver. 10. He appeals, therefore, to their own case, and says that it was beautifully illus- trated among themselves, f What care- fulness {(TTTcvfriv). This word properly denotes speed, haste; then diligence, earnest effort, forwardness. Here it is evidently used to denote the diligence and the great anxiety which they mani- fested to remove the evils which existed among them. They went to work to remove them. They did not sit down to mourn over them merely, nor did they wait for God to remove them, nor did they plead that they could do no- thing, but they set about the work as though they believed it might be done. When men are thoroughly convinced of sin, they will set about removing it with the utmost diligence. They will feel that this can be done, and must be done, or that the soul will be lost. 11 What clearing of yourselves {uttcm- yUv). Apology. This word properly means a plea or defence before a tribu- nal or elsewhere. Acts xxii. 1. 2 Tim. iv. 16. Tindal renders it, "Yea, it caused you to clear yourselves." The word here properly means apology for what had been done ; and it probably refers here to the effort which would be made by the sounder part of the church to clear themselves from blame in what had occurred. It does not mean that the guilty, when convicted of sin, will attempt to vindicate themselves and to apologize to God for what they had done ; but it means that the church at Corinth were anxious to state to Titus all the mitigating circumstances of the yea. yea, what vehement desire,-' yea [A. D. 60. what fear, • d Ep. 4. c He. 4.1. /Ps.42. 1. 130.6 case ; they showed great solicitude to free themselves, as far as could be done, from blame ; they were anxious, as far as could be, to show that they had not approved of what had occurred, and perhaps that it had occurred only be- cause it could not have been prevented. We are not to suppose that all the things here referred to occurred in the same individuals, and that the same persons precisely evinced diligence, and made the apology, &c. It was done by the church; all evinced deep feeling; but some manifested it in one way, and some in another. The whole church was roused, and all felt, and all endea- voured in the proper way to free them- selves from the blame, and to remove the evil from among them, t Yea, what indignation. Indignation against the sin, and perhaps against the persons who had drawn down the censure of the apostle. One effect of true repentance is to produce decided hatred of sin. It is not mere regret, or sorrow, it is positive hatred. There is a deep indignation against it as an evil and a bitter thing. ^ Yea, what fear. Fear lest the thing should be repeated. Fear lest it should not be entirely removed. Or it may possibly mean fear of the displeasure of Paul, and of the punishment which would be inflicted if the evil were not removed. But it more probably refers to the anxious state of mind that the whole evil might be corrected, and to the dread of having any vestige of the evil remaining among them, t Yea, what vehement desire. This may either mean their fervent wish to remove the cause of complaint, or their anxious de- sire to see the apostle. It is used in the latter sense in ver. 7, and according to Doddridge and Bloomfield this is the meaning here. Locke renders it, " de- sire of satisfying me." It seems to me more probable that Paul refers to their anxious wish to remove the sin, since A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VII. 171 what zeal, yea, what revenge ! * In all things ye have approved yourselves * to be clear in this matter. 12 Wherefore, though I wrote unto you, / did it not for his cause that had done the wrong, a Re. 3. 19, Mat. 5. 29, 30. 6 Ro. 14. 18. this is the topic under consideration. The point of his remarks in this verse is not so much their affection for him as their indignation against their sin, and their deep grief that sin had existed and had been tolerated among them. t Yea, what zeal. Zeal to remove the sin, and to show your attachment to me. They set about the work of re- formation in great earnest. f Yea, what revenge ! Tindal renders this, " it caused punishment." The idea is, that they immediately set about the work of inflicting punishment on the offender. The word here used (txSiKHo-t;) probably denotes maintenance of right, protection ; then it is used in the sense of avengement, or vengeance ; and then of penal retribution or punishment. See Lukexxi.22. 2Thess. i.8. IPetii. 14. f In all things, &c. The sense of this is, 'You have entirely acquitted your- selves of blame in this business.' The apostle does not mean that none of them had been to blame, or that the church had been free from fault, for a large part of his former epistle is occupied in reproving them for their faults in this business, but he means that by their zeal and their readiness to take away the cause of complaint, they had re- moved all necessity of further blame, and had pursued such a course as entirely to meet his approbation. They had cleared themselves of any further blame in this business, and had become, so far as this was concerned, "clear" (a^vjuf) or pure. 12. Wiierefore, though I ivrote unto you, &c. In this verse Paul states the main reason why he had written to them on the subject. It was not princi- pally on account of the man who had nor for his cause that suffered wrong, but that our care " for youi in the sight of God might appeal unto you. 13 Therefore we were com- forted in your comfort : yea, and exceedingly the more joyed we c c. 2. 4, done the wrong, or of him who had been injured ; but it was from tendei anxiety for the whole church, and in order to show the deep interest which he had in their welfare. 1 Not for his cause that had done the wrong. Not mainly, or principally on account of the incestuous person. 1 Cor. v. 1. It was not primarily with reference to him as an individual that I wrote, but from a regard to the whole church. ^ Nor for his cause that had suffered wrong. Not merely that the wrong which he had suffered might be rectified, and that his rights might be restored, valuable and desirable as was that object. The of- fence was that a man had taken his father's wife as his own (I Cor. v. I), and the person injured, therefore, wa.s his father. It is evident from this passage, I think, that the father was living at the time when Paul wrote this epistle. 1 But that pur care, ^c. I wrote mainly that I might show the deep interest which I had in the church at large, and my anxiety that it might not suffer by the misconduct of any of its members. It is from a regard to the welfare of the whole church that disci- pline should be administered, and not simply with, reference to an individual who has done wrong, or an individual who is injured. In church discipline such private interests are absorbed ia the general interest of the church at large. 1 3. Therefore we were comforted in your comfort. The phrase " your com- fort," here seems to mean the happiness which they had, or might reasonably be expected to have in obeying the direc- tions of Paul, and in the repentance which they had manifested. Paul had IW IT. CORINTHIANS. ^A. D. 60. for the joy of Titus, because his spirit was refreshed '^ by you all. 14 For if I have boasted any thing to him of you, I am not ashamed ; but as we spake all tilings to you in truth, even so our boasting, which / made be- fore Titus, is found a truth. o Ro. 15, 32. spoken of no other consolation or comfort than this ; and the idea seems to be that they were a happy people, and would be happy by obeying the commands of God. This fact gave Paul additional joy, and he could not but rejoice that they had removed the cause of the of- fence, and that they would not thus be exposed to the displeasure of God. Had they not repented and put away the evil, the consequences to them must have been deep distress. As it was, they would be blessed and happy. If And exceedingly the more, &c. Titus had been kindly received, and hospitably entertained, and had become much at- tached to them. This was to Paul an additional occasion of joy. See ver. 7. 14. For if I have boasted any thing to him, &c. This seems to imply that Paul had spoken most favourably to Titus of the Corinthians before he went among them. He had probably ex- pressed his belief that he would be kindly received ; that they would be disposed to listen to him. and to comply with the directions of the apostle ; per- haps he had spoken to him of what he anticipated would be their liberality in regard to the collection which he was about to make for the poor saints at Jerusalem. ^, I am not ashamed. It has all turned out to be true. He has found it as I said it would be. All my expectations are realized ; and you have been as kind, and hospitable, and be- nevolent as I assured him you would be. T As we spake all things to you in truth. Every thing which I said to you was said in truth. All my promises to you, and all my commands, and all 15 And his * inward affection is more abundant toward you whilst he remembereth the obe dience of you all, how with fear* and trembling ye received him. 16 1 rejoice, therefore, that I have confidence " in you in all things. bowels. e 2 Th. 3. 4. b Ph. 2. 12. Phile. 8. 21. my reasonable expectations expressed to you, were sincere. I practised no disguise, and all that I have said thus far turned out to be true. ^ Even so our boasting, &c. My boasting of your character, and of your disposition to do right, which I made before Titus has turned out to be true. It was as I said it would be. I did not commend you too highly to him, as I did not overstate the matter to you in my epistle. 15. And his inward affection, Sac, He has become deeply and tenderly attached to you. His affectionate re- gard for you has been greatly increased by his visit. On the meaning of the word here rendered " inward affection" (a-TTXay^vu., Marg. bowels) see Note on ch. vi. 12. It denotes here deep, tender attachment, or love. ^ How with fear and trembling ye received him. With fear of ofiending, and with deep appre- hension of the consequences of remain- ing in sin. He saw what a fear there was of doing wrong, and what evidence there was, therefore, that you were solicitous to do right. 16. / rejoice, therefore, that I have confidence, &c. I have had the most ample proof that you are disposed to obey God, and to put away every thing that is oflensive to him. The address of this part of the epistle, says Dod- dridge, is wonderful. It is designed, evidently, not merely to commend them for what they ha3 done, and to show them the deep attachment which he had for them, but in a special manner to pre- pare them for what he was about to say in the following chapter respecting the collection which he had so much at A.. D. 60.] CHAPTER VII. 173 heart for the poor saints at Jerusalem. What he here says was admirably adapted to introduce that subject. They had thus far showed the deepest regard for him. They had complied with all his directions. All that he had said of them had proved to be true. And as he had boasted of them to Titus (ver. 14), and expressed his entire confidence that they would comply with his requi- sitions, so he had also boasted of them to the churches of Macedonia, and ex- pressed the utmost confidence that they would be liberal in their benefactions. eh. ix. 2. All that Paul here says in their favour, therefore, was eminently adapted to excite them to liberality, and to prepare them to comply with his wishes in regard to that contribution. 1. Christians are bound by every so- lemn and sacred consideration to endea- vour to purify themselves, ver. 1. They who have the promises of eternal life, and the assurance that God will be to them a father, and evidence that they are his sons and daughters, should not indulge in the filthiness of the flesh and spirit. 2. Every true Christian will aim at perfection, ver. 1. He will desire to be perfect; he will strive for it; he will make it a subject of unceasing and con- stant prayer. No man can be a Chris- tian to whom it would not be a pleasure to be at once as perfect as God. And if any man is conscious that the idea of being made at once perfectly holy would be unpleasant or painful, he may set it down as certain evidence that he is a stranger to religion. 3. No man can be a Christian who voluntarily indulges in sin, or in what he knows to be wrong, ver. 1. A man who does that cannot be aiming at per- fection. A man who does that shows that he has no real desire to be perfect. 4. How blessed will be heaven, ver. 1. There we shall be perfect. And the crowning glory of heaven is not that we shall be happj/, but that we shall be holy. Whatever there is in the heart that is good shall there be perfectly de- 15* veloped ; whatever there is that is evil shall be removed, and the whole soul will be like God. The Christian desires heaven because he will be there perfect. He desires no other heaven. He could be induced to accept no other if it were offered to him. He blesses God day by day that there is such a heaven, and that there is no other ; that there is one world which sin does not enter, and where evil shall be unknown. 5. What a change will take place at death, ver. 1. The Christian will be there made perfect. How this change will be there produced we do not know Whether it will be by some extraordi- nary influence of the Spirit of God on the heart, or by the mere removal from the body, and from a sinful world to a world of glory, we know not. The fact seems to be clear, that at death the Christian will be made at once as holy as God is holy, and that he will ever continue to be in the future world. 6. What a desirable thing it is to die. ver. 1. Here, should we attain to the age of the patriarchs, like them we should continue to be imperfect. Death only will secure our perfection; and death, therefore, is a desirable event. The perfection of our being could not be attained but for death ; and every Christian should rejoice that he is to die. It is better to be in heaven than on earth ; better to be with God than to be away from him ; better to be made perfect than to be contending here with internal corruption, and to struggle with our sins. " I would not live always," was the language of holy Job ; " I de- sire to depart and to be with Christ,'* was the language of holy Paul. 7. It is often painful to be compelled to use the language of reproof, ver. 8. Paul deeply regretted the necessity of doing it in the case of the Corinthians, and expressed the deepest anxiety in regard to it. No man, no minister, parent, or friend can use it but with deep regret that it is necessary. But the painfulness of it should not prevent our doing it. It should be done tenderly but faithfully. If done with the deep feeling, with the tender aflection of Paul, mt II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. it will be done right ; and when so done, it will produce the desired effect, and do good. No man should use the lan- guage of reproof with a hard heart, or with severity of feeling. If he is, like Paul, ready to weep when he does it, it will do good. If he does it because he delights in it, it will do evil. 8. It is a subject of rejoicing where a people exercise repentance, ver. 8. A minister has pleasure not in the pain which his reproofs cause ; not in the deep anxiety and distress of the sinner, and not in the pain which Christians feel under his reproofs, but he has joy in the happy results or the fruits which follow from it. It is only from the be- lief that those tears will produce abun- dant joy that he has pleasure in causing them, or in witnessing them. 9. The way to bring men to repent- ance is to present to them the simple and unvarnished truth, ver. 8, 9. Paul stated simple and plain truths to the Corinthians. He did not abuse them ; he did not censure them in general terms ; he stated things just as they were, and specijied the things on account of which there was occasion for repent- ance. So if ministers wish to excite repentance in others, they must specify the sins over which others should weep ; if we wish, as individuals, to feel regret for our sins, and to have true repentance toward God, we must dwell on those particular sins which we have com- mitted, and should endeavour so to re- flect on them that they may make an appropriate impression on the heart. No man will truly repent by general reflections on his sin ; no one who does not endeavour so to dwell on his sins as that they shall make the proper im- pression which each one is fitted to produce on the soul. Repentance is that state of mind which a view of the truth in regard to our own depravity is fitted to produce. 10. There is a great difference be- tween godly sorrow and the sorrow of the world, ver. 10. All men feel sorrow. All men, at some period of their lives, grieve over their past conduct. Some in their sorrow are pained because they have offended God, and go to God, and find pardon and peace in him. That sorrow is unto salvation. But the mass do not look to God. They turn away from him even in their disappointments, and in their sorrows, and in the bitter consciousness of sin. They seek to alleviate their sorrows in worldly com- pany, in pleasure, in the intoxicating bowl ; and such sorrow works death. It produces additional distress, and deeper gloom here, and eternal wo hereafter. 11. We may learn what constitutes true repentance, ver. 11. There should be, and there will be, deep feeling. There will be " carefulness," deep anxiety to be freed from the sin ; there will be a desire to remove it ; *' indigna- tion" against it; "fear" of offending God ; " earnest desire" that all that has been wrong should be corrected ; " zeal" that the reformation should be entire ; and a wish that the appropriate " re- venge" or expression of displeasure should be excited against it. 'I'he true penitent hates nothing so cordially as he does his sin. He hates nothing but sin. And his warfare with that is de- cided, uncompromising, inexorable, and eternal. 12. It is an evidence of mercy and goodness in God that the sorrow which is felt about sin may be made to termi- nate in our good, and to promote our salvation, ver. 10, 11. If sorrow for sin had been suffered to take its own course, and had proceeded unchecked, it would in all cases have produced death. If it had not been for the merci ful interposition of Christianity, by which even sorrow might be turned to joy, this world would have been every- where a world of sadness and of death. Man would have suffered. Sin always produces, sooner or later, wo. Chris- tianity has done nothing to make men wretched, but it has done every thing to bind up broken hearts. It has re- vealed a way by which sorrow may be turned into joy, and the bitterness of grief may be followed by the sweet calm and sunshine of peace. 13. The great purpose of Christian discipline is to benefit the whole church. A.D.60.J CHAPTER VIII. 175 ver. 12. It is not merely on account of the offender, nor is it merely that the injured may receive a just recompense. It is primarily that the church may be pure, and that the cause of religion may not be dishonoured. When the work of discipline is entered on from any private and personal motives, it is usu- ally attended with bad feeling, and usually results in evil. When it is en- tered on with a desire to honour God, and to promote the purity of the church, when the whole aim is to deliver the church from opprobrium and scandal, and to have just such a church as Jesus Christ desires, then it will be prosecuted with good temper, and with right feel- ing, and then it will lead to happy re- sults. IjCt no man institute a process of discipline on an offending brother from private, personal, and revengeful feel- ings. Let him first examine his own heart, and let him be sure that his aim is solely the glory of Christ, before he attempts to draw down the censure of the church on an offending brother. How many cases of church discipline would be arrested if this simple rule were observed ! And while the case be- fore us shows that it is important in the highest degree that discipline should be exercised on an offending member of the church ; while no consideration should prevent us from exercising that discipline; and while every man should feel desirous that the offending brother should be reproved or punished, yet this case also shows that it should be done with the utmost tenderness, the most strict regard to justice, and the deepest anxiety that the general interests of re- ligion should not suffer by the manifesta- tion of an improper spirit, or by im- proper motives in inflicting punishment on an offending brother. CHAPTER Vra. ly the previous chapter the apostle had expressed his entire confidence in the ready obedience of the Corinthians in all things. To this confidence he had been led by the promptitude with which they had complied with his com- mands in regard to the case of discipline there, and by the respect which they had shown to Titus, whom he had sent to them. All that he had ever said in their favour had been realized ; all that had ever been asked of them had been ac- complished. The object of his state- ment in the close of ch. vii, seems to have been to excite them to diligence in completing the collection which they had begun for the poor and aflSicted saints of J u (lea. On t'tie consideration of that subject, which lay so near his heart, he now enters ; and this chapter and the following are occupied with suggesting arguments, and giving di- rections for a liberal contribution. Paul had given directions for taking up this collection in the first epistle. Seech, xvi. l.seq. Comp. Rom. xv. 26. This collection he had given Titus di- rection to take up when he went to Corinth. See ver. 6 — 17 of this chap- ter. But from some cause it had not been completed, ver. 10, 11. What that cause was, is not stated, but it may have been possibly the disturbances which had existed there, or the opposi- tion of the enemies of Paul, or the attention which was necessarily bestow- ed in regulating the affairs of the church. But in order that the contribution might be made, and might be a liberal one, Paul presses on their attention several considerations designed to excite them to give freely. The chapter is, there- fore, of importance to us, as it is a state- ment of the duty of giving Uberalfy to the cause of benevolence, and of the motives by which it should be done, lu the presentation of this subject, Paul urges upon them the following con- siderations. He appeals to the very liberal exam- ple of the churches of Macedonia, where, though they were exceedingly poor, they had contributed with great cheerfulness and liberality to the object, ver. 1 — 5. From their example he had been in- duced to desire Titus to lay the subject before the church at Corinth, and to finish the collection which he had be- gun, ver. 6. He directs them to abound in this, not as a matter of commandment, but 17« If. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 CHAPTER VIII. lyrOREOVER, brethren, we ^'^-'- do you to wit of the grace excited by the example of others, ver. 7,8. He appeals to them by the love of the Saviour ; reminds them that though he was rich yet he became poor, and that they were bound to imitate his example, ver. 9. He reminds them of their intention to make such a contribution, and of the effort which they had made a year be- fore ; and though they had been em- barrassed in it, and might find it diffi- cult still to give as much as they had intended, or as much as they would wish, still it would be acceptable to God. For if there was a willing mind, God accepted the offering, ver. 10 — 12. He assures them that it was not his wish to burden or oppress them. All that he desired was that there should be an equality in all the churches, ver. 13—15. To show them how much he was in- terested in this, he thanks God that he had put it into the heart of Titus to en- gage in it. And in order more effectually to secure it, he says that he had sent with Titus a brother who was well known, and whose praise was in all the churches. He had done this in order that the churches might have en- tire confidence that the contribution would be properly distributed. Paul did not wish it to be intrusted to himself. He would leave no room for suspicion .n regard to his own character ; he would furnish the utmost security to the churches that their wishes were com- pUed with. He desired to act honestly not only in the sight of the Lord, but to furnish evidence of his entire honesty to men. ver, 16 — 21. To secure the same object he had also sent another brother, and these three brethren he felt willing to recommend as faithful and tried ; as men in whom the church at Corinth might repose the utmost confidence, ver. 22 — 24. 1. Moreover, brethren, we do you to of God bestowed on the churches of Macedonia ; " a c. 9. 2, 4. unf. We make known to you ; we inform you. The phrase * we do you to wit,' is used in Tindal's translation, and means 'we cause you to know.' The purpose for which Paul informed them of the liberality of the churches of Macedonia was to excite them to similar liberality, f Of the grace of God, &c. The favour which God had shown them in exciting a spirit of liberality, and in enabling them to contribute to the fund for supplying the wants of the poor saints at Jerusalem. The word 'grace' (;^a§/f) is sometimes used in the sense of gift, and the phrase " gift of God" some have supposed may mean very great gift, where the words " of God" may be designed to mark any thing very eminent or excellent, as in the phrase 'cedars of God,' 'mountains of God,' denoting very great cedars, very great mountains. Some critics (as Macknight, Bloomfield, Locke, and others) have supposed that this means that the churches of Macedonia had been able to contribute largely to the aid of the saints of Judea. But the more obvious and correct interpretation, as I appre- hend, is that which is implied in the common version, that the phrase 'grace of God,' means that God had bestowed on them grace to give according to their ability in this cause. According to this it is implied, (1.) That a disposition to contribute to the cause of benevolence is to be traced to God. He is its author. He excites it. It is not a plant of native growth in the human heart, but a large and liberal spirit of benevolence is one of the effects of his grace, and is to be traced to him. (2.) It is a favour be- stowed on a church when God excites in it a spirit of benevolence. It is one of the evidences of his love. And indeed there cannot be a higher proof of the favour of God than when by his grace he inclines and enables us to contribute largely to meliorate the con- dition, and to alleviate the wants of our A.. D. 60.] CHAPTER VIII. 17^ 2 How that, in a great trial of affliction, the abundance of their joy and their deep " poverty a Mar. 12. 44. fellow-men. Perhaps the apostle here meant delicately to hint this. He did not therefore say coldly that the churches of Macedonia had contributed to this olject, but he speedcs of it as a favour shown to them by God that they were able to do it. And he meant, probably, gently to intimate to the Corinthians that it would be an evidence that they were enjoying the favour of God if they should contribute in like manner, ^ The churches of Macedonia. Philippi, Thessalonica, Berea. For an account of Macedonia, see Notes, Acts xvi. 9. Rom. XV. 26. Of these churches, that at Philippi seems to have been most distinguished for liberality (Phil. iv. 10. 15, 16. 18), though it is probable that other churches contributed according to their ability as they are commended (comp. ch. ix. 2) without distinction. 2. How that, in a great trial of affliction. When it might be supposed they were unable to give ; when many would suppose they needed the aid of others ; or when it might be supposed their minds would be wholly engrossed with their own concerns. The trial to which the apostle here refers was doubt- less some persecution which was excited against them, probably by the Jews. See Acts xvi. 20; xvii. 5. ^f The abundance of their joy. Their joy arising from the hopes and promises of the gospel. Not- withstanding their persecutions, their joy has abounded, and the effect of their joy has been seen in the liberal contribu- tion which they have made. Their joy could not be repressed by their persecu- tion, and they cheerfully contributed largely to the aid of others. f And their deep poverty. Their very low estate of poverty was made to contribute liberally to the wants of others. It is implied here, (1.) That they were very poor — a fact arising probably from the consideration that the poor generally abounded unto the riches of their * liberality. 3 For to their power (I bear » simplicity . embraced the gospel first, and also be- cause it is probable that they were mo- lested and stripped of their property in persecutions (comp. Heb. x. 34) ; (2.) That notwithstanding this they were enabled to make a liberal contribution — a fact demonstrating that a people can do much even when poor if all feel dis- posed to do it, and that afflictions are favourable to the effort; and, (3.) That one cause of this was the joy which they had even in their trials. If a peo- ple have the joys of the gospel ; if they have the consolations of religion them- selves, they will somehow or other find means to contribute to the welfare of others. They will be willing to labour with reference to it, or they will find something which they can sacrifice or spare. Even their deep poverty will abound in the fruits of benevolence. t Abounded. They contributed libe- rally. Their joy was manifested in a large donation, notwithstanding their poverty. T[ Unto the riches of their liberality. Marg. " Simplicity." The word (aTTAOTMf) here used means pro- perly sincerity, candour, probity ; then Christian simplicity, integrity ; then liberality. See Rom. xii. 8 (Marg.). 2Cor. ix. 11. 13. The phrase "riches of liberality," is a Hebraism, meaning rich, or abundant liberality. The sense is, their liberality was much greater than could be expected from persons so poor ; and the object of the apostle is, to excite the Corinthians to give liberally by tlieir example. 3. For to their power. To the ut- most of their ability, t I bear record Paul had founded those churches and had spent much time with them. He was therefore well qualified to bear testimony in regard to their condition. 1 Yea, and beyond their power. Be- yond what could have been expected ; or beyond what it would have been 178 II. CORINTHIANS. [A.D.60. record) yea, and beyond their power, they were willing of themselves : 4 Praying us with much in- treaty that we would receive the gift, and take upon us the fellow- ship * of the ministering to the saints. oAc. 11. 29. Ro. 15. 25, 26. thought possible in their condition. Doddridge remarks that this is a noble hyperbole similar to that used by De- mosthenes when he says, " I have per- formed all, even with an industry be- yond my power." The sense is, they were willing to give more than they were well able. It shows the strong interest which they had in the subject, and the anxious desire which they had to relieve the wants of others. TI Of themselves (etl/^-cti^irci). Acting from choice, self-moved, voluntarily, of their own accord. They did not wait to be urged and pressed to do it. They re- joiced in the opportunity of doing it. They came forward of their own accord and made the contribution. " God loveth a cheerful giver" (ch. ix. 7) ; and from all the accounts which we have of these churches in Macedonia it is evident that they were greatly distin- guished for their cheerful liberality. 4. Praying us with much entreaty. Earnestly entreating me to receive the contribution and convey it to the poor and afflicted saints in Judea. % And take upon us the fellowship of the mi- nistering to the saints. Greek, ' that we would take the gift and the fellowship of the ministering to the saints.' They asked of us to take part in the labour of conveying it to Jerusalem. The occasion of this distress which made the collection for the saints of Judea necessary, was probably the famine which was predicted by Agabus, and which occurred in the time of Claudius Cffisar. See Note on Acts xi. 28. Bar- nabas was associated with Paul in con- veying the contribution to Jerusalem. Acts vi. 30. Paul was unwilling to do 5 And this they did, not as we hoped, but first gave their ownselves to the Lord, and unto us by the will of God. 6 Insomuch that we desired Titus, that as he had begun, so he would also finish in you the same * grace also. * or gift. it unless they particularly desired it, and he seems to have insisted that some person should be associated with him. ver. 20. 1 Cor. xvi. 3, 4. 5. And this they did, &c. They did not give what we expected only. We knew their poverty, and we exjjected only a small sum from them. ^ Not as toe hoped. Not according to the utmost of our hopes. We were greatly disappointed in the amount which they gave, and in the manner in which it was done. *| But first gave their own- selves to the Lord. They first made an entire consecration of themselves and all that they had to the Lord. They kept nothing back. They felt that all they had was his. And where a peo- ple honestly and truly devote themselves to God, they will find no difficulty in having the means to contribute to the cause of charity, t And unto us by the will of God. That is, they gave themselves to us to be directed in regard to the contribution to be made. They complied with our wishes and followed our directions. The phrase "by the will of God," means evidently that God moved them to this, or that it was to be traced to his direction and provi- dence. It is one of the instances in which Paul traces every thing that is right and good to the agency and di- rection of God. 6. Insamuch. The sense of tliis passage seems to be this. ' We were encouraged by this unexpected success among the Macedonians. "V^'e were surprised at the extent of their liberality. And encouraged by this, we requested 'i'itus to go among you and finish the collection which you had proposed and A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VIII. 179 7 Therefore, as ye abound " in every things in faith, and utter- ance, and knowledge, and in all diligence, and in your love to us, see that ye abound in this grace also. a 1 Co. 1. 5. which you had begun. Lest you should be outstripped in liberality by the com- paratively poor Macedonian Christians, we were anxious that you should per- form what you had promised and con- templated, and we employed Titus, there- fore, that he might go at once and finish the collection among you.' | The same grace also. Marg. ^^Gift" See Note on ver. 1 . The word refers to the contri- bution which he wished to be made. 7. Therefore as ye abound in every thing. See Note, 1 Cor. i. 5. Paul never hesitated to commend Christians where it could be done with truth ; and the fact that they were eminent in some of the Christian duties and graces, he makes the ground of the exhortation that they would abound in all. From those who had so many eminent cha- racteristics of true religion he had a right to expect much ; and he therefore exhorts them to manifest a symmetry of Christian character, t In faiih. In the full belief of the truth and obliga- tion of the gospel, t And utterance. In the ability to instruct others ; perhaps referring to their power of speaking foreign languages. 1 Cor. xiv. '^ And knowledge. The knowledge of God, and of his truth, f And in all dili- gence. Diligence or readiness in the discharge of every duty. Of this, Paul had full evidence in their readiness to comply with his commands in the case of discipline to which so frequent refer- ence is made in this epistle, t And in your love to us. Manifested by the readiness with which you received our commands. See ch. vii. 4. 6, 7. 11. 16. t See that ye abound in this grace also. The idea here is, that eminence in spiritual endowments of any kind, or in any of the traits of the Christian <*.haracter should lead to great berievo- 8 I speak not * by command- ment, but by occasion of the forwardness of others, and to prove the sincerity of your love. 6 1 Co. 7. 6. lence, and that the character is not com- plete unless benevolence be manifested toward every good object that may be presented. 8. I speak not by commandment. This does not mean that he had no express command of God in the case, but that he did not mean to command them ; he did not speak authoritatively ; he did not intend to prescribe what they should give. He used only moral motives, and urged the considerations which he had done to persuade rather than to command them to give. See ver. 10. He was endeavouring to in- duce them to give liberally not by ab- stract command and law, but by show- ing them what others had given who had much less ability and much fewer advantages than they had. Men cannot be induced to give to objects of charity by command, or by a spirit of dictation and authority. The only successful, as well as the only lawful appeal, is to their hearts, and consciences, and sober judgments. And if an apostle did not take upon himself the language of authority and command in matters of Christian benevolence, assuredly minis- ters and ecclesiastical bodies now have no right to use any such language. t But by occasion of the forwardness of others. I m^ke use of the example of the churches of Maccvlonia as an argument to induce you to give libe- rally to the cause, t And to prove the sincerity of your love. The apostle does not specify here what " love" he refers to, whether love to God, to Christ, to himself, or to the church at large. It may be that he designedly used the word in a general sense to denote love to any good object ; and that he meant to say that liberality in assisting the poor and afflicted people of God would i80 II. CORINTHIANS. £A. D. 60. 9 For ye know the grace of our Lord Jesus Christ, that, though he was " rich, yet for your a Jno. 1. 1. be the best evidence of the sincerity of their love to God, to the Redeemer, to him, and to the church. Religion is love ; and that love is to be manifested by doing good to all men as we have opportunity. The most substantial evi- dence of that love is when we are will- ing to part with our property, or with whatever is valuable to us, to confer happiness and salvation on others. 9. For ye know. Sec. The apostle Paul was accustomed to illustrate every subject, and to enforce every duty where it could be done, by a reference to the life and sufferings of the Lord Jesus Christ. The design of this verse is apparent. It is, to show the duty of giving liberally to the objects of be- nevolence, from the fact that the Lord Jesus was willing to become poor in order that he might benefit others. The idea is, that he who was Lord and pro- prietor of the universe, and who possessed all things, was willing to leave his ex- alted station in the bosom of the Father and to become poor, in order that we might become rich in the blessings of the gospel, in the means of grace, and as heirs of all things ; and that we who are thus benefited, and who have such an example, should be willing to part with our earthly possessions in order that we may benefit others, t TA*^ grace. The benignity, kindness, mercy, goodness. His coming in this manner was a proof of the highest benevolence. Tf Though he was rich. The riches of the Redeemer here referred to, stand opposed to that poverty which he as- sumed and manifested when he dwelt among men. It implies, (1.) His pre- existence, for he became poor. He had been rich. Yet not in this world. He did not lay aside wealth here on earth after he had possessed it, for he had none. He was not fipst rich and then pooc on earth, for he had no earthly wealth. The Socinian interpretation sakes he became poor, * that ye through his poverty might be rich. *= tLu. 9. 58. Ph. 2. 6,7. c Re. 3. 18 is, that he was "rich in power and in the Holy Ghost;" but it was not true that he laid these aside, and that he became poor in either of them. He had power, even in his poverty, to still the waves, and to raise the dead, and he was always full of the Holy Ghost. His family was poor ; and his parents were poor ; and he was himself poor all his life. This then must refer to a state of antecedent riches before his assumption of human nature ; and the expression is strikingly parallel to that in Phil. ii. 6, seq. " Who being in the form of God, thought it not robbery to be equal with God, but made himself of no reputation," &c. (2.) He was rich as the Lord and proprietor of all things. He was the Creator of all (John i. 3. Col. i. 16), and as Creator he had a right to all things, and the disposal of all things. The most abso- lute right which can exist is that acquired by the act of creation ; and this right the Son of God possessed over all gold, and silver, and diamonds, and pearls ; over all eartli and lands ; over all the treasures of the ocean, and over all worlds. The extent and amount of his riches, therefore, is to be meeisured by the extent of his dominion over the universe ; and to estimate his riches, therefore, we are to conceive of the sceptre which he sways over the distant worlds. What wealth has man that can compare with the riches of the Creator and proprietor of all 1 How poor and worthless appears all the gold that man can accumulate compared with the wealth of him whose are the silver, and the gold, and the cattle upon a thousand hills 1 T[ Yet for your sakes. That is, for your sakes as a part of the great family that was to be redeemed. In what respect it was for their sake, the apostle immediately adds when he says, it was that they might be made rich. It was not for his jwji isaie, but A. D. 60.J CHAPTER VIII. 181 it was for ours. ^ He became poor. In the following respects. (1.) He chose a condition of poverty, a rank of life that was usually that of poverty. He " took upon himself the form of a servant." Phil. ii. 7. (2.) He was con- nected with a poor family. Though of the family and lineage of David (Luke ii. 4), yet the family had fallen into decay, and was poor. In the Old Testament he is beautifully represented as a shoot or sucker that starts up from the root of a decayed tree. See my Note on Isa. xi. 1. (3.) His whole life was a life of poverty. He had no home. Luke ix. 58. He chose to be depend- ent on the charity of the few friends that he drew around him, rather than to create food for the abundant supply of his own wants. He had no farms or plantations ; he had no splendid palaces ; he had no money hoarded in useless coffers or in banks; he had no property to distribute to his friends. His mother he commended when he died to the charitable attention of one of his dis- ciples (John xix. 27), and all his per- sonal property seems to have been the raiment which he wore, and which was divided among the soldiers that crucified him. Nothing is more remarkable than the difference between the plans of the Lord Jesus and those of many of his followers and professed friends. He formed no plan for becoming rich, and he always spoke with the deepest earnest- ness of the dangers which attend an effort to accumulate property. He was among the most poor of the sons of men in his life ; and few have been the men on earth who have not had as much as he had to leave to surviving friends, or to excite the cupidity of those who should fall heirs to their property when dead. (4.) He died poor. He made no will in regard to his property, for he had none to dispose of. He knew well enough the eflfect which would follow if he had amassed wealth, and had left it to be divided among his followers. They were very imperfect ; and even around the cross there might have been anxious discussion, and perhaps strife about it, as there is often now over the coffin 16 and the unclosed grave of a rich and foolish father who has died. Jesus in- tended that his disciples should never be turned away from the great work to which he called them by any wealth which he would leave them ; and he left them not even a keepsake as 9 memorial of his name. All this is the more remarkable from two considera- tions, (a) That he had it in his power to choose the manner in which he would come. He might have come in the condition of a splendid prince. He might have rode in a chariot of ease, or have dwelt in a magnificent palace. He might have lived with more than the magnificence of an oriental prince, and might have bequeathed treasures greater than those of Croesus or Solo- mon to his followers. But he chose not to do it. (6) It would have been as right and proper for him to have amassed wealth, and to have sought princely possessions, as for any of his followers. What is right for them would have been right for him. Men often mistake on this subject ; and though it cannot be demonstrated that all his followers should aim to be as poor as he was, yet it is undoubtedly true that he meant that his example should operate con- stantly to check their desire of amassing wealth. In him it was voluntary ,- in us there should be always a readiness to he poor if such be the will of God ; nay, there should be rather a preference to be in moderate circumstances that we may thus be like the Redeemer. 1 That ye through his poverty might be rich. That is, might have durable and eternal riches, the riches of God's everlasting favour. This includes, (1.) The present possession of an in- terest in the Redeemer himself. ' Do you see these extended fields 1' said the owner of a vast plantation to a friend. * They are mine. All this is mine.' ' Do you see yonder poor cottage V was the reply of the friend as he directed his attention to the abode of a poor widow. ' She has more than all this. She has Christ as her portion ; and that is more than all.' He who has an interest in the Redeemer has a possession that 192 II. COmM'HIANS. [A. D. 60 10 Ana iWe.in I give my advice : for laid is expedient for you, who have oeguii before, not is of more value than ail that princes can bestow. (2.) The heirship of an eternal inheritance, the prospect of im- mortal glory. Rom.viii. 17. (3.) Ever- lasting treasures in heaven. Thus the Saviour compares the heavenly blessings to treasures. Matt. vi. 20. Eternal and inimitable wealth is theirs in heaven ; and to raise us to that blessed inherit- ance was the design of the Redeemer in consenting to become poor. This, the apostle says, was to be secured by his poverty. This includes probably the two following things, viz. (I.) That it was to be by the moral injluence of the fact that he was poor that men were to be blessed. He designed by his example to counteract the effect of wealth ; to teach men that this was not the thing to be aimed at ; that there were more important purposes of life than to obtain money ; and to furnish a perpetual reproof of those who are aiming to amass riches. The example of the Redeemer thus stands before the whole church and the world as a living and constant memorial of the truth that men need other things than wealth ; and that there are objects that demand their time and influence other than the accumulation of property. It is well to have such an example ; well to have before us the example of one who never formed any plan for gain, and who constantly lived above the world. In a world where gain is the great object, where all men are fortung plans for it, it is well to have one great model that shall continually demonstrate the folly of it, and that shall point to better things. (2.) The word " poverty" here may include more than a mere want of property. It may mean all the cir- cumstances of his low estate and humble condition ; his sufferings and his woes. The whole train of his privations was included in this ; and the idea is, that he gave himself to this lowly condition in order that by his sufferings he might only to do, but also to be * for ward a year ago. 1 willing. procure for us a part in the kingdom of heaven. His poverty was a part of the sufferings included in the work of the atonement. For it was not the sufferings of the garden merely, or the pangs of the cross, that constituted the atonement ; it was the series of sorrows and painful acts of humiliation which so thickly crowded his life. By all these he designed that we should be made rich ; and in view of all these the argument of the apostle is, we should be willing to deny ourselves to do good to others. 10. And herein I give my advice. Not undertaking to command them, or to prescribe how much they should give. Advice will go much farther than com- mands on the subject of charities. Tf For this is expedient for you (a-u/ut^i^a). That is, this will be of advantage to you ; it will be profitable ; it will be becoming. The idea is, that they were bound by a regard to consistency and to their own welfare, to perform what they had purpv^sed. It became them? it was proper, and was demanded ; and there would have been manifest dis- advantages if it had not been done. ^ Who have begun before. Who com- menced the collection a year before. See ver. 6. It had been commenced with fair prospects of success, but had been interrupted probably by the dis- sensions which arose in the church there. ^ Not only to do. Not merely to accomplish it as if by constraint, or as a matter of compulsion and drudgery. Tl But also to be forward. Marg. " Will- ing." So the Greek (to 3-jxs/v). They were voluntary in this, and they set about it with vigorous and determined zeal and courage. There was a resolute determination in the thing, and a will- ingness and heartiness in it which showed that they were actuated by Christian principle. Consistency, and their own reputation and advantage, now demanded that they should com plete what they had begun. A. D. 60.1 CHAPTER VIII. 183 11 Now therefore perform ° the doing of it ; that as there was a readiness to will, so there may be a performance also out of that which ye have. a 1 Ti. 6. 19. He. 13. 16. Ja. 2. 15, 16. 11. .4s there was a readiness to loill. Now accomplish the thing, and be not satisfied with having begun it. Do not suppose that the intention was sufficient, or that you are now released from the obligation. A year indeed has elapsed ; but the necessity of the aid for the poor has not ceased. The sentiment here is, that if we have felt it our duty to aid in a cause of benevolence, and have commenced it, and have then been in- terrupted in executing our purpose, we should seize the first favourable oppor- tunity to accomplish what we had de- signed. We should not regard our- selves as released from our obligation, but should, from a regard to consistency and our obligation to God, accomplish what we had intended. ^ Oat of that which ye have. According to your ability. See ver. 12. It should be in proportion to your means. 1 2. For if there he first a willing mind. If there is ^readiness (Tr^odv/uia.), a disposition to give ; if the heart is in it, then the offering will be acceptable to God, whether you be able to give much or little. A willing mind is the first consideration. No donation however large can be acceptable where that does not exist ; none however small can be otherwise than acceptable where that is found. This had relation as used by Paul to the duty of almsgiving ; but the principle is as applicable to every thing in the way of duty. A willing mind is the first and main thing. It is that which God chiefly desires, and that without which every thing else will be offensive, hypocritical, and vain. See Note, ch. ix. 7. ^ It is accepted. Dod- dridge, RosenmCiller, Macknight, and some others apply this to the person, and render it, " Ae is accepted ;" but the more usual, and the more natural in- terpretation is to apply it to the gift — it 12 For if ' there be first a willing mind, it is accepted ac- cording to that a man hath, and not according to that he hath not. 6Lu. 21. 3. is accepted. God will approve of it, and will receive it favourably. ^ Ac- cording to that a man hath, &c. He is not required to give what he has not. His obligation is proportioned to his ability. His offering is acceptable to God according to the largeness and willingness of his heart, and not accord- ing to the narrowness of his fortune. — Locke. If the means are small, if the individual is poor, and if the gift shall be, therefore, small in amount, yet it may be proof of a larger heart and of more true love to God and his cause than when a much more ample benefaction is made by one in better circumstances. This sentiment the Saviour expressly stated and defended in the case of the poor widow. Mark xii. 42 — 44. Luke xxi. 1 — 4. She who had cast in her two mites into the treasury had put in more than all which the rich men had contributed, for they had given of their abundance, but she had cast in all that she had, even all her living. The great and obviously just and equal principle here stated, was originally applied by Paul to the duty of giving alms. But it is equally true and just as applied to all the duties which we owe to God. He demands, (1.) A willing mind, a heart disposed to yield obedience. He claims that our service should be volun- tary and sincere, and that we should make an unreserved consecration of what we have. Secondly, he demands only what we have power to render. He re- quires a service strictly according to our ability, and to be measured by that. He demands no more than our powers are fitted to produce ; no more than we are able to render. Our obligations in all cases are limited by our ability. This is obviously the rule of equity, and this is all that is anywhere de- manded in the Bible, and this is everv- lU II. CORINTHIANS. 13 For I mean not that other men be eased, and ye burdened : where demanded. Thus our love to him is to be in proportion to our ability, and not to be graduated by the ability of angels or other beings. " And thou shalt love the Lord thy God with all THY heart, and with all tht soul, and with all thy mind, and with all THT strength." Mark xii. 30. Here the obligation is limited by the ability, and the love is to be commensurate with the ability. So of repentance, faith, and of obedience in any form. None but a tyrant ever demands more than can be rendered ; and to demand more is the appropriate description of a tyrant, and cannot appertain to the ever blessed God. Thirdly, if there is any service rendered to God, according to the ability, it is accepted of him. It may not be as much or as valuable as may be rendered by beings of higher powers ; it may not be as much as we would desire to ren- der, but it is all that God demands, "and is acceptable to him. The poor widow was not able to give as much as the rich man ; but her offering was equally acceptable, and jnight be more valuable, for it would be accompanied with her prayers. The service which we can render to God may not be equal to that which the angels render ; but it may be equally appropriate to our condition and our powers, and may be equally acceptable to God. God may be as well pleased with the sighings of peni- tence as the praises of angels ; with the offerings of a broken and a contrite heart as with the loud hallelujahs of un- fallen beings in heaven. 13. For I mean not that other men he eased, &c. I do not intend that others should be eased in order to reUeve you. Literally, 'Not that there should be rest (avio-t?, a letting loose, remission, relaxation) to others, but affiiction {^Ki-^i^) to you.' Probably the Corinth- ians were able to contribute more than many other churches, certainly more than the churches of Macedonia (ver. ^), and Paul therefore presses^ upon [A. D. 60. 14 But by an equality, that now at this time your abundance them the duty of giving according to their means, yet he by no means in- tended that the entire burden should come on them. 14. But by an equality. On just and equal principles, f That now at this time, &c. That at the present time your abundance may be a supply for their wants, so that at some future time, if there should be occasion for it, their abundance may be a supply for your wants. The idea is this. Corinth was then able to give liberally, but many of the other churches were not. 'I'hey were poor, and perhaps persecuted and in affliction. But there might be great reverses in their condition. Corinth might be reduced from its affluence, and might itself become dependent on the aid of others, or might be unable to contribute any considerable amount for the purposes of charity. The members of the church in Corinth, therefore, should so act in their circumstances of prosperity, that others would be disposed to aid them should their condition ever be such as to demand it. And the doctrine here taught is, (1.) That the support of the objects of benevolence should be on equal principles. The rich should bear an equal and fair propor- tion, and if more frequent demands are made on their benefaction than on others they should not complain. (2.) Chris- tians should contribute liberally while they have the means. In the vicissitudes of life no one can tell how soon he may be unable to contribute, or may even be dependent on the charity of others himself. A change in the commercial world ; losses by fire or at sea ; want of success in business ; loss of health, and the failure of his plans, may soon render him unable to aid the cause of benevolence. While he is prospered he should embrace every opportunity to do good to all. Some of the most painful regrets which men ever have, arise from the reflection that when prospered they were indisposed to give A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VIII. 18d may be a supply for their want, that their abundance also may be a supply for your want, that there may be equality : to benefit others, and when their proper- ty is swept away they become unable. God often sweeps away the property which they were indisposed to contribute to aid others, and leaves them to penury and want. Too late they regret that they were not the liberal patrons of the objects of benevolence when they were able to be. ^ That there may be equali- ty. That all may be just and equal. That no unjust burden should be borne by any one portion of the great family of the redeemed. Every Christian brother should bear his due proportion. 15. As it is loritten. See Ex. xvi. 18. 1 He that had gathered much, Sec. This passage was originally ap- plied to the gathering of manna by the children of Israel. The manna which fell around the camp of Israel was ga- thered every morning. All that were able were employed in gathering it ; and when it was collected it was dis- tributed in the proportion of an omer, or about five pints to each man. Some would be more active and more success- ful than others. Some by age or in- firmity would collect little; probably many by being confined to the camp would collect none. They who had gathered more than an omer, therefore, v/ould in this way contribute to the wants of otliers, and would be constantly manifesting a spirit of benevolence. And such was their willingness to do good in this way, such their readiness to collect more than they knew would be demanded for their own use, and such the arrangement of Providence in furnishing it, that there was no want ; and there was no more gathered than was needfulto supply the demands of the whole. Paul applies this passage, therefore, in the very spirit in which it was originally penned. He means to say that the rich Christians at Corinth should impart freely to their poorer 16* 15 As it is written, " He that had gathered much had nothing over ; and he that had gathered little had no lack. a Ex. 16. 18. brethren. They had gathered more wealth than was immediately necessary for their families or themselves. They should, therefore, impart freely to those who had been less successful. Wealth, like manna, is the gift of God. It is like that spread by his hand around us every day. Some are able to gather much more than others. By their skill, their health, their diligence, or by provi- dential arrangements, they are eminently successful. Others are feeble, or sick, or aged, or destitute of skill, and are less successful. All that is obtained is by the arrangement of God. The health, the strength, the skill, the wisdom by which we are enabled to obtain it, are all his gift. That which is thus ho estly obtained, therefore, should be re- garded as his bounty, and we should esteem it a privilege daily to impart to others less favoured and less successful. Thus society will be bound more close- ly together. There will be, as there was among the Israelites, the feelings of universal brotherhood. There will be on the one hand the happiness flow- ing from the constant exercise of the benevolent feelings ; on the other the strong ties of gratitude. On the one hand the evils of poverty will be prevented, and on the other the not less, though dif- ferent evils resulting from superabundant wealth. Is it a forced and unnatural analogy also to observe, that wealth, like manna, corrupts by being kept in store? Manna if kept more than a single day became foul and loathsome Does not wealth hoarded up when » might be properly employed ; wealth that should have been distributed to relieve the wants of otljers, become corrupting in its nature, and offensive in the sight of holy and benevolent minds 1 Comp. James v. 2 — 4. Wealth, like manna, should be employed in the service which God deijigns — employed to diffuse every- 186 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 16 But thanks he to God, which put the same earnest care into the heart of Titus for you. 17 For indeed he accepted the exhortation ; * but bein^ more where the blessings of religion, comfort, and peace. 16. But thanks he to God. Paul re- garded every right feeling, and every pure desire; every inclination to serve God or to benefit a fellow mortal, as the gift of God. He, therefore, ascribes the praise to him that Titus was disposed to show an interest in the welfare of the Corinthians. 1 The same earnest care. The earnest care here referred to was \hat the Corinthians might complete the collection, and finish what they had proposed. Titus was willing to under- take this, and see that it was done. Tf For you. For your completing the collection. Paul represents it as being done /or them, or for their welfare. The poor saints in Judea indeed were to have the immediate benefit of the contribu- tion, but it was a privilege for them to give, and Paul rejoiced that they had that privilege. A man who presents to Christians a feasible object of benevo- lence, and who furnishes them an op- portunity of doing good to others, is doing good to them, and tliey should esteem it an act of kindness done to them. 17. For indeed he accepted the ex- hortation. He cheerfully complied with the exhortation which I gave him, to wit, to visit you, and excite you to this good work. \ But being more forward. More disposed to do this than I had lupposed. The idea here is, that he ^as very ready to engage in this ; he vas more ready to engage in it than t*aul was to exhort him to it ; he an- ic:pated his request; he had already .^esoived to engage in it. t Of his own ^cmd he went, &c. He went volunta- rily, and without urging. The ground of Paul's thankfulness here seems to have been this, lie apprehended pro- bably some difhoUiiy in obtaining the forward, of his own accord he went unto you. 18 And we have sent with him the brother, * whose praise b c. 12, 18. collection there. He was acquainted with the distracted state of the church, and feared that Titus might have some reluctance to engage in the service. He was therefore very agreeably surprised when he learned that Titus was willing to make another journey to Corinth and to endeavour to complete the collection. 18. And we have sent with him the brother. It has been generally supposed that this anonymous brother was Luke. Some have supposed however that it was Mark, others that it was Silas or Barnabas. It is impossible to determine with certainty who it was; nor is it material to know. Whoever it was, it was some one well known, in whom the church at Corinth could have entire confidence. It is remarkable that though Paul mentions him again (ch. xii. 18), he does it also in the same manner, without specifying his name. The only circumstances that can throw any light on this are, (1.) That Luke was the companion and intimate friend of Paul, and attended him in his travels. From Acts xvi. 10, 11, where Luke uses the term "tye," it appears that he was with Paul when he first went into Macedonia, and from ver. 1 5 it is clear that he went with Paul to Philippi. From Acts xvii. J, where Luke alters his style and uses the term " they," it is evident that he did not accompany Paul and Silas when they went to Thessalonica, but either remained at Philippi or departed to some other place He did not join them again until they went to Troas on the way to Jerusalem. Acts XX. 5. In what manner Luke spent the interval is not known. Mac- I knight supposes that it might have been in multiplying copies of his gospel for the use of the churches. Perhaps also j he might have been engaged in preach- ing, and m services like that in the ca A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VIII. 187 is in ih-e gospel throughout all the churches ; 19 And not that only, but who was also chosen " of the churches to travel with us with this * firrace, which is adminis- grace, a 1 Co. 16. 3, 4. « or, ffift. before us. (2.) It seems probable that Luke is the person referred to by the phrase " whose praise is in the gospel throughout all the churches." This would be more likely to be applied to one who had written a gospel, or a life of the Redeemer that had been exten- sively circulated, than to any other per- son. Still it is by no means certain that he is the person here referred to, nor is it of material consequence. ^ Whose praise. Who is well known and highly esteemed, t Is in the gospel. Either for writing the gospel, or for preaching the gospel. The Greek will bear either construction. In some way he was celebrated for making known the truths of the gospel. 1 9. A7id not that only. Not only is he esteemed on account of other ser- vices which he has rendered by his preaching and writings ; but he has had a new mark of the confidence of the churches in being appointed to convey the collection to Jerusalem. t Chosen of the churches. Chosen by the churches. Many concurred in the choice, showing that they had entire confidence in him. Paul had been un- willing to have charge of this contribu- tion alone ( 1 Cor. xvi. 3, 4. comp. ver. 20), and he had procured the appoint- ment of some one to undertake it. Probably he expected that the church at Corinth would concur in this appoint- ment. 1 With this grace. Marg. "Gift." See ver. 1. The word here refers to the alms, or the collection which had been made, t Which is ad- rniniaiered by us. That is, which is undertaken by us. Paul had been the instrument of procuring it. ^ To the glory of the same Lord. The Lord of tered by us to * the glory of the same Lord, and declaration of your ready mind : 20 Avoiding this, that no man should blame us in this abun- dance which is administered by us: h c. 4. 15. us all. The design was to promote the glory of the Lord by showing the influ- ence of reUgion in producing true be- nevolence. II And declaration of your ready mind. That is, to afford you an opportunity of evincing your readiness to do good to others, and to promote their welfare. 20. Avoiding this. That is, I intend to prevent any blame from being cast upon me in regard to the management of these funds. For this purpose Paul had refused to have the entire manage- ment of the funds (see 1 Cor. xvi. 3,4), and had secured the appointment of one who had the entire confidence of all the churches. ^ That no man should blame us. That no one should have any occasion to say that I had appro- priated it to my own use or contrary to the will of the donors. Paul felt how dangerous it was for ministers to have j much to do with money matters. He had a very deep impression of the ne- cessity of keeping his own character free from suspicion on this subject. He knew how easy it might be for his ene- mies to raise the charge that he had em- bezzled the funds and appropriated them to his own use. He therefore insisted on having associated with him some one who had the entire confidence of the churches, and who should be appointed by them, and thus he was certain of be- ing forever free from blame on the sub- ject. A most important example for all ministers in regard to the pecuniary- benefactions of the churches. ^ In this abundance, &c. In this large amount which is contributed by the churches and committed to our disposal. Large sums of money are in our time com- mitted to the ministers of the gospel in 188 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 21 Providing for honest " things, not only in the sight a Rd. 12. 17. Ph. 4. 8. 1 Pe. 2. 12. the execution of the objects of Chris- tian benevolence. Nothing can be more wise than the example of Paul here, that they should have associated with them others who have the entire con- fidence of the churches, that there may not be occasion for slander to move her poisonous tongue against the ministers of religion. 21. Providing for honest things. The expression here used occurs in Rom. xii. 1 7. See the Note on that place. In that place, however, it refers to the manner in which we are to treat those who injure us ; here it refers to the right way of using property ; and it seems to have been a kind of maxim by which Paul regulated his life, a vade mecum that was applicable to every thing. The sentiment is, that we are to see to it beforehand that all our con- duct shall be comely or honest. The word rendered " providing for" (tt^ovocu- fxmot) means foreseeing, or perceiving beforehand ; and the idea is, that we are to make it a matter of previous calcula- tion, a settled plan, a thing that is to be attended to of set design. In the middle voice, the form in which it occurs here, it means to provide for in one's own be- half; to apply oneself to any thing ; to practise diligently. — Robinson. The word rendered " things honest" (jtJtAd) means properly beautiful, or comely. The idea which is presented here is, that we are to see beforehand, or we are to make it a matter of set purpose that what we do shall be comely, i. e. just, honoura- ble, correct, not only in the sight of the Lord, but in the sight of men. Paul applies this in his own case to the alms which were to be intrusted to him. His idea is, that he meant so to con- duct in the whole transaction as that his conduct should be approved by God, but that it should also be regarded as beautiful or correct in the sight of men. He knew how much his own useful- ness depended on an irreproachable of the Lord, but also in the sigh,* of men. 22 And we have sent with character. He, therefore, procured the appointment of one who had the entire confidence of the churches to travel with him. But there is no reason foi confining this to the particular case under consideration. It seems to have been the leading maxim of the life of Paul, and it should be of ours. The maxim may be applied to every thing which we have to do ; and should con- stantly regulate us. It may be applied to the acquisition and use of property ; to the discharge of our professional duties ; to our intercourse with others ; to our treatment of inferiors and de- pendents ; to our charities, &c. — in all of which we should make it a matter of previous thought, of earnest diligence, that our conduct should be perfectly honest and comely before God and man. Let us learn from this verse also, that ministers of the gospel should be espe- cially careful that their conduct in money matters, and especially in the appropriation of the charities of the church, should be above suspicion. Much is often intrusted to their care, and the churches and individual Chris- tians often commit much to their dis- cretion. Their conduct in this should be without reproach ; and in order to this, it is well to follow the example of Paul, and to insist that others who have the entire confidence of the churches should be associated with them. No- thing is easier than to raise a slanderous report against a minister of the gospel ; and nothing gratifies a wicked world more than to be able to do it — and per- haps especially if it pertains to some improper use of money. It i3 not easy to meet such reports when they are started ; and a minister, therefore, should be guarded, as Paul was, at every possi- ble point, that he may be freed from that " whose breath outvenoms all the worms of Nile" — slanbek. 22. And we have sent with them our brotlier. Who this was is wholly A. D. 60.] CHAPTER VIII. 189 them our brother, whom we have 'Oftentimes proved diligent in many things, but now much more diligent, upon the great con- fidence which * / have in you. 23 Whether any do inquire > or, he hath, unknown, and conjecture is useless. Some have supposed that it was Apollos, others Silas, others Timothy. But there are no means of ascertaining who it was ; nor is it material. It was some one in whom Paul had entire confidence. 1 Whom we have of/entimes proved diligent. Of whom we have evidence that he has been faithful. It is evident, therefore, that he had been the com- panion and fellow-labourer of Paul. ^ But now much niwe diligent, Sec. Who will now prove himself much more diligent than ever before. ^ Upon the confidence, &c. Marg. " he hath." The margin is doubtless the more cor- rect reading here. The idea is, that this brother had great confidence in the Corinthians that they would give libe- rally, and that he would, therefore, evince special diligence in the business. 23. Whether any do inquire of Titus. It is to be observed that the words " any do inquire" are not in the original ; nor is it clear that these are the most proper words to be introduced here. The Greek, may mean either, "if any do inquire about Titus," or it may mean ' if any thing is to be said about Titus.' The sense of the passage may either be, that some of the faction at Corinth might be disposed to inquire about the authority of Titus to engage in this work, or that Paul having said so much in commemla- tion of the persons who went with Titus, it seemed proper also to say something in his favour also. The idea is, *If any inquiry is made from any quarter about him, or if it is necessary from any cause to say any thing about him, I would say he is my partner,' &.c. t He is my partner, &c. He partakes with me in preaching the gospel, and in establishing and organizing churches. of Titus, he is my partner and fellow-helper concerning you , or our brethren be inquired of, they are the messengers " of the churches, and the glory of Christ. a Ph. 2. 25. Comp. Tit. i. 5. To the Corinthians this fact would be a sufficient com- mendation of Titus. \ Or our brethren be inquired of. That is, the brethren who accompanied Titus. If any inquiry was made about their character, or if it was necessary to say any thing in regard to them, t They are the messengers of the churches. They have the entire confidence of the churches, having been selected and appointed by them to a work of labour and responsibility. Comp. Phil, ii, 25. The words here rendered ' messengers of the churches,' are in the original * apostles of the churches,' ( -.TTCKnoxot ix.)i\ii or, to. d c. 13. 3, 4. e Jer. 1. 10. corruption, intemperance, profaneness, wherever they may exist. The Chris- tian is opposed to all these, and it is the aim and purpose of his life as far as he may be able to resist and subdue them. He is a soldier enlisted under the banner of the Redeemer to oppose and resist all forms of evil. But his warfare is not conducted on worldly principles. Mahomet propagated his religion with the sword ; and the men of this world seek for victory by arms and violence. The Christian looks for his conquests only by the force and power of truth, and by the agency of the Spirit of God. 4. For the weapons of our warfare. The means by which we hope to achieve our victory. If Are not carnal. Not those of the flesh. Not such as the men of the world use. They are not such as are employed by conquerors;, nor are they such as men in general rely on to advance their cause. We do not depend on eloquence, or talent, or learning, or wealth, or beauty, or any of the external aids on which the men of this world rely. They are not such as derive advantage from any power in- herent in themselves. Their strength is derived from God alone. t ^i^i mighty through God. Marg. "/o." They are rendered mighty or powerful by the agency of God. They depend on him for their eflScacy. Paul has not here specified the weapons on which he relied ; but he had before specified them (ch. vi. 6, 7), so that there was no danger of mistake. The weapons were such as were furnished by truth and righteousness, and these were ren- dered mighty by the attending agency of God. The sense is, that God is the author of the doctrines which we preach, and that he attends them with the agency of his Spirit, and accompanies them to the hearts of men. It is im- 208 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 5 Casting down * imagina- tions, " and every high ^ thing that exalteth itself against the 19. or, reasonings. b Ps. 18. 27. a 1 Co, 1. Ez. 17. 24. portant for all ministers to feel that their weapons are mighty only through God. Conquerors and earthly warriors go into battle depending in the might of their own arm, and on the wisdom and skill which plans the battle. The Christian goes on his warfare, feeling that however well adapted the truths which he holds are to accomplish great purposes, and however wisely his plans are formed, yet that the efficacy of all depends on the agency of God. He has no hope of victory but in God. And if God does not attend him, he is sure of inevitable defeat. ^ To the put- ting down of strongholds. The word here rendered " strongholds" (i^u^en/mcL) means properly a fastness, fortress, or strong fortification. It is here beautifully used to denote the various obstacles resembling a fortress which exist, and which are designed and adapted to oppose the truth and the triumph of the Christian's cause. All those obstacles are strongly fortified. The sins of his heart are fortified by long indulgence and by the hold which they have on his soul. The wickedness of the world ivhich he opposes is strongly fortified oy the fact that it has seized on strong human passions ; that one point stengthens another ; that great numbers are united. The idolatry of the world was strongly fortified by prejudice, and 'ong establishment, and the protection )f laws, and the power of the priest- hood ; and the opinions of the world are entrenched behind false philosophy and the power of subtle argumentation. The whole world is fortified against Christianity ; and the nations of the earth have been engaged in little else than in raising and strengthening such strongholds for the space of six thou- sand years. The Christian religion goes forth against all the combined and Concentrated powers of resistance of the knowledge of God, and bringing into captivity "every thought to ^ the obedience of Christ : c Mat. 11.29,30. d Ge. 8. 21. Mat. 15. 19. He. 4. 12. whole world ; and the warfare is to be waged against every strongly fortified place of error and of sin. These strong fortifications of error and of sin are to be battered down and laid in ruins by our spiritual weapons. 5. Casting down imaginations. Marg. reasonings. The word is pro- bably used here in the sense of device^ and refers to all the plans of a wicked world ; the various systems of false philosophy ; and the reasonings of the enemies of the gospel. The various systems of false philosophy were so intrenched that they might be called the stronghold of the enemies of God. The foes of Christianity pretend to a great deal of reason, and rely on that in re- sisting the gospel. If And every high thing, &c. Every exalted opinion respecting the dignity and purity of human nature; all the pride of the human heart and of the understanding. All this is opposed to the knowledge of God, and all exalts itself into a vain self-confidence. Men entertain vain and unfounded opinions respecting their own excellency, and they feel that they do not need the provisions of the gospel and are unwilling to submit to God. 1 And bringing info captivity, &c. The figure here is evidently taken from military conquests. The idea is, that all the strongholds of heathenism, and pride, and sin would be demolished ; and that when this was done, like throwing down the walls of a city or making a breach, all the plans and purposes of the soul, the reason, the imagination, and all the powers of the mind would be subdued or led in triumph by the gospel, like the inhabitants of a captured city. Christ was the great Captain in this warfare. In his name the battle was waged, and liy his power the victory was won. The captives were made for him and under his authority ; and alk A. D. 60.] CHAPTER X. 209 6 And having in a readiness to revenge all disobedience, when your obedience " is fulfilled. a c. 7. 15. were to be subject to his control. Every power of thought in the heathen world ; all the systems of philosophy and all forms of opinion among men ; all the purposes of the soul ; all the powers of reason, memory, judgment, fancy in an individual, were all to come under the laws of Christ. All doctrines were to be in accordance with his will ; philosophy should no longer control them, but they should be subject to the will of Christ. All the plans of life should be controlled by the will of Christ, and formed and executed under his control — as captives are led by a con- queror. All the emotions and feelings of the heart should be controlled by him, and led by him as a captive is led by a victor. The sense is, that it was the aim, and purpose of Paul to accomplish this, and that it would certainly be done. The strongholds of philosophy, hea- thenism, and sin should be demolished, and all the opinions, plans, and purposes of the world should become subject to the all-conquering Redeemer. 6. And having in a readiness, &c. I am ready to punish all disobedience, notwithstanding all that is said to the contrary. See Notes on ver. 1, 2. Clothed as I am with this power ; aim- ing to subdue all things to Christ, though the weapons of my warfare are not carnal, and though I am modest or timid (ver. 1) when I am with you, I am prepared to take any measures of severity required by my apostolic office in order that I may inflict deserved pun- ishment on those who have violated the laws of Christ. The design of this is, to meet the objection of his enemies, that he would not dare to execute his threatenings. \ When your obedience is fulfilled. Doddridge renders this, "now your obedience is fulfilled, and the sounder part of your church restored to due order and submission." The idea seems to be, that Paul was ready 18* 7 Do ye look on things after the outward ' appearance 1 If any man trust to himself that he b Jno. 7. 24. to inflict discipline when the church had showed a readiness to obey his laws, and to do its own duty — delicately inti- mating that the reason why it was not done was the want of entire promptness in the church itself, and that it could not be done on any offender as long as the church itself was not prepared to sustain him. The church was to discountenance the enemies of the Redeemer ; to show an entire readiness to sustain the apostle, and to unite with him in the effort to maintain the discipline of Christ's house. 7. Do ye look on things after the outward appearance ? This is address- ed evidently to the members of the church, and with reference to the claims which had been set up by the false teachers. There can be no doubt that they valued themselves on their external advantages, and laid claim to peculiar honour in the work of the ministry, be- cause they were superior in personal appearance, in rank, manners, or elo- quence to Paul. Paul reproves them for thus judging, and assures them that this was not a proper criterion by which to determine on qualifications for the apostolic office. Such things were high- ly valued among the Greeks, and a con- siderable part of the eflbrt of Paul in these letters is to show that these things constitute no evidence that those who possessed them were sent from God. ^ If any man trust to himself, &c. This refers to the false teachers who laid claims to be the followers of Christ by way of eminence. Whoever these teachers were, it is evident that they claimed to be on the side of Christ, and to be appointed by him. They were probably Jews, and they boasted of their talents and eloquence, and possibly that they had seen the Saviour. The phrase " trust to himself," seems to imply that they relied on some special merit of their own, or some special advantage which 210 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. is Christ's, let him of himself think this again, that, as he is Christ's, even so are we Christ's. 8 For though I should boast somewhat more of our authority, which the Lord hath given us a c. 13. 2, 3. Ihey had. — Bloomjield. It may have oeen that they were of the same tribe that he was, or that they had seen him, or that they confided in their own talents or endowments as proof that they had been sent by him. It is not an un- common thing for men to have such confidence in their own gifts, and par- ticularly in a power of fluent speaking, as to suppose that this is a sufficient evidence that they are sent to preach the gospel. 1 Let him of himself think this again. Since he relies so much on himself; since he has such confi- dence in his own powers, let him look at the evidence that I also am of Christ. ^ That as he is Christ's, even so are we Christ's. That I have given as much evidence that I am commissioned by Christ as they can produce. It may be of a different kind. It is not in elo- quence, and rank, and the gift of a rapid and ready elocution, but it may be su- perior to what they are able to produce. Probably Paul refers here to the fact that he had seen the Lord Jesus, and that he had been directly commissioned by him. The sense is, that no one could produce more proofs of being called to the ministry than he could. 8. For though I should boast, &,c. If I should make even higher claims than I have done to a divine commission. I could urge higher evidence than I have done that I am sent by the Lord Jesus. t Of our auth, rity. Of my authority as an apostle, my power to administer discipline, and to direct the affairs of the church. 1 Which the Lord hath given us fur edification. A power primarily conferred to build up his people and save them and not to destroy. ^ / should not be ashamed. It would be founded on good evidence and sustained by the nature of my commission. I should for edification, ^ and not for your destruction, I should not be ashamed : 9 Tha't I may not seem as if I would terrify you by letters. 10 For his letters, ^ say they, b c. 13. 8. » said he. also have no occasion to be ashamed of the manner in which it has been exer- cised — a power that has in fact been employed in extending reUgion and edifying the church, and not in original ing and sustaining measures fitted to destroy the soul. 9. That I may not seem, &c. The meaning of this verse seems to be this. ' I say that I might boast more of my power in order that I may not appear disposed to terrify you with my letters merely. I do not threaten more than I can perform. I have it in my power to execute all that I have threatened, aricl to strike an awe not only by my letters, but by the infliction of extraordinary miraculous punishments. And if I should boast that I had done this, and could do it again, I should Jiave no reason to be ashamed. It would not be vain and empty boasting ; not boast- ing which is not well-founded.' 1 0. For his letters. The letters which he has sent to the church when absent. Reference is had here probably to the first epistle to the Corinthians. They might also have seen some of Paul's other epistles, and been so well ac- quainted with them as to be able to make the general remark that he had the power of writing in an authorita- tive and impressive manner. f Say they. Marg. Said he. Greek {'iit^r)) in the singular. This seems to have referred to some one person who had uttered the words — perhaps some one who was the principal leader of the faction opposed to Paul, f Are weighty and powerful. Tindal renders tliis, " Sore and strong," The Greek is, 'heavy and strong' (/^f^fiut nx) io'X'^^^.i). The j sense is, that his letters were energetic I and powerful. They abounded with 1 strong argument, manly appeals, and A. D. 60.] CHAPTER X. 2J i are weighty and powerful ; but ; his bodily presence is weak, impressive reproof. This even his ene- mies were compelled to admit, and this no one can deny who ever read them. Paul's letters comprise a considerable portion of the New Testament ; and some of the most important doctrines of the New Testament are those which are a Ivocated and enforced by him ; and his .etters have done more to give shape to the theological doctrines of the Chris- tian world than any other cause what- ever. He wrote fourteen epistles to churches and individuals on various occasions and on a great variety of topics ; and his letters soon rose into very high repute among even the in- spired ministers of the New Testament (see 2 Pet. iii. 15, 16), and were re- garded as inculcating the most important doctrines of religion. The general characteristics of Paul's letters are, (1.) They are strongly argumentative. See especially the epistles to the Ro- mans and the Hebrews. (2.) They are distinguished for boldness and vigor of style. (3.) They are written under great energy of feeling and of thought — a rapid and impetuous torrent that bears him forcibly along. (4.) They abound more than most other writings in paren- theses, and the sentences are often in- volved and obscure. ' (5.) They often evince rapid transitions and departures from the regular current of thought. A thought strikes him suddenly, and he pauses to illustrate it, and dwells upon it long, before he returns to the main subject. The consequence is, that it is often difficult to follow him. (().) They are powerful in reproof — abounding with strokes of great bold- n(^ss of denunciation, and also with spocimcns of most withering sarcasm ai)d most delicate irony. (7.) They abound in expressions of great tender- ness and pathos. Nowhere can be found expressions of a heart more ten- der and atTectionate than in the writings of Paul, (8.) They dwell much on great and profound doctrines, and on the application of the j-rinciples of Chris- tianity to the various duties of life. (9.) They abound with references to the Saviour. He illustrates every thing by his life, his example, his death, his resurrection. It is not wonderful that letters composed on such subjects and in such a fnanner by an inspired man produced a deep impression on the Christian world ; nor that they should be regarded now as among the most important and valuable portions of the Bible. Take away Paul's letters, and what a chasm would be made in the New Testament ! What a chasm ir the religious opinions and in the con- solations of the Christian world ! ^ But his bodily presence. His personal ap- pearance. ^ Is weak. Imbecile, feeble {u.a-^&/k) — a word often used to denote infirmity of body, sickness, disease. Matt. XXV. 39. 43, 44. Luke x. 9. Acts iv. 9 ; V. 15, 10. 1 Cor. xi. 30. Here it is to be observed that this is a mere charge which was brought against him, and it is not of necessity to be supposed that it was true, though the presumption is, that there was some foundation for it. It is supposed to refer to some bodily imperfections, and possibly to his dimi- nutive stature. Chrysostom says that his stature was low, his body crooked, and his head bald. Lucian, in his Phi- lopatris, says of him, corpore erat par- vo, contracto, incurvo, tricubitali — pro- bably an exaggerated description, perhaps a caricature — to denote one very di- minutive and having no advantages of personal appearance. According to Nicephorus, Paul "was a little man, crooked, and almost bent like a bow ; with a pale countenance, long and wrinkled ; a bald head ; his eyes full of fire and benevolence ; his beard long, thick, and interspersed with gray hairs, as was his head," &c. But there is no certain evidence of the truth of these representations. Nothing in the Bible would lead us to suppose that Paul was remarkably diminutive or deformed ; and though there may be some founda- tion for the charge here alleged that his 812 11. CORINTHIANS. and his speech contemptible. 1 1 Let such an one think this, that, such as we are in word by letters when we are absent, bodily presence was weak, yet we are to remember that this was the accusa- tion of his enemies, and that it was doubtless greatly exaggerafed. Nice- phorus was a writer of the sixteenth cen- tury, and his statements are worthy of no regard. That Paul was eminently an eloquent man may be inferred from a great many considerations ; some of which are, ( 1 .) His recorded discourses in the Acts of the Apostles, and the effect produced by them. No one can read his defence before Agrippa or Fe- lix and not be convinced that as an orator he deserves to be ranked among the most distinguished of ancient times. No one who reads the account in the Acts can believe that he had any re- markable impediment in his speech or that he was remarkably deformed. (2.) Such was somehow his grace and power as an orator that he was taken by the inhabitants of Lycaonia as Mercury, the god of eloquence. Acts xvi. 12. As- suredly the evidence here is, that Paul was not deformed. (3.) It may be added, that Paul is mentioned by Lon- ginus among the principal orators of antiquity. From these circumstances, there is no reason to believe that Paul was remarkably deficient in the quali- fications requisite for an orator, or that he was in any way remarkably deform- ed. 1 And his speech contemptible. To be despised. Some suppose that he had an impediment in his speech. But conjecture here is vain and useless. We are to remember that this is a charge made by his adversaries, and that it was made by the fastidious Greeks, who professed to be great admirers of eloquence, but who in his time confided much more in the mere art of the rhetorician than in the power of thought, and in energetic appeals to the reason and conscience of men. Judged by their standard it may be that Paul had not the graces in voice or manner, or in such will we be also when we are present. 12 For " we dare not ac. 3. 1. [A. D. 60. in deed make the knowledge of the Greek language, which they esteemed necessary in a finished orator ; but judged by his power of thought, and his bold and manly defence of truth, and his energy of character and manner, and his power of impressing truth on mankind, he deserves, doubtless, to be ranked among the first orators of antiquity. No man has left the impress of his own mind on more other minds than Paul. 11. Let such an one think this, &c. Let them not flatter themselves that there will be any discrepancy between my words and my deeds. Let them feel that all which has been threatened will be certainly executed unless there is repentance. Paul here designedly contradicts the charge which was made against him ; and means to say that all that he had threatened in his letters would be certainly executed unless there was reform. I think that the evidence here is clear that Paul does not intend to ad- mit what they said about his bodily presence to be true ; and most probably all that has been recorded about his de- formity is mere fable. 12. For we dare not make ourselves of the number. We admit that we are not bold enough for that. They had accused him of a want of boldness and energy when present with them. ver. 1.10. Here, in a strain of severe but delicate irony, he says he was not bold enough to do things which they had done. He did not dare to do the things which had been done among them. To such boldness of character, present or absent, he could lay no claim, f Or compare ourselves, &c. I am not bold enough for that. That requires a stretch of boldness and energy to which I can lay no claim, t That commend them- selves. That put themselves forward, and that boast of their endowments and attainments. It is probable that this was commonly done by those to A. D. 60.] CHAPTER X. 213 ourselves of the number, or com- pare ourselves with some that commend themselves : but they measuring themselves by them- whom the apostle here refers ; and it is certain that it is everywhere the characteristic of pride. To do this, Paul says, required greater boldness than he possessed, and on this point he yield- ed to them the palm. The satire here is very delicate, and yet very severe, and was such as would doubtless be felt by them, t But they measuring them- selves by themselves. Whitby and Clarke suppose that this means that they compared themselves with each other ; and that they made the false apostles particularly their standard. Doddridge, Grotius, Bloomfield, and 8ome others suppose the sense to be, that they made themselves the stand- ard of excellence. They looked con- tinually on their own accomplish- ments, and did not look at the excel- lences of others. They thus formed a disproportionate opinion of themselves, and undervalued all others. Paul says that he had not boldness enough for that. It required a moral courage to which he could lay no claim. Horace (l:Ipis. i. 7. 98) has an expression simi- lar to this. Metiri se qiiemque suo modulo ac pede, verum est. The sense of Paul is, that they made themselves the standard of excellence ; that they were satisfied with their own attainments ; and that they overlooked the superior excellence and attainments of others. This is a graphic description of pride and ^elf-complacency ; and, alas ! it is what is often exhibited. How many there are, and it is to be feared even among professing Christians, who have no other standard of excellence than themselves. Their views are the standard of orthodoxy ; their modes of worship are the standard of the proper nianner of devotion ; their habits and customs are in their own estimation per- fect ; and their own characters are the selves, and comparing themselves among them-selves, ^ are not wise. * 13 But we will not boast of » understand it not. a Pr. 26. 12. models of excellence, and they see little or no excellence in those who differ from them. They look on themselves as the true measure of orthodoxy, hu- mility, zeal, and piety ; and they con- demn all others, however excellent they may be, who differ from them. 1 And comparing themselves, &c. Or rather comparing themselves with themselves. Themselves they make to be the stand- ard, and they judge of every thing by that, t Are not wise. Are stupid and foolish. Because, (1.) They had no such excellence as to make themselves the standard. (2.) Because this was an indication of pride. (3.) Because it made them blind to the excellences of others. It was to be presumed that others had endovyments not inferior to theirs. (4.) Because the requirements of God, and the character of the Re- deemer were the proper standard of conduct. Nothing is a more certain indication of folly than for a man to make himself the standard of excellence. Such an individual must be blind to his own real character ; and the only thing certain about his attainments is, that ho is inflated with pride. And yet how common! How self-satisfied are most persons ! How pleased with their own character and attainments ! How grieved at any comparison which is made with others implying their inferiority ! How prone to undervalue all others simply because they differ from them! — The margin renders this, "understand it not," that is, they do not understand their own character or their inferiority. 1 3. But we will not boast of things without our measure. Tindal renders this, "But we will not rejoice above measure." There is great obscurity in the language here, arising from its brevity. But the general idea seems to be plain. Paul says that he had not boldness as they had to boast of things 2U II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. things without our measure, but according to the measure of the * rule which God hath distributed » or, line. wholly beyond his proper rule and his actual attainments and influence : and, especially, that he was not disposed to enter into other men's labours; or to boast of things that had been done by the mere influence of his name, and beyond the proper limits of his personal exertions. He made no boast of hav- ing done any thing where he had not been himself on the ground and laboured assiduously to secure the object. They, it is not improbable, had boasted of what had been done in Corinth as though it were really their work, though it had been done by the apostle himself. Nay more, it is probable that they boasted of what had been done by the mere in- fluence of their name. Occupying a central position, they supposed that their reputation had gone abroad, and that the mere influence of their reputa- tion had had an important effect. Not so with Paul. He made no boast of any thing but what God had enabled him to do by his evangelical labours, and by personal exertions. He entered into no other men's labours, and claim- ed nothing that others had done as his own. He was not bold enough for that. •| But according to the measure of the rule, &c. Marg. Or, line. The word rendered " rule" (Greek, Kuyliv, whence our English word canon) means pro- perly a reed, rod, or slaff employed to keep any thing stiff, erect, asunder (Horn. II. 8. 1 03) ; then a measuring rod oc line ; then any standard or rule — its usual meaning in the New Testa- ment, as, e. g., of life and doctrine. Gal, vi. 16. Phil. iii. 16.— Robinson's Lex. Here it means the limit, boun- dary line, or sphere of action assigned to any one. Paul means to say that God had appropriated a certain line or boundary as the proper limit of his sphere of action ; that his appropriate sphere extended to them ; that in going to them, though they were far distant to us, a measure to reach even unto you. 14 For we stretch not our- selves beyond our measure, as from the field of his early labours, he had confined himself within the proper limits assigned him by God ; and that in boasting of his labours among them he was not boasting of any thing which did not properly fall within the sphere of labour assigned to him. The mean- ing is, that Paul was especially careful not to boast of any thing beyond his proper bounds. •[ Which God hath distributed to us. Which in assigning our respective fields of labour God has assigned unto me and my fellow- labourers. The Greek word here ren- dered "distributed" (ijui^io-iv) means properly to measure ; and the sense is, that God had measured out or appor- tioned their respective fields of labour ; that by his providence he had assigned to each one his proper sphere, and that in' the distribution Corinth had fallen to the lot of Paul. In going there he had kept within the proper limits ; in boast- ing of his labours and success there he did not boast of what did not belong to him. ^ A measure to reach even unto you. The sense is, ' the limits assigned me include you, and I may therefore justly boast of what I have done among you as within my proper field of labour.' Paul was the apostle to the Gentiles (Acts XX vi. 17, 18) ; and the whole country of Greece therefore he regarded as falling within the limits assigned to him. No one therefore could blame him for going there as if he was an intruder ; no one assert that he had gone beyond the proper bounds. 14. For we stretch not ourselves be- yond our measure. In coming to preach to you we have not gone beyond the proper limits assigned us. We have not endeavoured to enlarge the proper boundaries, to stretch the line which limited us, but have kept honestly within the proper limits. ^ As though we reached not unto you. That is, as if our boundaries did not extend so fai A. D. 60.] CHAPTER X. 215 though we reached not unto you ; for we are come as far as to you also in preaching the gospel of Christ : 15 Not boasting of things as to comprehend you. We have not overstepped the proper limits, as if Greece was not within the proper sphere of action, f For we are come as far to you, &c. In the regular work of preaching the gospel we have come to you. We have gone from place to place preaching the gospel where we had opportunity ; we have omitted no important places, until in the regular discharge of our duties in preaching we have reached you and have preached the gospel to you. We have not omitted other places in order to come to you and enter into the proper field of labour of others, but in the regular work of making the gospel known as far as possible to all men we have come to Corinth. Far as it is, therefore, from the place where we started, we have approached it in a regular manner, and have not gone out of our proper province in doing it. 15. Not boasting of things without our measure. There is here probably an allusion to the false teachers at Corinth. They had come after Paul had been there, and had entered into his labours. When he had founded the church ; when he had endured trials and persecutions in order to reach Co- rinth ; when he had laboured there for a year and a half (Acts xviii. 11), they came and entered the quiet and easy field, formed parties, and claimed the field as their own. Paul says that he had not courage to do that. See Note, ver. 12. That required a species of boldness to which he could lay no claim; and he did not assume honour to him- self like that. ^ That is, of other men's labours. Not intruding into churches which we did not establish, and claim- ing the right to direct their affairs, and to exclude the founders from all proper honours, and all influence, and endea- vouring to alienate the affections of without our measure, that is of "other men's labours; bu.* having hope, when your faith is increased, that we shall be * en- a Ro. 15. 20. » or, magnified in you. Christians from their spiritual father and guide, t But having hope, &c. So far from this ; so far from a desire to enter into the labours of others and quietly enjoying the avails of their in- dustry ; and so far even from a desire to sit down ourselves and enjoy the fruit of our own labours, I desire to pene- trate other untrodden regions ; to en- counter new dangers ; to go where the gospel has not been planted, and to rear other churches there. I do not, there- fore, make these remarks as if I wished even to dispossess the teachers that have entered into my labours. I make them because I wish to be aided by you in extending the gospel further ; and I look to your assistance in order that I may have the means of going into the regions where I have not made known the name of the Redeemer, "f When your faith is increased. When you become so strong as not to need my presence and my constant care ; and when you shall be able to speed me on my way and to aid me on my journey. He expected to be assisted by them in his efforts to carry the gospel to other countries, f That we shall be enlarged. Marg. Magnified by you. Bloomfield supposes that this means, " to gain fame and glory by you ;" that is, as the teacher may justly by his pupils. So Robinson renders it, " to make great, to praise." But to me the idea seems to be that he wished them to enlarge or magnify him by introducing him to larger fields of action ; by giving him a wider sphere of labour. It was not that he wished to be magnified by obtaining a wider reputation, not as a matter of praise or ambition, but he wished to have his work and success greatly en- larged. This he hoped to be enabled to do partly by the aid of the church at Corinth. When they became able to manage their own affairs; when hia 216 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60- larged by you according to our rule abundantly. 16 To preach the gospel in the regions beyond you, and not to boast in another man's time was not demanded to superintend them ; when their faith became so strong that his presence was not needed ; and when they should assist him in his preparations for travel, then he would enter on his wider field of labour. He had no intention of sitting down in ease as the false teachers in Corinth seem disposed to have done. % According to our rule. Greek, ' According to our canon.' See on ver. 13. The sense is, according to the rule by which the sphere of his labours had been marked out. His rule was to carry the gospel as far as possible to the heathen world. He regarded the regions lying far be- yond Corinth as coming properly within his limits ; and he desired to occupy that field. t Ahimdantly. Greek, Unto abundance. So as to abound ; that is, to occupy the field assigned as far as possible. 16. To preach the gospel in the regions beyond you. What regions are referred to here can be only a matter of conjecture. It may be that he wished to preach in other parts of Greece, and that he designed to go to Arcadia or Lacfedemon. Rosenmiiller supposes that as the Corinthians were engaged in commerce, the apostle hoped that by them some tidings of the gospel would reach the countries with which they were engaged in traffic. But I think it most probable that he alludes to Italy and Spain. It is certain that he had formed the design of visiting Spain (Rom. XV. 24. 28) ; and he doubtless wished the Corinthians to aid him in that purpose, and was anxious to do this as soon as the condition of the eastern churches would allow it. 1 And not to boast in another man^s line of things, &c. Marg. Rule, the same word {kav^Lv) which occurs in ver. 13. The meaning is, that Paul did not mean to boast of what properly belonged to line ^ of things made ready to our hand. 17 But " he that glorieth, let him glory in the Lord. > or, rule. a Je. 9. 24. others. He did not claim what they had done as his own. He did not in- tend to labour within what was properly their bounds, and then to claim the field and the result of the labour as his. He probably means here to intimate that this had been done by the false teachers of Corinth ; but so far was he from designing to do this, that he meant soon to leave Corinth, which was properly within his limits, and the church which he had founded there, to go and preach the gospel to other regions. Whether Paul ever went to Spain has been a question (see Note on Rom. xv. 24) ; but it is certain that he went to Rome, and that he preached the gospel in many other places after this besides Corinth. 17. But he that glorieth. He that boasts. Whatever may be the occasion of his boasting, whether in planting churches or in watering them ; whether in his purposes, plans, toils, or success. Paul himself did not deem it improper on some occasions to boast (ch. xi. 16 ; xii. 5), but it was not of his own power, attainments, or righteonianess. He was disposed to trace all to the Lord, and to regard him as the source of all blessing and all success, f Let him giory in the Lord. In this serious and weighty admonition, Paul designs, doubtless, to express the manner in which he was accustomed to glory, and to furnish an admonition to the Co' rinthians. In the previous part of the chapter there had been some severe irony. He closes the chapter with the utmost seriousness and solemnity of manner, in order to show on his part that he was not disposed to glory in his own attainments and to admonish them not to boast of theirs. If they hail any thing valuable they should regard the Lord as the author of it. In this admo- nition it is probable that Paul had in A. D. 60.] CHAPTER X. 217 18 For not he that com- mendeth himself is approved, his eye the passage in Jer. ix. 23, 24. though he has not expressly quoted it. **Let not the wise man glory in his wisdom, neither let the mighty man glory in his might, let not the rich man glory in his liches ; but let him that glorieth, glory in this, that he under- standoth and knoweth me, that I am the LoKB which exercise loving-kindness, judgment, and righteousness in the earth." The sentiment is a favourite one with Paul, as it should be with all Christians. See Note on 1 Cor. i. .31. On this verse we may here remark, I. That nothing is more common than for men to boat^t or glory. Little as they really have in which to glory, yet there is no one probably who has not something of which he is proud, and of which he is disposed to boast. It would be difficult or impossible to find a person who had not something on which he prided himself; something in which he esteemed himself superior to others. II. The things of which they boast are very various. (1.) Many are proud of their personal beauty ; many, too,who would be unwilling to be thought proud of it. (2.) Many glory in their accomplishments; or, what is more likely, in the accomplishments of their children. (3.) Many glory in their talents ; talents for any thing, valuable or not, in which they suppose they surpass others. They glory in their talent for eloquence, or science, or gain- ing knowledge ; or in their talent for gaining property or keeping it ; for their skill in their professions or callings ; for their ability to run, to leap, or to practise even any trick or sleight of hand. There is nothing so worthless that it does not constitute a subject of glorying, provided it be ours. If it belong to others it may be val leless. (4.) Many glory in their propeity ; in fine houses, extended plantations, or in the reputa- tion of being rich ; or in gorgeous dress, equipage, and furniture. In short, there 19 but * whom the Lord com- mendeth. a Ro. 2. 29. is nothing which men possess in which they are not prone to glory. Forgetful of God the giver ; forgetful that all may be soon taken from them, or that they soon must leave all ; forgetful that none of these things can constitute a distinc- tion in the grave or beyond, they boast as if these things were to remain forever, and as if they had been acquired independ ently of God. How prone is the man of talents to forget that God has given him his intellect, and that for its proper use he must give account ! How prone is the rich man to forget that he must die ! How prone the gay and the beautiful to forget that they will lie undistinguished in the grave ; and that death will con- sume them as soon as the most vile and worthless of the species ! III. If we glory it should be in the Lord. We should ascribe our talents, wealth, health, strength, salvation to him. We should rejoice, (1.) That we have such a Lord, so glorious, so full of mercy, so power- ful, so worthy of confidence and love. (2.) We should rejoice in our endow- ments and possessions as his gift. We should r^ejoice that we may come and lay every thing at his feet, and whatever may be our rank, or talents, or learning, we should rejoice that we may come with the humblest child of poverty, and sorrow, and want, and say, " not unto us, not unto us, but unto thy name give glory for thy mercy and for thy truth's sake." Ps. cxv. 1. See Note on 1 Cor. i. 31. 18. For not he who commendetk himself, &c. Not he who boasts of his talents and endowments. He is not to be judged by the estimate which he shall place on himself, but by the esti- mate which God shall form and ex- press. TI Is approved. By God. It is no evidence that we shall be saved that we are prone to commend ourselves. See Rom. xvi. 10. f But whom the Lord commendeth. See Note on Rom. i ii. 29. The idea here is, that men are 318 IL CORINTHIANS t.A.D.60 to be approved or rejected by God. He is to pass judgment on them, and that judgment is to be in accordance with his estimate of their character, and not according to their own. If he approves them they will be saved ; if he does not, vain will be all their empty boast- ing ; vain all their reliance on their wealth, eloquence, learning, or earthly honours. None will save them from condemnation ; not all these things can purchase for them eternal life. Paul thus seriously shows that we should be mainly anxious to obtain the divine favour. It should be the grand aim and purpose of our life ; and we should re- press all disposition for vainglory or self-confidence ; all reliance on our ta- lents, attainments, or accompUshments for salvation. Our boast is that WE HAVE SUCH A ReBEEMEB ; AND IN THAT WE ALL MAY GLORT. REMARKS. 1. We should have no desire to show off any peculiar boldness or energy of character which we may have. ver. 1, 2. We should greatly prefer to evince the gentleness and meekness of Christ. Such a character is in itself of far more value than one that is merely energetic and bold ; that is rash, authoritative, and fond of display. 2. They who are officers in the church should have no desire to ad- minister discipline, ver. 2. Some men are so fond of power that they always love to exercise it. They are willing to show it even by inflicting punish- ment on others ; and " dressed in a little brief authority" they are constantly seeking occasion to show their conse- quence ; they magnify trifles ; they are unwilling to pass by the slightest of- fences. The reason is not that they love the truth, but that they love their own consequence, and they seek every opportunity to show it. 3. All Christians and all Christian ministers are engaged in a warfare, ver. 3. They are at war with sin in their own hearts, and with sin wherever it exists on earth, and with the powers of darkness. With foes so numerous and so vigilant, they should not expect to live a life of ease or quietness. Peace, perfect peace, they may expect in hea- ven, not on earth. Here they are to fight the good fight of faith and thus to lay hold on eternal life. It has been the common lot of all the children of God to maintain such a war, and shall we expect to be exempt ] " Shall I be carried to the skies On flowery beds of ease, While others fought to win the prize, And sailed through bloody seas 1 " Are there no foes for me to face, Must I not stem the flood 1 Is this vile world a friend to grace, To help me on to God "J" 4. The weapons of the Christian are not to be carnal, but are to be spiritual, ver. 4. He is not to make his way by the exhibition of human passion ; in bloody strife ; and by acting under the influence of ambitious feelings. Truth is his weapon ; and armed with truth, and aided by the Spirit of God, he is to expect the victory. How different is the Christian warfare from others ! How different is Christianity from other sys- tems ! Mahomet made his way by arms, and propagated his religion amidst the din of battle. But not so Christianity. That is to make its way by the silent, but mighty operation of truth ; and there is not a rampart of idolatry and sin that is not yet to fall before it. 5. The Christian should be a man of a pure spirit, ver. 4. He is to make his way by the truth. He should there- fore love the truth, and he should seek to difl'use it as far as possible. In propa- gating or defending it, he should be always mild, gentle, and kind. Truth is never advanced, and an adversary is never convinced, where passion is evinced ; where there is a haughty man- ner or a belligerent spirit. The apos- tolic precepts are full of wisdom, " speaking the truth in love" (Epb. iv. 15), "in MEEKNESS INSTRCCTINO those that oppose themselves; if God peradventure will give them repentance to the acknowledging of the truth." 2 Tim. ii. 25. 6. In his warfare the Christian shall conquer, ver. 4, 5. Against the truth A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XL 219 of Christianity nothing has been able to stand. It made its way against the arrayed opposition of priests and empe- rors ; against customs and laws ; against inveterate habits and opinions ; against all forms of sin, until it triumphed, and " the banners of the faith floated from the palaces of the Cesars." So it will be in all the conflicts with evil. Nothing is more certain than that the powers of darkness in this world are destined to fall before the power of Christian truth, and that every stronghold of sin shall yet be demolished. So it is in the conflicts of the individual Christian. He may struggle long and hard. He may have many foes to contend with. But he shall gain the victory. His triumph shall be secure ; and he shall yet be enabled to say, " I have fought a good fight — henceforth there is laid up fur me A ciiowx." "The saints in all this glorious war Shall conquer, though they die; They see the triumph from afar. And seize it with their eye." 7. Yet all should feel their depend- ence on God. ver. 4. It is only through him and by his aid that we have any power. Truth itself has no power except as it is attended and directed by God ; and we should engage in our conflict feeling that none but God can give us the victory. If forsaken by him we shall fall ; if supported by him we may face without fear a "frowning world,"' and all the powers of the " dark world of hell." 8. We should not judge by the out- ;vard appearance, ver. 7. It is the Vieart that determines the character ; and by that God shall judge us, and by that we should judge ourselves. 9. We should aim to extend the gos- pel as far as possible, ver. 14 — 16. Paul aimed to go beyond the regions where the gospel had been preached, and to extend it to far-distant lands. So the "field" still "is the world." A large portion of the earth is yet unevangelized. fnstead, therefore, of sitting down quietly in enjoyment and ease, let us, like him, earnestly desire to extend the influence of pure religion, and to bring distant nations to the saving knowledge of the truth. 10. Let us not boast in ourselves, ver. 17. Not of our talents, wealth, learning, or accomplishments let us glory. But let us glory that we have such a God as Jehovah. Let us glory that we have such a Redeemer as Jesus Christ. Let us glory that we have such a sanctifier as the Holy Spirit. Let us acknowledge God as the source of all our blessings, and to him let us honestly consecrate our hearts and our lives. 11. What a reverse of judgment there will yet be on human character! ver. 17, 18. How many now commend themselves who will be condemned in the last day. How many men boast of their talents and morals, and even their religion, who will then be involved in indiscriminate condemnation with the most vile and worthless of the race. How anxious should we be, therefore, to secure the approbation of God ; and whatever our fellow-men may say of us, how infinitely desirable is it to be com- mended then by our heavenly Father. CHAPTER XL This chapter is connected in its general design with the preceding. The object of Paul is to vindicate himself from the charges which had been brought against him, and especially to vindicate his claims to the apostolic office. It is ironical in its character, and is of course severe upon the false teachers who had accused him in Co- rinth. The main purpose is to state his claims to the office of an apostle, and especially to show that when he men- tioned those claims, or even boasted of his labours, he had ground for doing so. It would seem that they had charged him with "/o%" in boasting as he had done. Probably the false teachers were loud in proclaiming their own praise, but represented Paul aa guilty of folly in praising himself. Ho therefore (ver. 1) asks them if they could bear with him a little further in his folly, and entreats them to do it. This verse contains the scope of the chapter ; and the remainder of the II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D 60. chapter is an enumeration of the causes which he had for this boasting, though probably each reason is adapted to some form of accusation brought against him. Having entreated them to bear with him a little farther, he states the reasons why he was disposed to go into this subject at all. ver. 2 — 4. It was not because he was disposed to sound his own praise, but it was from love to them. He had espoused them as a chaste virgin to Christ. He was afraid that their affections would be alienated from the Redeemer. He reminded them of the manner in which Eve was tempted ; and he reminded them that by the same smooth and plausible arts their affections might also be stolen away, and that ^ey might be led into sin. He reminds them that there was danger of their receiving another gospel, and expresses the apprehension that they had done it, and that they had embraced a deceiver, ver. 4. Having made this general statement of his design, Paul now goes more into detail in answering the objections against him, and in showing the reasons which he had for boasting as he had done. The statement in answer to their objections relates to the following points. (1.) He had supposed that he was not behind the chiefest of the apostles. He had supposed that he had claims to the apostolic office of as high an order as any of them. Called to the work as he had been, and labouring as he had done, he had regarded himself as having an .indisputable claim to the office of an apostle. True, they had charged him with being rude in speech, a charge which he was not disposed to deny, but in a far more important point than that he had showed that he was not disqualified for the apostolic office. In knowledge, the main qualification, he had not been deficient, as probably even his opponents were disposed to admit, ver. 5, 6. (2.) He had not deprived himself of the claims to the office and honours of an apostle by declining to receive from them a compensation, and by preaching the gospel without charge, ver. 7 — 9 Probably they had alleged that this was a proof that he knew that he had no claim to the honcrurs of an api«tle. He, therefore, states exactly how this was. He had received a support, but he had robbed other churches to do it. And even when he was with them, he had received supplies from a distant church in order that he might not be burdensome to them. The charge was, therefore, groundless that he knew that he had no right to the support due to an apostle. (3.) He declares it to be his fixed purpose that no one should prevent his boasting in that manner. And this he did because he loved them, and because he would save them from the snares of those who would destroy them. He therefore stated the true character of those who attempted to deceive them. They were the ministers of Satan, ap- pearing as the ministers of righteous- ness, as Satan himself was transformed into an angel of light, ver. 10 — 15. (4.) Paul claims the privilege of boasting as a fool a little farther, ver. 1 G. And he claims that as others boasted, and as they were allowed to do so by the Corinthians, he had also a right to do the same thing. They suffered them to boast ; they allowed them to do it even if they devoured them, and smote them, and took their property. It was but fair, therefore, that he should be allowed to boast a little of what he was and of what he had done. ver. 17 — 20. (5.) He goes, therefore, into an ex- tended and most tender description of what he had suffered, and of his claims to their favourable regard. He had all the personal advantages arising from birth which they could pretend to. He was a Hebrew, of the seed of Abra- ham, and a minister of Christ, ver. 21 — 23. He had endured far more labours and dangers than they had done ; and in order to set this before them he enumerates the trials through which he had passed, and stated the labours which constantly came upon him. ver. 23 — 30. Of these things, of his sufferings, and A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XI. 221 CHAPTER XT. TirOULD to God ye could ^^ bear with me a little in trials, and infirmities, he felt that he had a right to speak, and these consti- tuted a far higher claim to the confi- dence of the Christian church than the endowments of which his adversa- ries boasted. (6.) As another instance of peril and suffering, he refers to the fact that his life was endangered when he was in Damascus, and that he barely escaped by being lowered down from the wall of the city. ver. 31 — 33. The con- clusion which Paul doubtless intends should be derived from all this is, that he had far higher grounds of claim to the office of an apostle than his adversaries would admit, or than they could furnish themselves. He admitted that he was weak and subject to infirmities ; he did not lay claim to the graces of a polished elocution, as they did ; but if a life of self-denial and toil, of an honest devo- tion to the cause of truth at imminent and frequent hazard of life, constituted an evidence that he was an apostle, he had that evidence. They appealed to their birth, their rank, their endowments as public speakers. In the quiet and comfort of a congregation and church established to their hands ; in reaping the avails of the labours of others ; and in the midst of enjoyments, they coolly laid claims to the honours of the mi- nisterial office, and denied his claims. In trial, and peril, and labour, and poverty ; in scourges, and imprison- ments, and shipwrecks ; in hunger and thirst; in unwearied travelling from place to place ; and in the care of all the churches, were his claims to their respect and confidence, and he was willing that any one that chose should make the com- parison between them. Such was his " foolish" boasting ; such his claims to their confidence and regard. I. Would to God. Greek, ' I would' ("O^'Xif). This expresses earnest de- sire, but in the Greek there is no appeal 19* my folly : and indeed bear * with me. 2 For I am jealous over you » or, ye do bear. to God. The sense would be well ex- pressed by ' O that,' or < I earnestly wish.* Tf Ye could bear with me. That you would bear patiently with me ; that you would hear me patiently, and suffer me to speak of myself, t -?'* w*y folly* Folly in boasting. The idea seems to be, ' I know that boasting is generally foolish, and that it is not to be indulged in. But though it is to be generally regarded as folly, yet circumstances compel me to it, and I ask your in- dulgence in it.' It is possible also that his opponents accused him of folly in boasting so much of himself. ^ And indeed bear with me. Marg. Ye do bear. But the text has probably the correct rendering. It is the expression of an earnest wish that they would tole- rate him a little in this. He entreats them to bear with him because he was constrained to it. 2. For I am jealous over you. This verse expresses the reason why he was disposed to speak of his attainments, and of what he had done. It was be- cause he loved them, and because he feared that they were in danger of being seduced from the simpUcity of the gos- pel. The phrase ' I am jealous' (Z«\a)) means properly, I ardently love you ; I am full of tender attachment to you. The word was usual among the Greeks to denote an ardent affection of any kind (from ^'m, to boil, to be fervid or fervent). The precise meaning is to be determined by the connexion. See Note on 1 Cor. xii. 31. The word may denote the jealousy which is felt by an apprehension of departure from fidelity on the part of those whom we love : or it may denote a fervid and glowing at- tachment. The meaning here proba- bly is, that Paul had a strong attach- ment to them. 1| With godly jealousy. Greek, " with the zeal of God" (Gkv ^nKu>). That is, with very great or vehement zeal — in accordance with the 222 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. with godly jealousy : for I have espoused you " to one husband, a Hos. 2. 19, 20. b Le. 21. 13. Hebrew custom when the name God is used to denote any thing signally great, as the phrase ' mountains of God,' meaning very elevated or lofty moun- tains. The mention of this ardent attachment suggested what follows. His mind reverted to the tenderness of the marriage relation, and to the possi- bility that in that relation the affections might be estranged. He makes use of this figure, therefore, to apprize them of the change which he apprehended. t For I have espoused you, &c. The word here used (a^/ao^») means proper- ly to adapt, to lit, to join together. Hence to join in wedlock, to marry. Here it means to marry to another ; and fee idea is, that Paul had been the agent employed in forming a connexion, simi- lar to the marriage connexion, between them and the Saviour. The allusion here is not certain. It may refer to the custom which prevailed when friends made and procured the marriage for the bridegroom ; or it may refer to some custom like that which prevailed among the Lacedemonians where persons were employed to form the lives and manners of virgins and prepare them for the du- ties of the married life. The sense is clear. Paul claims that it was b}' his instrumentality that they had been united to the Redeemer. Under him they had been brought into a relation to the Sa- viour similar to that sustained by the bride to her husband ; and he felt all the interest in them which naturally grew out of that fact and from a desire to present them blameless to the pure Redeemer. The relation of the church to Christ is often represented by mar- riage. See Eph. v. 23 — 33. Rev. xix. 7 ; xxi. 9. Tf To one husband. To the Redeemer, t That 1 may jJresent y on as a chaste virgin to Christ: The al- lusion here, according to Doddridge, is, to the custom among the Greeks " of having an officer whose business it was to educate and form young women, that I chaste virgin * to Christ. 3 But I fear, lest by may present you as a any especially those of rank and figure, de- signed for marriage, and then to present them to those who were to be their husbands, and if this offieer through negligence permitted them to be cor- rupted between the espousals and the consummation of the marriage, great blame would fall upon hifrn." Such a responsibihty Paul felt. So anxious was he for the entire purity of that church which was to constitute " the bride, the Lamb's wife;" so anxious that all who were connected with that church should be presented pure in heaven. 3. But I fear. Paul had just com- pared the church to a virgin, soon to be presented as a bride to the Rsdeemer. The mention of this seems to have sug- gested to him the fact that the first wo- man was deceived and led astray by the tempter, and that the same thing might occur in regard to the church which he was so desirous should be preserved pure. The grounds of his fear were, (1.) That Satan had seduced the first woman, thus demonstrating that the most holy were in danger of being led astray by temptation ; and, (2.) That special efforts were made to seduce them from the faith. The persuasive arts of the false teachers ; the power of phi- losophy ; and the attractive and cor- rupting influences of the world, he had reason to suppose might be employed to seduce them from simple attachment to Christ. 1 Lest by any means. Lest somehow ((MxVac). It is implied that many means would be used ; that all arts would be tried ; and that in some way, which perhaps they little suspected, these arts would be successful, unless they were put constantly on their guard. ^ As the serpent beguiled Eve. See Gen. iii. 1 — 11. The word serpent here refers doubtless to Satan who was the agent by whom Eve was beguiled. See John viii. 44. 1 John iii. 8. Rev. xii. 9 ; XX. 2. PauJ did not mean tha* A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XI. 223 means, as the serpent beguiled | minds should be corrupted from Eve through his subtilty, so your the simplicity that is in Christ. they were in danger of being corrupted in the same way, but that similar efforts would be made to seduce them. Satan adapts his temptations to the character and circumstances of the tempted. He varies them from age to age, and applies them in such a way as best to secure his object. Hence all should be on their guard. No one knows the mode in which he will approach him, but all may know that he will approach them in some way. ^ Through his suhtilty. See Gen. iii. 1 . By his craft, art, wiles (sc Tg Trxnv^yU). The word implies that shrewdness, cunning, craft was employed. A tempter always employs cunning and art to accomplish his object. The precise mode in which Satan ac- complished his object is not certainly known. Perhaps the cunning consist- ed in assuming an attractive form — a fascinating manner — a manner fitted to charm ; perhaps in the idea that the eating of the forbidden fruit had en- dowed a serpent with the power of reason and speech above all other ani- mals, and that it might be expected to produce a similar transformation in Eve. At all events there were false pretences and appearances, and such Paul appre- hended would be employed by the false teachers to seduce and allure them. See on ver. 13, 14. % So your minds should be corrupted. So your thoughts should be perverted. So your hearts should be alienated. The mind is cor- rupted when the affections are alienated from the proper object, and when the soul is filled with unholy plans, and pur- poses, and desires. ^ From the sim- plicity that is in Christ. (1.) From simple and single-hearted devotednfss to him — from pure and unmixed attach- ment to him. The fear was that their affections would be fixed on other objects, and that the singleness and an/'/y of their devotedness to him ^^ould be destroyed. (2.) From his pure doctrines. By the admixture of philosophy ; by the opi- nions of the world there was danger that their minds should be turned away from their hold on the simple truths which Christ had taught. (3.) From that simplicity of mind and heart ; that childlike candour and docility; that freedom from all guile, dishonesty, and deception which so eminently character- ized the Redeemer. Christ had a single aim ; was-free from all guile ; was pure- ly honest ; never made use of any im- proper arts ; never resorted to false ap- pearances, and never deceived. His followers should in like manner be art- less and guileless. There should be no mere cunning, no trick, no craft in ad- vancing their purposes. There should be nothing but honesty and truth in all that tkey say. Paul was afraid that they would lose this beai>tiful simplicity and artlessness of character and man- ner ; and that they would insensibly be led to adopt the maxims of mere cun- ning, of policy, of expediency, of seduc^ tive arts which prevailed so much in the world — a danger which was imminent among the shrewd and cunning people of Greece ; but which is confined to no time and no place. Christians should be more guileless than even children are; as pure and free from trick, and from art and cunning as was the Redeemer himself. (4.) From the simplicity m worship which the Lord Jesus com- mended and required. The worship which the Redeemer designed to esta- blish was simple, unostentatious, and pure — strongly in contrast with the gorgeousness and corruption of the pagan worship, and even with the im- posing splendour of the Jewish temple service. He intended that it should be adapted to all lands, and such as could be offered by all classes of men — a pure worship, claiming first the homage of the heart, and then such simple external expressions as should best exhibit the homage of the heart. How easily might this be corrupted ! What temptations were there to attempt to corrupt it by those who had been accustomed to the 224 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. CO. 4 For if he that cometh magnificence of the temple service, and who would suppose that the reUgion of the Messiah could not be less gor- geous than that which was designed to shadow forth his coming ; and by those who had been accustomed to the splen- did rites of the pagan worship, and who would suppose that the true religion ought not to be less costly and splendid than the false religion had been. If so much expense had been lavished on false religions, how natural to suppose that equal costliness at least should be bestowed on the true religion. Ac- cordingly the history of the church for a considerable part of its existence has been little more than a record of the va- rious forms in which the simple worship instituted by the Redeemer has been corrupted, until all that was gorgeous in pagan ceremonies and splendid in the Jewish ritual has been introduced as a part of Christian worship. (5.) From simplicity in dress and manner of living. The Redeemer's dress was simple. His manner of living was simple. His re- quirements demand great simplicity and plainness of apparel and manner of Ufe. 1 Pet. iii. ,3—6. 1 Tim. ii. 9, 10. yet how much proneness is there at all times to depart from this ! What a be- setting sin has it been in all ages to the church of Christ I And how much pains should there be that the very sim- plicity that is in Christ should be ob- served by all who bear the Christian name! 4. For if he that cometh, &c. There is much difficulty in this verse in ascer- taining the true sense, and expositors have been greatly perplexed and divided in opinion, especially with regard to the true sense of the last clause, " ye might well bear with him." It is difficult to ascertain whether Paul meant to speak ironically or seriously ; and different views will prevail as different views are taken of the design. If it be supposed that he meant to speak seiiously, the sense will be, 'If the false teacher could re- commend a better Saviour than I have preacheth another Jesus» whom done, or a Spirit better able to sanctify and save, then there would be a pro- priety in your receiving him and tole- rating his doctrines.' If the latter, then the sense will be, 'You cannot well bear with me ,• but if a man comes among you preaching a false Saviour, and a false Spirit, and a false doctrine, then you bear with him without any difficulty.' Another interpretation still has been proposed, by supposing that the word " me" is to be supplied at the close of the verse instead of " him," and then the sense would be, ' If you re- ceive so readily one who preaches another gospel, one who comes with far less evidence that he is sent from God than I have, and if you show your- selves thus ready to fall in with any kind of teaching that may be brought to you, you might at least hear with me also.' Amidst this variety it is not easy to ascertain the true sense. To me it seems probable, however, that Paul spoke seriously, and that our translation has expressed the true sense. The main idea doubtless is, that Paul felt that there was danger that they would be corrupted. If they could bring a better gospel, a more perfect system, and proclaim a more perfect Saviour there would be no such change. But that could not be expected. It could not be done. If therefore they preach- ed any other Saviour or any other gos- pel ; if they departed from the trutlis which he had taught them, it would be for the worse. It could not be other- wise. The Saviour whom he preached was perfect, and was able to save. The Spirit which he preached was perfect, and able to sanctify. The gospel which he preached was perfect, and there was no hope that it could be improved Any change must be for the worse ; and as the false teachers varied from his in- structions, there was every reason to ap- prehend that th^r minds would be corrupted from the simplicity that was in Christ. The principal idea, there- fore, is, that the gospel which he preachal A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XI. 225 we have not preached, or if ye receive another spirit, which ye liave not received, or another" aGa. 1.7,8. was as perfect as it could be, and that any change would be for the worse. No doctrine which others brought could be recommended because it was better. By the phrase ' he that cometh' is meant doubtless the false teacher in Corinth. ^ Preacheth another Jesves. Proclaims one who is more worthy of your love and more able to save. If he that comes among you and claims your affections can point out another Christ who is more worthy of your confidence, then I admit that you do well to receive him. It is implied here that this could not be done. The Lord Jesus in his character and work is perfect. No Sa- viour superior to him has been provided ; none but him is necessary, t Whom ive have not preached. Let them show, if they can, that they have any Saviour to tell of whom we have not preached. We have given all the evidence that we are sent by God, and have laid all the claim to your confidence, which they can do for having made known the Saviour. They with all their pretensions have no Saviour to tell you of with whom we have not already made you acquainted. They have no claims, there- fore, from this quarter which we have not also, t Or if ye receive another spirit, &c. If they can preach to you another Sanctifier and Comforter ; or if under their ministry you have received higher proofs of the power of the Spirit in performing miracles ; in the gift of tongues; in renewing sinners and in comforting your hearts. The idea is, that Paul had proclaimed the existence and agency of the same Holy Spirit which they did ; that his preaching had been attended with as striking proofs of the pKCsence and power of that Spirit ; that he had all the evidence of a divine commission from such an influence at- tending his labours which they could possibly have. They could reveal no spirit better able to sanctify and save ; uoiio who had more power than the gospel, which ye have not ac- cepted, ye might well bear ^ with him. » or, with me. Holy Spirit which they had received under the preaching of Paul, and there was therefore no reason why they should be " corrupted" or seduced from the simple doctrines which they had received, and follow others. ^ Or another gos- pel, &c. A gospel more worthy of your acceptance — one more free, more full, more rich in promises ; one that revealed a better plan of salvation, or that was more fuH of comfort and peace. t Ye might well hear with him. Marg. ^'ivith me" The word him is not in the Greek ; but is probably to be sup- plied. The sense is, there would then he some excuse for your conduct. There would be some reason why you should welcome such teachers. But if this cannot be done ; if they can preach no other and no better gospel and Saviour than I have done, then there is no excuse. There is no reason why you should follow such teachers and forsake those who were your earliest guides in reli- gion. — Let us never forsake the gospel which we have till we are sure we can get a better. Let us adhere to the sim- ple doctrines of the New Testament until some one can furnish better and clearer doctrines. Let us follow the rules of Christ in our opinions and our conduct ; our plans, our mode of wor- ship, our dress, and our amusements, engagements, and company, until we can certainly ascertain that there are better rules. A man is foolish for mak- ing any change imtil he has evidence that he is Ukely to better himself; and it remains yet to be proved that any one has ever bettered himself or his family by forsaking the simple doctiines of the Bible, and embracing a philoso- phical speculation; by forsaking the scriptural views of the Saviour as the incarnate God, and embracing the views which represent him as a mere man ; by forsaking the simple and plain rules of Christ about our manner of life, our dress, and our words and actions, and era 'J26 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 5 For I suppose I " was not a whit behind the very chiefest apostles. 6 But though '/ he rude in o 1 Co. 15. 10. c. 12. 11, b 1 Co. 1. 17. 2. 1, 13. bracing those which are recommended by mere fashion and by the customs of a gay world. 5. Fur I suppose, Sec. I think that I gave as good evidence that I was com- missioned by God as the most eminent of the apostles. In the miracles which I performed ; in th^ abundance of my labours, and in my success, I suppose that I did not fall behind any of them. If so, I ought to be regarded and treated as an apostle ; and if so, then the false teachers should not be allowed to sup- plant me in your affections, or to seduce you from the doctrines which I have taught. On the evidence that Paul was equal to others in the proper proof of a commission from God, see Notes on ver. 21—30. 6. But though I be rude i7i speech. See Note, ch. x. 10. The word rendered rude here (iV/wT«?) means properly a private citizen, in opposition to one in a public station ; then a plebeian, or one unlettered or unlearned, in opposition to one of more elevated rank, or one who is learned. See Notes on Acts iv. 13. 1 Cor. xiv. 16. The idea is, my lan- guage is that of a plain unlettered per- son. This was doubtless charged upon him by his enemies, and it may be that he designed in part to admit the truth of the charge, f Yet not in knowledge. 1 do not admit that I am ignorant of the religion which I profess to teach. I claim to be acquainted with the doc- trines of Christianity. It does not ap- pear that they charged him with igno- rance. If it be asked how the admission that he was rude in speech consists with the fact that he was endowed by the Holy Spirit with the power of speaking languages, we may observe that Paul had undoubtedly learned to speak Greek in his native place (Tarsus in Cilicia), and that the Greek which he had learned speech, yet not ' in knowledge ; but we have been thoroughly made manifest "' among you in all things. 7 Have I committed an offence c Ep. 3. 4. d c. 12. 12. there was probably a corrupt kind, such as was spoken in that place. It was this Greek which he probably continued to speak ; for there is no more reason to suppose that the Holy Spirit would aid him in speaking a language which he had thus early learned than he would in speaking Hebrew. The en- dowments of the Holy Spirit were con- ferred to enable the apostles to speak languages which they had never learned, not in perfecting them in languages with which they were before acquainted. It may have been true, therefore, that Paul may have spoken some languages which he never learned with more fluency and perfection than he did those which he had learned to speak when he was young. See the remarks of the Archbishop of Cambray, as quoted by Doddridge in loc. It may be remarked, also, that some estimate of the manner of Paul on this point may be formed from his writings. Critics profoundly acquainted with the Greek language remark, that while there is great energy of thought and of diction in the writings of Paul ; while he chooses or coins most expressive words, yet that there is everywhere a want of Attic elegance of manner, and of the smoothness and beauty which were so grateful to a Grecian ear. t But we have been thoroughly made mafiifest, &c. You have known all about me. I have con- cealed nothing from you, and you have had ample opportunity to become tho- roughly acquainted with me. The meaning is, * I need not dwell on this. I need speak no more of my manner of speech or knowledge. With all that you are well acquainted.' 7. Have I comniiiled an offence Have 1 done wrong. Greek, * Have I committed a sin.' There is here a some- what abrupt transition from the j>ro A. D. 60.J CHAPTER XI. 2a7 in abasing myself that ye might be exalted, because I have preached to you the gospel of God freely ? 8 I robbed other churches, vious verse ; and the connexion is not very apparent. Perhaps the connexion is this. ' I admit my inferiority in re- gard to my manner of speaking. But this does not interfere vs^ith my full understanding of the doctrines which I preach, nor does it interfere with the numerous evidences which I have fur- nished that I am called to the office of an apostle. What then is the ground of offence 1 In what have I erred 1 Wherein have I shown that I was not qualified to be an apostle 1 Is it in the fact that I have not chosen to press my claim to a support, but have preached the gospel without charge 1' There can be no doubt that they urged this as an objection to him, and as a proof that he was conscious that he had no claim to the office of an apostle. See Notes on 1 Cor. ix. 3 — 18. Paul here answers this charge ; and the sum of his reply is, that he had received a support, but that it had come from others, a support which they had furnished because the Corinthians had neglected to do it. t In abasing myi^elf. By labouring with my own hands ; by submitting to voluntary poverty, and by neglecting to urge my reasonable claims for a support. 1 That ye might he exalted. In spiritual blessings and comforts. I did it because I could thus better promote religion among you. I could thus avoid the charge of aiming at the acquisition of wealth; could shut the mouths of gain- sayers, and could more easily secure access to you. Is it now to be seriously urged as a fault that I have sought your welfare, and that in doing it I have submitted to great self-denial and to many hardships ] See Notes on 1 Cor. ix. 18, seq. 8. / robbed other churches. The churches of Macedonia and elsewhere, which had ministered to his wants. taking wages of them, to do you service. 9 And when I was present with you, and wanted, I " was chargeable to no man : for that a Ac. 18. 3. 1 Th. 2. 9. Probably he refers especially to the church at Philippi (see Phil. iv. 5, 16), which seems to have done more than almost any other church for his support. By the use of the word " robbed" here Paul does not mean that he had ob- tained any thing from them in a violent or unlawful manner, or any thing which they did not give voluntarily. The word (io-vKUTA) means properly, *I spoiled, plundered, robbed,' but the idea of Paul here is, that he, as it were, robbed them, because he did not render an equivalent for what they gave him. They sup- ported him when he was labouring for another people. A conqueror who plunders a country gives no equivalent for what he takes. In this sense only could Paul say that he had plundered the church at Philippi. His general principle was, that "the labourer wjis worthy of his hire," and that a man was to receive his support from the people for whom he laboured (see 1 Cor. 7 — 14), but this rule he had not ob- served in this case. ^ Taking wages of them. Receiving a support from them. They bore my expenses, t To do you service. That I might labour among you without being supposed to be striving to obtain your property, and that I might not be compelled to labour with my own hands, and thus to pre- vent my preaching the gospel as I could otherwise do. The supply from other churches rendered it unnecessary in a great measure that his time should be taken off from the ministry in order to obtain a support. 9. And when I was present '.oith you. When I was labouring in order to build up the church in Corinth. ^ I was chargeable to no man. I was burdensome to no one; or more literally ' I did not lie as a dead weight upon you.' The word here used, which II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60, which was lacking to me, the " brethren which came from Mace- donia supplied : and in all things 1 have kept myself from being burdensome unto you, and so Mill I keep myself. a Ph. 4. 10, 15. occurs nowhere else in the New Testa- ment (»*T4vaVx«(3-i<), means, literally, to become torpid against, i. e. to the detri- ment of any one ; and hence to be bur- densome. According to Jerome, its use here is a Cilicism of Paul. The idea is that he did not lead a torpid, inactive life at the expense of others. He did not expect a support from them when he was doing nothing ; nor did he demand support which would in any sense be a burden to them. By his own hafnds (Acts xviii. 3), and by the aid which he received from abroad, he was sup- ported without deriving aid from the people of Corinth, t And in all things, &c. In all respects I have carefully kept mysetf from being a burden on the church. Paul had no idea of living at other men's expense when he was doing nothing. He did not, as a general thing, mean to receive any thing for which he had not rendered a fair equiva- lent - a just principle for ministers and for all other men. See ch. xii. 1 3. 1 0. As the truth of Christ is in me. That is, I solemnly declare this as in the presence of Christ. As I am a Christian man ; as I feel bound to de- clare the truth, and as I must answer to Christ. It is a solemn form of assevera- tion, equal to an oath. See Note on Rom. ix. 1. Comp. 1 Tim. ii. 7. t No man shall stop me, &c. Marg. This boasting shall not be stopped in me. See Note on 1 Cor. ix. 15. The idea here is, that Paul was solemnly deter- mined that the same thing should con- tinue. He had not been burdensome to any, and he was resolved that he would not be. Rather than be burden- some he had laboured with his own hands, and he meant to do it still. No man in all Achaia should ever have reason to say that he had been an 10 As the truth of Christ is in me, * no man shall stop me of this boasting in the regions of Achaia. 1 1 Wherefore ? because I love you not ? God knoweth. » this boasting shall not be stopped in me. idler, and had been supported by the churches when he was doing nothing. It was the fixed and settled purpose of his life never to be burdensome to any man. What a noble resolution ! How fixed were the principles of his life ! And what an instance of magnanimous self-denial and of elevated purpose ! Every man, minister or otherwise, should adopt a similar resolution. He should resolve to receive nothing for which he has not rendered a fair equivalent, and resolve if he has health never to be a burden to his friends or to the church of God. And even if sick he may yet feel that he is not burdensome to others. If he is gentle and grateful ; if he makes no unnecessary care ; and especially if he furnishes an example of patience and piety, and seeks the blessing of God on his benefactors, he furnishes them what they will usually esteem an ample equivalent. No man need be burden- some to his friends ; and all should resolve that by the grace of God they never will be. There is considerable variety in the MSS. here (see Mill on the place), but in regard to the general sense there can be no doubt. Nothing should ever hinder this boasting ; no- thing should deprive him of the privilege of sayi-ng that he had not been a burden. t In the regions of Achaia. Achaia was that part of Greece of which Co- rinth was the capital. See Note on Acts xviii. 12. 11. Wherefore, &c. It is not be- cause I do not love you. It is not from pride, or because I would not as willingly receive aid from you as from any other. It is not because I am more unwilling to be under obligation to you than to others. I have a deep and tender attach- ment to you ; but it is because I cau thus best promote the gospel, and ad A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XI 229 12 But what I do, that I will do, that I may cut off occasion from them " which desire occa- a Ga. 1. 7. Ph. 1. 15, &c. vance the kingdom of the Redeemer. Possibly it might have been thought that his unwillingness to receive aid from them was some pr^f of reserve towards them or want of affection, and this may have been urged against him. This he solemnly denies. 12. But what I do. The course of life which I have been pursuing I will continue to pursue. That is, I will continue to preach as I have done with- out demanding a support. I will labour with my own hands if necessary ; I will preach without demanding rigidly what I might be entitled to. t That I may cut off occasion. That I may give them no opportunity of accusing me of de- siring to grow rich, and of calumniating me. Paul meant that they should have no plausible pretext even for accusing him ; that no man should be able to say that he was preaching merely for the hire. ^ Which desire occasion. No doubt his enemies eagerly sought oppor- tunities of accusing him, and greatly wished for some plausible reason for charging him with that which would be disgraceful and ruinous to his character. Or it may mean that they desired oppor- tunity from the example of Paul to justify themselves in their course ; that they took wages from the church at Corinth largely, and desired to be able to say that they had his example. t That wherein they glory. Probably meaning that they- boasted that they preached the gospel gratis ; that they received nothing for their labours. Yet while they did this, it is not improbable that they received presents of the Co- rinthians, and under varioiis pretences contrived to get from them an ample support, perhaps much more than would have been a reasonable compensation. Men who profess to preach the gospel gratis usually contrive in various ways to get more from the people than those wro receive a regular and stipulated 20 sion ; that wherein they glory, they may be found even as we. 13 For such are false ''apostles, 6Ga.2. 4. 2Pe.2. 1. lJno.4. 1. Re. 2. 2. compensation. By taxing pretty libe rally their hospitality; by accepting liberal presents ; by frequent proclama* tion of their self-denial and their poverty, they usually filch large amounts from the people. No people were ever louder in praise of poverty, or in proclamation of their own self-denials than some orders of monks, and that when it might be said almost that the richest possessions of Europe were passing into their hands At all events, Paul meant that these men should have no opportunity from his course to take any such advantage. He knew what he had a right to (I Cor. ix.), but he had not urged the right. He had received nothing from the church at Corinth, and he meant to receive nothing. He had honestly preached the gospel to them without charge, and he meant still to do it. 1 Cor. ix. 18. They should, therefore, have no opportunity from his conduct either to accuse him of preaching for money, or of sheltering themselves under his example in pretending to preach for nothing when they were in fact obtain- ing large sums from the people, t They may be found even as we. That they may be compelled honestly to pursue such a course as I do, and be found to be in fact what they pretend to be. The sense is, ' I mean so to act that if they follow my example, or plead my authority, they may be found to lead an honest lite ; and that if they boast on this subject, they shall boast strictly according to truth. There shall be no trick; nothing underhanded or decep- tive in what they do so far as my example can prevent it.* 13. For such are false apostles. They have no claim to the apostolic office. They are deceivers. They pre- tend to be apostles ; but they have no divine commission from the Redeemer. Pau4 had thus far argued the case with- out giving them an explicit designation 230 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. p. CO. deceitful « workers, transforming themselves into the apostles of Christ. .' a Ph. 3. 2. Tit. 1. 10, 11. as deceivers. But here he says that ■len who had conducted thus ; who had attempted to impose on the people ; who nad brought another gospel, whatever pretences they might have — and he was not disposed to deny that there was much that was plausible, — were really impostors and the enemies of Christ. It is morally certain, from ver. 22, that these men were Jews ; but why they had engaged in the work of preaching, or why they had gone to Corinth, cannot with certainty be determined. Tf Deceitful workers. Impostors. Men who practise various arts to impose on others. They were crafty, and fraudulent, and hypocritical. It is probable that they were men who saw that great ad- vantage might be taken of the new religion ; men who saw the power which It had over the people, and who saw the confidence which the new converts were inclined to repose in their teachers; perhaps men who had seen the disciples to the Christian faith commit all their property to the hands of the apostles, or who had heard of their doing it (Comp. Acts iv. 34, 35), and who sup- posed that by pretending to be apostles also they might come in for a share of this confidence, and avail themselves of this disposition to commit their pro- perty to their spiritual guides. To suc- ceed, it was needful as far as possible to undermine the influence of the true apostles, and take their place in the confidence of the people. Thence they were ' deceHful (SoKtoi) workers,' full of trick, and cunning, and of plausible arts to impose on others. | TraJisform- ing themselves, &c. Pretending to be apostles. Hypocritical and deceitful, they yet pretended to have been sent by Christ. This is a direct charge of hypocrisy. They knew they were de- ceivers ; and yet they assumed the high claims of apostles of the Son of God. • 14. And no marvel. And it is not 14 And no marvel ; for Satan * himself is transformed into an angel of light. b Ge. 3. 1, 5. Re. 12. 9. wonderful, ver. 1 5. Since Satan him- self is capable of appearing to be an angel of light, it is not to be deemed strange that tihose who are in his service also should resemble him. f For Satan himself is transformed, &c. That is, he who is an apostate angel ; who is malignant and wicked ; who is the prince of evil, assumes the appearance of a holy angel. Paul assumes this as an indisputable and admitted truth, without attempting to prove it, and without referring to any particular in- stances. Probably he had in his eye cases where Satan put on false and de- lusive appearances for the purpose of deceiving, or where he assumed the appearance of great sanctity and reve- rence for the authority of God. Such instances occurred in the temptation of our first parents (Gen. iii. 1 — 6), and in the temptation of the Saviour. Matt. iv. The phrase ' an angel of light,' means a pure and holy angel, light being the emblem of purity and holiness. Such are all the angels that dwell in heaven ; and the idea is, that Satan assumes such a form as to appear to be such an angel. Learn here, (1.) His power. He can assume such an aspect as he pleases. He can dis- semble and appear to be eminently pious. He is the prince of duplicity as well as of wickedness ; and it is the consumma- tion of bad power for an individual to be able to assuiihe any character which he pleases. (2.) His art. He is long practised in deceitful arts. For six thousand years he has been practising the art of delusion. And with him it is perfect. (3.) We are not to suppose that all that appears to be piety is piety. Some of the most plausible appearances of piety are assumed by Satan and his ministers. None ever professed a pro- founder regard for the authority of God than Satan did when he tempted the Saviour. And if the prince of wicked- A. D. 60.1 CHAPTER XI. 231 15 Therefore it is no great thing if his ministers also be transformed as the ministers of righteousness ; whose end * shall be according to their works. a Ph. 3, 19. ness can appear to be an angel of light, we are not to be surprised if those who have the blackest hearts appear to be men of most eminent piety. (4.) We should be on our guard. We should not listen to suggestions merely because they appear to come from a pious man, nor because they seem to be prompted by a regard to the will of God. We may be always sure that, if we are to be tempted, it will be by some one having t great appearance of virtue and religion. (5.) We are not to expect that Satan will appear to man to be as bad as he «. He never shows himself openly to oe a spirit of pure wickedness ; or black and abominable in his character ; or full of evil and hateful. He would thus defeat himself. It is for liiis reason that wicked men do not believe that there is such a being as Satan. Though continually under his influence and 'led captive by him at his will,' yet they neither see him, nor the chains which lead them, nor are they willing to be- lieve in the existence of the one or the other. 15. Therefore it is no great things &c. It is not to be deemed surprising. You are not to wonder if men of the basest, blackest character put on the appearance of the greatest sanctity, and even become eminent as professed •preachers of righteousness. Tj Whose end shall be, &c. Whose final destiny. Their doom in eternity shall not be ac- cording to their fair professions and plausible pretences, for they cannot de- ceive God ; but shall be according to their real character, and their works. Their work is a work of deception, and they shall be judged according to that. What revelations there will be in the day of judgment, when all impostors shall be unmasked, and when all hypo- ! crites and deceivers shall be seen in their 16 1 say again, Let no man think me a fool ; * if otherwise, yet as a fool ^ receive me, that I may boast myself a little. 17 That which I speak, I ftc. 12. 6. 11. » or, suffer. true colours ! And how desirable is it that there should be such a day to dis- close all beings in their true character, and roiiEVEH to remove imposture and delusion from the universe ! 16. / say again. I repeat it. He refers to what he had said in ver. 1. The sense is, ' I have said much respect- ing myself which may seem to be fool- ish. I admit that to boast in this manner of one's own self in general is folly. But circumstances compel me to it. And I entreat you to look at those cir- cumstances and not regard me as a fool for doing it.' t Jf otherwise. If you fihink otherwise. If I cannot obtain this of you that you will not regard me as acting prudently and wisely. If you will think me foolish, .still I am con- strained to make these remarks in vindi- cation of myself, 'i Yet as a fool re- ceive me. Marg. " Suffer." See ver. 1. Bear with me as you do with others. Consider how much I have been pro- voked to this ; how necessary it is to my character ; and do not reject and despise me because I am constrained to say that of myself which is usually re- garded as foolish boasting. 1 That I may boast myself a little. Since others do it and are not rebuked, may I be per- mitted to do it also. See ver. 18, 19. There is something sarcastic in the words ' a little.' The sense is, ' Others are allowed to boast a great deal. As- suredly I may be allowed to boast a little of what I have done.' 17. T7iat which I speak. In praise of myself, t / speak it 7iot after the Lord. See Note on 1 Cor. vii. 12. The phrase here may mean either, I do not speak this by inspiration or claiming to be inspired by the Lord ; or more pro- bably it may mean, I do not speak this imitating the example of the Lord Jesus or strictly as becomes his follower. Ha 233 gpeak it " not after the Lord, but as it were foolishly, in this con- fidence * of boasting. 18 Seeing " that many glory II. CORINTHIANS the flesh, I Co. 7. 12. : Ph. 3. 3. 4. b c. 9. 4. 1 Co. 4. 10. was eminently modest, and never vaunted or boasted. And Paul probably means to say, * I do not in this profess to follow him entirely. I admit that it is a de- parture from his pure example in this respect. But circumstances have com- pelled me ; and much as I would pre- fer another strain of remark, and sensi- ble as I am in general of the folly of boasting, yet a regard to my apostolic office and authority urges me to this course.' Bloomfield supposes that the apostle is not speaking seriously, but that he has an allusion to their view of what he was saying. * Bo it so, if you think that what I speak, I speak not as I profess to do according to the Lord, or with a view to subserve the purposes of his religion, but as it were in folly, in the confidence of boasting, yet permit me to do it notwithstanding, since you allow others to do it.' It is not easy to settle which is the true sense of the passage. I see no conclusive evidence against either. But the for- mer seems to me to be most in accordance with the scope of the whole. Paul ad- mitted that what he said was not in exact accordance with the spirit of the Lord Jesus ; and in admitting this he designed probably to administer a deli- cate hint that all their boasting was a wide departure from that spirit, t -^5 it were foolishly. As in folly. It is to be admitted that to boast is in general foolish ; and I admit that my language is open to this general charge. ^ In this confidence of boasting. In confi- dent boasting. I speak confidently and I admit in the spirit of boasting. 18. Seeing that many glory, &c. The false teachers in Corinth. They boasted of their birth, rank, natural en- dowments, eloquence, &c. See ver. 22. Comp. Phil. ui. 3, 4. 1 I will glory also. I also will boast of my endow- fA D. 60 will glory after also. 19 For ye sufler fools gladly, seeing ye yourselves are wise. 20 For ye suflfer, if a man ments, which though somewhat different yet pertain in the main to the fiesh also. See ver. 23, seq. His endowments in the flesh, or what he had to boast of pertaining to the flesh, related not so much to birth and rank, though not in- ferior to them in these, but to what the fiesh had endured — to stripes and im- prisonments, and hunger and peril. This is an exceedingly delicate and hap- py turn given to the whole subject. 19. For ye suffer fools gladly. You tolerate or endure those who are really fools. This is perhaps, says Dr. Bloom- field, the most sarcastic sentence ever penned by the apostle Paul. Its sense is, 'You profess to be wondrous wise. And yet you who are so wise a people, freely tolerate those who are foolish in their boasting; who proclaim their own merits- and attainments. You may al- low me, therefore, to come in for my share, and boast also, and thus obJaip your favour.' Or it may mean, 'You are so profoundly wise as easily to see who are fools. You have great power of discernment in this, and have found out that I am a fool, and also that other boasters are fools. Yet knowing this, you bear patiently with such fools ; have admitted them to your favour and friend- ship, and I may come in among the rest of the fools, and partake also of your favours.' They had borne \vith the false apostles who had boasted of their I endowments, and yet they claimed to i be eminent for wisdom and discern ] ment. 20. For ye suffer, &c. You bear patiently with men who impose on you in every way, and who are constantly defrauding you, though you profess to be so wise, and you may bear with me ' a little, though I have no such intention. I Seriously, if you bear with boasters who intend to delude and deceive you in \.D.60.] CHAPTER XI. 233 brin^ you into bondage, if a man devour you, if a man take of you, various ways, you may bear with one who comes to you with no such inten- tion, but with an honest purpose to do good. \ If a man bring you into bond- age (jtrtTA^cy^ci). If a man, or if any one (f/ T)yu{gc;v) denotes a complete natural day, or twenty-four hours. ^ In the deep. To what this refers we do not now certainly know. It is probable, however, that Paul refers to some period when, having been shipwrecked, he was saved by supporting himself on a plank or fragment of the vessel until he ob- tained relief. Such a situation is one of great peril, and he mentions it, there- fore, among the trials which he had endured. The supposition of some com- mentators that he spent his time on some rock in the deep ; or of others that this means some deep dungeon ; or of others that he was swallowed by a whale, like Jonah, shows the extent to which the fancy is often indulged in interpreting the Bible. 26. In journeyings often. Of course subject to the fatigue, toil, and danger which such a mode of life involves. ^ In perils of waters. In danger of countrymen, in perils hy th# heathen, in perils in the city, zV. perils ill the wilderness, in peril* in the sea, in perils among false brethren ; losing my life at sea, or by floods, or bj crossing streams. \ Of robbers. Man) of the countries, especially Arabia through which he travelled were the* infested, as they are now, with robbers It is not impossible or improbable tha^ he was often attacked and his life en dangered. It is still unsafe to trave< in many of the places through which he travelled. ^ By mine own ccninlrymen. The Jews. They often scourged him ; laid wait for him ; and were ready to put him to death. They had deep enmity against him as an apostate, and he was in constant danger of being put to death by them. ^ By the heathen. By those who had not the true religion. Several instances of his danger from this quarter are mentioned in the Acts. II In the city. In cities, as in Derbe, Lystra, Philippi, Jerusalem, Ephesus, &c. 1 In the wilderness. In the desert, where he would be exposed to ambushes, or to wild beasts, or to hun- ger and want. Instances of this are not recorded in the Acts, but no one can doubt that they occurred. The idea here' is, that he had met with con- stant danger wherever he was, whether in the busy haunts of men or in the solitude and loneliness of the desert. t In the sea. See ver. 25. ^ Among false brethren. This was the crowning danger and trial to Paul, as it is to all others. A man can better bear danger by land and water, among robbers and in deserts, than he can bear to have his confidence abused, and to be subjected to the action and the arts of spies upon his conduct. Who these were he has not informed us. He mentions it as the chief trial to which he had been exposed, that he had met those who pretended to be his friends, and who yet had sought every possible opportunity to expose and destroy him. Perhapa D. 60.] CHAPTER XI. 239 27 In weariness and painful- ness, in watchings °' often, in hunger '''and thirst, in fastings often, in cold and nakedness. a Ac. 20. 31. h 1 Co. 4. 11. he has here a delicate reference to the danger which he apprehended from the false brethren in the church at Corinth. 27. la weariness. Resulting from travelling, exposure, labour, and want. The word kottoz (from KOTrroo, to beat, to cut) means, properly, wailing and grief, accompanied with beating the breast. Hence the word means toil, labour, wearisome effort, t And pain- fulness. This word {fjt.o^^o?') is a stronger term than the former. It im- plies painful effort; labour producing sorrow, and in the New Testament is uniformly connected with the word ren- dered " weariness" ( 1 Thess. ii. 9. 2 Thess. iii. 8), rendered in both those places " travail." ^ In watchings often. In loss of sleep, arising from abundant toils and from danger. See Note on ch. vi. 5. f In hunger and thirst. From traveUing among strangers, and being dependent on them and on his own personal labours. See Note, I Cor. iv. II. \ la fastings often. Either voluntary or involuntaiy. See Note on ch. vi. 5. ^ In cold and nakedness. See Note, 1 Cor. iv. 11. 28. Beside those things that are with- out. In addition to these external trials, these trials pertaining to cne body, I have mental trials and anxieties result- ing from the necessary care of all the churches. But on the meaning of these words commentators are not agreed. Rosenmiiller supposes that the phrase means ' besides those things that come from other sources,' "that I may omit other things." Beza, Erasmus, Bloom- ficld, and some others suppose that the passage means those things out of the regular routine of his office. Doddridge, "beside foreign affairs." Probably the sense is, ' Apart from the things beside" (Xa)§«§) except some man should guide mel" See also Acts xix. 35. Rom. iii. .3. Phil. i. 18. 1^ To visions. The word vision is used in the Scriptures often to denote the mode in which divine communications were usually made to men. This was done by causing some scene to appear to pass before the mind as in a landscape, so that the individual seemed to see a repre- sentation of what was to occur in some future period. It was usually applied to prophecy, and is often used in tho Old Testament. See my Note on Isa. i. 1, and also on Acts ix. 10. The vision which Paul here refers to was that which he was permitted to have of the heavenly world, ver. 4. He was permitted to see what perhaps no othet mortal had seen, the glory of heaven. % And revelations of the Lord. Which the Lord had made. Or it may mean manifestations which the Lord had made of himself to him. The word rendered revelations means properly an uncovering (c^Trcx-dw-^ic, from un-iKsc^vTr- TO), to uncover), and denotes a removal of the veil of ignorance and darkness, so that an object may be clearly seen , and is thus applied to truth revealed, because the obscurity is removed tnd the truth becomes manifest. 2. 1 knew a man in Christ. I was acquainted with a Christian ; the phrase " in Christ" meaning nothing more than A. D. 60.1 CHAPTER XII. 247 about fourteen * years ago, » A. D. 46. Ac. 22. 17. that he was united to Christ or was a Christian. See Rom. xvi. 7. The reason why Paul did not speak of this directly as a vision which he had himself seen was probably that he was accused of boasting, and he had admitted that it did not become him to glory. But though it did not become him to boast directly, yet he could tell them of a man concerning whom there would be no impropriety evidently in boasting. It is not uncommon, moreover, for a man to speak of himself in the third person. Thus Cesar in his Commentaries uni- formly speaks of himself. And so John in his gospel speaks of himself, ch. xiii. 23, 24 ; xix. 26 ; xxi. 20. John did it on account of his modesty, because he would not appear to put himself forward, and because the mention of his own name as connected with the friend.ship of the Saviour in the remarkable man- ner in which he enjoyed it, might have savoured of pride. For a similar reason Paul may have been unwilling to men- tion his own name here ; and he may have abstained from referring to this occurrence elsewhere because it might savour of pride, and might also excite the envy or ill-will of others. Those who have been most favoured with spiritual enjoyments will not be the most ready to proclaim it. They will cherish the remembrance in order to excite gratitude in their own hearts and support them in trial ; they will not blazon it abroad as if they were more the favourites of heaven than others are. That this refers to Paul himself is evident for the fol- lowing reasons. (1.) His argument required that he should mention some- thing that had occurred to himself. Any thing that had occurred to another woxild not have been pertinent. (2.) He applies it directly to himself (ver. 7), when he says that God took effectual measures that he should not be unduly exalted in view of the abundant revela- tions bestowed on him. t About four- teen years ago. On what occasion or (whether in the body I cannot tell ; or whether out of the body, where this occurred, or why he con- cealed the remarkable fact so long, and why there is no other allusion to it, is unknown ; and conjecture is useless. If this epistle was written, as is com- monly supposed, about the year 58, then this occurrence must have happened about the year 44. This was several years after his conversion, and of course this does not refer to the iratice men- tioned in Acts ix. 9, at the time when he was converted. Dr. Benson supposes that this vision was made to him when he was praying in the temple after his return to Jerusalem,when he was directed to go from Jerusalem to the Gentiles (Acts xxii. 17), and that it was intended to support him in the trials which he was about to endure. There can be little danger of error in supposing that its object was to support him in those remarkable trials, and that God designed to impart to him such views of heaven and its glory, and of the certainty that he would soon be admitted there, as to support him in his sufferings, and make him willing to bear all that should be laid upon him. God often gives to his people some clear and elevated spirit- ual comforts before they enter into trials as well as while in them ; he prepares them for them before they come. This vision Paul had kept secret for fourteen years. He had doubtless often thought of it; and the remembrance of that glorious hour was doubtless one of the reasons why he bore trials so patiently and was willing to endure so much. But before this he had had no occasion to mention it. He had other proofs in abundance that he was called to the work of an apostle ; and to mention this would savour of pride and ostenta- tion. It was only when he was com' pelled to refer to the evidences of his apostolic mission that he refers to it here. t Whether in the body I cannot tell. That is, I do not pretend to explain it. I do not know how it occurred. With the fact he was acquainted ; but hoti 9» II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 I cannot tell : God knoweth ;) it was brought about he did not know. Whether the body was caught up to heaven ; whether the soul was for a time jseparated from the body; or whether the scene passed before the mind in a vision, so that he seemed to have been caught up to heaven, he does not pre- tend to know. The evident idea is, that at the time he was in a state of insensibility in regard to surround- ing objects, and was unconscious of what was occurring, as if he had been dead. Where Paul confesses his own ignorance of what occurred to himself it would be vain for us to inquire ; and the question how this was done is im- material. No one can doubt that God had power if he chose to transport the body to heaven; or that he had power for a time to separate the soul from the body ; or that he had power to represent to the mind so clearly the view of the heavenly world that he would appear to see it. See Acts vii, 56. It is clear only that he lost all consciousness of any thing about him at that time, and that he saw only the things in heaven. It may be added here, however, that Paul evidently supposed that his soul might be taken to heaven without the body, and that it might have separate consciousness and a separate existence. He was not, therefore, a materialist, and he did not believe that the existence and consciousness of the soul was de- pendent on the body. 1[ God knoweth. With the mode in which it was done God only could be acquainted. Paul did not attempt to explain that. That was to him of comparatively little con- sequence, and he did not lose his time in a vain attempt to explain it. How happy would it be if all theologians were as ready to be satisfied with the knowledge of a fact, and to leave the mode of explaining it with God, as this prince of theologians was. Many a man would have busied himself with a vain speculation about the way in which it was done ; Paul was contented such an one caught up to the third heaven. with the fact that it had occurred. t Such an one caught up. The word which is here used (a^Tra^a) means, to seize upon, to snatch away, as wolves do their prey (John xii. 10) ; or to seize with avidity or eagerness (Matt, xi. 12) ; or to carry away, to hurry off by force or involuntarily. See John vi. 15. Acts vii. 39 ; xxiii. 10. In the case before us there is implied the idea that Paul was conveyed by a foreign force ; or that he was suddenly seized and snatched up to heaven. The word expresses the suddenness and the rapid- ity with which it was done. Probably it was instantaneous, so that he appeared at once to be in heaven. Of the mode in which it was done Paul has given no explanations ; and conjecture would be useless. ^ To the third heaven. The Jews sometimes speak of seven heavens, and Mahomet has borrowed this idea from the Jews. But the Bible speaks of but three heavens, and among the Jews in the apostolic ages also the heavens were divided into three. (1.) The aerial, including the clouds and the atmosphere, the heavens above us, until we come to the stars. (2.) The starry heavens, the heavens in which the sun, moon, and stars appear to be situated. (3.) The heavens beyoiid the stars. That heaven was supposed to be the residence of God, of angels, and of holy spirits. It was this up- per heaven, the dwelling-place of God, to which Paul was taken, and whose wonders he was permitted to behold — this region where God dwelt ; where Christ was seated at the right hand of the Father, and where the spirits of the just were assembled. The fanciful opinions of the Jews about seven heavens may be seen detailed in Schocttgen or in Wetstein, by whom the principal pas- sages from the Jewish writings relating to the subject have been collected. As their opinions throw no light on this passage, it is unnecessary to detail them here. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XII. 249 3 And I knew such a man, (whether in the body, or out of the body, I cannot tell : God knoweth ;) 3. And I knew such a man. It is not uncommon to repeat a solemn affirmation in order that it may be made more emphatic. This is done here. Paul repeats the idea, that he was in- timately acquainted with such a man, and that he did not know whether he was in the body or out of the body. All that was known to God. 4. Into paradise. The word para- dise (7r:i^dSiicri?) occurs but three times in the New Testament. Luke xxiii, 4.3. 2Cor.xii, 4. Rev. ii. 7. It occurs often in the Septuagint, as the trans- lation of the word garde?!. Gen. ii. 8, 9, 10. 15, 16; iii. 1,2,3. 8.16.23,24; xiii. 10. Num. xxiv. 6. Isa. Ii. 3. Ezek.xxviii. 13; xxxi. 8, 9. Joel ii. 3. And also Isa. i. 30. Jer. xxix. 5 ; and of the word (di"id) Pardes in Neh. ii. 8. Eccl. ii. 5. Cant. ii. 13. It is a word which had its origin in the language of eastern Asia, and which has been adopt- ed in the Greek, the Roman, and other western languages. In Sanscrit the word paradesha means a land elevated and cultivated ; in Armenian, j5orc?e5 denotes a garden around the house planted with trees, shrubs, grass for use and ornament. In Persia, the word denotes the plea- sure gardens and parks with wild ani- mals around the country residences of the monarchs and princes. Hence it denotes in general a garden of pleasure ; and in the New Testament is applied to the abodes of the blessed after death, the dwelling-place of God and of hap- py spirits ; or to heaven as a place of blessedness. Some have supposed that Paul here by the word "paradise" means to describe a different place from that denoted by the phrase " the third hea- ven ;" but there is no good reason for this supposition. The only difference is that this word implies the idea of a place of blessedness; but the same place is undoubtedly referred to. ^ And 4 How that he was caught up into paradise, " and heard un- speakable words, which it is not * lawful for a man to utter. a Lu. 23. 43. Re. 2. 7. i or, possible. heard unspeakable words. The word which is here rendered " unspeakable" (upa-.iTA) may either mean what cannot be spoken, or what oiu^t not to be spoken. The word means unutterable, ineffiible ; and whichever idea we attach to it, Paul meant to say that he could not attempt by words to do justice to what he saw and heard. The use of the word " words'^ here would seem to imply that he heard the language of exalted praise ; or that there were truths imparted to his mind which he could not hope to convey in any lan- guage spoken by men. t ^i^lch it is not lawful for a man to utter. Marg. "Possible." Witsius supposes that the word «|iv may include both, and Dod- dridge accords with the interpretation. See also Robinson's Lex. The word is most commonly used in the significa tion of lawful. Thus, Matt. xiv. 4. " It is not lawful for thee to have her." Acts xvi. 21. " Which it is not lawful for us to observe;" xxii. 25. "Is it lawful for you to scourge a man that is a Roman," &c. In the same sense of lawful it is used in Matt. xii. 2. 10. 12 ; XX. 15. Mark ii. 20 ; x. 2. When it refers to possibility/ it probably means moral possibility ; that is, propriety, or it means that it is right. It seems to me, therefore, that the word here rather means that it was not proper to give utterance to those things ; it would not be right to attempt it. It might be also true that it would not have been possible for language to convey clearly the ideas connected with the things which Paul was then permitted to see ; but the main thought is, that there was some reason why it would not be proper for him to have attempted to communicate those ideas to men at large. The Jews held that it v?as unlawful to pronounce the Tetragrammaton, i. e. the name of four letters (nin>), Jehovah ; and 250 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60 whenever that name occurred in their Scriptures, they substituted the name Adonai in its place. They maintain indeed that the true pronunciation is utterly lost, and none of them to this day attempt to pronounce it. But this was mere superstition ; and it is im- possible that Paul should have been in- fluenced by any such reason as this. The transaction here referred to is very remarkable. It is the only instance in the Scriptures of any one who was taken to heaven, either in reality or in vision, and who returned again to the earth and was then qualified to commu- nicate important truths about the hea- venly world from personal observation. Enoch and Elijah were taken to hea- ven ; but they returned not to converse with men. Elijah appeared with Moses in conversation with Jesus on the mount of transfiguration ; but they conversed with him only about his decease, which he was about to accomplish at Jerusa- lem. Luke ix. 31. There would have been no propriety for them to have spoken to Jesus of heaven, for he came down from heaven and was in heaven (John iii. 13), and they were not per- mitted to speak to the disciples of hea- ven. Lazarus was raised from the dead (John xi.), and many of the saints which had slept in their graves arose at the death of Jesus (Matt, xxvii. 52), but there is no intimation that they commu- nicated any thing to the living about the heavenly world. Of all the millions who have been taken to heaven, not one has been permitted to return to bear his testimony to its glories ; to witness for God that he is faithful to his pro- mises ; to encourage his pious friends to persevere ; or to invite his impenitent friends to follow him to that glorious world. And so fixed is the law ; so settled is the principle, that even La- zarus was not permitted to go, though at the earnest request of the rich man in hell, and warn his friends not to follow him to that world of wo. Luke xvi. 27 — 31. Mahomet indeed feigned that he had made a journey to heaven, and he attempts to describe what he saw; and the difierence between true inspiration and fake or pretended inspiration is strikingly evinced by the difference between Paul's dignified si- lence — verba sacro digna silentio (Ho- race) — and the puerilities of the prophet of Mecca. See the Koran, ch. xvii. As the diflference between the true religion and imposture is strikingly illustrated by this, we may recur to the principal events which happened to the impostor on this celebrated journey. The whole account may be seen in Prideaux's Life of Mahomet, p. 43, seq. He solemnly affirmed that he had been translated to the heaven of heavens ; that on a white beast, less than a mule, but larger than an ass, he had been conveyed from the temple of Mecca to that of Jerusalem ; had successively ascended the seven heavens with his companion Gabriel, receiving and returning the salutations of its blessed inhabitants; had then proceeded alone within two bow-shots of the throne of the Almighty, when he felt a cold which pierced him to the heart, and was touched on the shoulder by the hand of God, who commanded him to pray fifty times a day, but with the advice of Moses he was prevailed on to have the number reduced to five ; and that he then returned to Jerusalem and to Mecca, having performed a journey of thousands of years in the tenth part of a night. The fact that Paul was not permitted to communicate what he had seen is very remarkable. It is natural to ask why it is so ] Why has not God sent down departed saints to tell men of the glories of heaven *? Why does he not permit them to come and bear testimo- ny to what they have seen and enjoy- ed? Why not come and clear up the doubts of the pious; why not come and convince a thoughtless world* why not come and bear honourable testimony for God that he is faithful to reward his people? And especially why did he not suff*er Paul, whom he had permitted to behold the glories of paradise, to testify simply to what he had seen, and tell us what was there ] To these questions, so obvious, it ia impossible to give an answer that we A..D. 60.] CHAPTEH Xll. 251 can demonstrate to be the true one. But we may suggest some reasons which may furnish a plausible answer, and which may serve to remove some of the perplexity in the case. I would, there- fore, suggest that the following may have been some of the reasons why Paul was not permitted to communicate what he saw to men. (1.) It was de- signed for the support of Paul himself in view of the very remarkable trials which he was about to endure. God had called him to great toils and self- denials. He was to labour much alone ; to go to foreign lands ; to be persecuted, and ultimately put to death ; and it was his purpose to qualify him for this work by some peculiar manifestation of his favour. He accordingly gave him such iiews of heaven that he would be sup- ported in his trials by a conviction of the undoubted truth of what he taught, and by the prospect of certain glory when his labours should end. It was one instance when God gave peculiar views to prepare for trials, as he often does to his people now, preparing them in a peculiar manner for peculiar trials. Christians, from some cause, often have more elevated views and deeper feeling before they are called to endure trials than they have at other times — peculiar grace to prepare them for suffering. But as this was designed in a peculiar manner for Paul alone, it was not pro- per for him to communicate what he saw to others. (2.) It is probable that if there were a full revelation of the glories of heaven we should not be able to comprehend it; or even if we did, we should be incredulous in regard to it So unlike what we see ; so elevated above our highest comprehension ; pro- bably so unlike what we now anticipate is heaven, that we should be slow to receive the revelation. It is always difficult to describe what we have not seen, even on earth, so that we shall have any very clear idea of it : how much more difficult must it be to describe heaven. We are often incredulous about what is reported to exist in foreign lands on earth which we have not seen, and a long time is often necessary before we will believe it. 1 lie king of Siam, when told by the Dutch ambassador that water became so hard in his coun- try that men might walk on it, said, " I have often suspected you of falsehood, but now I know that you lie." So incredulous might we be, with our weak faith, if we were told what actually ex- ists in heaven. We should not im- probably turn away from it as wholly incredible. (3.) There are great truths which it is not the design of God to reveal to men. The object is to com- municate enough to win us, to comfort us, to support our faith, not to reveal all. In eternity there must be boundless truths and glories which are not needful for us to know now, and which, on many accounts, it would not be proper to be revealed to men. The question is not, do we know all, but have we enough safely to guide us to heaven, and to comfort us in the trials of life. (4.) There is enough revealed of heaven for our guidance and comfort in this world. God has told us what it will be in gene- ral. It will be a world without sin ; without tears ; without wrong, injustice, fraud, or wars ; without disease, pesti- lence, plague, death ; and it is easy to fill up the picture sufficiently for all our purposes. Let us think of a world where all shall be pure and holy ; of a world free from all that we now behold that is evil; free from pain, disease, death ; a world where * friends neve' depart, foes never come ;' a world where all shall be harmony and love — an^ where all this shall be ETERif al, and we shall see that God has revealed enough for our welfare here. The highes* hopes of man are met when we antici- pate A3f ETERNAL HEAVEKT ; the hcavioot trials may be cheerfully borne when W6 have the prospect of everlastuvg rest. (5.) One other reason may be assigned why it was not proper for Paul to dis- close what he saw, and why God ha* withheld more full revelations froo men about heaven. It is, that his pur pose is that we shall here walk by faith and not by sight. We are not to see th« reward, nor to be told fully what it is We are to have such confidence in Go"nal splendours, (c) The sinner will soon know fully what it is to lose heaven. A moment may make him fully sensible of his loss — for he may die ; and a moment may put him forever beyond the possibility of reaching a world of glory. 5. Of such an one will I glory. Of such a man it would be right to boast. It would be admitted that it is right to exult in such a man, and to esteem him to be peculiarly favoured by God. I will boast of him as having received peculiar honour from the Lord. Bloom- field, however, supposes that the words rendered " of such an one" should be translated " of such a thing," or of such 6 For though I would desire to glory, I shall not be a fool ; for I will say the truth : but now a transaction ; meaning * I can indeed justly boast of my being caught up to heaven as of a thing the whole glory of which pertains to him who has thus exalted me ; but of myself, or of any thing in me, I will not boast.* So Ro- senmviller explains it. But it seems to me that the connexion requires that we should understand it of a person, and that the passage is partly ironical. Paul speaks in the third person. He chooses to keep himself directly out of view. And though he refers really to himself, yet he would not say this directly, but says that of such a man they would admit it would be proper to boast. t Yet of myself Directl}'. It is not expedient for me to boast of myself. ' You would allow me to boast of such a man as I have referred to ; I admit that it is not proper for me to boast directly of myself.' t But in mine injirmities. My weaknesses, trials, pains, sufferings ; such as many regard as infirmities. See Note on ch. xi. 30. 6. For though I would desire to glory. I take this to be a solemn and serious declaration of the irony which precedes ; and that Paul means to say seriously, that if he had a wish to boast as other men boasted, if he chose to make much of his attainments and privileges, he would have enough of which to make mention. It would not be mere empty boasting without any foundation or any just cause, for he had as much of which to speak in a confi- dent manner pertaining to his labours as an apostle, and his evidence of the divine favour as could be urged by any one. 'I might go on to speak much more than I have done, and to urge claims which all would admit to be well- founded.' t / shall not be a fool. ' It would not be foolish boasting ; for it would be according to truth. I could urge much more than I have done ; I could speak of things which no one A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XII. 353 I forbear, lest any man should think of me above that which would be disposed to call in question as laying the foundation of just claims to my being regarded as eminently fa- voured of God ; I could seriously state what all would admit to be such.' t For I will say the truth. That is, ' What- ever I should say on this subject would be the simple truth. I should mention nothing which has not actually occurred. But I forbear, lest some one should form an improper estimate of me.' The apostle seems to have intended to have added something more, but he was checked by the apprehension to which he here refers. Or perhaps he means to say that if he should boast of the vision to which he had just referred ; if he should go on to say how highly he had been honoured and exalted by it, there would be no impropriety in it. It was so remarkable that if he confined himself strictly to the truth, as he would do, still it would be regarded by all as a very extraordinary honour, and one to which no one of the false teachers could refer as laying a foundation for their boasting, t Lest am/ man should think of me, &c. The idea in this part of the verse I take to be this. ' I desire and expect to be estimated by my public life. I expect to be judged of men by my deeds, by what they see in me, and by my general reputation in respect to what I have done in establishing the Christian religion. I am willing that my character and reputation, that the estimate in which I shall be held by mankind, shall rest on that. I do not wish that my character among men shall be determined by my secret feel- ings ; or by any secret extraordinary communication from heaven which I may have, and which cannot be sub- jected to the observation of my fellow- men. I am willing to be estimated by my public life ; and however valuable such extraordinary manifestations may be to me as an individual ; or however much they may comfort me, I do not wish to make them the basis of my 22 he seeth me to 6e, or that he heareth of me. public reputation. I expect to stand and be estimated by my public deeds ; by what all men see and hear of me ; and I would not have them form even a favourable opinion of me beyond that.' This is the noble language of a man who was willing to enjoy such a repu- tation as his public Ufe entitled him to. He wished to have the basis of his repu- tation such that all men could see and examine it. Unlike enthusiasts and fa- natics, he appealed to no secret im- pulses ; did not rest his claims for public confidence on any peculiar communica- tions from heaven ; but wished to be estimated by his public deeds. And the important truth taught is, that however much communion we may have with God ; however much comfort and sup port in prayer and in our favoured mo- ments of fellowship with God ; or how- ever much we may fancy in this way that we are the favourites of Heaven , and however much this may support us in trial ; still this should not be made the foundation of claim to the favour- able opinions of our fellow-men. By our public character ; by our well-known actions; by our lives as seen by men, we should desire to be estimated, and we should be satisfied with such a measure of public esteem as our deport- ment shall fairly entitle us to. We should seldom, perhaps, refer to our moments of secret, happy, and most favoured communion with God. Paul kept his most elevated joys in this re- spect, secret for fourteen years : — what an example to those who are constantly blazoning their Christian experience abroad, and boasting of what they have enjoyed ! We should never refer to such moments as a foundation for the estimate in which our character shall be held by our fellow-men. We should never make this the foundation of a claim to the public confidence in us. For all such claims ; for all the estimate in which we shall be held by men, we should be willing to be tried by oxa 354 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 7 And lest I should be exalted above measure through the abun- lives. Paul would not even make a vision of heaven ; not even the privilege of having beheld the glories of the upper luorld, though a favour conferred on no other living man, a ground of the estimate in which his character should be held ! What an example to those who wish to be estimated by secret raptures, and by special commu- nications to their souls from heaven ! No. Let us be willing to be estimated by men by what they see in us ; to enjoy such a reputation as our conduct shall fairly entitle us to. Let our com- munion with God cheer our own hearts ; but let us not obtrude this on men as furnishing a claim for an exalted stand- ing in their estimation. 7. And lest I should be exalted. Lest I should be spiritually proud ; lest I should become self-confident and vain, and suppose that I was a special favour- ite of Heaven. If Paul was in danger of spiritual pride, who is not 1 If it was necessary for God to adopt some special measures to keep him humble, we are not to be surprised that the same thing should occur in other cases. There is abundant reason to believe that Paul was naturally a proud man. He was by nature self-confident ; trust- ing in his own talents and attainments, and eminently ambitious. When he became a Christian, therefore, one of his besetting sins would be pride ; and as he had been peculiarly favoured in his call to the apostleship ; in his suc- cess as a preacher ; in the standing which he had among the other apostles, and in the revelations imparted to him, there was also peculiar danger that he would become self-confident and proud of his attainments. There is no danger that more constantly besets Christians, and even eminent Christians, than pride. There is no sin that is more subtle, insinuating, deceptive ; none that lurks more constantly around the heart and that finds a more ready entrance, than dance of the revelations, there was given to me a thorn " in the flesh, a Eze. 28. 24. Ga. 4. 14. pride. He who has been characterized by pride before his conversion will be in special danger of it afterwards ; he who has eminent gifts in prayer, or in conversation, or in preaching, will be in special danger of it ; he who is eminently successful will be in danger of it; and he who has any extraordinary spiritual comforts will be in danger of it. Of this sin he who lives nearest to God may be in most special danger ; and he who is most eminent in piety should feel that he also occupies a position where the enemy will approach him in a sly and subtle manner, and where he is in peculiar danger of a fall. Possibly the fear that he might be in danger of being made proud by the flattery of his friends may have been one reason why Paul kept this thing concealed for four- teen years ; and if men wish to keep themselves from the danger of this sin, they should not be forward to speak even of the most favoured moments of their communion with God. \ Through the abundance of the revelations. By my being raised thus to heaven, and by being permitted to behold the wonders of the heavenly world, as well as by the numerous communications which God had made to me at other times, t There was given to me. That is, God was pleased to appoint me. The word which Paul uses is worthy of special notice. It is that this " thorn in the flesh" was given to him, implying that it was a favour. He does not complain of it; he does not say it was sent in cruelty ; he does not even speak of it as an aflfliction ; he speaks of it as a gift, as any man would of a favour that had been bestowed. Paul had so clear a view of the benefits which resulted from it that he regarded it as a favour, as Christians should every trial. ^ A thorn in the fiesh. The word here used ((7KOAo4) occurs nowhere else in the New Testament. It means propeily any thing pointed or sharp, e. g. a stake A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XII. 255 the "messenger of Satan, to buf- c Job 2. 7. Lu. 13. 16. or palisade (Xen. Anab, 5. 2. 5) ; or the point of a hook. The word is used in the Septuagint to denote a thorn or prickle, as a translation of n"'D {sir), in Hos. ii. 6, " I will hedge up thy way with thorns ," to denote a pricking briar in Ezek. xxviii. 24, as a transla- tion of p'7D (sillon), meaning a thorn or prickle, such as is found in the shoots and twigs of the palm-tree ; and to de- note " pricks in the eyes" (Num. xxxiii. 55), as a translation of o^siy (sikkirn), thorns or prickles. So far as the word here used is concerned, it means a sharp thorn or prickle ; and the idea is, that the trial to which he refers was as troublesome and painful as such a thorn would be in the flesh. But whether he refers to some infirmity or pain in the flesh or the body is another question, and a question in which interpreters have been greatly divided in opinion. Every one who has become familiar with commentaries knows that almost every expositor has had his own opinion about this, and also that no one has been able to give any good reason for his own. Most of them have been fanciful ; and many of them eminently ridiculous. Even Baxter, who was subject himself to some such disorder, supposes that it might be the stone or gravel; and the usually very judicious Doddridge supposes that the view which he had of the glories of heavenly ob- jects so affected his nerves as to pro- duce a paralytic disorder, and particu- larly a stammering in his speech, and perhaps also a ridiculous distortion of the countenance. This opinion was sug- gested by Whitby, and has been adopted also by Benson, Mack night, Slade, and Bloomfield. But though sustained by most respectable names, it would be easy to show that it is mere conjecture, and perhaps quite as improbable as any of the numerous opinions which have been maintained on the subject. If Paul's speech had been affected, and his &ce distorted, and his nerves shattered fet me, lest I should be exalted above measure. by such a sight, how could he doubt whether he was in the body or out of it when this occurred ] Many of the Latin fathers supposed that some un- ruly and ungovernable lust was intended. Chrysostom and Jerome suppose that he meant the headache ; Tertullian an earache ; and Rosenmiiller supposes that it was the gout in the head, kopf- gicht, and that it was a periodical dis- order such as affected him when he was with the Galatians. Gal. iv. 13. But all conjecture here is vain ; and the numerous strange and ridiculous opi- nions of commentators is a melancholy attestation of their inclination to fanci- ful conjecture where it is impossible in the nature of the case to ascertain the truth. All that can be known of this is, that it was some infirmity of the flesh, some bodily affliction or calamity, that was like the continual piercing of the flesh with a thorn (Gal. iv. 13); and that it was something that was designed to prevent spiritual pride. It is not indeed an improbable supposition that it was something that could be seen by others, and that thus tended to hum- ble him when with them. 1 The mes- senger of Satan. Among the Hebrews it was customary to attribute severe and painful diseases to Satan. Comp. Job ii. 6, 7. Comp. Note on Luke xiii. 16. In the time of the Saviour ma- lignant spirits are known to have taken possession of the body in numerous cases, and to have produced painful bodily diseases, and Paul here says that Satan was permitted to bring this ca- lamity on him. t To buffet me. To buffet, means to smite with the hand ; then to maltreat in any way. The mean- ing is, that the effect and design of this was deeply to afflict him. Doddridge and Clarke suppose that the reference is here to the false teacher whom Satan had sent to Corinth, and who was to him the source of perpetual trouble. But it seems more probable to me that he refers to some bodily infirmity. Tho 256 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 8 For this " thing I besought a De. 3. 23. 27. Ps. 77. 2. 11. La. 3. 8. Mat. 26. 44. the Lord thrice, that it might depart from me. general truth taught in this verse is, that God will take care that his people shall not be unduly exalted by the manifesta- tions of his favour, and by the spiritual privileges which he bestows on them. He will take measures to humble them ; and a large part of his dealings with his people is designed to accomplish this. Sometimes it will be done, as in the case of Paul, by bodily infirmity or trial, by sickness, or by long and linger- ing disease ; sometimes by great poverty and by an humble condition of life ; some- times by reducing us from a state of affluence where we were in danger of being exalted above measure ; some- times by suffering us to be slandered and calumniated, by suffering foes to rise up against us who shall blacken our character and in such a manner that we cannot meet it ; sometimes by perse- cution ; sometimes by want of success in our enterprises, and if in the ministry, by withholding his Spirit; sometimes by suffering us to fall into sin, and thus greatly humbling us before the world. Such was the case with David and with Peter ; and God often permits us to see in this manner our own weakness, and to bring us to a sense of our dependence and to proper humility by suffering us to perform some act that should be ever afterward a standing source of our humiliation ; some act so base, so hu- miliating, so evincing the deep depravity of our hearts as forever to make and keep us humble. How could David be lifted up with pride after the murder of Uriah 1 How could Peter after having denied his Lord with a horrid oath 1 Thus many a Christian is suffered to fall by the temptation of Satan to show him his weakness and to keep him from pride ; many a fall is made the occasion of the permanent benefit of the offender. And perhaps every Christian who has been much favoured with elevated spiritual views and comforts can recall something which shall be to him a standing topic of regret and humiliation in his past life. We should be thankful for any calamity that will humble us ; and we should remember that clear and elevated views of God and heaven are, after all, more than a compensation for all the sufferings which it may be neces- sary to endure in order to make us humble. 8. For this thing. On account of this ; in order that this calamity might be removed. ^ I besought the Lord. The word " Lord" in the New Testa- ment, when it stands without any other word in connexion to limit its significa- tion, commonly denotes the Lord Jesus Christ. See Note on Acts i. 24. The following verse here shows conclusively that it was the Lord Jesus to whom Paul addressed this prayer. The answer was that his grace was sufficient foi him ; and Paul consoled himself by saying that it was a sufficient support if the power of Christ implied in that answer, should rest on him. He would glory in trials if such was their result. Even Rosenmuller maintains that it was the Lord Jesus to whom this prayer was addressed, and says that the So- cinians themselves admit it. So Grotius (on ver. 9) says that the answer was given by Christ. But if this refers to the Lord Jesus, then it proves that it is right to go to him in times of trouble, and that it is right to worship him. Prayer is the most solemn act of adora- tion which we can perform ; and no better authority can be required for pay- ing divine honours to Christ than the fact that Paul worshipped him and called upon him to remove a severe and grievous calamity. 1 Thrice. This may either mean that he prayed for this often, or that he sought it on three set and solemn occasions. Many commen- tators have supposed that the former is meant. But to me it seems probable that Paul on three special occasions earnestly prayed for the removal of this calamity. It will be recollected that the I Lord Jesus prayed three times in the A.D.60.] CHAPTER XII. 257 9 And he said unto me, My garden of Gethsemane that the cup might be removed from him. Matt, rxvi. 44. At the third time he ceased, and submitted to what was the will of God. There is some reason to suppose that the Jews were in the habit of pray- ing three times for any important bless- ing or for the removal of any calamity ; and Paul in this would not only con- form to the usual custom, but especially he would be disposed to imitate the example of the Lord Jesus. Among the Jews three was a sacred number, and repeated instances occur where an important transaction is mentioned as having been done thrice. See Num. xxii. 28 ; xxiv. 10. 1 Sam. iii. 8 ; xx. 41. 1 Kings xviii. 44. Prov. xxii. 20. Jer. vii. 4; xxii. 29. John xxi. 17. The probability, therefore, is, that Paul on three different occasions earnestly be- sought the Lord Jesus that this calamity might be removed from him. It might have been exceedingly painful ; or it might, as he supposed, interfere with his success as a preacher ; or it might have been of such a nature as to ex- pose him to ridicule ; and he prayed, therefore, if it were possible that it might be taken away. The passage proves that it is right to pray earnestly and repeatedly for the removal of any calamity. The Saviour so prayed in the garden ; and Paul so prayed here. Yet it also proves that there should be a limit to such prayers. The Saviour prayed three times ; and Paul limited himself to the same number of petitions, and then submitted to the will of God. This does not prove that we should be limited to exactly this number in our petitions ; but it proves that there should be a limit ; that we should not be over- anxious, and that when it is plain from any cause that the calamity will not be removed, we should submit to it. The Saviour in the garden knew that the cup would not be removed, and he acquiesced. Paul was told indirectly that his calamity would not be removed, and he submitted. We may expect no 22* grace is sufficient for thee : for such revelation from heaven, but we may know in other ways that the calamity will not be removed : and we should submit. The child or other friend for whom we prayed may die ; or the calamity, as, e. g. blindness, or deaf- ness, or loss of health, or poverty, may become permanent, so that there is no hope of removing it ; and we should then cease to pray that it may be re- moved, and we should cheerfully acqui- esce in the will of God. So David prayed most fervently for his child when it was alive ; when it was deceased, and it was of no further use to pray for it, he bowed in submission to the will of God. 2 Sam. xii. 20. 9. And he said unto me. The Sa- viour replied. In what way this was done, or whether it was done at the time when the prayer was offered, Paul does not inform us. It is possible, as Mac- knight supposes, that Christ appeared to him again and spake to him in an audi- ble manner. Grotius supposes that this was done by the 'yip na (Bath-qol) — " daughter of the voice," so frequently referred to by the Jewish writers, and which they suppose to be referred to in 1 Kings xix. 12, by the phrase, "a still small voice." But it is impossible to determine in what way it was done, and it is not material. Paul was in habits of communion with the Saviour, and was accustomed to receive revelations from him. The material fact here is, that the request was not granted in the exact form in which he presented it, but that he received assurance of grace to support him in his trial. It is one of the instances in which the fervent prayer of a good man, oflered undoubtedly in faith, was not answered in the form in which he desired, though substan- tially answered in the assurance of grace sufficient to support him. It furnishes, therefore, a very instructive lesson in regard to prayer, and shows us that we are not to expect as a matter of course that all our prayers will be literally answered, and that we should not be 358 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. my strength is made perfect in disappointed or disheartened if they are not. It is a matter of fact that not all the prayers even of the pious, and of those who pray having faith in God as a hearer of prayer, are literally answ^ered. Thus the prayer of David (2 Sam. xii. 16 — 20) was not literally answered; the child for whose life he so earnestly prayed died. So the Saviour's request was not literally answered. Mark. xiv. 36. The cup of suffering which he so earnestly desired should be taken away was not removed. So in the case be- fore us. Comp. also Deut. iii. 23 — 27. Job XXX. 20. Lam. iii. 8. So in numerous cases now, Christians pray with fervour and with faith for the re- moval of some calamity which is not removed ; or for something which they regard as desirable for their welfare which is withheld. Some of the reasons why this is done are obvious. (1.) The grace that will be imparted if the ca- lamity is not removed will be of greater value to the individual than would be the direct answer to his prayer. Such was the case with Paul; so it was doubtless with David ; and so it is often with Christians now. The removal of the calamity might be apparently a blessing, but it might also be attended with dangers to our spiritual welfare ; the grace imparted may be of perma- nent value and may be connected with the development of some of the love- liest traits of Christian character. (2.) It might not be for the good of the indi- vidual who prays that the exact thing should be granted. When a parent prays with great earnestness and with insubviisfiion for the life of a child, he knows not what he is doing. If the child lives, he may be the occasion of much more grief to him than if he had died. David had far more trouble from Absa- lom than he had from the death of the child for which he so earnestly prayed. At the same time it may be better for the child that he should be removed. If he dies in infancy he will be saved. But who can tell what will be his weakness. Most gladly there- character and destiny should he live to be a man 1 So of other things. (3.) God has often some better thing in store for us than would be the immediate answer to our prayer. Who can doubt that this was true of Paul 1 The promised grace of Christ as sufficient to support us is of more value than would be the mere removal of any bodily affliction. (4.) It would not be well for us, proba- bly, should our petition be literally answered. Who can tell what is best for himself 1 If the thing were obtained, who can tell how soon we might forget the benefactor and become proud and self-confident 1 It was the design of God to humble Paul ; and this could be much better accomplished by continuing his affliction and by imparting the pro- mised grace, than by withdrawing the affliction and withholding the grace. The very thing to be done was to keep him humble ; and this affliction could not be withdrawn without also forego- ing the benefit. It is true, also, that where things are in themselves proper to be asked. Christians sometimes ask them in an improper manner, and this is one of the reasons why many of their prayers are not answered. But this does not pertain to the case before us. Tf My grace is sufficient for thee. A much better answer than it would have been to have removed the calamity; and one that seems to have been entirely satisfactory to Paul. The meaning of the Saviour is, that he would support him ; that he would not suffer him to sink exhausted under his trials ; that he had nothing to fear. The affliction was not indeed removed ; but there was a promise that the favour of Christ would be shown to him constantly, and that he would find his support to be ample. If Paul had this support, he might well bear the trial ; and if we have this assurance, as we may have, we may welcome affliction, and rejoice that calamities are brought upon us. It is a sufficient answer to our prayers if we have the solemn promise of the A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XII. 259 fore will I rather glory " in my infirmities, that the power ''of Christ may rest upon me. a ver. 5. bl Pe. 4. 14. Redeemer that we shall be upheld and never sink under the burden of our neavy woes. 1 Mr/ strength is made perfect in weakness. That is, the strength which I impart to my people is more commonly and more completely manifested when my people feel that they are weak. It is not imparted to those who feel that they are strong and who do not realize their need of divine aid. It is not so completely manifested to those who are vigorous and strong as to the feeble. It is when we are conscious that we are feeble, and when we feel our need of aid, that the Redeemer manifests his power to up- hold, and imparts his purest consola- tions. Grotius has collected several similar passages from the classic writers which may serve to illustrate this expres- sion. Thus Pliny, vii. Epis. 26, says, " We are best where we are weak." Seneca says, " Calamity is the occasion of virtue." Quintilian, " All temerity of mind is broken by bodily calamity." Minutius Felix, " Calamity is often the discipline of virtue." There are few Christians who cannot bear witness to the truth of what the Redeemer here says, and who have not experienced the most pure consolations which they have known, and been most sensible of his comforting presence and power in times of affliction, t Most gludly, thrrefore, &c. I count it a privilege to be afflicted, if my trials may be the means of my more abundantly enjoying the favour of the Redeemer. His presence and imparted strength are more than a com- pensation for all the trials that I endure. t That the power of Christ. The strength which Christ imparts ; his power manifested in supporting me in trials, t May rest upon me (st/st^jiv^s-;)). The word properly means to pitch a tent upon ; and then to dwell in or upon. Here it is used in the sense of abiding ui3on, or reaiaining with. 10 Therefore I take pleasure in infirmities, in reproaches, in necessities, in persecutions, in distresses for Christ's sake : for The sense is, that the power which Christ manifested to his people rested with them, or abode with them in their trials, and therefore he would rejoice in afflictions, in order that he might par- take of the aid and consolation thus imparted. Learn hence, (1.) That a Christian never loses any thing by suf- fering and affliction. If he may obtain the favour of Christ by his trials he is a gainer. The favour of the Redeemer is more than a compensation for aH that we endure in his cause. (2.) The Christian is a gainer by trial. I never knew a Christian that was not ultimately benefited by trials. I never knew one who did not find that he had gained much that was valuable to him in scenes of affliction. I do not know that I have found one who would be willing to exchange the advantages he has gained in affliction for all that the most uninterrupted prosperity and the highest honours that the world could give would impart. (3.) Learn to bear trials with joy. They are good for us. They develope some of the most lovely traits of character. They injure no one if they are properly received. And a Christian should rejoice that he may obtain what he does obtain in affliction, cost what it may. It is worth more than it costs ; and when we come to die, the things that we shall have most occasion to thank God for will be our afflictions. And, O ! if they are the means of raising us to a higher seat in heaven, and placing us nearer the Re- deemer there, who will not rejoice in his trials ? 10. Therefore I take pleasure Since so many benefits result from trials; since my afflictions are the occasion of obtain- ing the favour of Christ in so eminent a degree, I rejoice in the privilege of suffering. There is often real pleasure in aflliction, paradoxical as it may ap- pear. Some of the happiest persons I S60 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. when I am weak, then am I strong. 11 I am become a fool in glorying : ye have compelled have known are those who have been deeply afflicted ; some of the purest joys which I have witnessed have been mani- fested on a sick-bed, and in the prospect of death. And I have no doubt that Paul, in the midst of all his infirmities and reproaches, had a joy above that which all the wealth and honour of the world could give. See here the power of religion. It not only supports, it comforts. It not only enables one to bear suffering with resignation, but it enables him to rejoice. Philosophy blunts the feelings ; infidelity leaves men to murmur and repine in trial ; the pleasures of this world have no power even to support or comfort in times of affliction ; but Christianity fur- nishes positive pleasure in trial, and enables the sufferer to smile through his tears. ^ hi infirmities. In my weak- nesses. See Note on ch. xi. 30. Tf In reproaches. In the contempt and scorn with which I meet as a follower of Christ. Note, ch. xi. 21. ^ In necessities. In want. See Notes on ch. vi. 4, 5. t In distresses for Christ's sake. Note, ch. vi. 4. In the various wants and diffi- culties to which I am exposed on ac- count of the Saviour, or which I suffer in his cause. ^ For when J am weak, then am I strong. When I feel weak; when I am subjected to trial, and nature faints and fails, then strength is im- parted to me, and I am enabled to bear all. The more I am borne down with trials, the more do I feel my need of divine assistance, and the more do I feel the efficacy of divine grace. Such was the promise in Deut. xxxiii. 25 : " As thy days, so shall thy strength be." So in Heb. xi. 24 : " Who out of weak- ness were made strong." What Chris- tian has not experienced this, and been able to say that when he felt himself weak and felt like sinking under the accumulation of many trials, he has found his strength according to his day, me : for I ought to have been commended of you: for * in nothing am I behind the very ttc. 11.5. and felt an arm of power supporting himl It is then that the Redeemer manifests himself in a peculiar manner; and then that the excellency of the re- ligion of Christ is truly seen and its power appreciated and felt. 1 1. I am become a fool in glorying. The meaning of this expression I take to be this. ' I have been led along in speakingof myself until I admit I appear foolish in this kind of boasting. It is folly to do it, and I would not have en- tered on it unless I had been driven to it by my circumstances and the necessi- ty which was imposed on me of speak- ing of myself.' Paul doubtless desired that what he had said of himself should not be regarded as an example for others to follow. Religion repressed all vain boasting and self-exultation; and to prevent others from falling into a habit of boasting, and then pleading his example eis an apology, he is care- ful to say that he regarded it as folly ; and that he would by no means have done it if the circumstances of the case had not constrained him. If any one, there- fore, is disposed to imitate Paul in speaking of himself and what he has done, let him do it only when he is in circumstances like Paul, and when the honour of religion and his usefulness imperiously demand it ; and let him not forget that it was the deliberate convic- tion of Paul that boasting was the characteristic of a fool! ^ Ye have compelled me. You have made it ne- cessary for me to vindicate my character and to state the evidence of my divine commission as an apostle. ^ For 1 ought to have been commended of you. By you. Then this boasting, so foolish, would have been unnecessary. What a delicate reproof ! All the fault of this foolish boasting was theirs. They knew him intimately. They had de- rived great benefits from his ministry, and they were bound in gratitude and A.. D. 60] CHAPTER XII. 261 chiefest apostles, though « I be nothing. a Lu. 17. 10. 1 Co. 3. 7. Ep. 3. 8. from a regard to right and truth to vindicate him. But they had not done it ; and hence, through their fault, he had been compelled to go into this un- pleasant vindication of his own charac- ter. T! For in nothing am I behind the very chiefest apostles. Neither in the evidences of my call to the apostolic office (see 1 Cor. ix. 1, seq.) ; nor in the endowments of the Spirit ; nor in my success ; nor in the proofs of a di- vine commission in the power of work- ing miracles. See Note on ch. xi. 5. ^ Though I he nothing. This ex- pression was either used in sarcasm or seriously. According to the former sup- position it means, that he was regarded as nothing ; that the false apostles spoke of him as a mere nothing, or as having no claims to the office of an apostle. This is the opinion of Clarke, and many of the recent com- mentators. Bloomfield inclines to this. According to the latter view, it is an expression of humility on the part of Paul, and is designed to express his deep sense of his unworthiness in view of his past life — a conviction deepened by the exalted privileges conferred on him, and the exalted rank to which he had been raised as an apostle. This was the view of most of the early commen- tators. Doddridge unites the two. It is not possible to determine with cer- tainty which is the true interpretation ; but it seems to me that the latter view best accords with the scope of the pas- sage, and with what we have reason to suppose the apostle would say at this time. It is true that in this discussion (ch. x. seq.) there is much that is sar- castic. But in the whole strain of the passage before us he is serious. He is speaking of his sufferings, and of the evidences that he was raised to elevated rank as an apostle, and it is not quite natural to suppose that he would throw \ m a sarcastic remark just in the midst i of this discussion. Besides, this inter- 1 12 Truly the signs * of an apostle were wrought among b 1 Co. 9. 2. pretation accords exactly with what he says, 1 Cor. xv. 9: "For I am the least of all the apostles, that am not meet to be called an apostle." If this be the correct interpretation, then it teaches, (1.) That the highest attain- ments in piety are not inconsistent with the deepest sense of our nothingness and unworthiness. (2.) That the most distinguished favours bestowed on us by God are consistent with the lowest humility. (3.) That those who are most favoured in the Christian life, and most honoured by God, should not be un- willing to take a low place, and to regard and speak of themselves as nothin"-. Compared with God, what are they ] — Nothing. Compared with the angels, what are they ? — Nothing. As creatures compared with the vast universe, what are we ? — Nothing. An atom, a speck. Compared with other Christians, the eminent saints who have lived before us, what are we? Compared with what we ought to be, and might be, what are we] — Nothing. Let a man look over his past life, and see how vile and unworthy it has been ; let him look at God, and see how great and glo- rious he is; let him look at the vast universe, and see how immense it is ; let him think of the angels, and reflect how pure they are ; let him think of what he might have been, of how much more he might have done for his Saviour ; let him look at his body, and think how frail it is, and how soon it must return to the dust ; and no matter how elevated his rank among his fellow-worms, and no matter how much God has favoured him as a Christian or a minister, he will feel, if he feels right, that he is nothing The most elevated saints are distinguish- ed for the deepest humility ; those who are nearest to God feel most their dis- tance ; they who are to occupy the highest place in heaven feel most deeply that they are unv^orthy of the lowest. 12. Truly the signs of an apostle. II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. you in all patience, in signs, and wonders, and mighty deeds. 1 3 For what is it wherein you were inferior to other churches, Such miracles as the acknowledged apostles worked. Such *' signs" or evi- dences that they were divinely com- missioned. See Notes on Mark xvi. 17. Acts ii. 22. Rom. xv. 19. f Were wrought among you. That is, by me. See Note, 1 Cor. ix. 2. 1 In all patience. I performed those works notwithstand- ing the opposition which I met with. I patiently persevered in furnishing the evidence of my divine commission. There was a succession of miracles de- monstrating that I was from God, not- withstanding the unreasonable opposi- tion which I met with, until I convinced you that I was called to the office of an apostle. ^ In signs and wonders. In working miracles. Comp. Note, Acts ii. 22. What these miracles at Corinth were, we are not distinctly informed. They probably, however, were similar to those WTought in other places, in healing the sick, &c. ; the most benevo- lent as it was one of the most decisive proofs of the divine power. 13. For ivhat is it, &c. This verse contains a striking mixture of sarcasm and irony, not exceeded, says Bloom- field, by any example in Demosthenes. The sense is, ' I have given among you the most ample proofs of my apostolic commission. I have conferred on you the highest favours of the apostolic office. In these respects you are supe- rior to all other churches. In one re- spect only are you inferior — it is in this, that you have not been burdened with the privilege of supporting me. If you had had this, you would have been inferior to no others. But this was owing to me ; and I pray that you will forgive me this. I might have urged it ; I might have claimed it ; I might have given you the privilege of becom- ing equal to the most favoured in all respects. But I have not pressed it, and you have not done it, and I ask your except it be that I " myself was not burdensome to you ? forgive me this wrong. 14 Behold, the third time I oc.U. 9. pardon.' There is a delicate insinuation that they had not contributed to his wants (see Note, ch. xi. 8) ; an intima- tion that it was a privilege to contribute to the support of the gospel, and that Paul might have been " burdensome to them" (see Notes on 1 Cor.ix. 1--12) ; and an admission that he was in part to blame for this, and had not in this respect given them an opportunity to equal other churches in all respects % Was not burdensome to you. See this explained in the Notes on ch. x. 8. If Forgive me this wrong. ' If it be a fault, pardon it. Forgive me that I did not give you this opportunity to be equal to other churches. It is a privi- lege to contribute to the support of the gospel, and they who are permitted to do it should esteem themselves highly favoured. I pray you to pardon me for depriving you of any of your Chris- tian privileges.' What the feelings of the Corinthians were about forgiving Paul for this we know not ; but most churches would be as ready to forgive a minister for this as for any other offence. 14. Behold, the third time, lam ready to come to you. That is, this is the third time that I have purposed to come and see you, and have made preparation for it. He does not mean that he had been twice with them and was now coming the third time, but that he had twice before intended to go and had been disappointed. See 1 Cor. xvi. 5. 2 Cor. i. 16, 16. His purpose had been to visit them on his way to Macedonia, and again on his return from Macedo- nia. He had now formed a third reso- lution, which he had a prospect of carry- ing into execution, t And I will not be burdensome to you. I resolve still, as I have done before, not to receive a compensation that shall be oppressive to you. See Notes on ch. xi. 9, 10, A. D. 60.] CHAPTER Xll. 263 am ready to come to you ; and I will not be burdensome to you : for * I seek not yours, but you : for the children ought not to lay olCo. 10. 33. lTh.2.8. 5 For I seek not yours, hut you. I de- sire not to obtain your property, but to save your souls. This was a noble reso- lution ; and it is the resolution which should be formed by every minister of the gospel. While a minister of Christ has a claim to a competent support, his main purpose should not be to obtain such a support. It should be the higher and nobler object of winning souls to the Redeemer. See Paul's conduct in this respect explained in the Notes on Acts XX. 33. \ For the children, &c. There is great delicacy and address in this sentiment. The meaning is, * It is not natural and usual for children to make provisions for their parents. The common course of events and of duty is, for parents to make provision for their offspring. I, therefore, your spiritual father, choose to act in the same way. I make provision for your spiritual wants ; I labour and toil for you as a father does for his children. I seek your welfare, as he does, by constant self-denial. In return, I do not ask you to provide for me, any more than a father ordinarily expects his children to provide for him. I am willing to labour as he does, content with doing my duty, and promoting the welfare of those under me.' The words rendered " ought not" (cu h<^iiKii) are to be understood in a comparative sense. Paul does not mean that a child ought never to provide for his parents, or to lay any thing up for a sick, a poor, and an infirm father, but that the duty of doing that was slight and unusual compared with the duty of a parent to provide for his children. The one- was of comparatively rare oc- currence ; the other was constant and was the ordinary course of duty. It is a matter of obligation for a child to pro- vide for an aged and helpless parent ; but commonly the duty is that of a pa- rent to provide for hb children. Paul up for the parents, but the parents for the children. 15 And I will very gladly spend and be spent for ^ you ; » your souls. felt like a father toward the church in Corinth ; and he was willing, therefore, to labour for them without compensa- tion. 15. And I will very gladly spend. I am willing to spend my strength, and time, and life, and all that I have for your welfare, as a father cheerfully does for his children. Any expense which may be necessary to promote your salva- tion I am willing to submit to. The labour of a father for his children is cheerful and pleasant. Such is his love for them that he delights in toil for their sake and that he may make them hap- py. The toil of a pastor for his flock should be cheerful. He should be will- ing to engage in unremitted efforts for their welfare ; and if he has any right feeling he will find a pleasure in that toil. He will not grudge the time de- manded ; he will not be grieved that it exhausts his strength, or his life, any more than a father will who toils for his family. And as the pleasures of a father who is labouring for his children are among the purest and most pleasant which men ever enjoy, so it is with a pastor. Perhaps, on the whole, the pleasantest employment in life is that connected with the pastoral office ; the happiest moments known on earth are in the duties, arduous as they are, of the pastoral relation. God thus, as in the relation of a father, tempers toil and pleasure together; and accompanies most arduous labours with present and abundant reward, t Be spent. Be exhausted and worn out in my labours. So the Greek word means. Paul was willmg that his powers should be en- tirely exhausted and his life consumed in this service. ^ For you. Marg. as in the Greek, for your souls. So it should have been rendered. So Tindal renders it. The sense is, that he wa.s willing to become wholly exhausted if 264 II CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. though the more abundantly 1 1 burden you : nevertheless, being love you, the less I be loved. crafty, I caught you with guile. 16 But be it so, I did not) 17 Did I make a gain of you by it he might secure the salvation of their souls, f Though the more abun- dantly I love you, &c. This is design- ed doubtless as a gentle reproof. It refers to the fact that notwithstanding the tender attachment which he had evinced for them, they had not mani- fested the love in return which he had had a right to expect It is possible that there may be an allusion to the case of a fond, doting parent. It sometimes happens that a parent fixes his affections with undue degree on some one of his children ; and in such cases it is not uncommon that the child evinces special ingratitude and want of love. Such may be the allusion here — that Paul had fixed his affections on them like a fond, doting father, and that he had met with a return by no means con-es- ponding with the fervour of his attach- ment ; yet still he was willing, like such a father, to exhaust his time and strength for their welfare. The doctrine is, that we should be willing to labour and toil for the good of others, even when they evince great ingratitude. The proper end of labouring for their welfare is not to excite their gratitude, but to obey the will of God; and no matter whether others are grateful or not ; whether they love us or not ; whether we can promote our popularity with them or not, let us do them good always. It better shows the firmness of our Christian principle to endeavour to benefit others when they love us the less for all our attempts, than it does to attempt to do good on the swelling tide of poj)ular favour. 16. But be it so. This is evidently a charge of his enemies ; or at least a charge which it might be supposed they would make. Whether they ever in fact made it, or whether the apostle merely anticipates an objection, it is im- possible to determine. It is clearly to be regarded as the la7iguagc of objectors ; for, (I.) It can never be supposed that Paul would state as a serious matter that he had caught them with deceit or fraud. (2.) He answers it as an objection in the following verse. The meaning is, ' We admit that you did not burden us. You did not exact a support from us. But all this was mere trick. You accomplish the same thing in another way. You professed when with us not to seek our property but our souls. But in various ways you contrived to get our money, and to secure your object. You made others the agents for doing this, and sent them among us under various pretexts to gain money from us.' It will be remembered that Paul had sent Titus among them to take up the collection for the poor saints in Judea (ch. viii. 6), and it is not at all improbable that some there had charged Paul with making use of this pretence only to obtain money for his own private use. To guard against this charge, was one of the reasons why Paul was so anxious to have some per- sons appointed by the church to take charge of the contribution. See 1 Cor. xvi. 'S. Comp. Notes on 2 Cor. viii. 19 — 21. ^ Being crafty. Being cun- ning. That is, by sending persons to obtain money on diilerent pretences. t / caught you with guile. I took you by deceit or fraud. That is, making use of fraud in pretending that the money was for poor and afflicted saints, when in reality it was for my own use. It is impossible that Paul should have ever admitted this of himself; and they greatly pervert the passage who suppose that it applies to him, and then plead that it is right to make use of guile in accompUshing their purposes. Paul never carried lus measures by dis- honesty, nor did he ever justify fraud Comp. Notes on Acts xxiii. 6. 17. Did I make a gain, &c. In refuting this slander, Paul appeals boldly to the facts, and to what they knew. '■ Name the man, says he, who has thus A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XII. by any of them whom I sent unto you ? 18 1 desired Titus, * and with him I sent a brother : * Did Titus make a gain of you ? walked we not in the same spirit? walked we not in the same steps ? a c. 7. 2. b c. 8. 6. defrauded you under my instructions. If the charge is well-founded, let him be specified, and let the mode in which it was done be distinctly stated.' The phrase " make a gain" (from TrxavatTsa), means properly to have an advantage ; then to take advantage, to seek unlawful gain. Here Paul asks whether he had defrauded them by means of any one whom he had sent to them. 18. I desired Titus. To go and complete the collection which you had commenced. See ch. viii. 6. f And with him / sent a brother. See Note on ch. viii. 18. t Did Titus make a gain of you ? They knew that he did not. They had received him kindly, treated him with affection, and sent him away with every proof of confidence and respect. See ch. vii. 7. How then could they now pretend that he had defrauded them ? t Walked we not in the same spirit ? Did not all his actions resemble mine"? Was there not the same proof of honesty, sincerity, and love which I have ever manifested 1 This is a very delicate turn. Paul's course of life when with them they admitted was free from guile and from any attempt to get money by impro- per means. They charged him only with attempting it by means of others. He now boldly appeals to them and jsks whether Titus and he had not in fact acted in the same manner; and whether they had not alike evinced a spirit free from covetousness and jeceit ? 1 9. Again, think ye that we excuse ourselves unto you ? See Note on ch. V. 12. The sense is, do not sup- pose that this is said from mere anxiety 23 19 Again, think ye tliat we excuse ourselves <=unto you ? we speak before God in Christ: but we do all things, dearly beloved, for your edifying. 2b For I fear, lest, when ''I come, I shall not find you such as I would, and that I shall be c c. 5. 12. d 1 Co. 4. 21. c. 13. 2. m. to obtain your favour, or to ingratiate ourselves into your esteem. This is said doubtless to keep himself from the suspicion of being actuated by improper motives. He had manifested great so- licitude certainly in the previous chap- ters to vindicate his character ; but he here says that it was not from a mere desire to show them that his conduct was right; it was from a desire to honour Christ. ^ We speak before God in Christ. We declare the simple and undisguised truth as in the pre- sence of God. I have no mere desire to palliate my conduct ; I disguise no- thing ; I conceal nothing ; I say nothing for the mere purpose of self-vindication, but I can appeal to the Searcher of hearts for the exact truth of all that I say. The phrase " before God in Christ," means probably, * I speak as in the pre- sence of God and as a follower of Christ, as a Christian man.' It is the solemn appeal of a Christian to his God for the truth of what he said, and a solemn asseveration that what he said was not for the mere purpose of excusing or apologizing for (Greek) his conduct. ^ But we do all things, dearly beloved, for your edifying. All that I have done has been for your welfare. My vindication of my character, and my effort to disabuse you of your prejudices, has been that you might have unwaver- ing confidence in the gospel and might be built up in holy faith. On the word edify, see Notes on Rom. xiv. 1 9. 1 Cor. viii. 1 ; X. 23. 20. For I fear lest, when I come. See ver. 14. ^ I shall not find you suck as I would. That is, walking in the truth and order of the gospel. He had 266 IL CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. found unto you such as ye would not ; lest there be debates, envy- ings, wraths, strifes, backbitings, whisperings, swellings, tumults : 21 And lest, when 1 come again, my God will humble " me a c. 2. 1. feared that the disorders would not be removed, and that they would not have corrected the errors which prevailed, and for which he had rebuked them. It was on this account that he had said so much to them. His desire was that all these disorders might be removed, and that he might be saved from the necessity of exercising severe discipline when he should come among them. ^ And that / 8hall be found unto you such as ye would not. That is, that I shall be compelled to administer disci- pline, and that my visit may not be as pleasant to you as you would desire. For this reason he wished all disorder corrected, and all offences removed ; that every thing might be pleasant when he should come. See 1 Cor. iv. 21. Comp. Note on ch. x. 2. % Lest there be de- bates. I fear that there may be existing there debates, &c., which will require the interposition of the authority of an apostle. On the meaning of the word debate, see Note on Rom. i. 29. H Envy- ings. See Note on 1 Cor. iii. 3. ^Wraths. Anger or animosity between contending factions, the usual effect of forming parties. ^ Strifes. Between contending factions. See Note on 1 Cor. iii. 3. 1 Backbitings. See Note on Rom. i. 30. t Whisperings. See Note on Rom. i. 29. ^ Swellings. Undue ela- tion; being puffed up (see Note on 1 Cor. iv. 6. 18, 19; v. 2. viii. 1)~ such as would be produced by vain self-confidence, t Tumults. Disorder and confusion arising from this exist- ence of parties. Paul, deeply sensible of the evil of all this, had endeavoured in this correspondence to suppress it, that all things might be pleasant when he should come among them. 2 1 . And lest, when J come again, my among you, and that I shall be- wail many which have sinned already, and have not lepented * of the uncleanness, and fornica- tion, *and lasciviousness which they have committed. b Re. 2. 21. c 1 Co. 5. God will humble me, &c. Lest I should be compelled to inflict punishment on those whom I supposed to have been converted under my ministry. I had re- joiced in them as true converts. I had counted them as among the fruit of my ministry. Now to be compelled to in- flict punishment on them as having no religion would mortify me and humble me. The infliction of punishment on members of the church is a sort of punishment to him who inflicts it as well as to him who is punished. Mem- bers of the church should walk uprightly, lest they overwhelm the ministry in shame. ^ And that I shall bewail many, &c. If they repented of their sin he could still rejoice in them. If they continued in their sin till he came, it would be to him a source of deep la- mentation. It is evident from the word " many" here that the disorders had pre- vailed very extensively in the church at Corinth. The word rendered " have sinned already" means 'who have sinned before,^ and the idea is, that they were old offenders, and that they had not yet repented. f The uncleanness. See Note, Rom i. 24. T[ And fornication and lasciviousness, &cc. See Notes on 1 Cor. V. 1 ; vi. 18. This was the sin to which they were particularly exposed in Corinth, as it was the sin for which that corrupt city was particularly dis- tinguished. See the Introduction to the first epistle. Hence the frequent cautions in these epistles against it ; and hence it is not to be wondered at that some of those who had become professing Chris- tians had fallen into it. It may be added that it is still the sin to which converts from the corruptions and licen- tiousness of paganism are particularly exposed. A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XIII. 267 CHAPTER XIH. 'HIS is the third time I am coming to you. In "the aDe.19. 15. He. 10. 28,29. CHAPTER XIIT. This closing chapter of the epistle relates to the following subjects. I. The assurance of Paul that he was about to come among them (ver. 1 — 4), and that he would certainly inflict pu- nishment on all who deserved it. His enemies had reproached him us being timid and pusillanimous. See Notes on ch. X. 1, 2, 10, 11. They had said that he was powerful to threaten, but afraid to execute. It is probable that they had become more bold in this from the fact that he had twice purposed to go there and had failed. In reply to all this, he now in conclusion solemnly assures them that he was coming, and that in all cases where an offence was proved by two or three witnesses, pu- nishment would be inflicted, ver. 1. He assures them (ver. 2) that he would not spare ; and that since they sought a proof that Christ had sent him, they should witness that proof in the punish- ment which he would inflict (ver. 3) ; for that Christ was now clothed with power and was able to execute punishment, though he had been crucified, ver. 4. II. Paul calls on them solemnly to examine themselves and to see whether they had any true religion, ver. 5, 6. In the state of things which existed there ; in the corruption which had abounded in the church, he solemnly commands them to institute a faithful inquiry to know whether they had not been deceived ; at the same time ex- pressing the hope that it would appear as the result of their examination that they were not reprobates. III. He earnestly prays to God that they might do no evil ; that they might be found to be honest and pure, what- ever might be thought of Paul himself or whatever might become of him. ver. 7. Their repentance would save Paul from exerting his miraculous power in their mouth of two or three wit- nesses shall every word be es- tablished. punishment, and might thus prevent the proof of his apostolic authority which they desired, and the consequence might be that they might esteem him to be a reprobate, for he could not exert his miraculous power except in the cause of truth, ver. 8. Still he was willing to be esteemed an impostor if they would do no evil. IV. He assures them that he earnestly- wished their perfection, and that the design of his writing to them, severe as he had appeared, was their edification, ver. 9, 10. V. Then he bids them an affectionate and tender farewell, and closes with the usual salutations and benedictions, ver. 11—14. 1. This is the third time, &c. See Note on ch. xii. 14. For an interesting view of this passage, see Paley's Hor» Paulinse on this epistle. No. xi. It is evident that Paul had been to Corinth but once before this, but he had resolved to go before a second time, but had been disappointed. ^ In the mouth of two or three witnesses, &c. This was what the law of Moses required. Deut xx. 16. See Note on John viii. 17. Comp. Matt, xviii. 16. But in regard to its application here, commentators are not agreed. Some suppose that Paul refers to his own epistles which he had sent to them as the two or three witnesses by which his promise to them would be made certain ; that he had purposed it and promised it two or three times, and that as this was all that was required by the law, it would certainly be esta- blishetl. This is the opinion of Bloom- field, Rosenmiiller, Grotius, Hammond, Locke, and some others. But, with aL the respect due to such great names, it seems to me that this would be trifling and childish in the extreme. Light- foot supposes that he refers to Stephanas, Fortunatus, and Achaicus, who would be witnesses to them of his purpose. 268 II. CORINTHIANS. LA. D. 60. 2 I told you before, and fore- tel you, as if I were present, the second time ; and being absent now I write to them " which heretofore have sinned, and to all other, that, if I come again, I will not spare : a c. 12. 21. See 1 Cor. xvi. 17. But the more pro- bable opinion, it seems to me, is that of Doddridge, Macknight, and others, that he anticipated that there would be necessity for the administration of dis- cipline there, but that he would feel himself under obligation in administer- ing it to adhere to the reasonable maxim of the Jewish law. No one should be condemned or punished where there was not at least two or three witnesses to prove the offence. But where there were, discipline would be administered according to the nature of the crime. 3. 1 told you before. That I would not spare offenders ; that I would cer- tainly punish them. He had intimated this before in tlie first Epis. ch. iv. 21, and ch. v. % And forettl you. Now apprise you of my fixed determination to punish every offender as he deserves. t As if I were present the second time. The mention of the ' second time^ here proves that Paul had been with them but once before. He had formed the resolution to go to them, but had been disappointed. The time when he had been with them is recorded in Acts xviii. 1, seq. He now uses the same language to them which he says he would use if he were with them, as he had expected to be, the second time. See the remarks of Paley on this pas- sage, referred to above. ^ And being absent. See Note on 1 Cor. v. 3. t To them which have heretofore sinned. To all the offenders in the church. They had supposed that he would. not come to them (I Cor. iv. 18), or that if he came he would not dare to inflict punish- ment. 2 Cor. 9 — 1 1. They had, there- fore, given themselves greater liberty, and had pursued their own course, re- gardless of his authority and commands. 3 Since ye seek a proof of Christ speaking in me, which to you-ward is not weak, but is mighty *in you. 4 For though ''he was crucified through weakness, yet he liveth by the power of God. For we 6 1 Co. 9. 2. c Ph. 2. 7, 8. 1 Pe. 3. 18. 1 1 will not spare. I will punish them. They shall not escape. 3. Since ye seek a proof of Christ speaking in me. See the Notes on the previous chapters. They had called in question his apostolic authority ; they had demanded the evidence of his divine commission. He says that he would now furnish such evidence by inflicting just punishment on all offenders, and they should have abundant proof that Christ spoke by him, or that he was inspired. ^ Which to you-ward is not weak. Or who, that is, Christ, is not weak, &c. Christ has manifested his power abundantly towards you, that is, either by the miracles that had been wrought in his name ; or by the diseases and calamities which they had suffered on account of their disorders and of- fences (see Note on 1 Cor. xi. 30 ; and 1 Cor. v.) ; or by the force and efficacy of his doctrine. The connexion, it seems to me, requires that we should understand it of the calamities which had been inflicted by Christ on them for their sins, and which Paul says would be inflicted again if they did not repent. The idea is, that they had had ample demonstration of the power of Christ to inflict punishment, and they had reason to apprehend it again. 4. For though he was crucified through weakness. Various modes have been adopted of explaining the phrase " through weakness." The most proba- ble explanation is that which refers it to the human nature which he had assumed (Phil. ii. 7, 8. 1 Pet. iii. 18), and to the appearance of weakness which he mani- fested. He did not choose to exert his power. He appeared to his enemies to be weak and feeble. This idea would be an exact illustration of the point A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XIII. 269 also are weak * in him, but we * or, with. liefore the apostle. He is illustrating his own conduct, and especially in the fact that he had not exerted his miracu- lous powers among them in the punish- ment of offenders ; and he does it by the example of Christ, who though abundantly able to have exerted his power and to have rescued himself from his enemies, yet was willing to appear weak, and to be crucified. It is very clear, (1.) That the Lord Jesus seemed to his enemies to be weak and incapa- ble of resistance. (2.) That he did not put forth his power to protect his life. He in fact offered no resistance, as if he had no power. (3.) He had a human nature that was peculiarly sensitive, and sensible to suffering; and ' that was borne down and crushed under the weight of mighty woes. See my Notes on Isa. liii. 2, 3. From all these causes he seemed to be weak and feeble ; and these appear to me to be the principal ideas in this expression, t Yet he llveth. He is not now dead. Though he was crucified, yet he now lives again, and is now capable of exerting his great power. He furnishes proof of his being alive, in the success which attends the gospel, and in the miracles which are wrought in his name and by his power. There is a /ii>m_a- Redeemer in heaven; a Redeemer who is able to exert all the power which he ever exerted when on earth ; a Re- deemer, therefore, who is able to save the soul : to raise the dead ; tc punish all his foes, t By the power of God. In raising him from the dead and placing him at his own right hand. See Eph. i. 1 9—2 1 . Through the power of God he was brought from the tomb, and has had a place assigned him at the head of the universe. ^ For we also are weak in him. Marg. < with him.' We his apostles, also, are weak in virtue of our connexion with him. We are subject to infirmities and trials ; we seem to have no power ; we are exposed to contempt; and we appear to our enemies to be destitute of strength. 23* shall live with him by the power of God towards you. Our enemies regard us as feeble ; and they despise us. t But we shall live with him, &c. That is, we shall show to you that we are alive. By the aid of the power of God we shall show that we are not as weak as our foes pre- tend ; that we are invested with power ; and that we are able to inflict the punish- ment which we threaten. This is one of the numerous instances in which Paul illustrated the case before him by a reference to the example and charac- ter of Christ. The idea is, that Christ did not exert his power, and appeared to be weak, and was put to death. So Paul says that he had not exerted his power, and seemed to be weak. But, says he, Christ lives, and is clothed with strength ; and so we, though we appear to be weak, shall exert among you, or toward you, the power with which he has invested us, in inflicting punishment on our foes. 5. Examine yourselves. See Note on 1 Cor. xi. 28. The particular rea- son why Paul calls on them to examine themselves was, that there was occasion to fear that many of them had been de- ceived. Such had been the irregularities and disorders in the church at Corinth ; so ignorant had many of them shown themselves of the nature of the Chris- tian religion, that it was important, in the highest degree, for them to institute a strict and impartial examination to ascertain whether they had not been altogether deceived. This examination, however, is never unimportant or use- less for Christians; and an exhortation to do it is always in place. So impor- tant are the interests at stake, and so liable are the best to deceive themselves, that all Christians should be often in- duced to examine the foundation of their hope of eternal salvation. ^ Whether ye he in the faith. Whether you are true Christians. Whether you have any true faith in the gospel. Faith in Jesus Christ, and in the promises of God through him, is one of the distinguishing 370 II. CORINTHIANS. [A. D. 60. 5 Examine " yourselves alCo. 11. 28. 1 Jno. 3. 20, 21. characteristics of a true Christian ; and to ascertain whether we have any true faith, therefore, is to ascertain whether we are sincere Christians. For some reasons for such an examination, and some remarks on the mode of doing it, see Note on 1 Cor. xi. 28. ^ Prove your ownselves. The word here used (Jaufxaj^iri) is stronger than that before used, and rendered " examine" {■m^d^in) . This word, prove, refers to assaying or trying metals by the powerful action of heat ; and the idea here is, that they should make the most thorough trial of their religion, to see whether it would stand the test. See Note on 1 Cor. iii. 13. The proof of their piety was to be arrived at by a faithful examination of their own hearts and lives ; by a diligent comparison of their views and feelings with the word of God ; and especially by making trial of it in life. The best way to prove our piety is to subject it to actual trial in the various duties and responsibilities of Ij^e. A man who wishes to prove an axe to see whether it is good or not, does not sit down and look at it, or read all the treatises which he can find on axe- making, and on the properties of iron and steel, valuable as such information would be ; but he shoulders his axe and goes into the woods, and puts it to the trial there. If it cuts well ; if it does not break; if it is not soon made dull, he understands the quality of his axe better than he could in any other way. So if a man wishes to know what his religion is worlh, let him try it in the places where religion is of any value. Let him go into the world with it. Let him go and try to do good ; to endure affliction in a proper manner ; to combat the errors and follies of life ; to ad- monish sinners of the error of their ways; and to urge forward the great work of the conversion of the world, and he will soon see there what his re- ligion is worth — as easily as a man can test the qualities of an axe. Let him whether ye be in the faith ; prove your ownselves. Know not merely sit down and think, and compare himself with the Bible and look at his own heart — valuable as this may be in many respects — but let hira treat his religion as he would any thing else — let him subject it to actual expe- riment. That religion which will ena- ble a man to imitate the example of Paul or Howard, or the great Master himself, in doing good, is genuine. That reli- gion which will enable a man to endure persecution for the name of Jesus ; to bear calamity without murmuring; to submit to a long series of disappoint- ments and distresses for (^hrist's sake, is genuine. That religion which will prompt a man unceasingly to a life of prayer and self-denial ; which will make him ever conscientious, industrious, and honest ; which will enable him to warn sinners of the error of their ways, and which will dispose him to seek the friendship of Christians, and the salva- tion of the world, is pure and genuine. That will answer the purpose. It is like the good axe with which a man can chop all day long, in which there is no flaw, and which does not get dull, and which answers all the purposes of an axe. Any other reUgion than this is worthless. If Know ye not your own- selves. That is, 'Do you not know yourselves ]' This does not mean, as some may suppose, that they might know o/" themselves, without the aid of others, what their character was ; or that they might themselves ascertain it; but it means that they might know themselves ,• i. e. their character, princi pies, conduct. This proves that Chris- tians may know their true character If they are Christians, they may know it with as undoubted certainty as they may know their character on any other subject. Why should not a man be as able to determine whether he loves God as whether he loves a child, a pa- rent, or a friend] What greater diffi- culty need there be in understanding the character on the subject of religion A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XIII. 271 ye not your ownselves, how that Jesus Christ " is in you, except ye be reprobates ? ^ a Ro. 8. 10. Ga. 4. 19. than on any other subject ; and why should there be any more reason for doubt on this than on any other point of character 1 And yet it is remarkable, that while a child has no doubt that he loves a parent, or a husband a wife, or a friend a friend, almost all Christians are in very great doubt about their at- tachment to the Redeemer and to the great principles of religion. Such was not the case with the apostles and early Christians. "I know," says Paul, *' whom I have believed, and am persuaded that he is able to keep that which I have committed to him," &c. 2 Tim, i. 12. " We KNOW," says John, speaking in the name of the body of Christians, " that we have passed from death unto life." 1 John iii. 14. *' We know that we are of the truth." 19. "We know that he abideth in us." 24. "We KNOW that we dwell in him," 1 John iv. 13. See also v. 2. 19, 20. So Job said, " I KNOW that my Redeemer liveth, and that he shall stand in the latter day upon the earth," i&c. Job xix, 25, Such is the current language of Scrip- ture, Where, in the Bible, do the sacred speakers and writers express doubts about their attachment to God and the Redeemer] Where is such language to be found as we hear from almost all professing Christians, expressing entire uncertainty about their condition ; ab- solute doubt whether they love God or hate him; whether they are going to heaven or hell ; whether they are in- fluenced by good motives or bad ; and even making it a matter of merit to be in such doubt, and thinking it wrong not to doubt 1 What would be thought of a husband that should make it a mat- ter of merit to doubt whether he loved his wife ; or of a child that should think it wrong 7iot to doubt whether he loved his father or mother ] Such attachments ought to be doubted — but they do not occur in the common relations of life. 6 But I truit that ye shall know that we are not repro- bates. b 1 Co. 9. 27. 2 Ti 3. 8. On the subject of religion men often act as they do on no other subject ; and if it is right for one to be satisfied of th^ sincerity of his attachments to his best earthly friends, and to speak of such attachment without wavering ^r mis- giving, it cannot be wrong tc^Ji^ satisfied with regard to our attachment to God, and to fipeak of that attachment, as the apostles did, in language of undoubted confidence. 1 How that Jesiis Christ is in you. To be in Christ, or for Christ to be in us, is a common mode in the Scriptures of expressing the idea that we are Christians. It is language de- rived from the close union which sub- sists between the Redeemer and his people. See the phrase explained in the Note on Rom, viii, 10. 1 Except ye be reprobates. See Note on Rom. i, 28. The word rendered " reprobates" (aS'jKijuot) means properly not approved, rejected ,- that which will not stand the trial. It is properly applicable to metals, as denoting that they will not bear the tests to which they are subjected, bu are found to be base or adulterated. The sense here is, that they might know that they were Christians, unless their religion was base, false, adulterated ; or such as would not bear the test. There is no allusion here to the sense which is sometimes given to the word reprobate, of being cast off or abandoned by God, or doomed by him to eternal ruin in ac- cordance with an eternal purpose. Whatever may be the truth on that subject, nothing is taught in regard to it here. The simple idea is, that they might know that they were Christians, unless their religion was such as would not stand the test, or was worthless. 6, But I trust, &c. The sense of this verse is, ' Whatever may be the result of your examination of yourselves, I trust (Gr. / hope) you will not find us false and to be rejected ; that is, I trust you will find in rae evidence that I am II. CORINTHIANS. [A.D.60 7 Now I pray to God that ye ! should do that which is honest, do no evil ; not that we should appear approved, but that ye commissioned by the Lord Jesus to be his apostle The idea is, that they would find when he was among them, that he was endowed with all the quali- fications needful to confer a claim to the apostolic office. 7. Now I pray to God that ye do no evil. I earnestly desire that you may do right, and only right ; and I beseech God that it may be so, whatever may be the result in regard to me, and what- ever may be thought of my claims to the apostolic office. This is designed to mitigate the apparent severity of the sentiment in ver. 6. There he had said » that they would find him fully endowed with the power of an apostle. They would see that he was able abundantly to punish the disobedient. They would have ample demonstration that he was endowed by Christ with all the powers appropriate to an apostle, and that all that he had claimed had been well- founded, all that he threatened would be executed. But this seemed to imply that he desired that there should be occasion for the exercise of that power of administering discipline ; and he, therefore, in this verse, removes all sus- picion that such was his wish, by saying solemnly, that he prayed to God that they might never do wrong ; that they might never give him occasion for the exercise of his power in that way, though as a consequence he would be regarded as a reprobate, or as having no claims to the apostolic office. He would rather be regarded as an impostor; ra- ther lie under the reproach of his ene- mies that he had no claims to the apostolic character, than that they, by doing wrong, should give him occasion to show that he was not a deceiver. 1 Not that we should appear approved. My great object, and my main desire, IS not to urge my claims to the apostolic office and clear up my own character ; it is that you should lead honest lives, though we be as reprobates. 8 For " we can do nothing a Pr. 21. 30. whatever may become of me and my reputation. \ Though we be as repro- bates. I am willing to be regarded as rejected, disapproved, worthless, like base metal, provided you lead honest and holy lives. I prefer to be so esteem- ed, and to have you live as becomes Christians, than that you should dis- honour your Christian profession, and thus afford me the opportunity of de- monstrating, by inflicting punishment, that I am commissioned by the Lord Jesus to be an apostle. The sentiment is, that a minister of the gospel should desire that his people should walk worthy of their high calling, whatever may be the estimate in which he is held. He should never desire that they should do wrong — how can he do it ? — in order that he may take occasion from their wrong-doing to vindicate, in any way, his own character, or to establish a re- putation for skill in administering disci- pline or in governing a church. What a miserable ambition it is — and as wick- ed as it is miserable — for a man to wish to take advantage of a state of disorder, or of the faults of others, in order to es- tablish his own character, or to obtain reputation. Paul spurned and detested such a thought ; yet it is to be feared it is sometimes done. 8. For we. That is, we the apostles. ^ Can do nothing against the truth, &c. That is, we who are under the in- fluence of the Spirit of God ; who have been commissioned by him as apostles, can do nothing that shall be against that great system of truth which we are appointed to promulgate and defend. You need, therefore, apprehend no par- tial, or severe discipline from lis; no unjust construction of your conduct. Our aim is to promote the truth, and to do what is right ; and we cannot, there- fore, by any regard to our own reputa- tion, or to any personal advantage, do what is wrong, or countenance, or desira A. D. 60.] CHAPTER XIII. 2n against the truth, but for the truth. 9 For we are glad, wlien we are weak, and ye are strong: and this also we wish, even your perfection. " a 1 Th. 3. 10. He. 6. 1. what is wrong in others. We must wish that which is right to be done by others, whatever may be the effect on us — whether we are regarded as apostles or deceivers. I suppose, therefore, that this verse is designed to quahfy and confirm the sentiment in the previous verse, that Paul meant to do only right ; that he wished all others to do right ; and that whatever might be the effect on his own reputation, or however he might be regarded, he could not go against the great system of gospel truth which he preached, or even desire that others should ever do wrong, though it might in any way be for his advantage. It was 2i fixed principle with him to act only in accordance with truth ; to do what was right. 9. For we are glad when we are weak, &c. We rejoice in your wel- fare, and are willing to submit to self- denial and to infirmity if it may promote your spiritual strength. In the con- nexion in which this stands it seems to mean, ' I am content to appear weak, provided you do no wrong ; I am will- ing not to have occasion to exercise my power in punishing offenders, and had rather lie under the reproach of being actually weak, than to have occa- sion to exercise my power by punishing you for wrong-doing ; and provided you are strong in the faith and in the hope of the gospel, I am very willing, nay, I rejoice that I am under this necessity of appearing weak.' ^ And this also we wish. I desire this in addition to your doing no evil. ^ Even your perfection. The word here used (>t*Ta'gT/T) That they mean to make him betray his religion and become conformed to them. It is a great point gained for the gay world, when it can, by its caresses and atten- tions, get a Christian to forsake a prayer- meeting for a party, or surrender his deep spirituality to engage in some political project. '* Wo unto you," said the Redeemer, " when all men speak well of you." Luke vi. 26. (3.) One of the main differences between Christians and the world is, that others aim to please men ; the Christian aims to please God And this is a great dif- ference. (4.) It follows that if men would become Christians, they must cease to make it their object to please men. They must be willing to be met with contempt and a frown ; they must be v/illingto be persecuted and despised; they must be willing to lay aside all hope of the praise and the flattery of men, and be content with an honest effort to please God. (5.) True Chris- tians must differ from the world. Their aims, feelings, purposes must be unlike the world. They are to he a peculiar people; and they should be willing to be esteemed such. It does not follow, however, that a true Christian should not desire the good esteem of the world, or that he should be indifferent to an honourable reputation ( 1 Tim. iii. 7) ; nor does it follow that a consistent 26* 12 For " I neither received it of man, neither was I taught i7, but by the revelation * of Jesus Christ. fl 1 Co. 15. 1—3, h Ep. 3. 3. Christian will not often command the respect of the world. In times of trial, the world will repose confidence in Christians ; when any work of benevo- lence is to be done, the world will instinctively look to Christians; and notwithstanding sinners will not love re- ligion, yet they will secretly feel assured that some of the brightest ornaments of society are Christians, and that they have a claim to the confidence and esteem of their fellow-men. \ The servant of Christ. A Christian. 1 1 . Bat I certify you. I make known to you; or, I declare to you. See 1 Cor. xv. 1. Doubtless this had been known to them before, but he now assures them of it, and goes into an extended illustration to show them that he had not received his authority from man to preach the gospel. To state and prove this is the main design of this chapter. ^ Is not after man. Gr. Not according to man. See ver. 1. That is, he was not appointed by man, nor had he any human instructor to make known to him what the gospel was. He had neither received it from man, nor had it been debased or adul- terated by any human admixtures. He had received it directly from the Lord Jesus. 1 2. For I neither received it of man. This is very probably said in reply to his opponents, who had maintained that Paul had derived his knowledge of the gospel from other men, as he had not been personally known to the Lord Jesus, or been of the number of those whom he called to be his apostles. In reply to this, he says, that he did not receive his gospel in any way from man. t Neither was I taught it. That is, by man. He was not taught it by any written account of it, or by the instruction of man in any way. The only plausible objection to this statement which could be urged would 294 GALATIANS [A. D. 58. 13 For ye have heard of my conversation in time past in the Jews' religion, how that beyond be the fact that Paul had an interview with Ananias (Acts ix. 17) before his baptism, and that he would probably receive instructions from him. But to this it may be replied, (1.) That there is no evidence that Ananias went into an explanation of the nature of the Christian religion in his interview with Paul ; (2.) Paul had before this been taught what Christianity was by his interview with the Lord Jesus on the way to Damascus (Acts ix, 5 ; xxvi. 14 — 18) ; (3.) The purpose for which Ananias was sent to him in Damascus was that he might receive his sight, and be filled with the Holy Ghost. Acts ix. 17. Whatever instructions he may have received through Ananias, it is still true that his call was directly from the Lord Jesus, and his informa- tion of the nature of Christianity from his revelation. ^ Bat by tlie revela- tion of Jesus Christ. On his way to Damascus, and subsequently in the temple. Acts xxii. 17 — 21. Doubtless he received communications at various times from the Lord Jesus with regard to the nature of the gospel and his duty. The sense here is, that he was not indebted to me7i for his knowledge of the gospel, but had derived it entirely from the Saviour. 13. For ye have heard of my con- versation. My conduct, my mode of life, my deportment. See Note on 2 Cor. i. 12. Probably Paul had himself made them acquainted with the events of his early years. The reason why he refers to this is, to show them that he had not derived his knowledge of the Christian religion from any instruction which he had received in his early years, or any acquaintance which he had formed with the apostles. He had at first been decidedly opposed to the Lord Jesus, and had been converted only by his wonderful grace. ^ In the Jews' religion. In the belief and prac- tice of Judaism ; that is, as it was un- measure I persecuted the church « of God, and wasted it. 14 And profited in the Jews' a Ac. 8. 1, 3; 9. 1, 2; 26. 9. derstood in the time when he waa educated. It was not merely in the religion of Moses, but it was in that religion as understood and practised by the Jews in his time, when opposition to Christianity constituted a very n^aterial part of it. In that religion Paul pro- ceeds to show that he had been more distinguished than most persons of his time. Tf How that beyond measure. In the highest possible degree ; beyond all limits or bounds ; exceedingly. The phrase which Paul here uses (xatS-' v7ng(ioxm), by hyperbole, is one which he frequently employs to denote any thing that is excessive, or that cannot be expressed by ordinary language. See the Greek in Rom. vii. 13. 1 Cor. xii. 31. 2 Cor. i. 8; iv. 7. 17. t / persecuted the church. See Acts viii, 3 ; ix. 1, seq. ^ And wasted it. De- stroyed it. The word which is here used, means properly to waste or destroy, as when a city or country is ravaged by an army or by wild beasts. His pur- pose was utterly to root out and destroy the Christian religion. 14. And profited. Made advances and attainments. He made advances not only in the knowledge of the Jewish religion, but also he surpassed others in his zeal in defending its interests. He had had better advantages than most of his countrymen ; and by his great zeal and characteristic ardour, he had been able to make higher attainments than most others had done. ^ Above many my equals. Marg. Equal in years. This is the true sense of the original. It means that he surpassed those of the same age with himself. Possibly there may be a reference here to those of the same age who attended with him on the instructions of Gamaliel, t Being more exceedingly zealous. More stu- dious of; more ardently attached to them ; more anxious to distinguish him- self in attainments in the religion in which he was brought up. All this is A.D. 5S.] CHAPTER I. 295 religion above many ray * equals in mine own nation, being " more exceedingly zealous of the tra- ditions * of my fathers. « equal in ijears. a Ac. 22. 3. Ph. 3. 6. b Mar. 7. 5—13. fully sustained by all that we know of the character of Paul, as at all times a .iian of singular and eminent zeal in all that he undertook. ^ Of the tradi- tions of my fathers. Or the traditions of the Jews. See Note, Matt. xv. 2. A large part of the doctrines of the Phari- sees depended on mere tradition ; and Paul doubtless made tliis a special mat- ter of study, and was particularly tena- cious in regard to it. It was to be learned, from the very nature of it, only by oral teaching, as there is no evidence that it was then recorded. Subsequently these traditions were recorded in the Mishna, and are found in the Jewish writings. But in the time of Paul they were to be learned as they were handed down from one to another ; and hence the utmost diligence was requisite to obtain a knowledge of them. Paul does not here nay that he was zealous then for the practice of the new religion, nor for the study of the Bible. His object in going to Jerusalem and study- ing at the feet of Gamaliel was doubt- less to obtain a knowledge of the traditions of the sect of the Pharisees. Had he been studying the Bible all that time, he would have kept from the fiery zeal which he evinced in persecut- ing the church, and would, if he had studied it right, been saved from much trouble of conscience afterwards. 15. But when it pleased God. Paul traced all his hopes of eternal hfe, and all the good influences which had ever borne upon his mind, to God. f Who separated me, Sec. That is, who destined me ; or who purposed from my very birth that I should be a preacher and an apostle. The meaning is, that God had in his secret purposes set him apart to be an apostle. It does not mean that he had actually called him in his infancy to the work, for this was not so, 15 But when it pleased God, ' who separated me from my mother's womb, and called me by his grace, c Is. 49. 1. Je. 1. 5 but that he designed him to be an important instrument in his hands in spreading the true religion. Jeremiah (i. 5) was thus set apart, and John the Baptist was thus early designated for the work which they afterwards performed. It follows from this, (1.) That God often, if not always, has purposes in regard to men from their very birth. He designs them for some important field of labour, and endows them at their creation with talents adapted to that. (2.) It does not follow that because a young man has gone fl\r astray ; and has become even a blasphemer and a persecutor, that God has not destined him to some im- portant and holy work in his service. How many men have been called, like Paul, and Newton, and Bunyan, and Augustine, from a life of sin to the service of God. (3.) God is often training up men in a remarkable man- ner for future usefulness. His eye is upon them, and he watches over them, until the time comes for their conver- sion. His providence was concerned in the education and training of Paul. It was by the divine intention with reference to his future work that he had so many opportunities of education, and was so well acquainted with the " traditions" of that religion which he was yet to demonstrate to be unfounded and false. He gave him the opportu- nity to cultivate his mind, and prepare to grapple with the Jew in argument, and show him how unfounded were his hopes. So it is often now. He gives to a young man an opportunity of a finished education. Perhaps he suffers him to fall into the snares of infidelity, and to become familiar with the argu- ments of sceptics, that he may thus be better prepared to meet their soph- isms, and to enter into their feelings. His eye is upon them in their wander- 296 GALATIANS. [A. D.58. 16 To leveal " his Son in me, a 2 Co. 4. 6. ings, and they are suffered often to v/ander far; to range the fields of science; to become distinguished as scholars, as Paul was; until the time comes for their conversion, and then, in accordance with the purpose which set them apart from the world, God converts them, and consecrates all their talents and attainments to his service. (4.) We should never despair of a young man who has wandered far from God. If he has risen high in attainments ; if his whole aim is ambition ; or if he has become an infidel, still we are not to despair of him. It is possible still that God " separated" that talent to his service from the very birth, and that he means yet to call it all to his service. How easy it was to convert Saul of Tarsus when the proper period arrived. So it is of the now unconverted and unconsecrated, but cultivated talent among the young men of our land. Far as they may have wandered from God and virtue, yet much of that ta- lent has been devoted to him in baptism, and by parental purposes and prayers ; and, it may be — as is morally certain from the history of the past — that much of it is consecrated also by the divine purpose and intention for the noble cause of virtue and pure religion. In that now apparently wasted talent ; in that learning now apparently devoted to other aims and ends, there is much that will yet adorn the cause of virtue and religion ; and how fervently should we pray that it may be "called" by the grace of God and actually devoted to his service. 1 And called me by his grace. On the way to Damascus. It was special grace, because he was then engaged in bitterly opposing him and his cause. 16. To reveal his Son in me. This is to be regarded as connected with the first part of ver. 15, ' When it pleased God to reveal his Son in me,' t. e. on the way to Damascus. The phrase evidently means, to make me acquainted with the Lord Jesus, or to reveal his that * I might preach him among 6 Ac. 9. 15. Son to me. Comp. the Greek in Matt. X. 32. for a similar expression. The revelation here referred to was the miraculous manifestation which was made to Paul on his way to Damascus. Comp. 2 Cor. iv. 6. That revelation was in order to convince him that he was the Messiah ; to acquaint him with his nature, rank, and claims; and to qualify him to be a preacher to the heathen. ^ That I might preach him. In order that I might so preach him ; or with a view to my being appointed to this work. This was the leading purpose for which Paul was converted. Acts ix. 15; xxii. 21. ^ The heathen. The Gentiles ; the portion of the world that was not Jewish, or that was desti- tute of the true religion, t Imme- diately. Koppe supposes that this is to be connected with, " I went into Arabia" (ver. 17). Rosenmiiller supposes it means, "Immediately I consented.^* Dr. Wells and Locke suppose that it refers to the fact that he immediately went to Arabia. But this seems to me to be an unnatural construction. The words are too remote from each other to allow of it. The evident sense is, that he was at once decided. He did not take time to deliberate whether he should or should not become a Christian. He made up his mind at once and on the spot. He did not con- sult with any one ; he did not ask ad- vice of any one ; he did not wait to be instructed by any one. He was con- vinced by the vision in an overpowering manner that Jesus was the Messiah, and he yielded at once. The main idea is, that there was no delay, no consulta- tion, no deferring it, that he might see and consult with his friends, or with the friends of Christianity. The ob- ject for which he dwells on this is to show he did not receive his views of the gospel from man. f 1 conferred not. I did not lay the case {■Tr^oTa.v^i/j.hv') before any man ; I did not confer with any one. t Fksh and blood. Any hu- man being, for so the phrase properly A. D. SB.J CHAPTER I. 29? the heathen ; immediately 1 con- ferred not with flesh and " blood : a 2 Co. 5. 16. signifies. See Note, Matt. xvi. 17. This does not mean here, that Paul did not consult his own ease and happi- ness ; that he was regardless of the sufterings which he might be called to endure ; that he was willing to suffer, and was not careful to make provision for his own comfort — which was true in itself — but that he did not lay the case before any man, or any body of men for instruction or advice. He acted promptly and decisively. He was not disobedient to th-e heavenly vision (Acts xxvi. 19), but resolved at once to obey. Many suppose that this passage means that Paul did not take counsel of the evil passions and suggestions of his own heart, or of the feelings which would have prompted him to lead a life of ambition, or a life under the influ- ence of corrupt desires. But however true this was in fact, no such thing is intended here. It means simply that he did not take counsel of any human being. He resolved at once to follow the command of the Saviour, and at once to obey him. The passage shows, (1.) That when the Lord Jesus calls us to foUovvT him we should promptly and decidedly obey. (3.) We should not delay even to take counsel of earthly friends, or wait for human advice, or consult their wishes, but should at once resolve to follow the Lord Jesus. Most persons, when they are awakened to see their guilt, and their minds are impressed on the subject of religion, are prone to defer it ; to re- solve to think of it at some future time; or to engage in some other business before they become Christians ; or, at least, they wish to finish what they have on hand before they yield to God. Had Paul pursued this course, he would probably never have become a Christian. It foUov^s, therefore, (3.) That when the Lord Jesus calls us, we should at once abandon any course of life, how- ever pleasant, or any plan of ambition, 17 Neither went I up to Jeru- salem to them which were apos- tles before me ; but I went int(» however brilliant, or any scheme of gain, however promising, in order that we may follow him. What a brilliant career of ambition did Paul abandon ! and how promptly and decidedly did he do it ! He did not pause or hesitate a moment ; but brilliant as were his pros- pects, he at once forsook all ; paused in mid-career in his ambition ; and with- out consulting a human being, at once gave his heart to God. Such a course should be pursued by all. Such a promptness and decision will prepare one to become an eminent Christian, and to be eminently useful. 17. Neither went J up to Jerusalem. That is, I did not go there at once. I did not go to consult with the apostles there, or to be instructed by them in re- gard to the nature of the Christian religion. The design of this statement is, to show that in no sense did he derive his commission from man. Tl To them which were apostles before me. This implies that Paul then regarded himself to be an apostle. They were, he admits, apostles before he was ; but he felt also that he had original authority with them, and he did not go to them to receive instruc- tion, or to derive his commission from them. Several of the apostles remained in Jerusalem for a considerable time after the ascension of the Lord Jesus, and it was regarded as the principal place of authority. See Acts xv. t But I went into Arabia. Arabia was south of Damascus, and at no great distance. The line indeed between Arabia Deserta and Syria is not ver* definitely marked, but it is generally agreed that Arabia extends to a consi derable distance into the great Syriai* desert. To what part of Arabia, ant* for what purpose Paul went, is wholly unknown. Nothing is known of the circumstances of this journey ; nor m the time which he spent there known. It is known indeed (ver. 18) that ha 298 GALATIANS. [A. D.58. Arabia, and returned again unto Damascus. did not go to Jerusalem until three years after his conversion, but how large a part of this time was spent in Damas- cus, we have no means of ascertaining. Ft is probable that Paul was engaged during these three years in preaching the gospel in Damascus and the adjacent regions, and in Arabia. Comp. Acts ix. 20. 22. 27, The account of this journey into Arabia is wholly omitted by Luke in the Acts of the Apostles, and this fact, as has been remarked by Paley (HorjB Paulinse, ch. v. No. 2), demonstrates that the Acts and this epistle were not written by the same author, or that the one is independent of the other ; because, " if the Acts of the Apostles had been a forged history made up from the epistle, it is impossible that this journey should have been passed over in silence ; if the epistle had been composed out of what the author had read of St. Paul's history in the Acts, it is unaccountable that it should have been inserted." As to the reason why Luke omitted to mention the journey into Arabia, nothing is known. Various con- jectures have been entertained, but they are mere conjectures. It is sufficient to Bay, that Luke has by no means re- corded all that Paul or the other apos- tles did, nor has he pretended to do it. He has given the leading events in the public labours of Paul; and it is not at all improbable that he has omitted not a few short excursions made by him for the purpose of preacl ing the gospel. The journey into Arabia, probably, did not furnish any incidents in regard to the success of the goftpel there which re- quired particular record by the sacred historian, nor has Paul himself referred to it for any such reason, or intimated that it furnished any incidents, or any facts, that required particularly the notice of the historian. He has men- tioned it for a different purpose alto- gether, to show that he did not receive his commission from the apostles, and that he did not go at onco to consult 18 Then " after three years I went * up to Jerusalem to see a Ac. 9. 26. » or, returned. them. He went directly the other way. As Luke, in the Acts, had no occasion to illustrate this ; as he had no occasion to refer to this argument, it did not fall in with his design to mention the fact. Nor is it known why Paul went into Arabia. Bloomfield supposes that it was in order to recover his health after the calamity which he suffered on the way to Damascus. But every thing in regard to this is mere conjecture. I should rather think it was more in accordance with the general character of Paul that he made this short excur- sion for the purpose of preaching the gospel. *\ And returned again unto Damascus. He did not go to Jerusa- lem to consult with the apostles after his visit to Arabia, but returned again to the place where he was converted and preached there, showing that he had not derived his commission from the other apostles. 18. Then after three years. Proba- bly three years after his departure from Jerusalem to Damascus, not after his return from Arabia. So most commenta- tors have understood it. t Went up to Jerusalem. More correctly, as in the margin, returned. ^ To see Peter. Peter was the oldest and most distin- guished of the apostles. In ch. ii. 9. he, with James and John, is called a pillar. But why Paul particularly went to see him is not known. It was probably, however, from the celebrity and distinction which he knew Peter had among the apostles that he wished to become particularly acquainted with him. The word which is here ren- dered to see (la-Tc^iia-cti) is by no means that which is commonly employed to denote that idea. It occurs nowhere else in the New Testament ; and pro- perly means to ascertain by personal inquiry and examination, and then to narrate, as a historian was accustomed to do, whence our woi'd history. The notion of personally seeing and examin- ing, is one that belongs essentially to A.D.58.] CHAPTER H. Peter, and abode with him fifteen days. 19 But other of the apostles 299 saw I none, save James * the Lord's brother. 20 Now the things which 1 a Mar. 6. 3. the word, and the idea here is that of seeing or visiting Peter in order to a personal acquaintance. ^ And abode with him fifteen days. Probably, says Bloomfield, including three Lord's-days. Why he departed then is unknown. Beza supposes that it was on account of the plots of the Grecians against him, and their intention to destroy him (Acts ix. 29) ; but this is not assigned by Paul himself as a reason. It is probable that the purpose of his visit to Peter would be accomplished in that time, and he would not spend more time than was necessary with him. It is clear that in the short space of two weeks he could not have been very extensively taught by Peter the nature of the Christian religion, and probably the time is men- tioned here to show that he had not been under the teaching of the apos- tles. 19. Save James the Lord's brother. That the James here referred to was an apostle, is clear. The whole con- struction of the sentence demands this su[)position. In the list of the apostles in Matt. x. 2, 3, two of this name are mentioned, James the son of Zebedee and brother of John, and James the son of Alpheus. From the Acts of the apostles, it is clear that thers were two of this name in Jerusalem. Of these, James the brother of John was slain by Herod (Acts xii. 2), and the other con- tinued to reside in Jerusalem. Acts XV. 13; xxi. 13. This latter James was f-alled James the Less (Mark xv. 40), to distinguish him from the other James, probably because he was the younger. It is probable that this was the James referred to here, as it is evident from the Acts of the Apostles that he was a prominent man among the apostles in Jerusalem. Commentators have not been agreed as to what is meant by his being the brother of the Lord Jesus. Doddridge understands it as meaning that he was " the near kinsman" or cousin- german to Jesus, for he was, says he, the son of Alpheus and Mary, the sister of the virgin ; and if there were but two of this name, this opinion is undoubt- edly correct. In the Apostolical Consti- tutions (see Rosenmuller) three of this name are mentioned as apostles or eminent men in Jerusalem ; and hence many have supposed that one of them was the son of Mary the mother of the Lord Jesus. It is said (Matt. xiii. 55) that the brothers of Jesus were James, and Joses, and Simon, and Judas ; and it is remarkable that three of the apostles bear the same names; James the son of Alpheus, Simon Zelotes, and Judas. John xiv. 22. It is indeed possible^ as Bloomfield remarks, that three bro- thers of our Lord and three of his apostles might bear the same names, and yet be different persons ; but such a coincidence would be very remark- able, and not easily explained. But if it were not so, then the James here was the son of Alpheus, and con- sequently a cousin of the Lord Jesus. The word brother may, according to Scripture usage, be understood as de- noting a near kinsman. See Schleus- ner (Lex. 2) on the word dSi\ must stand condemned by the law of God. In the legal sense he cannot be justified ; and justification, if it ever exist at all, must be in a mode that is a departure from the regular operation of law, and in a mode which the law did not contemplate, for no htw makes any provision for the pardon of those who violate it. It must be by some system which is distinct from the law, and in which man may be justified on different principles than those which the law con- templates. IV. This other system of justification is that which is revealed in the gospel by the faith of the JiOrd Jesus. It does not consist in either of the following things. (1.) It is not a system or plan where the Lord Jesus takes the part of the sinner against the law or against God. He did not come to show that the sinner was right, and that God was wrong. He admitted most fully, and endeavour- ed constantly to show, that God was right, and that the sinner was wrong ; nor can an instance be referred to where the Saviour took the part of the sinner against God in any such sense that he endeavoured to show that the sinner had not done the things charged on him, or that he had a right to do them. (2.) It is not that we are either inno- cent, or are declared to be innocent. God justifies the " ungodly." Rom. iv. 5, We are not innocent ; we never have been ; we never shall be ; and it is not the design of the scheme to declare any such untruth as that we are not person- ally undeserving. It will be always true that the justified sinner has no claims to the mercy and favour of God. (3.) It is not that we cease to be undeserv- ing personally. He that is justified by faiih, and that goes to heaven, will go there admitting that he deserves eternal death, and that he is saved wholly by favour and not by desert. (4.) It is not a declaration on the part of God that we have wrought out salvation, or that we have any claim for what the Lord Jesus has done. Such a declaration would not be true, and would not be made. (5.) It is not that the righteous- ness of the Lord Jesus is transferred to his people. Moral character cannot be A. D. 58.] CHAPTER II. 319 transferred. It adheres to the moral agent as much as colour does to the rays of light which cause it. It is not true that we died for sin, and it cannot be 60 reckoned or imputed. It is not true that we have any merit, or any claim, and it cannot be so reckoned or imputed. All the imputations of God are according to truth; and he will al- ways reckon us to be personally unde- serving and sinful. But if justification be none of these things, it may be asked, what is it ] I answer — It is ike declared purpose of God to regard and treat those sinners who believe iii the Lord Jesus Christ as if they had not sinned, on the ground of the merits of the Saviour. It is not mere pardon. The main difference between pardon and justification respects the sinner con- templated in regard to his past conduct, and to God's future dealings with him. Pardon is a free forgiveness of past of- fences. It has reference to those sins as forgiven and blotted out. It is an act of remission on the part of God. Jus- tification has respect to the law, and to God's future dealings with the sinner. It is an act by which God determines to treat him hereafter as a righteous man, or as (/"he had not sinned. The ground or reason of this is, the merit of the Lord Jesus Christ ; merit such that we can plead it as if it were our own. The rationale of it is, that the Lord Jesus has accomplished by his death the same happy elfects in regard to the law and the government of God, which would be accomplished by the death of the sinner himself. In other words, no- thing would be gained to the universe by the everlasting punishment of the offend- er himself, which will not be secured by his salvation on the ground of the death of the Lord Jesus. He has taken our place, and died in our stead ; and he has met the descending stroke of justice, which would have fallen on our own head if he had not interposed (see my Notes on Isa. liii.) ; and now the great interests of justice will be as firmly se- cured if we arc saved, as they would be if we were lost. The law has been fully obeyed by one who came to save us, and o-s much honour has been done to it by his obedience as could have been by our own ; that is, it as much shows that the law is worthy of obedience to have it perfectly obeyed by the Lord Jesus, as it would if it were obeyed by us. It as much shows that the law of a sovereign is worthy of obedience to have it obeyed by an only son and an heir to the crown, as it does to have it obeyed by his subjects. And it has as much shown the evil of the violation of the law to have the Lord Jesus suffer death on the cross, as it would if the guilty had died themselves. If trans- gression whelm the innocent in calamity; if it extends to those who are perfectly guiltless, and inflicts pain and wo on them, it is as certainly an expression of the evil of transgression us if the guilty themselves sulfer. And an impression as deep has been made of the evil of sin by the sufferings of the Lord Jesus in our stead, as if we had suffered our- selves. He endured on the cross as in- tense agony as we can conceive it pos- sible for a sinner ever to endure ; and the dignity of the person who suffered^ THE iNCARXATE Goi), is morc than an equivalent for the more lengthened sor- rows which the penalty of the law ex- acts in hell. Besides, from the very dignity of the sufferer in our place, an impression has gone abroad on the uni- verse more deep and important than would have been by the sufferings of the individual himself in the virorld of wo. The sinner who is lost will be unknown to other worlds. His name may be unheard beyond the gates of the prison of despair. The impression which will be made on distant worlds by his individual sufferings will be as a part of the aggregate of wo, and his individual sorrows may make no im- pression on distant worlds. But not so with him who took our place. He stood in the centre of the universe. The sun grew dark, and the dead arose, and an- gels gazed upon the scene, and from his cross an impression went abroad to the farthest part of the universe, showing the tremendous effects of the violation of law, when not one soul could bo 320 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. 17 But if, wliile we seek to be justified by Christ, we ** our- a 1 Jno. 3. 9, 10. saved fiom its penalty without such sorrows of the Son of God. In virtue of all this, the offender, by believing on him, may be treated as if he had not ginned; and this constitutes justifica- tion. God admits him to favour as if he had himself obeyed the law, or borne its penalty, since as many good results will now follow from his salvation as could be derived from his punishment ; and since all the additional happy results will follow which can be derived from the exercise of pardoning mercy. The character of God is thus revealed. His mercy is shown. His determination to maintain his law is evinced. The truth is maintained ; and yet he shows the fulness of his mercy and the richness of his benevolence. 17. But if, while we seek to be justi- fied by Christ. The connexion here is not very clear, and the sense of the verse is somewhat obscure. Rosen- miiller supposes that this is an objection of a Jew, supposing that where the law of Moses is not observed there is no rule of life, and that therefore there must be sin ; and that since the doctrine of justification by faith taught that there was no necessity of obeying the cere- monial law of Moses, therefore Christ, who had introduced that system, must be regarded as the author and encou- rager of sin. To me it seems proba- ble that Paul here has reference to an objection which has in all ages been brought against the doctrine of justifi- cation by faith, and which seems to have existed in his time, that the doc- trine leads to licentiousness. The ob- jections are, that it does not teach the ne- cessity of the observance of the law in order to acceptance with God. That it pronounces a man justified and ac- cepted who is a violator of the law. That his acceptance does not depend on moral character. That it releases him from the obligation of law, and that it teaches that a man may be saved though selves also are found sinners, is therefore Christ the minister of sin ? God forbid. he does not conform to law. These ob- jections existed early, and have been found everywhere where the doctrine of justification by faith has been preached. I regard this verse, therefore, as refer- ring to these objections, and not as being peculiarly the objection of a Jew. The idea is, * You seek to be justified by faith without obeying the law. You pro- fessedly reject that, and do not hold that it is necessary to yield obedience to it. If now it shall turn out that you are sinners ; that your lives are not holy ; that you are free from the wholesome re- straint of the law, and are given up to lives of sin, will it not follow that Christ is the cause of it ; that he taught it ; and that the system which he introduced is responsible for it 1 And is not the gospel therefore responsible for introducing a system that frees from the restraint of the law, and introduces universal licen- tiousness ]' To this Paul replies by stating distinctly that the gospel has no such tendency, and particularly by re- ferring in the following verses to his own case, and to the effect of the doc- trine of justification on his own heart and life, t We ourselves are found sinners. If it turns out that we are sin- ners, or if others discover by undoubted demonstration that we lead lives of sin ; if they see us given up to a lawless life, and find us practising all kinds of evil ; if it shall be seen not only that we are not pardoned and made better by the gospel, but are actually made worse, and are freed from all moral restraint. ^ Is therefore Christ the minister of sin P Is it to be traced to him 1 Is it a fair and legitimate conclusion that this is the tendency of the gospel 1 Is it to be charged on him, and on the plan of justification through him, that a lax morality prevails, and that men are freed from the wholesome restraints of law? t God forbid. It is not so. This is not the proper effect of the gospel of Christ, and of the doctrine of justifica- A. D. 58.] CHAPTER II. 321 18 For if I build again the things which I destroyed, I make myself a transgressor. tion by faith. The system is not fitted to proiluce such a freedom from restraint, and if such a freedom exists, it is to be traced to something else than the gospel. 1 8. For if I build again the things which I destroyed. Paul here uses the first person ; but he evidently intends it as a general proposition, and means that if any one does it he becomes a transgressor. The sense is, that if a man, having removed or destroyed that which was evil, again introduces it or establishes it, he does wrong, and is a transgressor of the law of God. The particular application here, as it seems to me, is to the subject of circumcision and the other rites of the Mosaic law. They had been virtually abolished by the coming of the Redeemer, and by the doctrine of justification by faith. It had been seen that there was no neces- sity for their observance, and of that Peter and the others had been fully aware. Yet they were lending their influence again to establish them or to " build" them up again. They com- plied with them, and they insisted on the necessity of their observance. Their conduct, therefore, was that of building up again that which had once been de- stroyed, destroyed by the ministry, and toils, and death of the Lord Jesus, and by the fair influence of his gospel. To rebuild that again ; to re-establish those customs, was wrong, and now involved the guilt of a transgression of the law of God. Doddridge supposes that this is an address to the Galatians, and that the address to Peter closed at the pre- vious verse. But it is impossible to de- termine this and it seems to me more probable that this is all a part of the ad- dress to Peter ; or rather perhaps to the assembly when Peter was present. See Note on ver. 15. 19. For I through the law. On this passage the commentators are by no means agreed. It is agreed that in the 19 For I " through the law am dead to the law, that I might live ' unto God. aRo. 7.4, 10;8. 2. 6Ro. 6. 11, 14. phrase " am dead to the law," the law of Moses is referred to, and that the meaning is, that Paul had become dead to that as a ground or means of justifi- cation. He acted as though it were not ; or it ceased to have influence over him. A dead man is insensible to all around him. He hears nothing ; sees nothing ; and nothing affects him. So when we are said to be dead to any thing, the meaning is, that it does not have an in- fluence over us. In this sense Paul was dead to the law of Moses. He ceased to observe it as a ground of jus tification. It ceased to be the grand aim and purpose of his life, as it had been formerly, to obey it. He had higher purposes than that, and truly lived to God. See Note, Rom. vi. 2. But on the meaning of the phrase " through the law" (//« vo/ucv) there has been a great variety of opinion. Bloom- field, Rosenmiiller, and some others suppose that he means the Christian re- Ugion, and that the meaning is, " by one law, or doctrine, I am dead to another;" that is, the Christian doc- trine has caused me to cast aside the Mosaic religion. Doddridge, Clarke, Chandler, and most others, however, suppose that he here refers to the law of Moses, and that the meaning is, that by contemplating the true character of the law of Moses itself; by considering its nature and design ; by understanding the extent of its requisitions, he had become dead to it ; that is, he had laid aside all expectations of being justified by it. This seems to me to be the cor- rect interpretation. Paul had formerly expected to be justified by the law. He had endeavoured to obey it. It had been the object of his life to comply with all its requisitions in order to be saved by it. Phil. iii. 4—6. But all this while he had not fully understood its nature ; and when he was made fully ts feel and comprehend its spiritual re- quirements, then all his hopes of justifi 322 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 20 I am crucified * with Christ : nevertheless I live ; yet a c. 5. 24 : 6. 14. cation by it died, and he became dead to It. See this sentiment more fully ex- plained in the Note on Rom. vii. 9. f That I might live unto God. That £ might be truly alive, and might be found engaged in his service. He was dead to the law, but not to every thing. He had not become literally inactive and insensible to all things, like a dead man, but he had become truly sensible to the commands and appeals of God, and had consecrated himself to his ser- vice. See Note, Rom. vi. 11. 20. I am crucijied with Christ. In the previous verse, Paul had said that he was dead. In this verse he states what he meant by it, and shows that he did not wish to be understood as saying that he was inactive, or that he was li- terally insensible to the appeals made to him by other beings and objects. In re- spect to one thing he was dead ; to all that was truly great and noble he was alive. To understand the remarkable phrase, " I am crucified with Christ," we may remark, (1.) That this was the way in which Christ was put to death. He suffered on a cross, and thus became literally dead. (2.) In a sense similar to this, Paul became dead to the law, to the world, and to sin. The Re- deemer by the death of the cross be- came insensible to all surrounding ob- jects, as the dead always are. He ceased to see, and hear, and was as though they were not. He was laid in the cold grave, and they did not affect or influ- ence him. So Paul says that he became msensible to the lav/ as a means of jus- tification ; to the world ; to ambition and the love of money ; to the pride and pomp of life, and to the dominion of evil and hateful passions. They lost their power over him ; they ceased to influence him. (3.) This was with Christ, or by Christ. It cannot mean literally that he was put to death with him, for that is not true. But it means that the effect of the death of Christ on the cross was to make him dead to not I, but Christ liveth in '' me : and the life which I now live in b 1 Th. 5. 10. 1 Pe. 4. 2. these things, in like manner as he, when he died, became insensible to the things of this busy world. This may include the following things, (a) There was an intimate union between Christ and his people, so that what affected himy affected them. See John xv. 5, 6. (Jb) The death of the Redeemer on the cross involved as a consequence the death of his people to the world and to sin. See ch. v. 24; vi. 14. It was like a blow at the root of a vine or a tree, which would affect every branch and tendril, or like a blow at the head which effects every member of the body, (c) Paul felt identified with the Lord Jesus ; and he was wiUing to share in all the ignominy and contempt which was connected with the idea of the crucifixion. Ha was willing to regard himself as one with the Redeemer. If there was dis« grace attached to the manner in which he died, he was willing to share it with him. He regarded it as a matter to be greatly desired to be made just likt Christ in all things, and even in tha manner of his death. This idea he has more fully expressed in Phil. iii. 10. '' That I may know him, \i. e. I desire earnestly to know him,] and the power of his resurrection, and the fellowship of his sufferings, being made conforma- ble unto his death." See also Col. i. 24, Comp. 1 Pet. iv. 1 3. f Nevertheless 1 live. This expression is added, as in ver. 19, to prevent the possibility of mistake. Paul, though he was cruci- fied with Christ, did not wish to be un- derstood that he felt himself to be dead. He was not inactive ; not insensible, 80 the dead are, to the appeals which an made from God, or to the great object* which ought to interest an immortrf mind. He was still actively employed, and the more so from the fact that he was crucified with Christ. The object of all such expressions as this is, to show that it was no design of the gospel to make men inactive, or to annihilate their energies. It was not to cause men A. D. 58.] CHAPTER 11. 323 the flesh, I live by the faith of the Son of God, who loved ttJno. 10. 11. Ep. 5. 2. to do nothing. It was not to paralyze their powers, or stifle their own efforts. Paul, therefore, says, ' I am not dead. I am tiuly alive; and I live a better life than I did before.' Paul was as active after conversion as he was before. Be- fore, he was engaged in persecution; now, he devoted his great talents with as much energy, and with as untiring zeal, to the cause of the great Redeemer. In- deed the whole narrative would lead us to suppose that he was more active and zealous after his conversion than he was before. The effect of religion is not to make one dead in regard to the putting forth of the energies of the soul. True religion never made one lazy man ; it has converted many a man of indolence, and effeminacy, and self-indulgence to a man actively en- gaged in doing good. If a professor of religion is less active in the service of God than he was in the service of the world ; less laborious, and zealous, and ardent than he was before his supposed conversion, he ought to set it down as full proof that he is an utter stranger to true religion. ^ Yet not I. This also is designed to prevent misapprehen- sion. In the previous clause he had said that he lived, or was actively en- gaged. But lest this should be misun- derstood, and it should be inferred that he meant to say it v/as by his own energy or powers, he guards it, and says it was not at all from himself. It was by no native tendency ; no power of his own ; nothing that could be traced to himself. He assumed no credit for any zeal which he had shown in the true life. He was dis{)osed to trace it all to another. He had ample proof in his past experience that there was no tendency in himself to a life of true religion, and he therefore traced it all to another. 1 Christ livcfh in me. Christ was the source of all the life that he had. Of course this cannot be taken literally that Christ had a resi- me, me. and gave himself * for 21 I do not frustrate the grace dence in the apostle, but it must mean that his grace resided in him ; that hL» principles actuated him ; and that htS derived all his energy, and zeal, and life from his grace. The union between the Lord Jesus and the disciple was so close that it might be said the one lived in the other. So the juices of the vine are in each branch, and leaf, and tendril, and Uve in them and animate them ; the vital energy of the brain is in each delicate nerve — no matter how small — that is found in any part of tho human frame. Christ was in him as it were the vital principle. All his life and energy were derived from him. ^ And the life which I now live in the Jlcsh. As I now live on the earth sur- rounded by the cares and anxieties of this life. I carry the life-giving princi- ples of my religion to all my duties and all my trials. ^ / live by the faith of the Son of God. By confidence in the Son of God, looking to him for strength, and trusting in his promises, and in his grace. Who loved me, &c. He felt under the highest obligation to him from the fact that he had loved him, and given himself to the death of the cross in his behalf The conviction of obligation on this account Paul often expresses. See Notes on Rom. vi. 8 — 1 1. Rom. viii. 35—39. 2 Cor. v. 15. There is no higher sense of obligation than that which is felt towards the Saviour ; and Paul felt himself bound, as we should, to live entirely to him who had redeemed liim by his blood. 21. 1 do not frustrate the grace of God. The word rendered "frustrate" (d^iTZ) means properly to displace, abrogate, abolish ; then to make void, to render null. Mark vii. 9. Luke vii. 30. 1 Cor. i. 19. The phrase " the grace of God," here refers to the favour of God manifested in the plan of salvation by the gospel, and is another name for the gospel. The sense is, that Paul would not take any measures or 324 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. of God : for if " righteousness cotne by the law, then Christ is dead in vain. oHe. 7. 11. pursue any course that would render that vain or inefficacious. Neither by his own Ufe, by a course of conduct which would show that it had no influ- ence over the heart and conduct, nor by the observance of Jewish rites and cus- toms, would he do any thing to render that inefficacious. The design is to show that he regarded it as a great prin- ciple that the gospel was efficacious in renewing and saving man, and he would do nothing that would tend to prevent that impression on mankind. A Hfe of sin, of open depravity and licentious- ness would do that. And in like man- ner a conformity to the rites of Moses as a ground of justification would tend to frustrate the grace of God, or to ren- der the method of salvation solely by the Redeemer nugatory. This is to be regarded, therefore, as at the same time a reproof of Peter for complying with customs which tended to frustrate the plan, of the gospel, and a declaration that he intended that his own course of life should be such as to confirm the plan, and show its efficacy in pardoning the sinner and rendering him alive in the service of God. t For if right- eousness come by the law. If justifica- tion can be secured by the observance of ani/ law — ceremonial or moral — then there was no need of the death of Christ as an atonement. This is plain. If man by conformity to any law could be justified before God, what need was there of an atonement? The work would then have been wholly in his own power, and the merit would have been his. It follows from this, that man cannot be justified by his own morality, or his alms-deeds, or his forms of religion, or his honesty and integrity. If he can, he needs no Saviour, he can save himself. It follows also that when men depend on their own amiableness, and morality, and good works, they would feel no need of a Saviour ; and this is the true reason why the mass of O CHAPTER III. FOOLISH " Galatians, who « hath bewitched you, that b Mat. 7. 26. c c. 5. 7. men reject the Lord Jesus. They sup pose they do not deserve to be sent to hell. They have no deep sense of guilt. They confide in their own in- tegrity, and feel that God ought to save them. Hence they feel no need of a Saviour; for why should a man in health employ a physician 1 And confiding in their own righteousness, they reject the grace of God, and despise the plan of justification through the Redeemer. To feel the need of a Saviour it is necessary to feel that we are lost and ruined sin- ners ; that we have no merit on which we can rely ; and that we are entirely dependent on the mercy of God for sal- vation. Thus feeling, we shall receive the salvation of the gospel with thank- fulness and joy, and show that in re- gard to us Christ is not "dead in vain." CHAPTER HI. AJfALTSIS. The address of Paul to Peter, as 1 suppose, was closed at the last verse of chapter ii. The apostle in this chapter, in a direct address to the Galatians, pursues the argument on the subject of justification by faith. In the previous chapters he had shown them fully that he had received his views of the gospel directly from the Lord Jesus, and that he had the concurrence of the most emi- nent among the apostles themselves. He proceeds to state more fully what his views were ; to confirm them by the authority of the Old Testament; and to show the necessary eflfect of an observ- ance of the laws of Moses on the great doctrine of justification by faith. Thia subject is pursued through this chapter and the following. This chapter com- prises the following subjects. (1.) A severe reproof of the Gala* tians for having been so easily seduced by the arts of cunning men from the simplicity of the gospel, ver. 1. He says that Christ had been plainly set forth crucified among them, and it was A.D. 5S.] CHAPTER II. $35 strange that they had so soon been led astray from the glorious doctrine of sal- vation by faith. (2.) He appeals to them to show that the great benefits which they had re- ceived iiad not been in consequence of the observance of the Mosaic rites, but had come solely by the hearing of the gospel, ver. 2 — 5. Particularly the Holy Spirit, with all his miraculous and converting and sanctifying influen- ces, had been imparted only in connex- ion with the gospel. This was the most rich and most valuable endowment which they had ever received ; and this was solely by the preaching of Christ and him crucified. (3.) In illustration of the doctrine of justification by faith, and in proof of the truth of it, he refers to the case of Abraham, and shows that he was justified in this manner, and that the Scripture had promised that others would be justified in the same way. ver. 6—9. (4.) He shows that the law pro- nounced a curse on all those who were under it, and that consequently it was impossible to be justified by it. But Christ had redeemed us from that curse, having taken the curse on himself, so that now we might be justified in the sight of God. In this way, says he, the blessing of Abraham might come on the Gentiles, and they all might be saved in the same manner that he was. ver. 10—14. (5.) This view he confirms by show- ing that the promise made to Abraham was made before the giving of the law. It was a mode of justification in exist- ence before the law of Moses was given. It was of the nature of a solemn com- pact or covenant on the part of God. It referred particularly to the Messiah, and to the mode of justification in him. And as it was of the nature of a cove- nant, it was impossible that the law given many years after could disannul it, or render it void. ver. 15 — 18. (6.) It might then be asked, what was the use of tlie law 1 Why was it given 1 It was added, Paul says, on ac- count of transgressions, and was de- 28 signed to restrain men from sin, and to show them their guilt. It was, further, not sitperior to the promise of a Media- tor, or to the Mediator, for it was ap- pointed by the instrumentality of angels, and it was in the hand of the Mediatoi himself, under him, and subject to him. It could not therefore be superior to him, and to the plan of justification through him. ver. 1 9, 20. (7.) Yet Paul answers an important objection here, and a very obvious and material inquiry. It is, whether he means to teach that the law of God is contradictory to his promises '' Whether the law and the gospel are rival sys- tems ] Whether it is necessary, in order to hold to the excellency of the one to hold that the other is contradictory, evil, and worthless 1 To all this he answers ; and says, by no means. He says the fault was not in the law. The view which he had taken, and which was re- vealed in the Bible, arose from the na- ture of the case. The law was as good a law as could be made, and it answered all the purposes of law. It was so ex cellent, that if it had been possible that men could be justified by law at all, that was the law by which it would have been done. But it was not possi- ble. The efiect of the law, therefore, was to show that all men were sinners, and to shut them up to the plan of justification by the work of a Re- deemer. It was appointed, therefore, not to justify men, but to lead them to the Saviour, ver. 21 — 24. (8.) The effect of the plan of justifi- cation by faith in the Lord Jesus was to 1 make the mind free. It was no longer under a schoolmaster. They who are justified in this way become the children of God. They all become one in the I Redeemer. 'I'here is neither Jew nor Greek, but they constitute one great family, and are the children of Abra- ham and heirs according to the promise, ver. 25—29. 1. foolish Galatians. That is, I foolish for having yielded to the influ- ence of the false teachers, and for hav- ing embraced doctrines that tended to subvert the gospel of the Redeemer 326 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 ye should not obey the truth, before whose eyes Jesus Christ The original word here used (uvmtci) denotes void of understanding; and they had shown it in a remarkable man- ner in rejecting the doctrine of the apostles, and in embracing the errors into which they had fallen. It will be remembered that this is an expression similar to what was applied to them by others. See the Introduction, § I. Thus Callimachus in his hymns calls them "a foolish people," and Hillary, himself a Gaul, calls them Gallos indociles, ex- pressions remarkably in accordance with that used here by Paul. It is implied that they were without stability of character. The particular thing to which Paul refers here is, that they were so easily led astray by the argu- ments of the false teachers. 1 Who hath bewitched you. The word here used (eySao-jcatvg) properly means, to prate about any one ; and then to mislead by pretences, as if by magic arts ; to fas- cinate ; to influence by a charm. The idea here is, that they had not been led by reason and by sober judgment, but that there must have been some charm or fascination to have taken them away in this manner from what they had em- braced as true, and what they had the fullest evidence was true. Paul had sufficient confidence in them to believe that they had not embraced their present views under the unbiassed influence of judgment and reason, but that there must have been some fascination or charm by which it was done. It was in fact accomplished by the arts and the plausible pretences of those who came from among the Jews. ^ That ye should not obey the truth. The truth of the gospel. That you should yield your minds to falsehood and error. It should be observed, however, that this phrase is wanting in many MSS. It is omitted in the Syrian version ; and many of the most important Greek and Latin Fathers omit it. Mill thinks it should be omitted ; and Griesbach has omitted it. It is not essential to the passage in order tc the srnse; and it hath been evidently set forth, crucified among you ? conveys no truth which is not elsewhere taught fully. It is apparently added to show what was the effect of their be- ing bewitched or enchanted. ^ Before whose eyes. In whose very presence. That is, it has been done so clearly that you may be said to have seen it. TI Jesus Christ hath been evidently set forth. By the preaching of the gos- pel. He has been so fully and plainly preached that you may be said to have seen him. The effect of his being preached in the manner in which it has been done, ought to have been as great as if you had seen him crucified before your eyes. The word rendered " hath been evidently set forth" (■^piy^d<^yi), means properly to write before ; and then to announce beforehand in writing ; or to announce by posting up on a tablet. The meaning here is, probably, that Christ had been announced among them crucified, as if the doctrine was set forth in a public written tablet.— Mobinson's Lex. There was the ut- most clearness and distinctness of view, so that they need not make any mistake in regard to him. The Syriac renders it, * Christ has "been crucified before your eyes as if he had been represented by painting.* According to this, the idea is, that it was as plain as if there had been a representation of him by a picture. This has been done chiefly by preaching. I see no reason, however, to doubt that Paul means also to include the celebration of the Lord's supper, in which the Lord Jesus is so clearly ex- hibited as a crucified Saviour. ^ Cmi' cijied among you. That is, represented among you as crucified. The words "among you," however, are wanting in many MSS. and obscure the sense. If they are to be retained, the meaning is, that the representations of the Lord Jesus as crucified had been as clear and impressive among them as if they had seen him with their own eyes. The argument is, that they had so clear a representation of the Lord Jesus, and of the design of Ns death, that it was A. D. 58.] CHAPTER III. 2 This only would I learn of you, Received ° ye the Spirit by aEp 1. 13. strange that they had so soon been per- verted from the belief of it. Had they seen the Saviour crucified ; had they stood by the cross and witnessed his agony in death on account of sin, how could they doubt what was the design of his dying, and how could they be se- duced from faith in his death, or be led to embrace any other method of justifi- cation ] How could they now do it, when, although they had not seen him die, they had the fullest knowledge of the object for which he gave his precious life ? The doctrine taught in this verse is, that a faithful exhibition of the suf- ferings and death of the Saviour ought to exert an influence over our minds and hearts as if we had seen him die ; and that they to whom such an exhibi- tion has been made should avoid being led astray by the blandishments of false doctrines, and by the arts of man. Had we seen the Saviour expire, we could never have forgotten the scene. Let us endeavour to cherish a remem- brance of his sufferings and death as if we had seen him die. 2. This only would I leairn of you. I would ask this of you ; retaining still the language of severe reproof. The design here, and in the following verses, is, io prove to them that the views which they had at first embraced were correct, and that the views which they now cherished were false. To show them this, he asks them the simple question, by what means they had obtained the exalted privileges which they enjoyed ? Whether they had obtained them by the simple gospel, or whether by the observance of the lawl The word " only" here {fAW(,v) implies that this was enough to settle the question. The argument to which he was about to ap- peal was enough for his purpose. He did not need to go any further. They had been converted. They had received the Holy Spirit. They had had abun- dant evidence of their acceptance with God, and the simple matter of inquiry the works of the law, hearing of faith ? tRo. 10. 17. or 397 by the now was, whether this had occurred as the regular effect of the gospel, or whether it had been by obeying the law of Moses] f Received ye the Spirit. The Holy Spirit. He refera here, doubtless, to all the manifestations of the Spirit which had been made to them, in renewing the heart, in sancti- fying the soul, in comforting them in affliction, and in his miraculous agency among them. The Holy Spirit had been conferred on ihem at their conver- sion (Comp. Acts X. 44; xi. 17), and this was to them proof of the favour of God, and of their being accepted by him. II By the works of the law. By obeying the law of Moses or of any law. It was in no way connected with their obeying the law. This must have been so clear to them that no one could have any doubt on the subject. The inestimably rich and precious gift of the Holy Spirit had not been conferred on them in consequence of their obeying the law. TI Or by the hearing of faith. In connexion with hearing the gospel requiring faith as a condition of salva- tion. The Holy Spirit was sent down only in connexion with the preaching of the gospel. It was a matter of truth, and which could not be denied, that those influences had not been imparted under the law, but had been connected^ with the gospel of the Redeemer. Comp. Acts ii. The doctrine taught in this verse is, that the benefits result- ing to Christians from the gift of the Holy Spirit are enough to prove that the gospel is from God, and therefore true. This was the case with regard to the miraculous endowments communi- cated in the early ages of the church by the Holy Spirit ; for the miracles which were wrought, the knowledge of lan- guages imparted, and the conversion of thousands from the error of their ways, proved that the system was from heaven; and it is true now. Every Christian has had ample proof, from the influ- ences of the Spirit on his heart and 35>8 GALATIANS. [A. D, 58 3 Are ye so foolish ? having a c. 4. 9. b He. 9. 10. around him, that the system which is attended with such benefits is from- heaven. His own renewed heart ; his elevated and sanctified affections ; his exalted hopes; his consolations in trial ; his peace in the prospect of death, and the happy influences of the system around him in the conversion of others, and in the intelligence, order, and purity of the community, are ample proof that the religion is true. Such effects do not come from any attempt to keep the law ; t^hey result from no other system. No system of infidelity produces them; no mere system of infidelity can produce them. It is only by that pure system which proclaims salvation by the grace of God; which announces salvation by the merits of the Lord Jesus, that such effects are produced. The Saviour pro- mised the Holy Spirit to descend after his ascension to heaven to apply his work ; and everywhere, under the faithful preaching of the simple gospel, that Spirit keeps up the evidence of the truth of the system by his influences on the hearts and lives of men. 3. Are ye so foolish ? Can it be that you are so unwise? The idea is, that Paul hardly thought it credible that they could have pursued such a course. They had so cordially embraced the gospel when he preached to them, fthey had given such evidences that they were under its influence, that he regard- ed it as hardly possible that they should have so far abandoned it as to embrace such a system as they had done, ^ Hav- ing begun in the Spirit. That is, when the gospel was first preached to them. They had commenced their professedly Christian hfe under the influence of the Holy Spirit, and with the pure and spi- ritual worship of God. They had known the power and spirituality of the glorious gospel. They had been re- newed by the Spirit ; sanctified in some measure by him ; and had submitted themselves to the spiritual influences of the gospel. ^ Are ye now made perfect. Tindal renders this, " ye would "begun in the Spirit, are ye now made perfect ^ by the flesh? now end." The word here used (jT^TfAso)) means properly, to bring through to an end, to finish ; and the sense here has probably been expressed by Tindal. The idea of perfecting, in the sense in which we now use that word, is not implied in the original. It is that of finishing, ending, completing ; and the sense is ; ' You began your Christian career under the elevated and spiritual influences of Christianity, a system so pure and so exalted above the carnal ordinances of the Jews. Having begun thus, can it be that you site finish- ing your Christian course, or carrying it on to completion by the observance of those ordinances, as if they were more pure and elevating than Chris- tianity 1 Can it be that you regard them as an advance on the system of the gospel V 1 By the flesh. By the ob- servance of the carnal rites of the Jews, for so the word here evidently moans. This has not been an uncommon thing. Many have been professedly converted by the Spirit, and have soon fallen into the observance of mere rites and cere- monies, and depended mainly on them for salvation. Many churches have com- menced their career in an elevated and spiritual manner, and have ended in the observance of mere forms. So many Christians begin their course in a spi- ritual manner, and end it " in the flesh" in another sense. They soon conform to the world. They are brought under the influence of worldly appetites and propensities. They forget the spiritual nature of their religion ; and they live for the indulgence of ease, and for the gratification of the senses. They build them houses, and they " plant vine- yards," and they collect around them the instruments of music, and the bowl and the wine is in their feasts, and they surrender themselves to the luxury of living : and it seems as if they intended io perfect their Christianity by drawing around them as much of the world as possible. The beautiful simplicity of their early piety is gone. The blessed- A, D. 58.] CHAPTER III. 'S'29 4 Have ye suffered so * many things in vain? " if it be yet in vain. 5 He therefore that minister- cth ^ to you the Spirit, and work- « or, great. a 2 Jno. 8. b 2 Co. 3. 8. ness of those moments when they lived by simple faith has fled. The times when they sought all their consolation in God are no more ; and they now seem to differ from the world only in form. I dread to see a Christian inhe- rit much wealth, or even to be thrown into very prosperous business. I see in it a temptation to build himself a splen- did mansion, and to collect around him all that constitutes luxury among the people of the world. How natural for him to feel that if he has wealth like others, he should show it in a similar manner ! And how easy for the most humble and spiritually-minded Chris- tian, in the beginning of his Christian life, to become conformed to the world (such is the weakness of human nature in its best forms) ; and having begun in the spirit, to end in the flesh ! 4. Have ye suffered so many things in vain P Paul reminds them of what they had endured on account of their attachment to Christianity. He assures them, that if the opinions on account of which they had suffered were false, then their sufferings had been in vain. They were of no use to them — for what advantage was it to suffer for a false opinion 1 The opinions for which they had suffered had not been those which they now embraced. They were not those connected with the observance of the Jewish rites. They had suffered on account of their having embraced the gospel, the system of justification by a crucified Redeemer ; and now, if those sentiments were wrong, why, their suf- ferings had been wholly in vain. See this argument pursued at much greater length in 1 Cor. xv. 18, 19. 29—32. t If it be yet in vain. That is, ' I trust it is not in vain. I hope you have not so far abandoned the gospel, that all 28* eth miracles among you, doeth he it by the works of the law or by the hearing of faith ? 6 Even as Abraham ' believed God, and it was ^ accounted to him for righteousness. c Ge. 15. 6. ^ or, imputed. your sufferings in its behalf have been of no avail. I believe the system ia true ; and if true, and you are sincere Christians, it will not be in vain that you have suffered in its behalf, though you have gone astray. I trust, that al- though your principles have been shaken, yet they have not been wholly over thrown, and that you will yet reap the reward of your having suffered so much on account of the gospel.' 5. He therefore that ministerethy &c. This verse contains substantially a repetition of the argument in ver. 2. The argument is, that the gift of the Holy Spirit to them was not imparted in consequence of the observance of the law of Moses, but in connexion with the preaching of the gospel. By the word " he" in this place, Clarke, Dod- dridge, Bioomfield, Chandler, Locke, and many others, suppose that the apos- tle means himself. Bioomfield says, that it is the common opinion of " all the ancient commentators." But this seems to me a strange opinion. The obvious reference, it seems to me, is to God, who had furnished or imparted to them the remarkable influences of the Holy Spirit, and this had been done in connexion with the preaching of the gospel, and not by the observance of the law. If, however, it refers to Paul, it means that he had been made the agent or instrument in imparting to them those remarkable endowments, and that this had been done by one who had not enforced the necessity of o'oeying the law of Moses, but who had preached to them the simple gospel. 6. Even as Abraham believed God, &c. See this passage fully explained in the Notes on Rom. iv. 3. The pas- sage is introduced here by the apostle to show that the most eminent of the 330 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 7 Know ye therefore, that they which are of faith, the same are the children " of Abraham. o Jno. 8. 39. Ro. 4. 11—16. patriarchs was not saved by the deeds of the law. He was saved by faith, and this fact showed that it was possible to be saved in that way, and that it was the design of God to save men in this manner. Abraham -believed God, and was justified, before the law of Moses was given. It could not, therefore, be pretended that the law was necessary to justification; for if it had been, Abra- ham could not have* been saved. But if not necessary in his case, it was in no other; and this instance demonstrated that the false teachers among the Gala- tians were wrong even according to the Old Testament. 7. Know ye therefore, &c. Learn from this case. It is an inference which follows, that all they who believe are the children of Abraham. \ They which are of fail h. Who believe, and who are justified in tliis manner, t -Are the children of Abraham. Abraham was the " father of the faithful." The most remarkable trait in his character was his unwavering confidence in God. They who evinced the same trait, therefore, were worthy to be called his children. They would be justified in the same way, and in the same manner meet the approbation of God. It is implied here, that it was sufficient for salvation to have a character which would render it proper to say that we are the children of Abraham. If we are like him, if we evince the same spirit and character, we may be sure of salvation. 8. And the Scripture. The word Scripture refers to the Old Testament. See Note, John v. 39. It is here per- sonified, or spoken of as foreseeing. The idea is, that he by whom the Scrip- tures were inspired, foresaw that. It is agreeable, the meaning is, to the account on the subject in the Old Testament. The Syriac renders this, " Since God foreknew that the Gentiles would be justified by faith, he before announced 8 And the Scripture, foresee- ing that God would justify ^ the heathen through faith, preached b ver. 22. to Abraham, as the Scripture saith, in thee shall all nations be blessed." f Foreseeing. That is, this doctrine is contained in the Old Testament. It was foreseen and predicted that the hea- then would be justified by faith, and not by the works of the law. \ That God would justify the heathen. Gr. The nations — Td t^Tx — the Gentiles. The fact that the heathen, or the Gentiles would be admitted to the privileges of the true religion, and be interested in the benefits of the coming of the Mes- siah, is a fact which is everywhere abundantly predicted in the Old Testa- ment. As an instance, see Isa. xlix. 6. 22, 23 ; Ix. I do not know that it is anywhere distinctly foretold that the heathen would be justified by faith, nor does the argument of the apostle require us to believe this. He says that the Scriptures, i. e. he who inspired the Scriptures, foresaw that fact, and that the Scriptures were written as if with the knowledge of that fact ; but it is not directly affirmed. The whole structure and frame of the Old Testament, how- ever, proceeds on the supposition that it would be so ; and this is all that the declaration of the apostle requires us to understand. T[ Preached before the gos- pel. This translation does not convey quite the idea to us, which the language of Paul, in the original, would to the people to whom he addressed it. We have affixed a technical sense to the phrase ' to preach the gospel.' It is applied to the formal and public annun- ciation of the truths of religion, espe- cially the ' good news' of a Saviour's birth, and of redemption by his blood. But we are not required by the language used here to suppose that this was done to Abraham, or that 'the gospel* was preached to him in the sense in which we all now use that phrase. The ex- pression, in Greek (^rgcEyw^/^sAzVctTc/), means mcely, *the joyful r^ews was A. D. 58.] CHAPTER III. 331 before the gospel unto Abraham, sayiiig, * In thee shall all nations be blessed. 9 So then * they which be of a Ge. 12. 3 ; 22. 18. Ac. 3. 25. b c. 4. 28. announced beforehand to Abraham ;' scil. that in him should all the nations of the earth be blessed. It was implied, indeed, that it would be by the Messiah ; but the distinct pointof the ' good news' was not the 'gospel' as we understand it, but it was that somehow through him all the nations of the earth would be made happy. Tindal has well trans- lated it, "Showed beforehand glad tidings unto Abraham." This transla- tion should have been adopted in our common version. ^ In thee shall all nations be blessed. See Notes on Acts iii. 25. Rom. iv. 13. All nations should be made happy in him, or through him. The sense is, that the Messiah was to be descended from him, and the religion of the Messiah, producing peace and salvation, was to be extended to all the nations of the earth. See Gen. xii. 3. Comp. Note on ver. 16 of this chapter. 9. So then they which be of faith. They whose leading characteristic it is that they believe. This was the leading trait in the character of Abraham, and this is the leading thing required of those who embrace the gospel, and in the character of a true Christian. 1 Are blessed with faithful Abraham. In the same manner they are interested in the promises made to him, and they will be treated as he was. They are justified in the same manner, and ad- mitted to the same privileges on earth and in heaven. 10. For as many as are of the works of the law. As many as are seeking to be justified by yielding obedience to the law — whether the moral law, or the ceremonial law. The proposition is general; and it is designed to show that, from the nature of the case, it is impos- sible to be justified by the works of the law, since, under all circumstan*'.cs of faith are blessed with faithful Abraham. 10 For as many as are of the works of the law, are under the curse : for it is written, <" Cursed c De. 27. 26. obedience which we can render, we are still left with its heavy curse resting on us. t Are under the curse. The curse which the law of God denounces. Having failed by all their efforts to yield perfect obedience, they must, of course, be exposed to the curse which the law denounces on the guilty. The word rendered curse {tc-MTo^t) means, as with us, properly, imprecation, or cursing. It is used in the Scriptures particularly in the sense of the Hebrew n'7N, malediction, or execration (Job xxxi. 30. Jer. xxix. J 8. Dan. ix. 11) ; of the word mN?o (Mai. ii. 2. Rev. iii. 33) ; and especially of the common Hebrew word n'7^3, a curse. Gen. xxvii. 12, 13. Deut. xi. 26, 28, 29 ; xxiii. 5 ; xxvii. 13, et ssepe al. It is here used evidently in the sense of devoting to pu- nishment or destruction ; and the idea is, that all who attempt to secure salva- tion by the works of the law, must be exposed to its penalty. It denounces a curse on all who do not yield entire obedience ; and no partial compliance with its demands can save from the pe- nalty. 1 For it is written. The sub- stance of these words is found in Deut. xxviii. 26: "Cursed be he that con- firmeth not all the words of this law to do them." It is the solemn close of a series of maledictions, which Moses de- nounces in that chapter on the violators of the law. In this quotation, Paul has given the sense of the passage, but he has quoted literally neither from the Hebrew nor from the Septuagint. The sense, however, is retained. The word " cursed" here means, that the violator of the law shall be devoted to punish- ment or destruction. The phrase " that continueth not," in the Hebrew is " that confirmeth not" — that does not establish or confirm by his life. He would con- firm it by continuing to obey it ; and 333 GALATIANS. [A, D. 58. is every one that continueth not in all things which are written in the book of the law to do them. 11 But that no man is justified a Hab. 2. 4. ,hus the sense in Paul and in Moses is substantially the same. The word "ail" is not expressed in the Hebrew in Deu- teronomy, but it is evidently implied, and has been inserted by the EnglisK translators. It is found, however, in six MSS. of Kennicott and De Rossi ; in the Samaritan text; in the Septuagint; and in several of the Targums. — Clarke. t The hook of the law. That is, in the law. This phrase is not found in the passage in Deut. The expression there is, " the words of this law." Paul gives it a somewhat larger sense, and applies it to the whole of the law of God. The meaning is, that the whole law must be obeyed, or man cannot be justified by it, or will be exposed to its penalty and its curse. This idea is expressed more fully by James (ii. 10) : " Who- soever shall keep the whole law, and yet oifend in one point, he is guilty of all;" that is, he is guilty of breaking the law as a lohole, and must be held responsible for such violation. The sentiment here is one that is common to all law, and must be, from the nature of the case. The idea is, that a man who does not yield compliance to a whole law, is subject to its penalty, or to a curse. All law is sustained on this principle. A man who has been honest, and temperate, and industrious, and pa- triotic, if he commits a single act of murder, is subject to the curse of the law, and must meet the penalty. A man who has been honest and honourable in all his dealings, yet if he commit a sin- gU3 act of forgery, he must meet the curse denounced by the laws of his country, and bear the penalty. So, in all matters pertaining to law : no matter what the integrity of the man ; no mat- ter how upright he has been, yet, for the one offence the law denounces a pe- nalty, and he miist bear it. It is out of the question for him to be justified by by the law in the sight of God, it is evident : for, The "just shall live by faith. \^ And the law ^ is not of h Ro. 10. 5, 6. it. He cannot plead as a reason why he should not be condemned for the act of murder or forgery, that he has in all other respects obeyed the law, or even that he has been guilty of no such of- fences before. Such is the idea of Paul in the passage before us. It was clear to his view that man had not in all re- spects yielded obedience to the law of God. If he had not done this, it was impossible that he should be justified by the law, and he must bear its penalty. 11. But that no man is justified, &c. The argument which Paul has been pursuing he proceeds to confirm by an express declaration of the Bible. The argument is this : ♦ It is impossible that a man should be justified by the law, because God has appointed another way of justification.' But there cannot be two ways of obtaining life, and as he has appointed faith as the condition on which men shall live, he has pre- cluded from them the possibility of ob- taining salvation in any other mode. t For, The just shall live hy faith. This is quoted from Hab. ii. 4. This passage is also quoted by Paul in Rom. i. 17. See it explained in the Note on that verse. The sense here is, that life is promised to man only in connexion with faith. It is not by the works of the law that it is done. The condition of life is faith : and he lives who believes. The meaning is not, I apprehend, that the man who is justified by faith shall live, but that life is promised and exists only in connexion with faith, and that the just or righteous man obtains it only in this way. Of course it cannot be ob- tained by the observance of the law, but must be by some other scheme. 12. And the law is not of faith. The law is not a matter of faith; it does not relate to faith ; it does not re- quire faith ; it deals in other matters, and it pertains to another system thao A. D. 58.] CHAPTER III. 333 faith : but, Tlie " man that doeth them siiall live in them. 13 Christ * hath redeemed us a Le. 18. 5. Eze. 20. 11. 6 2 Co. 5,21. c. 4. 5, to faiih. t But, The man, &c. This is the language of the law, and this is what the law teaches. It does not make provision for faith, but it requires un- wavering and perpetual obedience, if man would obtain life by it. See this pas- sage explained in the Notes on Rom. x. 5. 13. Christ hath redeemed us. The word used here {i^nyj^ta-iv) is not that which is usually employed in the New Testament to denote redemption. That word is xwT^sa). The difference between them mainly is, that the word used here more usually relates to a purchase of any kind ; the other is used strictly with reference to a ransom. The word here used is more general in its mean- ing ; the other is strictly appropriated to a ransom. This distinction is not observable here, however, and the word here used is employed in the proper sense of redeem. It occurs in the New Testament only in this place, and in ch. iv. 5. Eph. v. 16. Col. iv. 5. It properly means, to pur- chase, to buy up ; and then to purchase any one, to redeem, to set free. Here it means, that Christ had purchased, or set us free from the curse of the law, by his being made a curse for us. On the meaning of the words redeem and ran- som, see my Notes on Rom. iii. 25, and Isa. xliii. 3. Comp. 2 Cor. v. 21. \ From the curse of the law. The curse which the law threatens, and which the execution of the law would inflict ; the punishment due to sin. This must mean, that he has rescued us from the consequences of transgression in the world of wo ; he has saved us from the punishment which our sins have de- served. The word, " us" here, must refer to oil who are redeemed ; that is, to the Gentiles as well as the Jews. The curse of the law is a curse which is due to sin, and cannot be regarded as applied particularly to any one class of men All who violate the law of God, from the curse of the law, being made a curse for us : for it is written, ' Cursed is every one that hangeth on a tree : c De. 21. 23. however that law may be made known, are exposed to its penalty. The word " law" here, relates to the law of God in general, to all the laws of God made known to man. The law of God de- nounced death as the wages of sin. It threatened punishment in the future world forever. That would certainly have been inflicted, but for the coming and death of Christ. The world is lying by nature under this curse, and it is sweeping the race on to ruin. Tf Being made a curse for us. This is an ex- ceedingly important expression. Tindal renders it, " And was made a cursed for us." The Greek word is k^to^o., the same word which is used in ver. 10. See Note on that verse. There is scarcely any passage in the New Testa- ment on which it is more important to have correct views than this; and scarcely any one on which more erro- neous opinions have been entertained. In regard to it, we may observe that it does not mean, (1.) That by being made a curse, his character or work were in any sense displeasing to God. He approved always of what the Lord Jesus did, and he regarded his whole character with love and approbation. The passage should never be so inter- preted as to leave the impression that he was in any conceivable sense the object of the divine displeasure. (2.) He was not ill-deserving. He was not blame-wor- thy. He had done no wrong. He was holy, harmless, undefiled. No crime charged upon him was proved ; and there is no clearer doctrine in the Bible than that in all his character and work the Lord Jesus was perfectly holy and pure. (3.) He was not guilty in any proper sense of the word. The word guilty means, properly, to be bound to punishment for crime. It does not mean properly, to be exposed to suffer- ing, but it always, when properly used, implies the notion of personal crime. I S34 GALATIANS. [A. D.58. Icnow that theologians have used the word in a somewhat different sense, but it is contrary to the common and just apprehensions of men. When we say that a man is guilty, we instinctively think of liis having committed a crime, or having done something wrong. When a jury fiiids a man guilty, it impHes that the man has committed a crime, and ought to be punished. But in this sense, and in no conceivable sense, where the word is properly used, was the Lord Jesus guilty. (4.) It cannot be meant that the Lord Jesus properly bore the penalty of the law. His suf- ferings were in the place of the penalty, not the penalty itself. They were a substitution for the penalty, and were, therefore, strictly and properly vicarious, and were not the identical sufferings which the sinner would himself have endured. There are some things in the penalty of the law, which the Lord Jesus did not endure, and which a sulv stitute or a vicarious victim could not endure. Remorse of conscience is a part of the inflicted penalty of the law, and will be a vital part of the sufferings of the sinner in hell — but the Lord Jesus did not endure that. Eternity of sufferings is an essential part of the penalty of the law — but the Lord Jesus did not suffer forever. Thus there are numerous sorrows connected with the consciousness of personal guilt, which the Lord Jesus did not and cannot en- dure. (5.) He was not sinful, or a sinner, in any sense. He did not so take human guilt upon him, that the words sinful and sinner could with any propriety be applied to him. They are not applied to him in any way in the Bible ; but the language there is unde- viating. It is, that in all senses he was holy and undefiled. And yet language is often used on this subject which is horrible and but httle short of blasphe- my, as if he was guilty, and as if he was even the greatest sinner in the uni- verse. I have heard language used which sent a thrill of horror to my heart; and language may be found in the wri^t- ings of those who hold to the doctrine of imputation in the strictest sense, which is but little short of blasphemy. I have hesitated whether I should copy expres- sions here on this subject from one of the greatest and best of men, — I mean Luther, — to show the nature of the views which men sometimes entertain on the subject of the imputation of sin to Christ. But as Luther deliberately published them to the world in his fa- vourite book, which he used to call his " Catharine de Bora," after the name of his wife; and as similar views are sometimes entertained now ; and as it is important that such views should be held up to universal abhorrence, — no matter how respectable the source from which they emanate, — I will copy a few of his expressions on this subject. " And this, no doubt, all the prophets did foresee in spirit, that Christ should become the greatest transgressor, mur derer, adulterer, thief, rebel, and bias phemer, that ever was or could re IX THE world. For he beujg made a sacrifice for the sins of the whole world, is not now an innocent person and without sins ; is not now the Son of God, born of the Virgin Mary; but a sinner which hath and carrieth the sin of Paul, who was a blasphemer, an oppressor, and a perse- cutor; of Peter, which denied Christ; of David, which was an adulterer, a murderer, and caused the Gentiles to blaspheme the name of the Lord ; and, briefly, which hath and beareth all the sins of all men in his body : not that he himself committed them, but for that he received them, being committed or done of us, and laid them upon his own body, that he might make satisfaction for them with his own blood. There- fore, this general sentence of Moses comprehendeth him also (albeit in his own person he was innocent), because it found him amongst sinners and trans- gressors ; like as the magistrate taketh him for a thief, and punisheth him whom he findeth among other thieves and transgressors, though he never com- mitted any thing worthy of death. When the law, therefore, found him among thieves, it condemned and killed him as a thief." *' If thou wilt deny him to be a sinner and accursed, deny. A. D. 58.] CHAPTER III. 335 also, that he was crucified and dead." *' But if it be not absurd to confess and belie i^e that Christ was crucified between two thieves, then it is not absurd to say that he was accursed, and of all sin- NEHS, THE RREATEST."* " God, OUT most merciful Father, sent his only Son into the world, and laid upon him all the sins of all men, saying, be thou Pe- ter, that denier ; Paul, that persecutor, ulasphemer, and cruel oppressor ; David, that adulterer ; that sinner which did eat the apple in Paradise ; that thief which hanged upon the cross ; and, briefly, be thou the person which hath committed the sins of all men ; see, therefore, that thou pay and satisfy for them." — Luther on the Galatians, ch. iii. 13. [pp. 213—215. Ed. Lond. 1838.] Luther was a great and holy man. He held, as firmly as any one can, to the personal holiness of the Re- deemer. But this language shows how imperfect and erroneous views may warp the language of holy men; and how those sentiments led him to use language which is little less than blasphemy. Indeed, we cannot doubt that if Luther had heard this very lan- guage used by one of the numerous enemies of the gospel in his time, as applicable to the Saviour, he would have poured out the full torrent of his burning wrath, and all the stern denun- ciations of his most impassioned elo- quence, on the head of the scoffer and the blasphemer. It is singular, it is one of the remarkable facts in the history of mind, that a man with the New Tes- tament before him, and accustomed to contemplate daily its language, could ever have allowed himself to use ex- pressions like these of the holy and un- spotted Saviour. But what is the meaning of the language of Paul, it will be asked, when he says that he was "made a curse for us T' In reply, I answer, that the meaning must be as- certained from the passage which Paul quotes in support of his assertion, that Christ was " made a curse for us." That passage is, " Cursed is every one that ♦ The underscoring is mine. hangeth on a tree." This passage is found in Deut. xxi. 23. It occurs in a law respecting one who was hanged for a " sin worthy of death." ver. 22, The law^ was, that he should be buried the same day, and that the body should not remain suspended over the night, and it is added, as a reason for this, that " he that is hanged is accursed of God ;" or, as it is in the margin, " the curse of God." The meaning is, that when one was executed for crime in this manner, he was the object of the Divine displea- sure and malediction. Regarded thus as an object accursed of God, there was a propriety that the man who was exe- cuted for crime should be buried as soon as possible, tbat the offensive ob- ject should be hidden from the view. In quoting this passage, Paul leaves out the words " of God," and simply says, that the one who was hanged on a tree was held accursed. The sense of the passage before us is, therefore, that Jesus was subjected to what was regarded as an accursed death. He was treated in his death as if he had been a criminal. He was put to death in the same man- ner as he would have been if he had himself been guilty of the violation of the law. Had he been a thief or a mur- derer ; had he committed the grossest and the blackest crimes, this would have been the punishment to which he would have been subjected. This was the mode of punishment adapted to those crimes, and he was treated as //"all these had been committed by him. Or, in other words, had he been guilty of all these, or any of these, he could not have been treated in a more shameful and ignominious manner than he was; nor could he have been subjected to a more cruel death. As has already been intimated, it does not mean that he waa guilty, nor that he was not the object of the approbation and love of God, but that his death was the same that it would have been if he had been the vilest of malefactors, and that that death was regarded by the law as accursed. It was by such substituted sorrows that we are saved ; and he consented to die the most shameful and painful death. $36 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. 14 That « the blessing of Abraham might come on the Gentiles through Jesus Christ ; aRo.4. 9,16. as if he were the vilest malefactor, in order that the most guilty and vile of thx°^,poor), because they could not impart spiritual riches. They really could confer few benefits on man. Or it may be, as Locke supposes, because the law kept men in the poor estate of pupils from the full enjoyment of the inheritance, ver. 1 — 3. 1 W/tereunto ye desire again to be in bondage. As if you 31 ments, whereunto ye desire again to be in bondage ? 10 Ye observe days, and months, and times, and years. had a wish to be under servitude. The absurdity is as great as it would be for a man who had been freed from slavery to desire again his chains. They had been freed by the gospel from the galling servitude of heathenism, and they now again had sunk into the Jewish obser- vances, as if they preferred slavery to freedom, and were willing to go from one form of it to another. The main idea is, that it is absurd for men who have been made free by the gospel to go back again into any kind of servitude or bondage. We may apply it to Christians now. Many sink into a kind of servitude not less* galling than was that to sin before their conversion. Some become the slaves of mere cere- monies and forms in religion. Some are slaves to fashion, and the world yet rules them with the hand of a tyrant. They have escaped, it may be, from the galling chains of ambition, and de- grading vice, and low sensuality ; but they became slaves to the love of mo- ney, or of dress, or of the fashions of the world, as if they loved slavery and chains,- and they seem no more able to break loose than the slave is to break the bonds which bind him. And some are slaves to some expensive and foolish habit. Professed Christians and Chrifitian ministers too become slaves to the disgusting and loathsome habit of using tobacco, bound by a servitude as galling and as firm as that which ever shackled the limbs of an African. I grieve to add also that many professed Christians are slaves to the habit of " sit- ting long at the wine" and indulging in it freely. O that such knew the liberty of Christian freedom, and would break away from all such shackles, and show how the gospel frees men from all fool- ish and absurd customs ! 10. Ye observe. The object of this vei-se is to specify some of the things to which they had become enslaved- 362 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 111 am afraid of you, lest I have bestowed upon you labour in vain. H Days. The days here referred to are doubtless the days of the Jewish fes- tivals. They had numerous days of such observances, and in addition to those specified in the Old Testament, the Jews had added many others as days commemorative of the destruction and rebuilding of the temple, and of other important events in their history. It is not a fair interpretation of this to suppose that the apostle refers to the Sabbath, properly so called, for this was a part of the Decalogue ; and was observ- ed by the Saviour himself, and by the apostles also, liis a fair interpretation to apply it to all those days which are not commanded to be kept holy in the Scriptures ; and hence the passage is as applicable to the observance of saints' days, and days in honour of particular events in sacred history, as to the days observed by the Galatians. There is as real servitude in the observance of the numerous festivals and fasts in the Papal communion and in some Pro- testant Churches, as there was in the observance of the days in the Jewish ecclesiastical calendar, and for any thing that I can see, such observances are as inconsistent now with the freedom of the gospel as they were in the time of Paul. We should observe as seasons of holy time what it can be proved God has commanded us, and no more. Tf And mo7iths. The festivals of the new moon, kept by the Jews. Num. X. 10; xxviii. 11 — 14. On this fes- tival, in addition to the daily sacrifice, two bullocks, a ram, and seven sheep of a year old were offered in sacrifice. The appearance of the new-moon was announced by the sound of trum- pets. See Jahn, Archae. § 352. ^ And times. Seated times; festivals returning periodical ly, as the Passover, the feast of Pentecost, and the feast of Tabernacles. See Jahn, Archae. ch. iii. § 346 — 360, T And years. The sabbatical year, or the year of jubilee. See Jahn as above. be 12 Brethren, I beseech you. I for I am as ye 1 1. lam afraid of you, &c. I have fears respecting you. His fears were that they had no genuine Christian principle. They had been so easily perverted and turned back to the servi- tude of ceremonies and rites, that he was apprehensive that there could be no real Christian principle in the case. What pastor has not often had such fears of his people, when he sees them turn to the weak and beggarly elements of the world, or when, after having " run well," he sees them become the slaves of fashion, or of some habit in- consistent with the simplicity of the gospel 1 1 2. Brethren, I beseech ynu, be as 1 am, &c. There is great brevity in this passage, and no little obscurity, and a great many different interpretations have been given of it by commenta- tors. The various views expressed may be seen in Bloomfield's Crit. Dig. Locke renders it, " Let you and I be as if we were all one. Think yourselves to be very me ; as I in my own mind put no difference at all between you and myself." Koppe explains it thus : " Imitate my example ; for I, though a Jew by birth, care no more for Jewish rites than you." Rosenmiiller explains it, " Imitate my manner of life, in re- jecting the Jewish rites ; as I, having renounced the Jewish rites, was much like you when I preached the gospel to you." Other interpretations may be seen in Chandler, Doddridge, Calvin, &c. In our version there seems to be an impropriety of expression ; for if he was as they were it would seem to be a matter of course that they would be like him, or would resemble him. The sense of the passage, however, it seems to me cannot be difficult. The refer ence is doubtless to the Jewish rites and customs, and to the question whether they were binding on Chris- tians. Paul's object is to persuade them to abandon them. He appeals to A. P. 58.] CHAPTER IV. 363 are: ye liave not injured me It all. 13 Ye know how, through" in- a 1 Co. 2. 3. them, therefore, by his own example. And it means evidently, • Imitate me in this thing. Follow my example, and yield no conformity to those rites and customs.' The ground on which he asks them to imitate him may be either, (1.) That he had abandoned them, or, (2.) Because he asks them to yield a point to him. He had done 80 in many instances for their welfare, and had made many sacrifices for their salvation, and he now asks them to yield this one point, and to become as he was, and to cease these Jewish ob- servances, as he had done. ^ For I am as ye are. Gr. ' For 1 as ye.' This means, I suppose, 'For I have conformed to your customs in many things. I have abandoned my own peculiarities ; given up my customs as far as possible; conformed to you as Gentiles as far as I could do, in order to benefit and save you. I have laid aside the peculiarity of the Jew on the principle of becom- ing all things to all men (Notes, 1 Cor. ix. 20 — 22), in order that I might save you. I ask in return only the slight sacrifice that you will now become hke me in the matter under consideration.' ^ Ye have not iiijured me at all. ♦ It is not a personal matter. I have no cause of complaint. You have done me no personal wrong. There is no variance between us; no unkind feel- ing ; no injury done as individuals. I may, therefore, with the more freedom, ask you to yield this point, when I assure you that I do not feel personally injured. I have no wrong to complain of, and I ask it on higher grounds than would be an individual request : it is for your good, and the good of the great cause.' When Christians turn away from the truth, and disregard the instructions and exhortations of pastors, and become conformed to the world, it is not a personal matter, or a maf;er of personal offence to them, painful as it firmity of the flesh I preached the gospel jnto you at the first : 14 And my temptation which was in my flesh ye despised not, may be to them. They have no pecu- liar reason to say that they are person- ally injured. It is a itigher matter. The cause suffers. The interests of religion are injured. The church at large is offended, and the Saviour is " wounded in the house of his friends." Conformity to the world, or a lapse into some sin is a public offence, and should be regarded as an injury done to the cause of the Redeemer. It shows the magnanimity of Paul that, though they had abandoned his doctrines, and forgotten his love and his toils in their welfare, he did not regard it as a per- sonal offence, and did not consider him- self personally injured. An ambitious man or an impostor would have made that the main, if not the only thing. 13. Ye know how. To show them the folly of their embracing the new views which they had adopted, he re- minds them of past times, and particu- larly of the strength of the attachment which they had evinced for him in for- mer days, t Through infirmity of the fiesh. Qx. Weakness {ya^'micty"). Comp. Notes on 1 Cor. ii. 3. 2 Cor. x. 10 ; xii. 7. 14. And my temptation. My trial ; the thing which was to me a trial and calamity. The meaning, is, that he was afflicted with various calamities and infirmities, but that this did not hinder their receiving him as an angel from heaven. There is, however, a consider- able variety in the MSS. on this verse. Many MSS., instead of " my tempta tion," read " your temptation ;" and Mill maintains that this is the true read- ing. Griesbach hesitates between the two. But it is not very important ta determine which is the true reading. If it should be " your" then it means that they were tempted by his infirmities to reject him ; and so it amounts to about the same thing. The general sense is, that he had some bodily infirmity, per 364 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. nor rejected ; but received me as an angel * of God, even as Christ * Jesus. 15 Where * is then the bless- edness ye spake of? for 1 bear you record, that, if it had been o2Sa. 19.27. Mai. 2. 7. haps some periodically returning disease, that was a great trial to him, which they bore with with great patience and affection. What that was, he has not informed us, and conjecture is vain. ^ But received me as an angel of God. With the utmost respect, as if I had been an angel sent from God. ^ Even «s Christ Jesus. As you would have done the Redeemer himself. Learn hence, (1.) That the Lord Jesus is su- perior to an angel of God. (2.) That the highest proof of attachment to a mi- nister, is to receive him as the Saviour would be received. (3.) It showed their attachment to the Lord Jesus, that they received his apostle as they would have received the Saviour himself. Comp. Matt. x. 40. 15. Where is then the blessedness. Marg. '■ What was' — in accordance with the Greek. The words " ye spake of " are not in the Greek, and should have been printed in Italic. But they obscure the sense at any rate. This is not to be regarded as a question, asking what had become of the blessedness, imply- ing that it had departed ; but it is rather to be regarded as an exclamation, refer- ring to the happiness of that moment, and their affection and joy when they thus received him. ' What blessedness you had then ! How happy was that moment ! What tenderness of affection ! What overflowing joy !' It was a time full of joy, and love, and affectionate confidence. So Tindal well renders it, " How happy were ye then !" In this interpretation, Doddridge, RosenmiiUer, Bloomfield, Koppe, Chandler, and others concur. Locke renders it, " What be- nedictions did you then pour out on me !" 1 For J bear yoxi record. I tes- tify. 1 Ye would have plucked out youf oivn eyes, Sec. No higher proof possible, ye would have plucked out your own eyes, and have given them to me. 16 Am I therefore become your enemy, because I tell you the truth ? b Mat. 10. 40. « or, what was. of attachment could have been given. They loved him so much, that they would have given to him any thing, however dear; they would have done any thing to contribute to his welfare. How changed, now that they had aban- doned his doctrines, and yielded them- selves to the guidance of those who taught a wholly different doctrine ! 16. Am I therefore become your ene- my, &c. Is my telling you the truth in regard to the tendency of the doctrines which you have embraceii, and the cha- racter of those who have led you astray, and your own error, a proof that I have ceased to be your friend 1 How apt are we to feel that the man who tells us of our faults is our enemy ! How apt are we to treat him coldly, and to " cut his acquaintance," and to regard him with dislike ! The reason is, he gives us pain ; and we cannot have pain given us, even by the stone against which we stumble, or by any of the brute creation, without momentary indignation, or re- garding them for a time as our enemies. Besides, we do not like to have another person acquainted with our faults and our follies ; and we naturally avoid the society of those who are thus acquainted with us. Such is human nature ; and it requires no little grace for us to over- come this, and to regard the man who tells us of our faults, or the faults of our families, as our friend. We love to be flattered, and to have our friends flatter- ed ; and we shrink with pain from any exposure, or any necessity for repent- ance. Hence we become alienated from him who is faithful in reproving us for our faults. Hence men become offend- ed with their ministers when they re- prove them for their sins. Hence they become offended at the truth. Hence they resist the infl of the Holy A. D. 58.] CHAPTER IV 3G! 17 They zealously affect you, but " not well ; yea, they would aRo. 10.2. Spirit, wliose office it is to bring the truth to the heart, and to reprove men for their sins. There is nothing more difficult than to regard with steady and unwavering affection the man who faith- fully tells us the truth at all times, when that truth is painful. Yet he is our best friend. " Faithful are the wounds of a friend, but the kisses of an enemy are deceitful." Prov. xxvii. 6. If I am in danger of falling down a precipice, he shows to me the purest friendship who tells me of it ; if I am in danger of breathing the air of the pestilence, and it can be avoided, he shows to me pure kindness who tells me of it. So still more, if I am indulging in a course of conduct that may ruin me, or cherish- ing error that may endanger my salva- tion, he shows me the purest friend- ship who is most faithful in warning me, and apprizing me of what must be the termination of my course. 17. They zealously affect you. Sec 1 Cor. xii. 31 (Gr.) ; xiv. 39. The word here used (Zxxoa), means to be zealous towards, i. e. for or against any person or thing ; usually, in a good sense, to be eager for. Here it means, that the false teachers made a show of zeal towards the Galatians, or professed atTection for them in order to gain them as their followers. They were full of ardour, and professed an extraordinary concern for their welfare — as men always do who are demagogues, or who seek to gain proselytes. The object of the apostle in this is, probably, to say, that it was not wholly owing to them- selves that they had become alienated from the doctrines which he had taught. Great pains had been taken to do it; and there had been a show of zeal which would be likely to endanger any person. t But not well. Not with good mo- tives, or with good designs, f Yea, they would exclude you. Marg. Us. A few printed editions of the New Tes- tament have iffA-i!, us, instead of u/j.d{, 31* exclude * you, that ye might af feet them. 18 But it is good to be zeal you. — MIH. The word exclude hcrf probably means, that they endeavoured to exclude the Galatians from the love and affection of Paul. They would shut them out from that, in order that they might secure them for their own purposes. If the reading in the mar- gin, however, should be retained, the sense would be clearer. * They wish to exclude us, i. e. me, the apostle, in order that they may have you wholly to them- selves. If they can once get rid of your attachment to me, then they will have no difficulty in securing you for them- selves.' This reading, says Rosenmiil- ler, is found " in many of the best co- dices, and versions, and fathers." It ia adopted by Doddridge, Locke, and others. The main idea is clear : Paul stood in the way of their designs. The Gala- tians were truly attached to him, and it was necessary, in order to accomplish their ends, to withdraw their affections from him. When false teachers have designs on a people, they begin by alienating their confidence and affec- tions from their pastors and teachers They can hope for no success until thia is done ; and hence the efforts of error- ists, and of infidels, and of scorners, is to undermine the confidence of a people in the ministry, and when this is done there is little difficulty in drawing them over to their own purposes. \ That ye might affect them. The same word as in the former part of the verse, — ' thai ye might zealously affect them' — i. e that ye might show ardent attachmen' to them. Their Jlrst work is to mani fest special interest for your welfare their second, to alienate you from hinr who had first preached the gospel to you ■ their object, not your salvation, or youi real good, but to secure your zealou? love for themselves. 18. But it is good to be zealously af- fected. The meaning of this is, ' Under- stand me : I do not speak against zeal, I have not a word to say in its dispa- 300 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 ously affected always ■ in « good thing, and not only when I am present with you. 19 My * little children, of whom I travail in birth again un- til Christ be formed in you, ragement. In itself, it is good ; and their zeal would be good if it were in a good cause.' Probably, they relied much on their zeal; perhaps they maintained, as ejrrorists and deceivers are very apt to do, that zeal was sufficient evidence of the goodness of their cause, and thct persons who are so very zealous could not possibly be bad men. How often is this plea set up by the friends of errorists and deceivers ! t -^nd not only when I am present with you. It seems to me that there is great adroitness and great delicacy of irony in this remark ; and that the apostle intends to remind them as gently as possible, that it would have been as well for them to have shown their zeal in a good cause when he was absent, as well as when he was with them. The sense may be, ' You were exceedingly zealous in a good cause when I was with you. You loved the truth; you loved me. Since I left you, and as soon almost as I was out of your sight, your zeal died away, and your ar- dent love for mc was transferred to others. Suffer me to remind you, that it would be well to be zealous of good when I am away, as well as when I am with you. There is not much true af- fection in that which dies away as soon as a man's back is turned.' The doc- trine is, that true zeal or love will live alike when the object is near and when it is removed ; when our friends are present with us, and when they leave us ; when their eye is upon us, and when it is turned away. 19. My Utile children. The lan- guage of tender affection, such as a pa- rent would use towards his own offspring. See Note, 1 Cor. iv. 15. Comp. Matt. xviii. 3. John xiii. 33. 1 John ii. 1. 12, 13; iv. 4; v. 21. The idea here j.s, that Paul felt that he sustained to- 20 I desire to be present with you now, and to change my voice ; for ^ I stand in doubt of you. 21 Tell me, ye that desire to a 1 Co. 15. 58. h 1 Co. 4. 15. « or, I am perplexed for you. wards them the relation of a father, and he had for them the deep and tender feelings of a parent. 1 Of whom I travail in birth again. For whose wel- fare I am deeply anxious : and for whom I endure deep anguish. Comp. 1 Cor. iv. 1.5. His anxiety for them he com- pares to the deepest sufferings which human nature endures; and his lan- guage here is a striking illustration of what ministers of the gospel should feel, and do sometimes feel, in regard to their people, f Until Christ be formed in you. The name Christ is often used to denote his religion, or the principles of his gospel. See Note on Rom. xiii. 14. Here it means, until Christ reigns wholly in your hearts; till you wholly and entirely embrace his doctrines ; and till you become wholly imbued with his spirit. See Ool. i. 27. 20. / desire to be present with you now. They had lost much by his ab- sence ; they had changed their views , they had in some measure become alienated from him ; and he wishes that he might be again with them, as he was before. He would hope to accomplish much more by his personal presence than he could by letter. ^ And to change my voice. That is, from com- plaint a-nd censure, to tones of entire confidence, f For 1 stand in doubt of you. Marg. ' I am perplexed for \you.' On the meaning of the word i here used, see Note on 2 Cor. iv. 8. I The sense is plain. Paul had much reason to doubt the sincerity and the solidity of their Christian principles, ' and he was deeply anxious on that ac- count. j 21. Tell me, &c. In order to show fully the nature and the effect of the law, Paul here introduces an illustration from an important fact in the Jewish A. D. 58.] CHAPTER IV. 3a7 be under the law, do ye not hear the law ? 22 For it is written, That history. This allegory has given great perplexity to expositors, and, in some respects, it is attended with real difficul- ty. An examination of the difficulties will be found in the larger commenta- ries. My object, without examining the expositions which have been pro- posed, will be to state, in as few words as possible, the simple meaning and de- sign of the allegory. The design it is not difficult to understand. It is to show the efftd of being under the bond- age or servitude of the Jewish laiv, compared with the freedom which the gospel imparts. Paul had addressed the Galatians as having a real desire to be under bondage, or to be servants. Note on ver. 9. He had represented Chris- tianity as a state of freedom, and Chris- tians as the sons of God — not servants, but freemen. To show the difference of the two conditions, he appeals to two cases which would furnish a striking illustration of them. The one was the case of Hagar and her son. The effect of bondage was well illustrated there. She and her son were treated with severity, and were cast out and per- secuted. This was a fair illustration of bondage under the law ; of the servi- tude to the laws of Moses ; and was a fit representation of Jerusalem as it was in the time of Paul. The other case was that of Isaac. He was the son of a free woman, and was treated accord- ingly. He was regarded as a son, not as a servant. And he was a fair illus- tration of the case of those who were made free by the gospel. They enjoyed a similar freedom and sonship, and should not seek a state of servitude or bondage. The condition of Isaac was a fit illustration of the New Jerusalem ; the heavenly city ; the true kingilom of God. But Paul does not mean to say, as I suppose, that the history of the son of Hagar and of the son of Re- becca was mere allegory, or that the narrative by Moses was deaigned to Abraham had two sons ; the ons " by a bond-maid, the other * by a free woman. aGe. 16. 15. tGe. 21.1, 2. represent the different condition of those who were under the law and under the gospel. He uses it simply, as showing the difference between servitude and freedom, and as a striking illustra- tion of the nature of the bondage to the Jewish law, and of the freedom of the gospel, just as any one may use a striking historical fact to illustrate a principle. These general remarks will constitute the basis of my interpretation of this celebrated allegory. The expres- sion " tell me," is one of affectionate re- monstrance and reasoning. See Luke vii. 42 : '• Tell me, therefore, which of these will love him most!" Comp. Isa. i. 18: " Come, now, and let us reason together, saiih the Lord." ^ Ye that desire to be under the law. Note ver. 9. You who wish to yield obedience to the laws of Moses. You who maintain that conformity to those laws is neces- sary to justification. ^ Do ye not hear the law ? Do you not understand what the law says 1 Will you not listen to its own admonitions, and the instruc- tion which may be derived from the law on the subject ? The word " law" here refers not to the commands that were uttered on mount Sinai, but to the book of the law. The passage to which re- ference is made is in the Book of Genesis ; but all the five books of Moses were by the Jews classed under the general name of the law. See Note on Luke xxiv. 44. The sense is, ' Will you not listen to a narrative found in one of the books of the law itself, fully illustrating the nature of that servitude which you wish]' 22. For it is written. Gen. xvi. xxi. ^ Abraham had two sons. Ish- niael and Isaac. Abraham subsequently had several sons by Keturah after the death of Sarah. Gen. xxvi. 1 — 6. But the two sons by Hagar and Sarah were the most prominent, and the events of their lives furnished the par- ticular illustration which Paul desired im GALATIANS. [A D. 58 23 But he who was of the * bond-womaii was born after the flesh ; but he of the free wo- man was by promise. ^ The one by a bund-maid. Ishmael, the son of Hagar. Hagar was an Egyptian slave, whom Sarah gave to Abraham in order that he might not be wholly without posterity. Gen. xvi. 3. 1 The other by a free woman. Isaac, the son of Sarah. Gen. xxi. 1 , 2. 23. But he who was of the bond-wo- man was born after the flesh. In the ordinary course of nature, without any special promise, or any unusual divine interposition, as in the case of Isaac. t But he of the free woman, &c. The birth of Isaac was in accordance with a special promise, and by a remarkable divine interposition. See Gen. xviii. 1 ; xxi. 1 , 2. Heb. xi. 1 1 , 1 2. Comp. Notes on Rom. iv. 19 — 21. The idea here of Paul is, that the son of the slave was in an humble and inferior con- dition from his very birth. Tlicre was no special promise attending him. He was born into a state of inferiority and servitude which attended him through his whole life. Isaac, however, was met with promises as soon as he was born, and was under the benefit of those promises as long as he lived. The object of Paul is, to state the truth in regard to a condition of servitude and slavery. It is attended with evils from beginning to end ; from the birth to the grave. By this illustration he means to show them the folly of becoming the voluntary slaves of the law after they had once been made free. 24. Which things. The different accounts of Ishmael and Isaac. 1 Are an allegory. May be regarded alle- gorically, or as illustrating great princi- ples in regard to the condition of slaves and freemen; and may therefore be used to illustrate the effect of servitude to the law of Moses compared with the freedom of the gospel. He does not mean to say that the historical re- cord of Moses was not true, or was merely allegorical ; nor does he mean 24 Which things are an alle- gory : ' for these are the two ^ covenants ; the one from the a Ro. 9. 7, 8. ft 1 Co. 10. 11. ' or, testaments. to say that Moses meant this to bi^ an allegory, or that he intended that it should be applied to the exact purpose to which Paul applied it. No such design is apparent in the narrative of Moses, and it is evident that he had no such intention. Nor can it be shown that Paul means to be understood as saying that Moses had any such design, or that his account was not a record of a plain historical fact. Paul uses it as he would any other historical fact that would illustrate the same principle, and he makes no more use of it than the Saviour did in his parables of real or fictitious narratives to illustrate an im- portant truth, or than we always do of real history to illustrate an important principle. The word which is here used by Paul {:.KX»y,^iU)) is derived from axxcc, another, and ixyogzicc, to speak, to speak openly or in public. — Passow. It properly means to speak any thing otherwise than it is under- stood (Passow); to speak allegorically ; to allegorize. The word does not occur elsewhere in the New Testament, nor is it found in the Septuagint, though it occurs often in the classic writers. An allegory is a continued metaphor. See Blair's Lectures, xv. It is a figurative sentence or discourse, in which the prin- cipal object is described by another sub- ject resembling it in its properties and circumstances. — Webster. Allegories are in words what hieroglyphics are in painting. The distinction between a parable and an allegory is said to be, that a parable is a supposed history to illustrate some important truth, as the parable of the good Samaritan, &c. an allegory is based on real facts. It is not probable, however, that this distinc- tion is always carefully observed. Some- times the allegory is based on the resemblance to some inanimate object, as in the beautiful allegory in the eightieth Psalin. Allegories, parables. A. D. 58.] CHAPTER IV. 369 mount * Sinai, " which gen- « Sina. a De. 33. 2. and metaphors abound in the writings of the East. Truth was more easily treasured up in this way, and could be better preserved and transmitted when it' was connected with an interesting story. The lively fancy of the people of the East also led them to this mode of communicating truth ; though a love for it is probably founded in human na- ture. The best sustained allegory of any considerable length in the world is, doubtless, Bunyan's Pilgrim's Progress; and yet this is among the most popular of all books. The ancient Jews were exceedingly fond of allegories, and even turned a considerable part of the Old Testament into allegory. The ancient Greek philosophers also were fond of this mode of teaching. Pythagoras instructed his followers in this manner, and this was common among the Greeks, and was imitated much by the early Christians. — Calmet. Many of the Christian fathers, of the school of Origen, made the Old Testament almost wholly allegorical, and found mysteries in the plainest narratives. The Bible became thus with them a book of enigmas, and exegesis consisted in an ingenious and fanciful accommodation of all the narratives in the Scriptures to events in subsequent times. The most fanciful, and the most ingenious man, on this principle, was the best in- terpreter ; and, as any man might attach any hidden mystery which he chose to the Scriptures, they became wholly useless as an infallible guide. Belter principles of interpretation now pre- vail ; and the great truth has gone forth, never more to be recalled, that the Bible is to be interpreted on the same princi- ple as all other books; that its language is to be investigated by the same laws as language in all other books; and that no more liberty is to be taken in allegorizing the Scriptures than may be taken with Herodotus or Livy. It is lawful to use narratives of real events to illustrate important principles always. Such a use is often made of history ; dereth to bondage, which is Agar. and such a use, I suppose, the apostle . Paul makes here of an important fact in the history of the Old Testament. ^ For these are. These may be used to represent the two covenants. The apostle could not mean that the sons of Sarah and of Hagar were literally the two covenants ; for this could not be true, and the declaration would be unintelligible. In what sense could Ishmael be called a covenant ? The meaning, therefore, must be, that they furnished an apt illustration or repre- sentation of the two covenants ; they would show what the nature of the two covenants was. The words " are" and " is" are often used in this sense in the Bible, to denote that one thing repre- sents another. Thus in the institution of the Lord's supper ; " Take, eat, this IS my body" (Matt. xxvi. 26) ; L e. this represents my body. The bread was not the living body that was then before them. So in ver. 28. "This is my blood of the new covenant ;" i. e. this represents my blood. The wine in the cup could not be the living Hood of the Redeemer that was then flow ing in his veins. See Note on that place. Comp. Gen. xli. 26. T[ The two cove- nants. Marg. Testaments. The word means, here, covenants or compacts. See Note on 1 Cor. xi. 25. The two covenants here referred to, are the one on mount Sinai made with the Jews, and the other that which is made with the people of God in the gospel. The one resembles the condition of bondage in which Hagar and her son were; the other the condition of freedom in which Sarah and Isaac were. ^ The one from the mount Sinai. Marg. Sina. The Greek is Sina, though the word may be written either way. 1 Which gender- eth to bondage. Which tends to pro- duce bondage or servitude. That is, the laws are stern and severe ; and the observance of them costly, and onerous like a state of bondage. See Note on Acts XV. 10. ^ Which is Agar. Which Hagar would appropriately represent 370 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. 25 For this Agar is mount Sinai in Arabia. And ^ answereth to Jerusalem which now is, and « or, 15 in the same rank with. is in bondage with her child- ren. 36 But Jerusalem " which is aHe. 12. 22. Re.21. 2, 10. The condition of servitude produced by the Jaw had a strong resemblance to her condition as a slave. 25. For this Agar is mount Sinai. This Hagar well represents the law given on mount Sinai. No one can believe that Paul meant to say that Hagar was literally mount Sinai. A great deal of perplexity has been felt in regard to this passage, and Bentley pro- posed to cancel it altogether as an inter- polation. But there is no good au- thority for this. Several MSS. and versions read it, " For this Sinai is a mountain in Arabia;" others, "to this Hagar Jerusalem answereth," &c. Griesbach has placed these readings in the margin, and has marked them as not to be rejected as certainly false, but as worthy of a more attentive examina- tion ; as sustained by some plausible ar- guments, though not in the whole satis- factory. The word Hagar in Arabic is said to signify a rock ,• and it has been supposed that the name was appropri- ately given to mount Sinai, because it was a pile of rocks, and that Paul had allusion to this meaning of the word here. So Chandler, Rosenmiiller, and others interpret it. But I cannot find in Castell or Gesenius that the word Hagar in Arabic has this significa- tion ; still less is there evidence that the name was ever given to mount Sinai by the Arabs, or that such a signi- fication was known to Paul. The plainest and most obvious sense of a passage is generally the true sense ; and the obvious sense here is, that Hagar was a fair representation of mount Sinai, and of the law given there. T[ In Arabia. Mount Sinai is situated in Arabia Petraea, or the Rocky. Ko- Benmiiller says that this means " in the Arabic language ;" but probably in this interpretation he stands alone. ^ And answereth to Jerusalem. Marg. Is in the same rank with. The margin is the better translation. The meaning is, it is just like it, or corresponds with it. Jerusalem as it is now {i. e. in the days of Paul), is like mount Sinai. It fs subject to laws, and rites, and customs ; bound by a state of servitude, and fear, and trembling, such as existed wheu the law was given on mount Sinai. There is no freedom ; there are no great and liberal views; there is none of the liberty which the gospel imparts to men. The w^ord a-vara^ii, answereth to, means properly to advance in order together ; to go together with, as sol- diers march along in the same rank: and then to correspond to. It meansr here that mount Sinai and Jerusalem as it then was would be fitted to march together in the same platoon or rank. In marshalling an army, care is taken to place soldiers of the same height, and size, and skill, and courage, if pos. sible, together. So here it means that they were alike. Both were connected with bondage, like Hagar. On the one, a law was given that led to bondage ,* and the other was in fact under & miserable servitude of rites and forms. t Which now is. As it exists now; that is, a slave to rites and forms, as it was in fact in the time of Paul. 11 And is in bondage. To laws and customs. She was under hard and oppressive rites, like slavery. She waa also in bondage to sin (John viii. 33, 34) ; but this does not seem to be the idea here. % With her children. Her inhabitants. She is represented as a mother, and her inhabitants, the Jewa^ are in the condition of the son of Hagar. On this passage comp. Note* on I Cor. X. 4. for a more full illustra- tion of the principles involved here. 26. But Jerusalem which is above. The spiritual Jerusalem ; the true church of God. Jerusalem was the place where God was worshipped, and hence it became synonymous with the word church, or is used to represent the people of God. The word rendered A. D. 58.] CHAPTER IV. 371 above is free, which is the mother of us all. 27 For it is written, " Rejoice thou barren that bearest not; o Is. 54.1. 6 Ac. 3.25. c. 3. 29. "above," (uva) means properly up above, that which is above ; and hence heavenly, celestial. Col. iii. 1, 2. John viii. 23. Here it means, the heavenly or celestial Jerusalem. Rev. xxi. 2 ; " And I John saw the holy city, new Jerusalem, coming down from God, out of heaven." Heb. xii. 22 : " Ye are come unto mount Zion, and unto the city of the living God, the heavenly Jerusalem." Here it is used to denote the church, as being of hea- venly origin, t Is free. The spirit of the gospel is that of freedom. It is freedom from sin, freedom from the bondage of rites and customs, and it tends to promote universal freedom. See Note on ver. 7. Comp. John viii. 32. 36. Note, 2 Cor. iii. 17. f Which is the mother of us all. Of all who are true Christians, whether we are by birth Jews or Gentiles. We should not, therefore, yield ourselves to any degrad- ing and abasing servitude of any kind. Comp. Note, 1 Cor. vi. 12. 27. For it is written. This passage ij» found in Isa. liv. 1. For an exposition of its meaning as it occurs there, see my Notes on Isaiah. The object of the apo*tle in introducing it here seems to be to prove that the Gentiles as well as the Jews would partake of the privi- leges connected with the heavenly Jerusalem. He had in the previous verse spoken of the Jerusalem from above as the common mother of all true Christians, whether by birth Jews or Gentiles. This might be disputed or doubted by the Jews ; and he there- fore adduces this proof from the Old Testament. Or if it was not doubted, still the quotation was pertinent, and would illustrate the sentiment which he had just uttered. The mention of Jerusalem as a mother seems to have suggested this text. Isaiah had spoken of Jerusalem as a female that had been break forth and cry, thou that travailest not ; for the desolate hath many more children than she which hath an husband. 28 Now we, ^ brethren, as long desolate and chililless, now re- joicing by a large accession from the Gentile world, and increased in num- bers like a female who should have more children than one who had been long married. To this Paul appropri- ately refers when he says that the whole church, Jews and Gentiles, were the children of the heavenly Jerusalem, represented here as a rejoicing mother. He has not quoted literally from the Hebrew, but he has used the Septua- gint version, and has retained the sense. The sense is, that the accession froiri the Gentile world would be far more nu- merous than the Jewish people had ever been ; a prophecy that has been already fulfilled. % Rejoice thou barren that bearest not. As a woman who has had no children would rejoice. This repre- sents probably the heathen world, as having been apparently forsaken and abandoned, and with whom there had been none of the true children of God. t Break forth and cry. Or ' break forth and exclaim ;' i. e. break out into loud and glad exclamations at the re- markable accession. The cry here re- ferred to was to be a joyful cry or shout; the language of exultation. So the Hebrew word in Isa. liv. 1 (yrrs) means. 1 For the desolate. She who was deso- late and apparently forsaken. It lite- rally refers to a woman who had seemed to be desolate and forsaken, who was unmarried. In Isaiah it may refer to Jerusalem, long forsaken and desolate, or as some suppose to the Gentile world. See my Note on Isa. liv. 1. t Than she which hath an husband. Perhaps referring to the Jewish people as in covenant with God, and often spoken of as married to him. Isa. Ixii. 4, 5 ; liv. 5. 28. Now we, brethren. We who are Christians. 1 Are the children of the promise. We so far resemble Isaac, 372 GALATIANS. [A.D. 58. Isaac was, are the children of promise. 29 But as then he " that was born after the flesh, persecuted him that was born after the Spi- rit, even so '' it is now. 30 Nevertheless, what saith oGe. 21.9. ftJno. 15. 19. c Ge. 21. 10, 12. that there are great and precious pro- mises made to us. We are not in the condition of Ishmael, to whom no pro- mise was made. 29. But as then he that was born af- ter the Jlesh. Ishmael. See ver. 23. Tf Persecuted him that was born after the Spirit. That is, Isaac. The phrase, " after the Spirit," here, is synonymous with * according to the promise' in the previous verse. It stands opposed to the phrase ' after the flesh,' and means that his birth was by the special or mi- raculous agency of God. See Rom. iv. It was not in the ordinary course of events. The persecution here referred to, was the injurious treatment which Isaac received from Ishmael, or the op- position which subsisted between them. The particular reference of Paul is doubtless to Gen. xxi. 9, where it is said that " Sarah saw the son of llagar the Egyptian, which she had borne unto Abraham, mocking." It was on ac- count of this, and at the special request of Sarah, that Hagar and her son were expelled from the house of Abraham. Gen. xxi. 10. ^ Eve7i so it is now. That is, Christians, the children of the promise, are persecuted by the Jews, the inhabitants of Jerusalem, " as it now is," and who are uninterested in the pro- mises, as Ishmael was. For an illus- tration of this, see Paley's Horas Pauli- nae, on this Epistle, No. V. Dr. Paley has remarked that it does not appear that the apostle Paul was ever set upon by the Gentiles, unless they were first stirred up by the Jews, except in two instances. One of these was at Phi- lippi, after the cure of the Pythoness (Acts xvi. 19) ; and the other at Ephe- Bus, at the instance of Demetrius. Acts " the Scripture ? Cast out the bond-woman and her son : for the son of the bond-woman shall not be heir with the son of the free woman. 31 So then, brethren, we are not children of the bond-woman, but of the free. xix. 24. The persecutions of the Chris- tians arose, therefore, mainly from the Jews, from those who were in bondage to the law, and to rites and customs ; and Paul's allusion here to the case of the persecution which Isaac the free-born son endured, is exceedingly pertinent and happy. .30. Nevertheless. But ( 'Axxa ). f What saith the Scripture? What does the Scripture teach on the subject ? What lesson does it convey in regard to the bondman 1 ^ Cast out the bund- woman and her son. This was the language of Sarah, in an address to Abraham, requesting him to cast out Hagar and Ishmael. Gen. xxi. 10. That was done. Paul uses it here as applicable to the case before him. As used by him, the meaning is, that every thing like servitude in the gospel is to be rejected, as Hagar and Ishmael were driven away. It does not mean, as it seems to me, that they were to expel the Jewish teachers in Galatia, but that they were to reject every thing like ser- vitude and bondage; they were to ad- here only to that which was free. Paul cannot here mean that the passage in Gen. xxi. 10, originally had reference to the gospel, for nothing evidently was farther from the mind of Sarah than any such reference; nor can it be shown that he meant to approve of or vindicate the conduct of Sarah ; but he finds a passage applicable to his purpose, and he conveys his ideas in that language as exactly expressing his meanirg. We all use language in that way wherever we find it. 31. So then, brethren. It follows from all this. Not from the allegory regarded as an argument — for Paul does A.D.58.] CHAPTER IV. 373 not use it thus — ^but from the considera- tions suggested on the whole subject. Since the Christian religion is so supe- rior to the Jewish ; since we are by it freed from degrading servitude, and are not in bondage to rites and ceremonies; since it was designed to make us truly free, and since by that religion we are admitted to the privileges of sons, and are no longer under laws, and tutors, and governors, as if we were minors; from all this it follows, that we should feel and act, not as if we were children of a bondwoman, and born in slavery, but as if we were children of a free- woman, and born to liberty. It is the birthright of Christians to think, and feel, and act like freemen, and they should not allow themselves to become the slaves of customs, and rites, and ceremonies, but should feel that they are the adopted children of God. Thus closes this celebrated allegory — an allegory that has greatly perplexed most expositors, and most readers of the Bible. In view of it, and of the exposition above, there are a few remarks which may not inappropriately be made. (1.) It is by no means affirmed, that the history of Hagar and Sarah in Ge- nesis, had any original reference to the gospel. The account there is a plain historical narrative, not designed to have any such reference. (2.) The narrative contains import- ant principles, that may be used as il- lustrating truth, and is so used by the apostle Paul. There are parallel points between the history and the truths of religion, where the one may be illus- trated by the other. (3.) The apostle does not use it at all in the way of argument, or as if that proved that the Galatians were not to submit to the Jewish rites and customs. It is an illustration of the comparative nature of servitude and freedom, and would, therefore, illustrate the difference between a servile compliance with Jew- ish rites, and the freedom of the (4.) This use of an historical fact by the apostle does not make it proper for us to turn the Old Testament into alle- 32 gory, or even to make a very free use of this mode of illustrating truth. That an allegory may be used sometimes with advantage, no one can doubt while the " Pilgrim's Progress" shall exist. Nor can any one doubt that Paul has here derived, in this manner, an important and striking illustration of truth from the Old Testament. But no one ac- quainted with the history of interpreta- tion can doubt that vast injury has been done by a fanciful mode of explaining the Old Testament; by making every fact in its history an allegory ; and every pin and pillar of the tabernacle and the temple a type. Nothing is bet- ter fitted to bring the whole science of interpretation into contempt ; nothing more dishonours the Bible, than to make it a book of enigmas, and religion to consist in puerile conceits. The Bible is a book of sense ; and all the doctrines essential to salvation are plainly reveal- ed. It should be interpreted, not by mere conceit and by fancy, but by the sober laws according to which are inter- preted other books. It should be ex- plained, not under the influence of a vivid imagination, but under the influ- ence of a heart imbued with a love of truth, and by an understanding disci- plined to investigate the meaning of words and phrases, and capable of ren- dering a reason for the interpretation which is proposed. Men may abun- dantly use the facts in the Old Testa- ment to illustrate human nature, as Paul did ; but far distant be the day, when the principles of Origcn and of Cocceius shall again prevail, and when it shall be assumed, that " the Bible means every thing that it can be made to mean." CHAPTER V. AXALTSIS. This chapter is, properly, a continua- tion of the argument in the previous chapter, and is designed to induce the Galatians to renounce their conformity to the Jewish law, and to become en- tirely conformed to the gospel. In par- ticular, it seems to be designed to meet a '\iarge that had been brought against hi , that he had preached the necessity 374 S CHAPTER V. TAND " fast therefore in the '' liberty wherewith Christ a Ep. 6. 14. b .Ino. 8. 32, 36. Ro. 6. 18. Ac. 15. 10. of circumcision, or that he had so prac- tised it, as to show that he believed that it was obligatory on others. Under his example, or pleading his authority, it seems the false teachers there had urged the necessity of its observance. See ver. 1 1 . The argument and the exhorta- tion consist of the following parts. I. He exhorts them to stand firm in the liberty of Christianity, and not to be brought again under bondage, ver. 1. II. He solemnly assures them, that if they depended on circumcision for sal- vation, they could derive no benefit from Christ. They put themselves into a per- fect legal state, and must depend on that alone; and that was equivalent to re- nouncing Christ altogether, or to falling from grace, ver. 2 — 6. III. He assures them that their pre- sent belief could not have come from him by whom they were originally brought to the knowledge of the truth ; but must have been from some foreign influence, operating like leaven, ver. 7—9. IV. He says he had confidence in them, on the whole, that they would obey the truth, and that they would suf- fer him who had troubled them to bear his proper judgment, gently insinuating that he should be disowned or cut off. ver. 10. 12. V. He vindicates himself from the charge that he preached the necessity of circumcision. His vindication was, that if he had done that, he would have escaped per^cution, for then the of- fence of the cross would have ceased, ver. 11. VI. He assures them that they had been called unto liberty ; that the gospel had made them free. Yet Paul felt how easy it was to abuse this doctrine, and to pretend that Christ had freed them from all restraint, and from the bondage of all law. Against, this he cautions them. Their liberty was not licentiousness. It GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. hath made us free, and be not en- tangled again with the yoke of bondage. 2 Behold, I Paul say unto you, was not freedom from all the restraints of law. It was not that they might give indulgence to the passions of the flesh. It was designed that they should serve one another ; and not fall into the in- dulgence of raging passions, producing strife and mutual hatred, ver. 13 — 15. VII. To illustrate this, and to show them the evils of giving indulgence to their appetites under the pretence that they were free, he proceeds to show what were the passions to which carnal indulgence would give rise, or what were the works of the flesh, ver. 16 — 21. VIII. On the other hand, the Spirit produces a train of most lovely virtues, feelings, and affections, against which there could be no law. ver. 22, 23. IX. They who were Christians had in fact crucified the flesh. They were bound to live after the teachings of the Spirit, and Paul, therefore, exhorts them to lay aside all vain-glory and envy, and to live in peace, ver. 24 — 26. 1. Standfast, therefore. Be firm and unwavering. This verse properly be- longs to the previous chapter, and should not have been separated from it. The sense is, that they were to be firm and unyielding in maintaining the great principles of Christian liberty. They had been freed from the bondage of rites and ceremonies ; and they should by no means, and in no form, yield to them again. % In the liberty, &c. Comp. John viii. 32. 36. Rom. vi. 18. Notes, ch. iv. 3 — 5. 1 And be not entangled again. Tindal renders this, " And wrap not yourselves again." The sense is, do not again allow such a yoke to be put on you ; do not again become slaves to any rites, and customs, and habits. ^ The yoke of bondage. Of servitude to the Jewish laws. See Note, Acts XV. 10. 2. Behold, I Paul say tmto you. I, who at first preached the gospel to you ; I, too, who have been circumcised, and A. D. 58 f CHAPTER V. 375 that if ye be circumcised, Christ shall profit you nothing. 3 For I testify again to every who was formerly a strenuous asserter of the necessity of observing the laws of Moses ; and I, too, who am charged (see ver. 11) with still preaching the ne- cessity of circumcision, now solemnly say to you, that if you are circumcised with a view to being justified by that in whole or in part, it amounts to a rejec- tion of the doctrine of justification by Christ, and an entire apostasy from him. He is to be " a whole Saviour." No one is to share with him in the honour of sav- ing men ; and no rite, no custom, no ob- servance of law, is to divide the honour with his death. The design of Paul is to give them the most solemn assurance on tliis point ; and by his own authority and experience to guard them from the danger, and to put the matter to rest ^ Thai if ye be circumcised. This must be understood with reference to the subject under consideration. If you are cir- cumcised with such a view as is main- tained by the false teachers that have come among you ; that is, with an idea that it is necessary in order to your jus- tification. He evidently did not mean that if any of ihem had been circum- cised before their conversion to Chris- tianity ; nor could he mean to say, that circumcision in all cases amounted to a rejection of Christianity, for he had himself procured the circumcision of Timothy. Acts xvi. 3. If it was done, as it was then, for prudential considera- tions, and with a wish not necessarily to irritate the Jews, and to give one a more ready access to them, it was not to be regarded as wrong. But if, as the false teachers in Galatia claimed, as a thing essential to salvation, as indispensable to justification and acceptance with God, then the matter assumed a different as- pect ; and then it became in fact a re- nouncing of Christ as himself sufficient to save us. So with any thing else. Rites and ceremonies in religion may be in themselves well enough, if they are held to be matters not essential ; but the moment they are regarded as vital and man that is circumcised, that he is a debtor to do the whole law. 4 Christ is become of no ef- essential, that moment they begin to in- fringe on the doctrine of justification by faith alone, and that moment they are to be rejected ; and it is because of the danger that this will be the case, that they are to be used sparingly in the Christian church. Who does not know the danger of depending on prayers, and alms, and the sacraments, and extreme unction, and penance, and empty forms for salvation 1 And who does not know- how much in the Papal communion the great doctrine of justification has been obscured by numberless such rites and forms ] "f Christ shall profit you nothinvr. Will be of no advantage to you. Your dependence on circumcision, in these circumstances, will in fact amount to a rejection of the Saviour, and of the doctrine of justification by him. 3. For I testify again. Probably he had stated this when he had preached the gospel to them at first, and he now solemnly bears witness to the same thing again. Bloomfield, however, supposes that the word again here (jrdxiv) means, on the other hand, ox, furthermore,- or, as we would say, ' and again.' ^ Tliat he is a debtor to do the whole law. He binds himself to obey all the law of Moses. Circumcision was the distin- guishing badge of the Jews, as baptism is of Christians. A man, therefore, who became circumcised, became a professor of the Jewish religion, and bound him- self to obey all its peculiar laws. This must be understood, of course, with re- ference to the point under discussion ; and means, if he did it vvith a view to justification, or as a thing that was ne- cessary and binding. It would not ap- ply to such a case as that of Timothy where it was a matter of mere expe- diency or prudence. See Note on ver. 2. 4. Christ is become of no effect unto you. You will derive no advantage from Christ. His work in regard to you is needless and vain. If you can be justified in any other way than by him 376 GALATIANS. [A, D. 5S. feet " unto yon, whosoever of you are justified by the law : ye are fallen '' from grace. 5 For we through the Spirit then of course you do not need him, and your adoption of the other mode is in fact a renunciation of him. Tindal ren- ders this, " Ye are gone quite from Christ." The word here used (x-urot^ia), means, properly, to render inactive, idle, useless ; to do away, to put an end to ; and here it means that they had with- drawn from Christ, if they attempted to be justified by the law. They would not need him if they could be thus jus- tified ; and they could derive no benefit from him. A man who can be jus- tified by his own obedience, does not need the aid or the merit of another ; and if it was true, as they seemed to suppose, that they could be justified by the law, it followed that the work of Christ was in vain so far as they were concerned. *| Whosoever of you are jus- tijiedhy the law. On the supposition that any of you are justified by the law ; or if, as you seem to suppose, any are justified by the law. The apostle does not say that this had in fact ever occurred ; but he merely makes a supposition. If such a thing should or could occur, it would follow that you had fallen from grace. Tf Ye are fallen from grace. That is, this would amount to apostasy from the religion of the Redeemer, and would be in fact a rejection of the grace of- the gospel. That this had ever in fact oc- curred among true Christians the apos- tle does not affirm, unless he affirmed that men can in fact be justified by the law, since he makes the falling from grace a consequence of that. But did Paul mean to teach that ] Did he mean to affirm that any man in fact had been, or could be justified by his own obedience to the lawl Let his own writings answer. See, especially, Rom. iii. 20. But unless he held that, then this passage does not prove that any one who has ever been a true Christian has • fallen away. The fair interpretation of the passage does not demand that. Its wait " for the hope of righteous- ness '^ by faith. 6 For in Jesus Christ neither a Ro. 9. 31, 32. c Ro. 8. 23. b He 12. '5. d 2 Ti. 4 simple and obvious meaning is, that if a man who had been a professed Chris- tian should be justified by his own con formity to the law, and adopt that mode of justification, then that would amount to a rejection of the mode of salvation by Christ, and would be a renouncing of the plan of justification by grace. The two systems cannot be united. The adoption of the one is, in fact, a rejec- tion of the other. Christ will be " a whole Saviour," or none. This passage, therefore, cannot be adduced to prove that any true Christian has in fact fallen away from grace, unless it proves also that man may be justified by the deeds of the law, contrary to the repeated de- clarations of Paul himself. The word " grace" here, does not mean grace in the sense of personal religio7i, it means the system of salvation by grace, in contradistinction from that by merit or by works — the system of the gospel. 5. For we. We who are Chris- tians. It is a characteristic of the true Christian. t Through the Spirit. The Holy Spirit. We expect salvation only by his aid. ^ Wait for. That is, we expect salvation in this way. The main idea is, not that of waiting as if the thing were delayed,- it is that of expecting. The sense is, that true Christians have no other hope of salva- tion than by faith in the Lord Jesus. It is not by their own works, nor is it by any conformity to the law. The object of Paul is, to show them the true na- ture of the Christian hope of eternal life, and to recall them from dependence on their conformity to the law. ^ The hope of righteousness. The hope of justification. They had no other hope of justification than by faith in the Redeemer. See Note on Rom. i. 17. 6. Far in Jesus Christ. In the re- ligion which Christ came to establish. 1 Neither circumcision, Sec. It makes no difference whether a man is circum- A. D. 58.] CHAPTER V. 377 • circumcision availeth any thing, nor uncircumcision ; but failli which ' worketh by love. 7 Ye did run well ; who did * hinder you, that ye should not obey the truth? cised or not. He is not saved because he is circumcised, nor is he condemned because he is not. The design of Chris- tianity is to abohsh these rites and cere- monies, and to introduce a way of sal- vation that shall be applicable to all mankind alike. See Notes on ch. iii. 28. 1 Cor. vii. 19. Comp.Rom.ii. 29. t But faith which worketh by love. Faith that evinces its existence by love to God, and benevolence to men. It is not a mere intellectual belief, but it is that vehich reaches the heart, and con- trols the affections. It is not a dead faith, but it is that which is operative, and which is seen in Christian kindness and affection. It is not mere belief of the truth, or mere orthodoxy, but it is that which produces true attachment to others. A mere intellectual assent to the truth may leave the heart cold and unaffected ; mere orthodoxy, however bold, and self-confident, and " sound," may not be inconsistent with conten- tions, and strifes, and logomachies, and divisions. The true faith is that which is seen in benevolence, in love to God, in love to all who bear the Christian name ; in a readiness to do good to all mankind. This shows that the heart is affected by the faith that is held ; and this is the nature and design of all true religion. Tindal renders this, " faith, which by love is mighty in opera- tion." 7. Ye did run well. The Christian life is often represented as a race. See Notes on 1 Cor. ix. 24—26. Paul means here, that they began the Chris- tian life with ardour and zeal. Comp. ch. iv. 15. 1 Who did. kinder you. Marg. Drive you back. The word used here (*vax3TTa) means properly to beat or drive back. Hence it means to hinder, check, or retard. Dr. Dod- dridge remarks that this is " an Olympic 32* 8 This persuasion cometh not of him that calleth you. 9 A little ' leaven leaveneth the whole lump. a 1 Co. 7. 19. ' or, drive you back. 6 1Th.l.3. Ja.2.18— 22. c Mat. 13. 33. 1 Co. 5. 6. expression, and properly signifies com- ing across the course while a person is running in it, in such a manner as to jostle, and throw lim out of the way." Paul asks, with emphasis, who it could have been that retarded them in their Christian course, implying that it could have been done only by their own con- sent, or that there was really no cause why they should not have continued as they began. 1 That ye should not obey the truth. The trae system of justification by faith in the Redeemer. That you should have turned aside, and embraced the dangerous errors in re- gard to the necessity of obeying the laws of Moses. 8. This persuasion. This belief that it is necessary to obey the laws ot Moses, and to intermingle the observ- ance of Jewish rites with the belief of the Christian doctrines in order to be saved. K Not of him that calleth you. That is, of God, who had called them into his kingdom. That it refers to God and not to Paul is plain. They knew well enough that Paul had not persuaded them to it, and it was import- ant now to show them that it could not be traced to God, though they who taught it pretended to be commissioned by him. 9. A little leaven, &c. This is evi- dently a proverbial expression. See it explained in the Notes on 1 Cor. v. 6. Its meaning here is, that the embracing of the errors which they had adopted was to be traced to some influence ex- isting among themselves, and acting like leaven. It may either mean that there was existing among them from the first a slight tendency to conform to rites and customs, and that this had now like leaven pervaded the mass ; or it may mean that the false teachers there might be compared to leaven 378 GALATIANS. [A, D. 58. 10 I have confidence in you through the Lord, that ye will be none otherwise minded : but he that troubleth you shall bear whose doctrines, though they were few in number, had pervaded the mass of Christians ; or it may mean, as many have supposed, that any conformity to the Jewish law was like leaven. If they practised circumcision, it would not stop there. The tendency to con- form to Jewish rites would spread from that until it would infect all the doc- trines of religion, and they would fall into the observance of all the rites of the Jewish law. It seems to me that the second interpretation referred to above is the correct one ; and that the apostle means to say, that the influence which had brought this change about was at first small and unimportant; that there might have been but a few teachers of that kind, and it might have not been deemed worthy of par- ticular attention or alarm ; but that the doctrines thus infused into the churches, had spread like leaven, until the whole mass had become affected. 10. / have confidence in you, &c. Though they had been led astray, and had embraced many false opinions, yet, on the whole, Paul had confidence in their piety, and believed they would yet return and embrace the truth. 1 That ye will he none otherwise minded. That is, than you have been taught by me ; or than I think and teach on the subject. Paul doubtless means to say, that he had full confidence that they would embrace the views which he was inculcating on the subject of justi- fication, and he makes this remark in order to modify the severity of his tone of reprehension, and to show that, not- withstanding all he had said, he had confidence still in their piety. He be- lieved that they would coincide with him in his opinion, alike on the general subject of justification, and in regard to the cause of their alienation from the truth. He, therefore, gently insinuates that it was not to be traced to them- his "judgment, whosoever he be. 11 And I, brethren, if I yet preach circumcision, why do I a 2 Co. 10.6. selves that they had departed from the truth, but to the "little leaven" that had leavened the mass; and he adds that whoever had done this, should be held to be responsible for it. f But he that troubleth you. By leading you into error. Tl Shall bear his judgment Shall be responsible for it, and will re- ceive proper treatment from you. He gently states this general principle, which is so obvious ; states that he doeii not believe that the defection is to be traced to themselves; and designs to prepare their minds for a proposition which he intends to submit (ver 12), that the offending person or persona should be disowned and cut ofT. t Whosoever he be. ' I do not know who he is. I mention no names ; accuse no one by name ; and advise no severe measures against any particular individual. I state only the obvioud principle that every man should bear his own burden, and be held responsible for what he has done — no matter who he is.' 1 1. And I, brethren. Paul here pro. ceeds to vindicate himself from giving countenance to the doctrines which they had advanced there. It is evident that the false teachers in Galatia ap. pealed to Paul himself, and alleged that he insisted on the necessity of circum* cision, and that they were teaching no more than he taught. On what they founded this is unknown. It may have been mere slander ; or it may hav» arisen from the fact that he had circum- cised Timothy (Acts xvi. 3), and, pos- sibly, that he may have encouraged circumcision in some other similar cases. Or it may have been inferred from the fact (which was undoubtedly true) that Paul in general complied with the customs of the Jews when he was with them. But his conduct and example had been greatly perverted. He had never enjoined circumcision A. D. 58.] CHAPTER V. 379 yet suffer persecution ? " then is the offence * of the cross ceased. oc. 6. 12. ft 1 Co. 1.23. as necessary to salvation ; and had never complied with Jewish customs where there was danger that it would be understood that he regarded them as at all indispensable, or as furnishing a ground of acceptance with God. ^ If I yet preach circumcision. If I preach it as necessary to salvation ; or if I enjoin it on those who are converted to Christianity. \ Why do I yet suffer persecution ? That is, from the Jews. * Why do they oppose me 1 Circum- cision is the peculiar badge of the Jewish religion ; it implies all the rest (see ver. 2) ; and if I preach the neces- sity of that, it would satisfy the Jews, and save me from persecution. They would never persecute one who did that as they do me ; and the fact that I am thus persecuted by them is full demon- stration that I am not regarded as preaching the necessity of circum- cision.' It is remarkable that Paul does not expressly deny the charge. The reason may be, that his own word would be called in question, or that it might require much explanation to show why he had recommended cir- cumcision in any case, as in the case of Timothy. Acts xvi. 3. But the fact that he was persecuted by the Jews settled the question, and showed that he did not preach the necessity of cir- cumcision in any such sense as to satisfy them, or in any such sense as was claimed by the false teachers in Galatia. In regard to the fact that Paul was persecuted by the Jews, see Actsxiv. 1,2. 19; xvii.4, 5. 13. Comp. Paley, Horas Faulinae, Galat. No. V. ^ Then is the offence of the cross ceased. For if I should preach the necessity of circumcision, as is alleged, the of- fence of the cross of Christ would be removed. The necessity of depending on the merits of the sacrifice made on the cross would be taken away, since then men could be saved by conformity 12 I wouki they were even cut off which trouble you. 13 For, brethren, ye have been called unto liberty ; only to the laws of Moses. The very thinof that I have so much insisted on, and that has been such a stumbling-block to the Jews (Note, 1 Cor. i. 23), that con- formity to their rites was of no avail, and that they must be saved only by the merits of a crucified Saviour, would be done away with.' Paul means that if this had been done, he would have saved himself from giving offence, and from the evils of persecution. He would have preached that men could be Raved by conformity to Jewish rites, and that would have saved him from all the persecutions which he had en- dured in consequence of preaching the necessity of salvation by the cross. 12. / would they were even cut off. That is, as I understand it, from the communion of the church. So far am I, s3ys Paul, from agreeing with them, and preaching the necessity of circum- cision as they do, that I sincerely wish they were excluded from the church as unworthy a place among the children of God. For a very singular and mon- strous interpretation of this passage, though adopted by Chrysostom, Theo- doret, Theophylact, Jerome, Grotius, Rosenmiiller, Koppe, and others, the learned reader may consult Koppe on this verse. To my amazement, I find that this interpretation has also been adopted by Robinson in his Lexi- con, on the word dTOJtiWTi). 1 will state the opinion in the words of Koppe. No7i modo circunicidant se, sed, si velint, etiam mutilant se — ipsa geni- talia resecent. The simple meaning is, I think, that Paul wirshed that the authors of these errors and disturb- ances were excluded from the church. t Which trouble you. Who pervert the true doctrines of r-alvation, and w.lo thus introduce error into the church. Error always sooner or later causes trouble. Comp. Note, 1 Cor. v. 7. J 3. For, brelhren, ye have been 380 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. use not " liberty for an occasion to the flesh, but by love serve *one another. called unto liberty. Freedom from Jewish rites and ceremonies. See the Notes on eh. iii. 28; iv. 9. 21—31. The meaning here is, that Paul wished the false teachers removed because true Christians had been called unto liberty, and they were abridging and destroying that liberty. They were not in sub- jection to the law of Moses, or to any thing else that savoured of bondage. They were free ; free from the servitude of sin, and free from subjection to ex- pensive and burdensome rites and cus- toms. They were to remember this as a great and settled principle; and so vital a truth was this, and so important that it should be maintained, and so great the evil of forgetting it, that Paul says he earnestly wishes (ver. 12) that all who would reduce them to that state of servitude were cut off from the Christian church. 1 Only use not liberty, &c. The word use here intro- duced by our translators, obscures the sense. The idea is, * You are called to liberty, but it is not liberty for an occa- sion to the flesh. It is not freedom from virtuous restraints, and from the laws of God. It is liberty from the servitude of sin, and religious rites and ceremonies, not freedom from the neces- sary restraints of virtue.' It was neces- sary to give this caution, because, (I.) There was a strong tendency in all con- V rts from heathenism to relapse again ii to their former habits. Licentious- ness abounded, and where they had been addicted to it before their conver- sion, and where they were surrounded by it on every hand, they were in con- stant danger of falling into it again. A bare and naked declaration, there- 1 »re, that they had been called to li- lirty, to freedom from restraint, might have been misunderstood, and some might have supposed that they were free from all restraints, (2.) It is needful to guard the doctrine from abuse at all times. There has been a 14 For all the \2.w is ful filled in one word, even in this, a 1 Co. 8. 9. 1 Pe. 2. 16. b 1 Jno. 3. 18. strong tendency, as the history of the church has shown, to abuse the doc« trines of grace. The doctrine that Christians are " free ;" that there is liberty to them from restraint, has been perverted always by Antinomians, and been made the occasion of their indulg- ing freely in sin. And the result has shown that nothing was more import- ant than to guard the doctrine of Chris- tian liberty, and to show exactly what Christians are freed from, and what laws are still binding on them. Paul is, therefore, at great pains to show that the doctrines which he had maintained did not lead to licentiousness, and did not allow the indulgence of sinful and corrupt passions, t -^n occasion. As allowing indulgence to the flesh, or as a furtherance or help to corrupt pas- sions. See the word explained in the Notes on Rom. vii. 8. t To the flesh. The word flesh is often used in the writings of Paul to denote corrupt and gross passions and affections. See Notes on Rom. vii. 18 ; viii. 1. ^ Btit by love serve one another. By the proper manifestation of love one to another strive to promote each other's welfare. To do this will not be incon- sistent with the freedom of the gospel. When there is love there is no servi- tude. Duty is pleasant, and offices of kindness agreeable. Paul does not consider them as freed from all law and all restraint; but they are to be governed by the law of love. They were not to feel that they were so free that they might lawfully give indulgence to the desires of the flesh, but they were to regard themselves as under the law to love one another; and thus they would fulfil the law of Christian free- dom. 14. For all the law is fulfilled, A;c. That is, this expresses the substance of the whole law; it embraces and com- prises all. The apostle of course here alludes to the law in regard to our duty D. 58.] CHAPTER V. 331 " Thou shalt love thy neighbour as thyself. 15 But if ye bite and devour one another, take heed that ye he not consumed one of another. 4 Le. 19. 18. Mat. 22. 39, 40. Ja. 2. 8. b Ro. 8. 1,4, 13. » or, fulfil not. to our fellow-men, since that was the point which he particularly enforces. He is saying that this law would coun- teract all the evil workings of the flesh, and if this were fulfilled, all our duty to others would be discharged. A similar sentiment he has expressed in Rom. xiii. 8 — 10. See Notes on that passage. The turn here in the discussion is wor- thy of particular notice. With great skill he changes the subject from a doc- trinal argument to a strain of practical remark, and furnishes most important lessons for the right mode of overcoming our corrupt and sensual passions, and discharging our duty to others, f T/ioti shalt love thy neighbour, &c. See this explained in the Note on Matt. xix. 19. 15, But if ye bite. The word here used (Joxvcd), means, properly, to bite, to sting ; and here seems to be used in the sense of contending and striving — a me- taphor not improbably taken from dogs and wild beasts. ^ And devour one another. As wild beasts do. The sense is, ' if you contend with each other ;' and the reference is, probably, to the strifes which would arise between the two parties m the churches — the Jewish and the Gentile converts. ^ Take heed that ye be not consumed, &,c. As wild beasts contend sometimes until both are slain. Thus, the idea is, in their con- tentions they would destroy the spiritu- ality and happiness of each other ; their characters would be ruined ; and the church be overthrown. The readiest way to destroy the spirituality of a church, and to annihilate the influence of reli- gion, is to excite a spirit of contention. 16. This / say then. This is the true rule about overcoming the propen- sities of your carnal natures, and of avoiding the evils of strife and conten- tion ( Walk. The Christian life is 16 This I say then, Walk * in the Spirit, and ^ ye shall not ful- fil the lust of the flesh. 17 For -= the flesh lusteth against the Spirit, and the Spirit against the flesh : and these are c 2 Ro. 7. 21—23. often represented as a journey, and the word walk, in the Scripture, is often equivalent to live. Mark vii. 5. Notes, Rom. iv. 12; vi. 4; viii. 1. % In *he Spirit. Live under the influences of the Holy Spirit ; admit those influences fully into your hearts. Do not resist him, but yield to all his suggestions. See Note, Rom. viii. 1. What the Holy Spirit would produce, Paul states in ver. 22, 23. If a man would yield his heart to those influences, he would be able to overcome all his carnal propensities; and it is because he resists that Spirit, that he is ever overcome by the corrupt passions of his nature. Never was a better, a safer, or a more easy rule given to overcome our corrupt and sen- sual desires than that here furnished. Comp. Notes, Rom. viii. 1 — 13. ^ And ye shall not fulfil, &c. Marg. Fulfil not — as if it were a command. So Tin- dal renders it. But the more common interpretation, as it is the more signifi cant, is that adopted by our translators. Thus it is not merely a command, it is the statement of an important and deeply interesting truth — that the only way to overcome the corrupt desires and propen- sities of our nature, is by submitting to the influences of the Holy Spirit. It is not by philosophy ; it is not by mere resolutions to resist them ; it is not by the force of education and laws ; it is only by admitting into our souls the in- fluence of religion, and yielding our- selves to the guidance of the Holy Spirit of God. If we live under the influences of that Spirit, we need not fear the power of the sensual and corrupt propensities of our nature. 17. For the flesh lusteth against the Spirit. The inclinations and desires of the flesh are contrary to those of the Spirit. They draw us away in an op- GALATIANS. [A. D. 59 contrary " the one to the other ; oRo. 8. 6, 7. 6Ro. 7. 15, 19. posite direction, and while the Spirit of God would lead us one way, our carnal nature would lead us another, and thus produce the painful controversy which exists in our minds. The word " Spi- rit" here refers to the Spirit of God, and to his influences on the heart. ^ And these are contrary, «&c. They are op- posite in their nature. They never can harmonize. See Rom. viii. 6, 7. Comp. below ver. 19 — 23. The amtrariety Paul has illustrated by showing what each produces ; and they are as opposite as adultery, wrath, strife, murders, drunkenness, &c., are to love, joy, goodness, gentleness, and temperance. ^ So that ye cannot do the things that ye would. See this sentiment illus- trated in the Notes on Rom. vii. 15 — 19. The expressiori " cannot do" is stronger by far than the original, and it is doubt- ed whether the original will bear this interpretation. The literal translation would be, * Lest what ye will, those things ye should do' (iV* ^« « av ^iKn'Ti Tour A TTuiiTi). It is rendered by Dod- dridge, " So that ye do not the things that ye would." By Locke, " You do not the things that you propose to your- eelves ;" and Locke remarks on the pas- sage, " Ours is the only translation that I know which renders it cannot." The Vulgate and the Syriac give a literal translation of the Greek, " So that you do not what you would." This is un- doubtedly the true rendering ; and, in the original, there is no declaration about the possibility or the impossi- bility, the ability or the inability to do these things. It is simply a state- ment of a fact, as it is in Rom. vii. 15. 19. That statement is, that in the mind of a renewed man there is a con- trariety in the two influences which bear on his soul — the Spirit of God in- clining him in one direction, and the lusts of the flesh in another; that one of these influences is so great as in fact to restrain and control the mind, and prevent its doing what it would other- so that * ye cannot do the things that ye would. wise do ; that when there is an inclina- tion in one direction, there is a control- ling and overpowering influence in another, producing a conflict, which prevents it, and which finally checks and restrains the mind. There is no reason for interpreting this, moreover, as seems always to be the case, of the overpowering tendency in the mind to evil, as if it taught that the Christian was desirous of doing good, but could not, on account of his indwelling cor- ruption. So far as the language of Paul or the fact is concerned, it may be un- derstood of just the opposite, and may mean, that such are the restraints and influences of the Holy Spirit on the heart, that the Christian does not the evil which he otherwise would, and to which his corrupt nature inclines him. He (Paul) is exhorting them (ver. 16) to walk in the Spirit, and assures them that thus they would not fulfil the lusts of the flesh. To encourage them to this, he reminds them that there were contrary principles in their minds, the influences of the Spirit of God, and a carnal and downward tendency of the flesh. These are contrary one to the other; and such are, in fact, the influ- ences of the Spirit on the mind, that the Christian does not do the things which he otherwise would. So understood, or understood in any fair interpretation of the original, it makes no assertion about the ability or inability of man to do right or wrong. It affirms as a fact, that where these opposite principles exist, a man does not do the things which other- wise he would do. If a man could not do otherwise than he actually does, he would not be to blame. Whether a Christian could not resist the influences of the Holy Spirit, and yield to the cor- rupt desires of the flesh ; or whether he could not overcome these evil propensi- ties and do right always, are points on which the apostle here makes no aflSrma- tion. His is the statement of a mere fact, that where these counteracting A. D. 58.] CHArTER V. 383 18 But if ye be led of the Spirit, ye are not under the law. 19 Now the works of the flesh * are manifest ; which are a Ro. 6. 14 ; 8. 2. 6 Mat. 15. 19. Ep. 5. 3- 6. Oi> . 3. 5, 6. Re. 22. 15. piopensities exist in the mind, there is a conflict, and that the man does not do what he otherwise would do. 1 8. But if ye be led by the Spirit. If you submit to the teachings and guidance cf the Holy Spirit. ^ Ye are not under the law. You are under a different dispensation — the dispensation of the Spirit. You are free from the re- straints and control of the Mosaic law,and are under the control of the Spirit of God. 19. Now the v)orks of the Jlesh. What the flesh, or what corrupt and unrenewed human nature produces. ^ Are manfest. Plain, well-known. The world is fullof illustrations of what corrupt human nature produces, and as to the existence and nature of those, works, no one can be ignorant. It is evident here that the word > grown out of it, as a striking illustratioiT of the corrupt and depraved nature o{" man. f Hatred. Gr. Hatreds, in the plural. Antipathies, and want of love, producingcontentions and strifes, t ^- riance. Contentions. See Note, Rom. ' i. 29 f Emulations (^iihot). In a bad sense, meaning heart-burning, or jea- lousy, or perhaps inordinate ambition. The sense is ardour or zeal in a bad cause, leading to strife, &c. f Wrath. This also is plural in the Greek (^ujuo)), meaning passions, bursts of anger. Note, 2 Cor. xii. 20. t Strife. Also plural in the Greek. See Note, 2 Cor. xii. 20. 1 Seditions. See Note, Rom. xvi. 17. t Heresies. See Note, Acts V. 17. 1 Cor. xi. 19. 384 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58. 21 Eiivyings, murders, drunk- enness, revellings, and such like : of the which I tell you before, as I have also told you in time 21. Envyings. Note, 2 Cor. xii. 20. 1 Revellings. Notes, 2 Cor. xii. 20. ll.)m. xiii. 13. ^ And such like. This class of evils, without attempting to spe- cify all. t Of which I tell you before. In regard to which I forewarn you. % As I have also fold you in time past. When he was with them, f Shall not inherit the kingdom of God. Cannot possibly be saved. See Notes on 1 Cor. vi. 9 — 11. In regard to this passage, we may remark : (1.) That it furnishes the most striking and unanswerable proof of human depravity. Paul repre- sents these things as " the works of the flesh," th.-> works of the unrenewed na- ture of man. They are such as human nature, when left to itself, everywhere produces. The world shows that such is the fact ; and we cannot but ask, is a nature producing this to be regarded as pure 1 Is man an unfallen being 1 Can he save himself.' Does he need no Saviour 1 (2.) This passage is full of fearful admonition to those who indulge in any or all of these vices. Paul, in- spired of God, has solemnly declared, that such cannot be saved. They can- not enter into the kingdom of heaven as they are. Nor is it desirable that they should. What would heaven be if filled up with adulterers, and fornicators, and idolaters, with the proud and envious, and with murderers and drunkards] To call such a place heaven, would be an abuse of the word. No one could wish to dwell there; and such men cannot enter into heaven. (3.) The human heart must be changed, or man cannot be saved. This follows of course. If such is its tendency, then there is a necessity for such a change as that in re- generation in order that man may be happy and be saved. (4.) We should rejoice that such men cannot, with their present characters, be admitted to hea- ven. We should rejoice that there is past, that they which do such things shall not inherit the king- dom of God. 22 But the fruit « of the Spirit a Jno. 15. 5. Ep. 5. 9. one world where these vices are un- known, a world of perfect and eternal purity. When we look at the earth ; when we see how these vices prevail ; when we reflect that every land is pol- luted, and that we cannot traverse a continent or an island, visit a nook or corner of the earth, dwell in any city or town, where these vices do not exist, O how refreshing and invigorating is it to look forward to a pure heaven ! How cheering the thought that there is one world where these vices are unknown ; one world, all whose ample plains may be traversed, and the note of blasphemy shall never fall on the ear ; one world, where virtue shall be safe from the arts of the seducer ; one world where we may forever dwell, and not one reehng and staggering drunkard shall ever be seen ; where there shall be not one fa- mily in want and tears from the vice of its unfaithful head! With what joy should we look forward to that world ! With what ardour should we pant that it may be our own ! 22. But the fruit of the Spirit. That which the Holy Spirit produces. It is not without design, evidently, that the apostle uses the word " Spirit" here, as denoting that these things do not flow from our own nature. The vices above enumerated are the proper " works" or result of the Operations of the human heart ; the virtues which he enumerates are produced by a foreign influence — the agency of the Holy Spi- rit. Hence Paul does not trace them to our own hearts, even when renewed. He says that they are to be regarded as the proper result of the Spirit's opera- tions on the soul. T[ Is love. To God and to men. Probably the latter here is particularly intended, as the fruits of the Spirit are placed in contradistinction from those vices which lead to strifes among men. On the meaning of the A. D. 58.] CHAPTER V. 385 IS love, joy, peace, long-suf- fering, gentleness, goodness, faith, word love, see Notes on 1 Cor. xiii. 1; and for an illustration of its operations and effects, see the Notes on that whole chai»ter. % Joy. In the love of God ; in the evidences of pardon ; in commu- nion with the Redeemer, ami in his ser- vice ; in the duties of religion, in trial, and in the hope of heaven. See Notes, Rom. V. 2. Comp. 1 Pet. i. 8. ^ Peace. As the result of recon- ciliation with God. See Notes, Rom. V. 1. t Long-suffering. In affliction and trial, and when injured by others. See Note, 1 Cor. xiii. 4. ^ Gentleness. The same word which is translated kindness in 2 Cor. vi. G. See Note on that place. The word means good- ness, kindness, benignity ; and is op- posed to a harsh, crabbed, crooked temper. It is a disposition to be pleased ; it is mildness of temper, calmness of spirit, an unruffled disposition, and a disposition to treat all with urbanity and politeness. This is one of the regular effects of the Spirit's operations on the heart. Religion makes no one crabbed, and morose, and sour. It sweetens the temper ; corrects an irrita- ble disposition ; makes the heart kind ; disposes us to make all around us as happy as possible. This is true polite- ness ; a kind of politeness which can far better be learned in the school of Christ than in that of Chesterfield ; by the study of the New Testament than under the direction of the dancing-mas- ter, t Goodness. See Note on Rom. XV. 14. Here the word seems to be used in the sense of beneficence, or a disposition to do good to others. The sense is, that a Christian must be a good man. t Faith. On the meaning of the word faith, see Note on Mark xvi. 16. The word here may be used in the Bense oi fidelity, and may denote that the Christian will be a faithful man, a man faithful to his word and promises ; a man who can be trusted or confided in. It is probable that the word is used 33 23 Meekness, temperance against " such there is no law. alTi. 1.9 in this sense because the object of the apostle is not to speak of the feelings which we have towards God so much as to illustrate the influences of the Spirit in directing and controlling our feelings towards men. True religion makes a man faithful. The Christian is faithful as a man; faithful as a neighbour, friend, father, husband, son. He is faithful to his contracts ; faithful to his promisesL No man can be a Christian who is not thus faithful, and all jjretensions to being under the influ- ences of the Spirit when such fidelity does not exist, are deceitful and vain. 22. Meekness. See Note, Matt. v. 5. 1 Temperance. The word here used, (lyK.ga'Titci), means properly self-control, continence. It is derived from h and K^aTo?, strength, and has reference to the power or ascendancy which w^e have over exciting and evil passions of all kinds. It denotes the self-rule which a man has over the evil propensities of his nature. Our word temperance we use now in a much more limited sense, as referring mainly to abstinence from intoxicating drinks. But the word here used is employed in a much more extended signification. It includes the dominion over all evil propensities, and may denote continence, chastity, self- government, moderation in regard to all indulgences as well as abstkience from intoxicating drinks. See the word explained in the Notes on Acts xxiv. 25. The sense here is, that the influ- ences of the Holy Spirit on the heart make a man moderate in all indul- gences ; teach him to restrain his pas- sions, and to govern himself; to control his evil propensities, and to subdue all inordinate affection. The Christian will not only abstain from intoxicating drinks, but from all exciting passions ; he will be temperate in his manner of living, and in the government cf hia temper. This may be applied to tem- perance properly so called with us ; but f86 GALATIANS. rA.-D 58 24 And they that are Christ's have crucified the flesh with the * affections and lusts. or, passions. a Ro. 8. 4, 5. b Ph. 2. 3. It should not be limited to that. A Christian must be a temperate man ; and if the effect of his religion is not to produce this, it is false and vain. Abstinence from intoxicating drinks, as well as from all improper excitement, is demanded by the very genius of his re- ligion, and on this subject there is no danger of drawing the cords too close. No man was ever injured by the strict- est temperance, by total abstinence from ardent spirits, and from wine as a bever- age ; no man is certainly safe who does not abstain ; no man, it is believed, can be in a proper frame of mind for reli- gious duties who indulges in the habit- ual use of intoxicating drinks. No- thing does more scandal to religion than such indulgences; and, other things being equal, he is the most under the influence of the Spirit of God who is the most thoroughly a man of temper- ance. If Against such there is no law. That is, there is no law to con- demn such persons. These are not the things which the law denounces. These, therefore, are the true freemen ; free from the condemning sentence of the law, and fre»? in the service of God. Law condemns sin ; and they who evince the spirit here referred to are free from its denunciations. 24. And they that are Chrisfs. All who are true Christians, t Have crucified the flesh. The corrupt pas- sions of the soul have been put to death ; i. e. destroyed. They are as though they were dead, and have no power over us. See Note, ch. ii. 20. 1 With the affections. Marg. Pas- sions. All corrupt desires, 'i And lusts. See Note, Rom. i. 24. 25. If we live in the Spirit. Note, ver. 16. The sense of this verse pro- bably is, * "We who are Christians profess to be under the influences of the Holy Spirit. By his influences and agency 25 If " we live in the Spirit let us also walk in the Spirit. 26 Let * us not be desirous of vain glory, provoking one an- other, envying one another. is our spiritual life. We profess not to be under the dominion of the flesh; not to be controlled by its appetites and desires. Let us then act in this man- ner, and as if we believed this. Let us yield ourselves to his influences, and show that we are controlled by that Spirit.' It is an earnest exhortation to Christians to yield wholly to the agency of the Holy Spirit on their hearts, and to submit to his guidance. See Notes, Rom. viii. 5. 9. 26. Let us not be desirous of vain- glory. The word here used (ttmSo^oi) means, proud or vain of empty advan- tages, as of birth, property, eloquence, or learning. The reference here is probably to the paltry competitions which arose on account of these sup- posed advantages. It is possible that this might have been one cause of the diflSculties existing in the churches of Galatia, and the apostle is anxious wholly to check and remove it. The Jews prided themselves on their birth, and men are everywhere prone to over- value the supposed advantages of birth and blood. The doctrines of Paul are, that in great and most vital respects men are on a level ; that these things con- tribute nothing to salvation (Notes, ch. iii. 28) ; and that Christians should esteem them of little importance, and that they should not be suffered to interfere with their fellowship, or to mar their harmony and peace, t Provoking one another. The sense is, that they who are desirous of vainglory, do pro- voke one another. They provoke those whom they regard as inferiors by a haughty carriage and a contemptuous manner towards them. They look upon them often with contempt ; pass them by with disdain; treat them as beneath their notice ; and this provokes on the other hand hard feeling, an others the discipline of the church Every man who has any proper feelings, when he attempts to recover an erring brother should pray for him and for himself also ; and will regard his duty as only half done, and that very im- perfectly, if he does not " consider also that he himself may be tempted." 2. Bear ye one another's burdens. See Note, Rom. xv. 1. Bear with each other ; help each other in the divine life. The sense is, that every man has peculiar temptations and easily besetting sins, which constitute a heavy burden. We should aid each other in regard to these, and help one another to overcome them. t And so fulfil the law of Christ The peculiar law of Christ, requiring us to love one another. See Note on John xiii. 34. This was the distinguish- ing law of the Redeemer ; and they could in no way better fulfil it than by aiding each other in the divine life. The law of Christ would not allow us to reproach the offender, or to taunt him, or to re- joice in his fall. We should help him to take up his load of infirmities, and sustain him by our counsels, our exhort- ations, and our prayers. Christians, conscious of their infirmities, have a right to the sympathy and the prayers of their brethren. They should not be cast off to a cold and heartless world ; a world rejoicing over their fall, and ready to brand them as hypocrites. They should be pressed to the warm bosom of brotherly kindness ; and prayer should be made to ascend without ceas- ing around an erring and a fallen bro- ther. Is this the case in regard to all who bear the Christian name ? 3. For if a man think himself to be something, &c. See ch. v. 26. This is designed, evidently, to be another reason why we should be kind and ten- der to those who have erred. It is, that 360 GALATIANS. [A. D. 68. he is nothing, he deceiveth him- self. 4 But let every man prove a2Co. 13. 5. even those v/ho are most confident may fall. They who feel secure, and think It impossible that they should sin, are not safe. They may be wholly de- jeiAcd, and may be nothing, when they have the highest estimate of themselves. They may themselves fall into sin, and have need of all the sympathy and kindness of their brethren. Tf When he is nothing. When he has no strength, and no moral worth. When he is not such as he apprehends, but is Ufted up with vain self-conceit. Tf He deceiveth himself. He understands not his own character. "The worst part of the fraud falls on his own head." — Doddridge. He does not accomplish what he expected to ; and instead of acquiring reputation from others, as he expected, he renders himself contempti- ble in their sight. 4. Bui let every man prove. That IB, try or examine in a proper manner. Let him form a proper estimate of what is due to himself, according to his real character. Let him compare himself with the word of God, and the infallible rule which he has given, and by which we are to be judged in the last great day. Comp. Note, Rom. xii. 3. 1 Cor. xi. 28. 2 Cor. xiii. 5. ^ His own loork. What he does. Let him form n fair and impartial estimate of his own character. 1[ And then shall he have rejoicing. That is, he will be appro- priately rewarded, and will meet with no disappointment. The man who forms an improper estimate of his own character will be sure to be disappoint- ed. The man who examines himself, and who forms no extravagant expecta- tion in regard to what is due to himself, will be appropriately rewarded, and will be made happy. If, by the careful ex- amination of himself, he finds his life to be virtuous, and his course of conduct pure ; if he has done no wrong to othei^, and if he finds evidence that he is a child of God, then he will have " his own work, and then shall he have rejoicing in himself * alone, and not in another : b Pr. 14. 14. cause of rejoicing. \ In himself alcme, Comp. Prov. xiv. 14 : "A good man shall be satisfied from himself." The sentiment is, that he will find in himself a source of pure joy. He will not be dependent on the applause of others for happiness. In an approving conscience; in the evidence of the favour of God ; in an honest effort to lead a pure and holy life, he will have happiness. The source of his joys will be within ; and he will not be dependent, as the man cf ambition, and the man who thinks o." himself more highly than he ought, will, on the favours of a capricious multitude, and on the breath of popular applause. t And not in another. He will not be dependent on others for happiness. Here is the true secret of happiness. It consists, (1.) In not forming an im- proper estimate of ourselves ; in know- ing just what we are, and what is due to us ; in not thinking ourselves to be something, when we are nothing. (2.) In leading such a life that it may be ex- amined to the core, that we may know exactly what we are without being dis- tressed or pained. That is, in having a good conscience, and in the honest and faithful discharge of our duty to God and man. (3.) In not being dependent on the fickle applause of the world for our comfort. The man who has no in- ternal resources, and who has no approv- ing conscience ; who is happy only when others smile, and miserable when they frown, is a man who can have no secu- rity for enjoyment. The man who has a good conscience, and who enjoys the favour of God, and the hope of heaven, carries with him the source of perpeiuai joy. He cannot be deprived of it. His purse may be taken, and his house rob- bed, but the highwayman cannot rob him of his confforts. He carries with him an unfailing source of happiness when abroad, and the same source, of happiness abides with him at home ; ha bears it into society, and it remains vnth A. D. 58.] CHAPTER VI shall bear 391 5 For every man his own burden. 6 Let " him that is taught in a 1 Co. 9. 11—14. him in solitiide ; it is his companion when in health, and when surrounded by his friends, and it is no less his companion when his friends leave him, and when he lies upon a bed of death. 5. For every man shall bear his own burden. This seems to be a kind of proverbial saying; and it means here, every man shall have his proper reward. If he is a virtuous man, he will be hap- py ; if a vicious man, he will be misera- ble. If a virtuous man, he will have the source of happiness in himself; if a sinner, he must bear the proper pe- nalty of his sin. In the great day every man shall be properly rewarded. Knowing this, we should be little anx- ious about the sentiments of others, and should seek to maintain a good con- science towards God and man. The design of this passage is, to pnpvent men from forming an improper estimate of themselves, and of the opinions of others. Let a man feel that he is soon to stand at the judgment scat, and it will do much to keep him from an im- proper estimate of his own importance ; let him feel that he must give an account to God, and that his great interests are to be determined by the estimate which God will affix to his character, and it will teach him that the opinion of the world is of little value. This will re- strain his vanity and ambition. This will show him that the great business of life is to secure the favour of God, and to be prepared to give up his account ; and there is noway so effectual of check- ing ambition, and subduing vanity and the love of applause, as to feel that we are soon to stand at the awful bar of God. 6. Let him that is taught in the word. In the word of God; i. e. the gospel. ^ Communicate unto him. Let him share with him who teaches ; let there be a common participation of all good things, t I^ o-ll good things. In every thing that is needful for their the word communicate unto him that teacheth in all good things. 7 Be not deceived; God is not mocked : for whatsoever a man comfortable subsistence. On the duty here enjoined, see Notes on 1 Cor. ix 11—13. 7. Be not deceived. That is, in re gard to your character, and your hopes for eternity. This is a formula of in- troduction to some admonition that is peculiarly weighty and important It implies that there was danger that they would be deceived in reference to theii character. The sources of the danger were the corruption of their own hearts, the difficulty of knowing their true character, the instructions of false teachers, &c. See Note on 1 Cor. vi. 9. Tf God is not mocked. He can- not be imposed on, or mocked. He knows what our real character is, and he will judge us accordingly. The word rendered mocked (/uuitni^l^u)), means, properly, to turn up the nose in scorn ; hence to mock, or deride, or in- sult. The sense is, that God could not be imposed on, or could not be insulted with impunity, or successfully. To mock is, properly, (1.) To imitate, to mimic ; to imitate in contempt or deri- sion. (2.) To deride, to laugh at, to ridicule. (3.) To defeat, or to illude, or to disappoint (4.) To fool, to tan- talize. — Webster. Here it cannot mean to imitate, or to mimic, but it refers to the principles of the divine administra- tion, and must mean that they could not be treated with contempt, or suc- cessfully evaded. They could not hope to illude or impose on God. His principles of government were set- tled, and they could not Impose on him. To what the reference is here, is not perfectly plain. In the connexion in which it stands, it seems to refer to the support of the ministers of the gospel ; and Paul introduces the general princi- ple, that as a man sows he will reap, to show them what will be the effect of a liberal and proper use of their property. If they made a proper use of it ; if they 393 GALATIANS. [A.D. 58 sowetb, that shall he also reap. 8 For he that soweth to his ■ flesh shall of the flesh reap oJob. 4. 8. Pr. 22. 8. Ho. 8. 7. employed it for benevolent purposes ; if they appropriated what they should to the support of religion, they would reap accordingly. God could not be imposed on in regard to this. They could not make him think that they had true re- ligion when they were sowing to the flesh, and when they were spending their money in purchasing pleasure, and in luxury and vanity. No zeal, how- ever ardent ; no prayers, however fervent or long ; no professions, however loud, would impose on God. And to make such prayers, and to manifest such zeal and such strong professions, while the heart was with the world, and they were spending their money for every thing else but religion, was mocking God. Alas, how much mockery of God like this still prevails ! How much, when men seem disposed to make God believe that they are exceedingly zealous and devoted, while their heart is truly with the world! How many long prayers are offered ; how much zeal is shown; how many warm professions are made, as if to make God and man believe that the heart was truly engaged in the cause of religion, while little or nothing is given in the cause of benevo- lence ; while the ministers of religion are suffered to starve ; and while the " loud professor" rolls in wealth, and is distinguished for luxury of living, for gayety of apparel, for splendour of equip- age, and for extravagance in parties of pleasure! Such professors attempt to mock God. They are really sowing to the flesh ; and of the flesh they must reap corruption. If For whatsoever a man soweth, &c. See Note, 2 Cor. ix. 6. This figure is taken from agriculture. A man who sows wheat, shall reap wheat ; he who sows barley, shall reap barley ; he who sows cockle, shall reap cockle. Every kind of grain will pro- duce grain like itself. So it is in regard to our works. He who is liberal, shall be dealt with liberally ; he who is right- corruption ; but he that soweth to the Spirit, * shall of the Spirit reap life everlasting. 6Pr. 11. 18. Ja. 3.18. eous, shall be rewarded ; he who is a sinner, shall reap according to his deeds. 8. For he that soweth to his flesh. That makes provision for the indulgence of fleshly appetites and passions. See Notes on ch. v. 19—21. He who makes use of his property to give indul- gence to licentiousness, intemperance, and vanity. ^ Shall of the flesh. From the flesh, or as that which indul- gence in fleshly appetites properly pro- duces. Punishment, under the divine government, is commonly in the line of offences. The punishment of licen- tiousness and intemperance in this life is commonly loathsome and offensive disease ; and, when long indulged, the sensualist becomes haggard, and bloated and corrupted, and sinks into the grave Such, also, is often the punishment o^ luxurious Uving, of a pampered appetite, of gluttony, as well as of intemperate drinking. But if the punishment does not follow in this life, it will be sure to overtake the sensualist in the world to come. There he shall reap ruin final and everlasting. \ Corruption. (1.) By disease. (2.) In the grave — the home to which the sensualist rapidly travels. (3.) In the world of wo. There all shall be corrupt. His virtue — even the semblance of virtue, shall all be gone. His understanding, will, fancy — his whole soul shall be debased and cor- rupt. No virtue will linger and live on the plains of ruin, but all shall be de- pravity and wo. Every thing in hell is debased and corrupt ; and the whole harvest of sensuality in this world and the world to come, is degradation and defilement. If But he that soweth to the Spirit. He who follows the lead- ings and cultivates the affections which the Holy Spirit would produce. See Notes on ch. v. 22, 23. 1 Shall of the Spirit. As the result of following the leadings of the Spirit. ^ Reap life everlasting. See Note on Rom. ii. 7. A. D. 58.] CHAPTER VI. 393 9 And let* us not be weary in | 10 As we have therefore op- well-doino- ; for in due season we i portunity, " let us do good unto shall reap, if a 1 Co. 15. 53. ' we faint not. 6 He. 10.36. Re. 2. 10. all " men, a Ec. 9. 10. especially to them b Mat. 5. 43. Tit. 3. 8. 9. And let us not be weary in well- doing. See Note on 1 Cor. xv. 58. The reference here is particularly to the support of the ministers of religion (ver. 6), but the apostle makes the exhortation general. Christians sometimes become weary. There is so much opposition to the best plans for doing good ; there is so much to be done ; there are so many calls on their time and their charities ; and there is often so much ingratitude among those whom they endeavour to benefit, that they become disheartened. Such Paul addresses, and exhorts them not to give over, but to persevere. If For in due season. At the day of judgment. Then we shall receive the full reward of all our self-denials and charities. ^ We shall reap, if we faint 7iof. If we do not give over, exhausted and disheartened. It is implied here, that unless a man perseveres in doing good to the end of life, he can hope for no reward. He who becomes disheart- ened, and who gives over his efforts ; he that is appalled by obstacles, and that faints on account of the embarrassments thrown in his way ; he that pines for ease, and withdraws from the field of benevolence, shows that he has no true attachment to the cause, and that his heart has never been truly in the work of religion. He who becomes a true Christian, becomes such fou EXEnif itt. He has enlisted, never to withdraw. He becomes pledged to do good and to serve God always. No obstacles are to deter, no embarrassments are to drive him from the field. With the vigour of his youth, and the wisdom and influ- ence of his riper years ; with his re- maining powers when enfeebled by age; with the last pulsation of life here, and with his immortal energies in a hiiJ^her world, he is to do good. For that he is to live. In that he is to die ; and when he awakes in the resurrection witn re- novated powers, he is to awake to an everlasting service of doing good, as far as he may have opportunity, in the kingdom of God. 10. As we have therefore opportuni- ty, let us do good unto all men. This is the true rule about doing good. " The opportunity to do good," says Cotton Mather, '• imposes the obligation to do it." The simple rule is, that we are fa- voured with the opportunity, and that we have the power. It is not that we are to do it when it is convenient; or when it will advance the interest of a party ; or when it may contribute to our fame ; the rule is, that we are to do it when we have the opportunity. No matter how often that occurs ; no mat- ter how many objects of benevolenca are presented — the more the better ; no matter how much self-denial it may cost us ; no matter how little fume we may get by it ; still, if we have the opportu nity to do good, we are to do it, and should be thankful for the privilege. And it is to be done to alt men. Not to our family only ; not to our party ; not to our neighbours ; not to those of our own colour ; not to those who live in the same land with us, but to all mankind. If we can reach and benefit a man who lives on the other side of the globe, whom we have never seen, and shall never see in this world or in the world to come, still We are to do him good. Such is Christianity. And in this, as in all other respects, it differs from the narrow and selfish spirit of clanship which prevails all over the world. ^ Especially. On the same principle that a man is bound particularly to benefit his own family and friend.s. In his large and expansive zeal for the world at large, he is not to forget or neglect them. He is to feel that they have pe- culiar claims on him. They are near him. They are bound to him by ten- der tics. They may be particularly de- pendent on him. Christianity does not relax the ties which bind us to our country, our family, and our frienda. 394 GALATIANS. [A D. 58 • who are of the household of faith. 11 Ye see how large a letter I a 1 Jno, 3. 14. It makes them more close and tender, and excites us more faithfully to dis- charge the duties which grow out of these relations. But, in addition to that, it excites us to do good to all men, and to bless the stranger as well as the friend ; the man who has a different colour from our own, as well as he who has the same ; the man who lives in another clime, as well as he who was born in the same country in which we live. ^ Of the household of faith. Christians are distinguished from other men primarily by their believing the gos- pel, and by its influence on their lives. 11. Ye see. This might be rendered see, in the imperative. fSo Tindal ren- ders it, " Behold." But it is more com- monly supposed that it should be ren- dered in the indicative. The sense is not materially different whichever trans- lation is adopted. The object of the apostle is, to direct their attention to the special proof of his love, which he had manifested in writing such a letter. 1 How large a letter. Considerable variety has existed in regard to the in- terpretation of this phrase. The word here used and translated how large (tthkiicoc), means, properly, how great. Some have supposed that it refers to the size of the letters which Paul made in writing the epistle — the length and crudeness of the characters which he used. Such interpreters suppose that he was not well versed in writing Greek, and that he used large letters, and those somewhat rudely made, like the Hebrew. So Doddridge and Whit- by interpret it ; and so Theodoret, Je- rome, Theophylact, and some others. He might not, says Doddridge, have been well versed in the Greek charac- ters ; or " this inaccuracy of his writings might have been owing to the infirmity or weakness of his nerves, which he had hinted at before." Jerome says, that Paul was a Hebrew, and that he was have written unto you with mine own hand. 12 As many as desire to make a fair show in the flesh, th,/ unacquainted with the mode of writing Greek letters ; and that because neces- sity demanded that he should write a letter in his own hand, contrary to hi3 usual custom, he was obliged to form his characters in this crude manner. According to this interpretation, it was, (1.) A pledge to the Galatians that the epistle was genuine, since it bore the marks of his own handwriting; and, (2.) It was proof of special affection for them that he was willing to undergo this labour on their account. Others suppose that he means to refer to the size of the epistle which he had written. Such is the interpretation of Grotius, Koppe, Bloomfield, Clarke, Locke, Chandler, and is, indeed, the common interpretation, as it is the obvious one. According to this, it was proof of special interest in them, and regard for them, that he had written to them a whole letter with his own hand. Usually he employed an amanuensis, and added his name, with a brief benediction or remark at the close. See Notes, Rom. xvi. 22. 1 Cor. xvi. 21. What induced him to depart from his usual custom here is unknown. Jerome supposes that he refers here to what follows from this verse to the end of the epistle, as that which he had written with his own hand, but the word lyga-^ct, says Rosen- miiller, refers rather to what he had v/ritten, than to that which he intended to write. On this verse, the reader may consult with advantage, Tholuck on the Life and Writings of Paul. German Se- lections, by Edwards and Park, Ando- ver, 1839, pp. 35. 64, 65. 12. As many as desire to make c fair show in the Jlesh. To be distin guished for their conformity to external rites and customs. To be known for their zeal in this cause. They sought to show their zeal by making converts, and by inducing others also to conform to those customs. Paul here refers A, D, 68.] CHAPTER VI. 395 constrain you to be circum- cised ; only lest they should suf- fer persecution for the cross of Christ. doubtless to the Jewish teachers, and he says that their main object was to evince their zeal in the observance of rites and ceremonies. ^ They constrain you. You who are Gentiles. They insist on circumcision as indispensable to salva- tion. H Only lest they should suffer persecution. It is not from any true love for the cause of religion. It is, that they may avoid persecution from ;hc Jews. If they should renounce the doctrine which taught that circum- cision was indispensable, they would be exposed to the rage of the Jews, and would suffer persecution. Rather than do this, they make a show "of great zeal in inducing others to be circum- cised. Tf For the cross of Christ. From attachment to the cause of a crucified Saviour. If they insisted on entire dependence on the merits of his blood, and renounced all dependance on rites and ceremonies, they would suffer persecution. This verse shows the true cause of the zeal which the Judaizing teachers evinced. It was the fear of persecution. It was the want of independence and boldness in maintaining the doctrine that men were to be saved only by the merits of the Lord Jesus. By attempting to blend together the doctrines of Judaism and Christianity ; by maintaining that the observance of the Jewish rites was necessary, and yet that Jesus was the Messiah, they endeavoured to keep in with both parties ; and thus to escape the opposition of the Jews. It was an unhallowed compromise. It was an attempt to blend things together which could not be united. One must really displace the other. If men depended on the rites of Moses, they had no need of dependence on the Messiah ; if they professed to depend on him, then to rely on any thing else was in fact to disown and reject him. Embracing 13 For neither they them- selves who are circumcised keep the law ; but desire to have you circumcised, that they may glory in your flesh. the one system was in fact renouncing the other. Such is the argument of Paul ; and such his solemn remon- strance against embracing any doctrine which would obscure the glory of simple dependence on the cross of Christ. 13. For neither they themselves who are circumcised. The Jewish teachers, or perhaps all Jews. It was true in general that the Jews did not wholly and entirely obey the law of Moses, but it is probable that the apostle refers particularly here to the Judaizing teachers in Galatia. f Keep the law. The law of Moses, or the law of God. Paul's idea is, that if they were circum- cised they brought themselves under obligation to keep the whole law of God. See Note, ch. v. 3. But they did not do it. (1.) No man perfectly observes the whole law of God. (2.^ The Jewish nation as such were very far from doing it. (3.) It is probable that these persons did not pretend even to keep the whole law of Moses. Paul insists on it that if they were circum- cised, and depended on that for salva- tion, they were under obligation to keep the whole law. But they did not. Probably they did not offer sacri- fice, or jom in any of the numerous observances of the Jewish nation, ex- cept some of the more prominent, such as circumcision. This, says Paul, is inconsistent in the highest degree ; and they thus show their insincerity and hypocrisy, t That they may glory in your Jlesh. In having you as converts, and in persuading you to be circum- cised, that they may show their zeal for the law and thus escape persecu- tion. The phrase " in your flesh'* here, is equivalent to < in your circum- cision;' making use of your circum- cision to promote their own importance, and to save themselves from persecution. i96 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 14 But " God forbid that I i whom «ho«ld glory, save in the cross of our Lord Jesus Christ, * by 14. But God forbid. Note, Rom. iii. 4. * For me it is not to glory ex- cept in the cross of Christ.' The objf.d of Paul here is evidently to place himself in contrast with the Judaizing teachers, and to show his de- termined purpose to glory in nothing else but the cross of Christ. Well they knew that he had as much occa- sion for glorying in the things pertain- ing to the flesh-, or in the observance of external rites and customs, as any of them. He had been circumcised. He had had all the advantages of accurate training in the knowledge of the Jewish law. He had entered on life with un- common advantages. He had evinced a zeal that was not surpassed by any of them ; and his life, so far as conformity to the religion in which he had been trained was concerned, was blameless. Phil. iii. 4 — 8. This must have been to a great extent known to the Gala- tians ; and by placing his own conduct in strong contrast with that of the Judaizing teachers, and showing that ?ie had no ground of confidence in him- self, he designed to bring back the minds of the Galatians to simple de- pendence on the cross. ^ That I should glory. That I should boast ; or that I should rely on any thing else. Others glory in their conformity to the laws of Moses ; others in their zeal, or their talents, or their learning, or their orthodoxy ; others in their wealth, or their accomplishments ; others in their family alliances, and their birth ; but the supreme boast and glorying of a Christian is in the cross of Christ. J In the cross of our Lord Jesus Christ. In Jesus the crucified Messiah. It is a subject of rejoicing and glorying that we have such a Saviour. The world looked upon him with contempt ; and the cross was a stumbling block to the Jew, and folly to the Greek. Notes, 1 Cor. i. 23. But to the Christian, tha* cross is the subject of glorying. It is so '' unto me, a Ph. 3. 3, 7, 8, the world is crucified and I unto the world. « or, whereby. b c. 2. 20. because, (1.) Of the love of him who suffered there ; (2.) Of the purity and holiness of his character, for the inno- cent died there for the guilty ; (3.) Of the honour there put on the law of God by his dying to maintain it unsullied ; (4.) Of the reconciliation there made for sin, accomplishing what could ha done by no other oblation, and by no power of man ; (5.) Of the pardon there procured for the guilty ; (6.) Of the fact that through it we become dead to the world, and are made alive to God ; (7.) Of the support and consolation which goes from that cross to sustain us in trial ; and, (8.) Of the fact that it procured for us admission into heaven, a title to the world of glory. All is glory around the cross. It was a glo- rious Saviour who died ; it was glorious love that led Lim to die ; it was a glo- rious object to redeem a world ; and ii is unspeakable glory to which he will raise lost and ruined sinners by his death. O who would not glory in such a Saviour! compared with this, what trifles are all the objects in which men usually boast ! And what a lesson is here furnished to the true Christian ! Let us not boast of our wealth. It will soon leave us, or we shall be taken from it, and it can aid us little in the great matters that are before us. It will not ward oflf disease ; it will not enable us to bear pain ; it will not smooth the couch of death ; it will not save the soul. Let us not glory in our strength, for it will soon fail ; in our beauty, for we shall soon be undistinguished in the corruptions of the tomb; in our accomplishments, for they will not save us ; in our learning, for it is not that by which we can be brought to heaven. But let us glory that we have for a Saviour the eternal Son of God — that glorious Being who was adored by the inhabitants of heaven ; who made the worlds; who is pure, and lovely, and most holy and who has undertaken A. D. 58.] CHAPTER VI. 397 15 For * in Christ Jesus nei- ther circumcision availeth any thing, nor uncircumcision, but a * new creature. ac.5.6. 6 2Co. 5. 17. c Ps. 125. 5. our cause and died to save us. I de- sire no higher honour than to be saved by ttie Son of God. It is the exaltation of my nature, and shows me more than any thing else its true dignity, that one so great and glorious sought my redemption. That cannot be an object of temporary value which he sought by coming from heaven, and if there is any object of real magnitude in this world, it is the soul which the eternal Son of God died to redeem. •J Bi/ whom the world is crucified unto me, &c. See Notes on ch. ii. 20. 15. For in Christ Jesus. In his re- ligion. See Note on ch. v. 6. ^ But a new creature. The fact that a man is created anew, or born again, consti- tutes the real difference between him and other men. This is what Christ requires ; this is the distinction which he designs to make. It is not by con- formity to certain rites and customs khat a man is to be accepted ; it is not by elevated rank, or by wealth, or oeauty, or blood ; it is not by the colour of the complexion ; but the grand in- quiry is, whether a man is born again, and is in fact a new creature in Christ Jesus. See Note on 2 Cor. v. 17, for an explanation of the phrase " a new creature." 16. And as many as walk. As many as live, for so the word walk is used in the Scriptures, t According to this rule. Gr. This canon. See the word explained in the Notes on 2 Cor. X. 13. f Peace be on them. See Note, Rom. xv. 33. ^ And upon the Israel of God. The true church of God ; all who are his true worship- pers. See Notes on Rom. ii. 28, 29 ; ix. 6. 17. From henceforth. For the re- maining time ; that is, during the re- mainder of my life. ^ Let no man trouble me. This implies that he had 34 16 And as many as walk ac- cording to this rule, peace * be on them, and mercy, and upon the Israel of God. 17 From henceforth let no had trouble of some kind, and he earn- estly desires that he may have no more. What particular trouble he here refers to, is not certainly known, and com- mentators have not been agreed. It seems to me that the connexion re- quires us to understand it of the mo- lestation which he had had in regard to his call to the apostolic office, and his authority to explain and defend the religion of the Redeemer. This had been one principal subject of this epis- tle. His authority had been called in question. He had felt it necessary to go into a vindication of it. His in- structions had been departed from on the ground that he was not one of tno original apostles, and that he differerf from others. See ch. i. 11. Hence all the anxiety and trouble which he had had in regard to their departure from the doctrines which he had taught them. He closes the whole subject of the epistle by this tender and affecting language, the sense of which has been well expressed by CreUius. 'I have shown my apostolic authority, and proved that I am commissioned by the Lord Jesus. I have stated and vindi- cated the great doctrine of justification by faith, and shown that the Mosaic law is not necessarily binding. On these points may I have no more trou- ble. I have enough for my nature to bear of other kinds. I bear in my body the impressive proofs that I am an apostle, and the sufferings that re- quire all my fortitude to sustain them. These marks, received in the service of the Lord Jesus, and so strongly re- sembling those which he himself re- ceived, prove that I am truly engaged in his cause, and am commissioned by him. These wounds and sorrows are so many, that I have need of the kind- ness and prayers of Christians rather than to be compelled to vindicate my S98 GALATIANS. [A. D. 58 man trouble me ; for • I bear in my body the marks of the Lord Jesus. c Col. 1.24. 6 2 Ti. 4.22. Phil. 8. 25. self, and to rebuke them for their own wanderings.' t For I bear in my body the marks of the Lord Jesus. The word here rendered " marks" (a-riy- uATu), means properly the marks or brands which are pricked or burnt in upon the body. So slaves were some- times branded by their masters to pre- vent their escape; and so devotees to an idol god sometimes caused to be im- pressed on themselves the name or image of the divinity which they adored. Herodotus (ii. 113) mentions a temple of Hercules in Egypt in which if any slave took refuge, and had the sacred brands or marks impressed on him (a'Tiy/ueL'Ta) he thereby devoted himself to the god, and it was not lawful for any one to injure him. Many have supposed that Paul here says, in allu- sion to such a custom, that he had the name of the Redeemer impressed on his body, and that he regarded himself as devoted to him and his cause. It seems to me that by these marks or brands he refers to the weak which he had received in his body ; the marks of stripes and sufferings which he en- dured in the service of the Redeemer. Comp. 2 Cor. xi. 24, 25. He had re- peatedly been scourged. He bore the marks of that on his person now. They were the evidences that he was devoted to the Saviour. He had re- ceived them in his cause ; and they were the proofs that he belonged to the Lord Jesus. He had suffered for him, and had suffered much. Having thus suffered, and having thus the evi- dence that he belonged to the Saviour, and having by his sufferings given ample proof of that to others, he asks to be freed from further molestation. Some had in their body the marks of circumcision, the evidence that they were disciples of the law of Moses ; others had perhaps in their persons the image and name of an idol to which 18 Brethren, the * grace of our Lord Jesus Christ be with your spirit. Amen. Unto the Galatians, written from Rome. they were devoted ; but the marks which he bore were the weak which he had received by being again and again whipped publicly in the cause of the Redeemer. To that Redeemer, therefore, he felt himself united, and from that attachment he would not allow himself to be diverted. How often has an old soldier shown his scars with pride and exultation as a proof of his attachment to his country ! Numerous scars ; the loss of an arm, an eye, or a leg, are thus the much- valued and vaunted pledges of attach- ment to Uberty, and a passport to the confidence of every man who loves his country. 'I prize this wound,' said Lafayette, when struck in the foot by a musket ball at Germantown, * as among the most valued of my honours.' So Paul felt in regard to the scourges which he had received in the cause of the Lord Jesus. They were his boast and his glory ; the pledge that he had been engaged in the cause of the Sa- viour, and a passport to all who loved the Son of God. Christians now arc not subjected to such stripes and scourgings. But let us have some marks of our attachment to the Lord Jesus. By a holy life ; by self-denial ; by subdued animal affections ; by zeal in the cause of truth ; by an imitation of the Lord Jesus ; and by the marks of suffering in our body, if we should be called to it, let us have some evi- dence that we are his, and be able to say when we look on death and eter- nity, * we bear with us the evidence that we belong to the Son of God.* To us that will be of more value than any ribbon or star indicating elevated rank ; more valuable than a ducal coro- net ; more valuable than the brightest jewel that ever sparkled on the brow of royalty. 18. Brethren, the gracey &c. Set Note, Rom. xvi. 20. Date Due ^1 ,, ■ . ■*-■ -i-^^^^^^^^^^B m ^m^'^^^^""'^ ^^mmmmm JL ^iift^^^^^ ^ MilY f "i A ir ray 1 1 ' A.M.